]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
Implement catch syscall group
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2662 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2663 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2664 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2665 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2666 information on convenience variables.
2667
2668 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2669 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2670 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2671 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2672 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2673 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2674
2675 @table @code
2676 @kindex add-inferior
2677 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2678 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2679 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2680 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2681 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2682 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2683
2684 @kindex clone-inferior
2685 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2686 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2687 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2688 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2689 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2690
2691 @smallexample
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2695 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2696 Added inferior 2.
2697 1 inferiors added.
2698 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2699 Num Description Executable
2700 2 <null> helloworld
2701 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2702 @end smallexample
2703
2704 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2705
2706 @kindex remove-inferiors
2707 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2708 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2709 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2710 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2711
2712 @end table
2713
2714 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2715 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2716 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2717 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2721 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2723 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2724 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2725 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2726
2727 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2730 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2731 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2732 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2736 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2737 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2738 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2739
2740
2741 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2742 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex set print inferior-events
2746 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2747 @item set print inferior-events
2748 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2749 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2750 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2751 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2752 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2753 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2754
2755 @kindex show print inferior-events
2756 @item show print inferior-events
2757 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2758 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2759 @end table
2760
2761 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2762 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2763 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2764
2765
2766 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2767 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2768 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2769 info program-spaces}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2773 @item maint info program-spaces
2774 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2775 @value{GDBN}.
2776
2777 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2778
2779 @enumerate
2780 @item
2781 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2782
2783 @item
2784 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2785 the @code{file} command.
2786
2787 @end enumerate
2788
2789 @noindent
2790 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2791 indicates the current program space.
2792
2793 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2794 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2795 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2796
2797 @smallexample
2798 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2799 Id Executable
2800 * 1 hello
2801 2 goodbye
2802 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2803 @end smallexample
2804
2805 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2806 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2807 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2808 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2809 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2813 Id Executable
2814 * 1 vfork-test
2815 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2819 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2820 @end table
2821
2822 @node Threads
2823 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2824
2825 @cindex threads of execution
2826 @cindex multiple threads
2827 @cindex switching threads
2828 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2829 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2830 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2831 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2832 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2833 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2834 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2835
2836 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2837 programs:
2838
2839 @itemize @bullet
2840 @item automatic notification of new threads
2841 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2842 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2843 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2844 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2845 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2846 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2847 messages on thread start and exit.
2848 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2849 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2850 isn't compatible with the program.
2851 @end itemize
2852
2853 @cindex focus of debugging
2854 @cindex current thread
2855 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2856 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2857 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2858 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2859 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2860
2861 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2862 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2863 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2864 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2865 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2866 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2867 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2868 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2869 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2870 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2871
2872 @smallexample
2873 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2874 @end smallexample
2875
2876 @noindent
2877 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2878 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2879 further qualifier.
2880
2881 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2882 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2883 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2884 @c program?
2885 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2886 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2887 @c threads ab initio?
2888
2889 @anchor{thread numbers}
2890 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2891 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2892 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2893 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2894 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2895 between threads of different inferiors.
2896
2897 @cindex qualified thread ID
2898 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2899 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2900 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2901 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2902 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2903 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2904 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2905 inferior.
2906
2907 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2908 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2909 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2910 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2911
2912 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2913 @cindex thread ID lists
2914 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2915 argument. A list element can be:
2916
2917 @enumerate
2918 @item
2919 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2920 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2921 @samp{1}.
2922
2923 @item
2924 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2925 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2926 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2927
2928 @item
2929 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2930 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2931 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2932 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2933 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2934
2935 @end enumerate
2936
2937 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2938 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2939 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2940 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2941 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2942 7.1}.
2943
2944
2945 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2946 @cindex global thread number
2947 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2948 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2949 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2950 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2951 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2952 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2953
2954 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2955 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2956 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2957
2958 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2959 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2960 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2961 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2962 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2963 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2964 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2965 general information on convenience variables.
2966
2967 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2968 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2969 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2970
2971 @smallexample
2972 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2973 @end smallexample
2974
2975 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2976
2977 @smallexample
2978 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2979 @end smallexample
2980
2981 @table @code
2982 @kindex info threads
2983 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2984
2985 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2986 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2987 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2988 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2989
2990 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2991
2992 @enumerate
2993 @item
2994 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2995
2996 @item
2997 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
2998 option was specified
2999
3000 @item
3001 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3002
3003 @item
3004 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3005 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3006 program itself.
3007
3008 @item
3009 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3010 @end enumerate
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3014 indicates the current thread.
3015
3016 For example,
3017 @end table
3018 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3019
3020 @smallexample
3021 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3022 Id Target Id Frame
3023 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3024 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3025 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3026 at threadtest.c:68
3027 @end smallexample
3028
3029 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3030 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3031 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3032
3033 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3034 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3038 Id GId Target Id Frame
3039 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3040 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3041 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3042 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3046 Solaris-specific command:
3047
3048 @table @code
3049 @item maint info sol-threads
3050 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3051 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3052 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3053 @end table
3054
3055 @table @code
3056 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3057 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3058 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3059 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3060 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3061 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3062
3063 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3064 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3065
3066 @smallexample
3067 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3068 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3069 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3070 8 printf ("hello\n");
3071 @end smallexample
3072
3073 @noindent
3074 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3075 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3076 threads.
3077
3078 @kindex thread apply
3079 @cindex apply command to several threads
3080 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3081 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3082 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3083 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3084 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3085 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3086 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3087 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3088
3089
3090 @kindex thread name
3091 @cindex name a thread
3092 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3093 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3094 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3095 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3096
3097 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3098 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3099 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3100 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3101 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3102
3103 @kindex thread find
3104 @cindex search for a thread
3105 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3106 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3107 matches the supplied regular expression.
3108
3109 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3110 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3111 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3112 is the LWP id.
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3116 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3117 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3120 @end smallexample
3121
3122 @kindex set print thread-events
3123 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3124 @item set print thread-events
3125 @itemx set print thread-events on
3126 @itemx set print thread-events off
3127 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3128 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3129 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3130 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3131 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3132
3133 @kindex show print thread-events
3134 @item show print thread-events
3135 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3136 have started and exited.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3140 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3141 programs with multiple threads.
3142
3143 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3144 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3145
3146 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3149 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3150 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3151 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3152 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3153 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3154 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3155 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3156 macro.
3157
3158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3159 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3160 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3161 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3162 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3163 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3164
3165 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3166 refers to the default system directories that are
3167 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3168 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3169 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3170
3171 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3172 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3173 was loaded in the inferior process.
3174
3175 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3176 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3177 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3178 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3179 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3180 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3181 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3182
3183 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3184 only on some platforms.
3185
3186 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3187 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3188 Display current libthread_db search path.
3189
3190 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3191 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3192 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3193 @item set debug libthread-db
3194 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3195 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3196 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 @node Forks
3200 @section Debugging Forks
3201
3202 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3203 @cindex multiple processes
3204 @cindex processes, multiple
3205 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3206 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3207 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3208 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3209 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3210 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3211 will cause it to terminate.
3212
3213 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3214 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3215 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3216 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3217 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3218 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3219 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3220 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3221 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3222 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3223
3224 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3225 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3226 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3227 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3228
3229 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3230 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3231 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3232
3233 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3234 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3235
3236 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3237 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3238
3239 @table @code
3240 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3241 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3242 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3243 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3244 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3245
3246 @table @code
3247 @item parent
3248 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3249 unimpeded. This is the default.
3250
3251 @item child
3252 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3253 unimpeded.
3254
3255 @end table
3256
3257 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3258 @item show follow-fork-mode
3259 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3260 @end table
3261
3262 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3263 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3264 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3265
3266 @table @code
3267 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3268 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3269 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3270 retain debugger control over them both.
3271
3272 @table @code
3273 @item on
3274 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3275 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3276 independently. This is the default.
3277
3278 @item off
3279 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3280 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3281 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3282 is held suspended.
3283
3284 @end table
3285
3286 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3287 @item show detach-on-fork
3288 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3289 @end table
3290
3291 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3292 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3293 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3294 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3295 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3296 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3297
3298 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3299 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3300 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3301 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3302 and Programs}.
3303
3304 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3305 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3306 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3307 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3308 the child process's @code{main}.
3309
3310 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3311 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3312
3313 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3314 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3315 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3316 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3317 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3318 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3319 command.
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3323 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3324
3325 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3326 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3327
3328 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3329
3330 @table @code
3331 @item new
3332 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3333 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3334 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3335 original inferior.
3336
3337 For example:
3338
3339 @smallexample
3340 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3341 (gdb) info inferior
3342 Id Description Executable
3343 * 1 <null> prog1
3344 (@value{GDBP}) run
3345 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3346 Program exited normally.
3347 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3348 Id Description Executable
3349 1 <null> prog1
3350 * 2 <null> prog2
3351 @end smallexample
3352
3353 @item same
3354 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3355 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3356 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3357 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3358 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3359
3360 For example:
3361
3362 @smallexample
3363 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3364 Id Description Executable
3365 * 1 <null> prog1
3366 (@value{GDBP}) run
3367 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3368 Program exited normally.
3369 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3370 Id Description Executable
3371 * 1 <null> prog2
3372 @end smallexample
3373
3374 @end table
3375 @end table
3376
3377 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3378 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3379
3380 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3381 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3382 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3383
3384 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3385 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3386
3387 @cindex checkpoint
3388 @cindex restart
3389 @cindex bookmark
3390 @cindex snapshot of a process
3391 @cindex rewind program state
3392
3393 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3394 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3395 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3396 later.
3397
3398 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3399 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3400 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3401 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3402 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3403
3404 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3405 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3406 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3407 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3408 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3409 start again from there.
3410
3411 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3412 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3413
3414 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3415
3416 @table @code
3417 @kindex checkpoint
3418 @item checkpoint
3419 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3420 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3421 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3422
3423 @kindex info checkpoints
3424 @item info checkpoints
3425 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3426 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3427 listed:
3428
3429 @table @code
3430 @item Checkpoint ID
3431 @item Process ID
3432 @item Code Address
3433 @item Source line, or label
3434 @end table
3435
3436 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3437 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3438 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3439 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3440 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3441 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3442 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3443
3444 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3445 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3446 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3447 the debugger.
3448
3449 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3450 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3451 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3452
3453 @end table
3454
3455 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3456 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3457 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3458 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3459 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3460 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3461 previously read data can be read again.
3462
3463 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3464 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3465 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3466 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3467 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3468 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3469
3470 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3471 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3472 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3473 different execution path this time.
3474
3475 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3476 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3477 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3478 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3479 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3480 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3481 potentially pose a problem.
3482
3483 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3484
3485 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3486 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3487 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3488 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3489 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3490 next.
3491
3492 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3493 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3494 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3495 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3496 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3497
3498 @node Stopping
3499 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3500
3501 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3502 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3503 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3504
3505 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3506 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3507 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3508 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3509 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3510 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3511 explicitly request this information at any time.
3512
3513 @table @code
3514 @kindex info program
3515 @item info program
3516 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3517 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3518 @end table
3519
3520 @menu
3521 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3522 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3523 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3524 Skipping over functions and files
3525 * Signals:: Signals
3526 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3527 @end menu
3528
3529 @node Breakpoints
3530 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3531
3532 @cindex breakpoints
3533 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3534 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3535 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3536 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3537 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3538 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3539 program.
3540
3541 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3542 the executable is run.
3543
3544 @cindex watchpoints
3545 @cindex data breakpoints
3546 @cindex memory tracing
3547 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3548 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3549 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3550 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3551 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3552 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3553 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3554 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3555 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3556 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3557 same commands.
3558
3559 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3560 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3561 Automatic Display}.
3562
3563 @cindex catchpoints
3564 @cindex breakpoint on events
3565 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3566 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3567 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3568 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3569 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3570 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3571 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3572
3573 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3574 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3575 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3576 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3577 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3578 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3579 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3580 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3581 enable it again.
3582
3583 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3584 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3585 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3586 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3587 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3588 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3589 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3590
3591 @menu
3592 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3593 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3594 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3595 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3596 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3597 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3598 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3599 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3600 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3601 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3602 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3603 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3604 @end menu
3605
3606 @node Set Breaks
3607 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3608
3609 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3610 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3611 @c
3612 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3613
3614 @kindex break
3615 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3616 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3617 @cindex latest breakpoint
3618 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3619 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3620 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3621 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3622 convenience variables.
3623
3624 @table @code
3625 @item break @var{location}
3626 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3627 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3628 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3629 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3630 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3631
3632 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3633 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3634 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3635 that situation.
3636
3637 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3638 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3639 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3640
3641 @item break
3642 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3643 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3644 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3645 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3646 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3647 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3648 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3649 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3650 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3651 inside loops.
3652
3653 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3654 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3655 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3656 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3657 existed when your program stopped.
3658
3659 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3660 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3661 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3662 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3663 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3664 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3665 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3666
3667 @kindex tbreak
3668 @item tbreak @var{args}
3669 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3670 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3671 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3672 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3673
3674 @kindex hbreak
3675 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3676 @item hbreak @var{args}
3677 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3678 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3679 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3680 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3681 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3682 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3683 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3684 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3685 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3686 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3687 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3688 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3689 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3690 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3691 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3692 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3693 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3694 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3695
3696 @kindex thbreak
3697 @item thbreak @var{args}
3698 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3699 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3700 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3701 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3702 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3703 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3704 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3705 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3706
3707 @kindex rbreak
3708 @cindex regular expression
3709 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3710 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3711 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3712 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3713 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3714 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3715 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3716 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3717 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3718
3719 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3720 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3721 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3722 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3723 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3724 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3725
3726 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3727 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3728 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3729 classes.
3730
3731 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3732 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3733 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3734
3735 @smallexample
3736 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3737 @end smallexample
3738
3739 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3740 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3741 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3742 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3743 every function in a given file:
3744
3745 @smallexample
3746 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3747 @end smallexample
3748
3749 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3750 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3751
3752 @kindex info breakpoints
3753 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3754 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3755 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3756 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3757 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3758 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3759 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3760
3761 @table @emph
3762 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3763 @item Type
3764 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3765 @item Disposition
3766 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3767 @item Enabled or Disabled
3768 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3769 that are not enabled.
3770 @item Address
3771 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3772 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3773 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3774 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3775 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3776 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3777 @item What
3778 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3779 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3780 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3781 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3782 @end table
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3786 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3787 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3788 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3789 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3790 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3791
3792 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3793 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3794 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3795 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3796
3797 @noindent
3798 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3799 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3800 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3801 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3802 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3803
3804 @noindent
3805 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3806 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3807 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3808 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3809 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3810 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3811
3812 @noindent
3813 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3814 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3815
3816 @end table
3817
3818 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3819 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3820 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3821 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3822
3823 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3824 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3825 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3826 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3827
3828 @itemize @bullet
3829 @item
3830 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3831
3832 @item
3833 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3834 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3835
3836 @item
3837 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3838 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3839
3840 @item
3841 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3842 several places where that function is inlined.
3843 @end itemize
3844
3845 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3846 the relevant locations.
3847
3848 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3849 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3850 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3851 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3852 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3853 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3854 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3855
3856 For example:
3857
3858 @smallexample
3859 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3860 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3861 stop only if i==1
3862 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3863 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3864 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3865 @end smallexample
3866
3867 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3868 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3869 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3870 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3871 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3872 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3873 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3874 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3875 that belong to that breakpoint.
3876
3877 @cindex pending breakpoints
3878 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3879 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3880 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3881 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3882 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3883 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3884 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3885 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3886 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3887 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3888 is not yet resolved.
3889
3890 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3891 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3892 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3893 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3894 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3895 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3896
3897 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3898 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3899 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3900 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3901
3902 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3903 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3904 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3905
3906 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3907 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3908 address specification to an address:
3909
3910 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3911 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3912 @table @code
3913 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3914 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3915 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3916
3917 @item set breakpoint pending on
3918 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3919 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3920
3921 @item set breakpoint pending off
3922 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3923 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3924 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3925
3926 @item show breakpoint pending
3927 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3928 @end table
3929
3930 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3931 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3932 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3933
3934 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3935 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3936 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3937 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3938 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3939 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3940 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3941 breakpoints.
3942
3943 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3944
3945 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3946 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3947 @table @code
3948 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3949 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3950 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3951 breakpoint must be used.
3952
3953 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3954 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3955 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3956 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3957 @end table
3958
3959 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3960 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3961 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3962 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3963 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3964 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3965 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3966 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3967 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3968
3969 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3970 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3971 @table @code
3972 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3973 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3974 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3975 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3976
3977 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3978 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3979 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3980 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3981 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3982 @end table
3983
3984 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3985 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3986 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3987
3988 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3989 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3990
3991 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3992
3993 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3994 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3995 @table @code
3996 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3997 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3998 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3999 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4000 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4001
4002 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4003 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4004 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4005 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4006 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4007 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4008 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4009 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4010 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4011 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4012 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4013 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4014 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4015
4016 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4017 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4018 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4019 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4020 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4021 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4022 @end table
4023
4024
4025 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4026 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4027 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4028 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4029 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4030 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4031 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4032 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4033
4034
4035 @node Set Watchpoints
4036 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4037
4038 @cindex setting watchpoints
4039 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4040 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4041 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4042 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4043 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4044
4045 @itemize @bullet
4046 @item
4047 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4048
4049 @item
4050 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4051 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4052 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4053
4054 @item
4055 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4056 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4057 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4058 @end itemize
4059
4060 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4061 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4062 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4063 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4064 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4065 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4066 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4067 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4068 the expression changes.
4069
4070 @cindex software watchpoints
4071 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4072 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4073 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4074 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4075 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4076 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4077 culprit.)
4078
4079 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4080 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4081 slow down the running of your program.
4082
4083 @table @code
4084 @kindex watch
4085 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4086 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4087 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4088 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4089 to watch the value of a single variable:
4090
4091 @smallexample
4092 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4093 @end smallexample
4094
4095 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4096 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4097 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4098 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4099 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4100 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4101
4102 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4103 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4104 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4105 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4106 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4107 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4108 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4109 error.
4110
4111 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4112 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4113 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4114 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4115 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4116 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4117 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4118 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4119 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4120 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4121 Examples:
4122
4123 @smallexample
4124 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4125 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4126 @end smallexample
4127
4128 @kindex rwatch
4129 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4130 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4131 by the program.
4132
4133 @kindex awatch
4134 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4135 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4136 or written into by the program.
4137
4138 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4139 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4140 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4141 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4142 @end table
4143
4144 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4145 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4146 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4147 a never-changing value:
4148
4149 @smallexample
4150 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4151 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4152 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4153 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4154 @end smallexample
4155
4156 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4157 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4158 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4159 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4160 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4161 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4162
4163 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4164 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4165 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4166 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4167 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4168 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4169 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4170 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4171
4172 @table @code
4173 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4174 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4175 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4176
4177 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4178 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4179 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4180 @end table
4181
4182 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4183 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4184 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4185
4186 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4187
4188 @smallexample
4189 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4190 @end smallexample
4191
4192 @noindent
4193 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4194
4195 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4196 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4197 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4198 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4199 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4200 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4201 will print a message like this:
4202
4203 @smallexample
4204 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4205 @end smallexample
4206
4207 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4208 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4209 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4210 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4211 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4212 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4213 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4214 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4215
4216 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4217 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4218 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4219 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4220 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4221 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4222
4223 @smallexample
4224 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4225 @end smallexample
4226
4227 @noindent
4228 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4229
4230 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4231 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4232 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4233 expression with separately allocated resources.
4234
4235 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4236 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4237 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4238
4239 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4240 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4241 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4242 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4243 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4244 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4245 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4246 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4247 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4248
4249 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4250 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4251 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4252 watched expression from every thread.
4253
4254 @quotation
4255 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4256 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4257 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4258 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4259 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4260 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4261 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4262 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4263 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4264 @end quotation
4265
4266 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4267
4268 @node Set Catchpoints
4269 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4270 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4271 @cindex exception handlers
4272 @cindex event handling
4273
4274 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4275 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4276 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @kindex catch
4280 @item catch @var{event}
4281 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4282
4283 @table @code
4284 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4285 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4286 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4287 @kindex catch throw
4288 @kindex catch rethrow
4289 @kindex catch catch
4290 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4291 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4292
4293 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4294 regular expression will be caught.
4295
4296 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4297 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4298 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4299 exception being thrown.
4300
4301 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4302 @value{GDBN}:
4303
4304 @itemize @bullet
4305 @item
4306 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4307 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4308 supported.
4309
4310 @item
4311 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4312 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4313 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4314 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4315 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4316 built.
4317
4318 @item
4319 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4320 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4321
4322 @item
4323 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4324 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4325 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4326 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4327
4328 @item
4329 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4330 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4331 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4332 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4333 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4334 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4335 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4336 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4337 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4338
4339 @item
4340 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4341
4342 @item
4343 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4344 @end itemize
4345
4346 @item exception
4347 @kindex catch exception
4348 @cindex Ada exception catching
4349 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4350 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4351 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4352 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4353 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4354
4355 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4356 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4357 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4358 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4359 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4360 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4361 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4362 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4363
4364 @item exception unhandled
4365 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4366 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4367
4368 @item assert
4369 @kindex catch assert
4370 A failed Ada assertion.
4371
4372 @item exec
4373 @kindex catch exec
4374 @cindex break on fork/exec
4375 A call to @code{exec}.
4376
4377 @item syscall
4378 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4379 @kindex catch syscall
4380 @cindex break on a system call.
4381 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4382 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4383 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4384 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4385 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4386 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4387 will be caught.
4388
4389 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4390 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4391 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4392 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4393
4394 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4395 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4396 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4397 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4398
4399 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4400 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4401 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4402 available choices.
4403
4404 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4405 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4406 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4407 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4408 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4409 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4410 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4411 behind the OS upgrades).
4412
4413 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4414 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4415 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4416 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4417 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4418 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4419 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4420 syscall groups available on your environment.
4421
4422 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4423 arguments to it:
4424
4425 @smallexample
4426 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4427 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4428 (@value{GDBP}) r
4429 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4430
4431 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4432 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4433 (@value{GDBP}) c
4434 Continuing.
4435
4436 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4437 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4438 (@value{GDBP})
4439 @end smallexample
4440
4441 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4442
4443 @smallexample
4444 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4445 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4446 (@value{GDBP}) r
4447 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4448
4449 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4450 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4451 (@value{GDBP}) c
4452 Continuing.
4453
4454 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4455 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4456 (@value{GDBP})
4457 @end smallexample
4458
4459 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4460 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4461 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4462
4463 @smallexample
4464 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4465 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4466 (@value{GDBP}) r
4467 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4468
4469 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4470 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4471 (@value{GDBP}) c
4472 Continuing.
4473
4474 Program exited normally.
4475 (@value{GDBP})
4476 @end smallexample
4477
4478 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4479
4480 @smallexample
4481 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4482 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4483 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4484 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4485 (@value{GDBP}) r
4486 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4487
4488 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4489 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4490
4491 (@value{GDBP}) c
4492 Continuing.
4493 @end smallexample
4494
4495 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4496 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4497 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4498 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4499
4500 @smallexample
4501 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4502 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4503 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4504 (@value{GDBP})
4505 @end smallexample
4506
4507 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4508 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4509 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4510 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4511 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4512 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4513
4514 @smallexample
4515 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4516 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4517 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4518 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4519 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4520 (@value{GDBP})
4521 @end smallexample
4522
4523 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4524
4525 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4526 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4527
4528 @smallexample
4529 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4530 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4531 @end smallexample
4532
4533 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4534
4535 @item fork
4536 @kindex catch fork
4537 A call to @code{fork}.
4538
4539 @item vfork
4540 @kindex catch vfork
4541 A call to @code{vfork}.
4542
4543 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4544 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4545 @kindex catch load
4546 @kindex catch unload
4547 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4548 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4549 matches one of the affected libraries.
4550
4551 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4552 @kindex catch signal
4553 The delivery of a signal.
4554
4555 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4556 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4557 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4558
4559 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4560 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4561 signal names.
4562
4563 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4564 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4565 will be caught.
4566
4567 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4568 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4569 catchpoint.
4570
4571 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4572 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4573 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4574 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4575 commands.
4576
4577 @end table
4578
4579 @item tcatch @var{event}
4580 @kindex tcatch
4581 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4582 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4583
4584 @end table
4585
4586 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4587
4588
4589 @node Delete Breaks
4590 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4591
4592 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4593 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4594 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4595 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4596 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4597 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4598
4599 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4600 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4601 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4602 their breakpoint numbers.
4603
4604 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4605 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4606 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4607
4608 @table @code
4609 @kindex clear
4610 @item clear
4611 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4612 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4613 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4614 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4615
4616 @item clear @var{location}
4617 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4618 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4619 most useful ones are listed below:
4620
4621 @table @code
4622 @item clear @var{function}
4623 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4624 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4625
4626 @item clear @var{linenum}
4627 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4628 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4629 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4630 @end table
4631
4632 @cindex delete breakpoints
4633 @kindex delete
4634 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4635 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4636 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4637 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4638 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4639 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4640 @end table
4641
4642 @node Disabling
4643 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4644
4645 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4646 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4647 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4648 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4649 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4650
4651 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4652 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4653 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4654 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4655 do not know which numbers to use.
4656
4657 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4658 affects all of its locations.
4659
4660 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4661 different states of enablement:
4662
4663 @itemize @bullet
4664 @item
4665 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4666 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4667 @item
4668 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4669 @item
4670 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4671 disabled.
4672 @item
4673 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4674 N times, then becomes disabled.
4675 @item
4676 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4677 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4678 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4679 @end itemize
4680
4681 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4682 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4683
4684 @table @code
4685 @kindex disable
4686 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4687 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4688 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4689 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4690 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4691 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4692 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4693
4694 @kindex enable
4695 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4696 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4697 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4698
4699 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4700 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4701 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4702
4703 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4704 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4705 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4706 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4707 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4708 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4709 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4710
4711 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4712 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4713 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4714 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4715 @end table
4716
4717 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4718 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4719 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4720 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4721 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4722 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4723 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4724 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4725 Stepping}.)
4726
4727 @node Conditions
4728 @subsection Break Conditions
4729 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4730 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4731
4732 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4733 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4734 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4735 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4736 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4737 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4738 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4739 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4740
4741 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4742 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4743 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4744 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4745 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4746
4747 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4748 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4749 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4750 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4751 one.
4752
4753 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4754 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4755 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4756 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4757 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4758 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4759 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4760 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4761 conditions for the
4762 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4763 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4764
4765 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4766 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4767 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4768 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4769 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4770 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4771
4772 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4773 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4774 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4775 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4776 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4777
4778 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4779 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4780 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4781 with the @code{condition} command.
4782
4783 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4784 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4785 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4786 catchpoint.
4787
4788 @table @code
4789 @kindex condition
4790 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4791 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4792 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4793 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4794 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4795 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4796 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4797 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4798 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4799 prints an error message:
4800
4801 @smallexample
4802 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4803 @end smallexample
4804
4805 @noindent
4806 @value{GDBN} does
4807 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4808 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4809 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4810
4811 @item condition @var{bnum}
4812 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4813 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4814 @end table
4815
4816 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4817 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4818 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4819 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4820 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4821 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4822 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4823 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4824 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4825 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4826 your program reaches it.
4827
4828 @table @code
4829 @kindex ignore
4830 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4831 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4832 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4833 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4834 takes no action.
4835
4836 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4837 a count of zero.
4838
4839 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4840 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4841 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4842 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4843
4844 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4845 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4846 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4847
4848 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4849 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4850 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4851 Variables}.
4852 @end table
4853
4854 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4855
4856
4857 @node Break Commands
4858 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4859
4860 @cindex breakpoint commands
4861 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4862 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4863 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4864 enable other breakpoints.
4865
4866 @table @code
4867 @kindex commands
4868 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4869 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4870 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4871 @itemx end
4872 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4873 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4874 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4875
4876 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4877 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4878
4879 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4880 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4881 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4882 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4883 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4884 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4885 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4886 Expressions}).
4887 @end table
4888
4889 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4890 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4891
4892 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4893 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4894 that resumes execution.
4895
4896 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4897 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4898 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4899 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4900 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4901
4902 @kindex silent
4903 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4904 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4905 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4906 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4907 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4908 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4909
4910 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4911 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4912 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4913
4914 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4915 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4916
4917 @smallexample
4918 break foo if x>0
4919 commands
4920 silent
4921 printf "x is %d\n",x
4922 cont
4923 end
4924 @end smallexample
4925
4926 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4927 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4928 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4929 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4930 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4931 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4932 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4933
4934 @smallexample
4935 break 403
4936 commands
4937 silent
4938 set x = y + 4
4939 cont
4940 end
4941 @end smallexample
4942
4943 @node Dynamic Printf
4944 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4945
4946 @cindex dynamic printf
4947 @cindex dprintf
4948 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4949 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4950 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4951 having to recompile it.
4952
4953 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4954 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4955 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4956 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4957 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4958 redirects to files and so forth.
4959
4960 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4961 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4962 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4963 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4964 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4965 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4966 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4967
4968 @table @code
4969 @kindex dprintf
4970 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4971 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4972 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4973 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4974
4975 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4976 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4977 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4978 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4979 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4980 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4981
4982 @item gdb
4983 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4984 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4985
4986 @item call
4987 @kindex dprintf-style call
4988 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4989 @code{printf}).
4990
4991 @item agent
4992 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4993 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4994 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4995 support running commands on the target.
4996
4997 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4998 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4999 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5000 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5001 command.
5002
5003 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5004 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5005 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5006 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5007 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5008 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5009
5010 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5011 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5012 you could do the following:
5013
5014 @example
5015 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5016 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5017 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5018 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5019 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5020 (gdb) info break
5021 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5022 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5023 continue
5024 (gdb)
5025 @end example
5026
5027 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5028 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5029 the variable settings.
5030
5031 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5032 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5033 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5034 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5035 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5036 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5037
5038 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5039 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5040 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5041
5042 @end table
5043
5044 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5045 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5046 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5047 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5048 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5049 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5050
5051 @node Save Breakpoints
5052 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5053
5054 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5055 breakpoints}} command.
5056
5057 @table @code
5058 @kindex save breakpoints
5059 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5060 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5061 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5062 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5063 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5064 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5065 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5066 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5067 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5068 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5069 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5070 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5071 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5072 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5073 that can no longer be recreated.
5074 @end table
5075
5076 @node Static Probe Points
5077 @subsection Static Probe Points
5078
5079 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5080 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5081 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5082 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5083 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5084
5085 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5086 ELF-compatible systems:
5087
5088 @itemize @bullet
5089
5090 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5091 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5092 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5093 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5094 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5095 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5096 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5097 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5098
5099 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5100 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5101 C@t{++} languages.
5102 @end itemize
5103
5104 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5105 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5106 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5107 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5108 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5109 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5110 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5111 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5112 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5113
5114 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5115 probes}, with optional arguments:
5116
5117 @table @code
5118 @kindex info probes
5119 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5120 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5121 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5122 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5123
5124 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5125 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5126 probes from all providers are listed.
5127
5128 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5129 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5130 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5131
5132 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5133 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5134 given, all object files are considered.
5135
5136 @item info probes all
5137 List the available static probes, from all types.
5138 @end table
5139
5140 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5141 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5142 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5143 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5144 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5145
5146 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5147 commands, with optional arguments:
5148
5149 @table @code
5150 @kindex enable probes
5151 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5152 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5153 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5154 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5155
5156 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5157 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5158 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5159
5160 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5161 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5162 given, all object files are considered.
5163
5164 @kindex disable probes
5165 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5166 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5167 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5168 @end table
5169
5170 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5171 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5172 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5173 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5174 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5175 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5176 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5177 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5178 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5179 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5180 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5181 at the current probe point.
5182
5183 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5184 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5185 an error message.
5186
5187
5188 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5189 @node Error in Breakpoints
5190 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5191
5192 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5193 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5194
5195 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5196 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5197 @smallexample
5198 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5199 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5200 @end smallexample
5201
5202 @noindent
5203 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5204 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5205 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5206
5207 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5208 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5209
5210 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5211 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5212 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5213
5214 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5215 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5216 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5217 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5218
5219 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5220 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5221 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5222 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5223 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5224 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5225 first in the bundle.
5226
5227 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5228 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5229 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5230 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5231 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5232 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5233 is hit.
5234
5235 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5236 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5237
5238 @smallexample
5239 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5240 @end smallexample
5241
5242 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5243 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5244 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5245 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5246 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5247 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5248 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5249 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5250
5251 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5252 adjusted breakpoints:
5253
5254 @smallexample
5255 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5256 to 0x00010410.
5257 @end smallexample
5258
5259 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5260 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5261 frequently than expected.
5262
5263 @node Continuing and Stepping
5264 @section Continuing and Stepping
5265
5266 @cindex stepping
5267 @cindex continuing
5268 @cindex resuming execution
5269 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5270 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5271 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5272 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5273 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5274 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5275 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5276 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5277 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5278 handlers}).)
5279
5280 @table @code
5281 @kindex continue
5282 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5283 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5284 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5285 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5286 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5287 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5288 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5289 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5290 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5291 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5292
5293 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5294 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5295 @code{continue} is ignored.
5296
5297 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5298 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5299 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5300 @code{continue}.
5301 @end table
5302
5303 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5304 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5305 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5306 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5307
5308 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5309 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5310 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5311 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5312 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5313 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5314
5315 @table @code
5316 @kindex step
5317 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5318 @item step
5319 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5320 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5321 abbreviated @code{s}.
5322
5323 @quotation
5324 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5325 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5326 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5327 @c distinction here.
5328 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5329 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5330 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5331 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5332 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5333 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5334 below.
5335 @end quotation
5336
5337 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5338 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5339 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5340 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5341 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5342 called within the line.
5343
5344 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5345 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5346 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5347 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5348 was any debugging information about the routine.
5349
5350 @item step @var{count}
5351 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5352 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5353 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5354
5355 @kindex next
5356 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5357 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5358 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5359 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5360 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5361 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5362 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5363 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5364
5365 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5366
5367
5368 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5369 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5370 @c
5371 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5372 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5373 @c function are executed without stopping.
5374
5375 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5376 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5377 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5378
5379 @kindex set step-mode
5380 @item set step-mode
5381 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5382 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5383 @itemx set step-mode on
5384 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5385 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5386 information rather than stepping over it.
5387
5388 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5389 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5390 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5391
5392 @item set step-mode off
5393 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5394 debug information. This is the default.
5395
5396 @item show step-mode
5397 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5398 source line debug information.
5399
5400 @kindex finish
5401 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5402 @item finish
5403 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5404 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5405 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5406
5407 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5408 ,Returning from a Function}).
5409
5410 @kindex until
5411 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5412 @cindex run until specified location
5413 @item until
5414 @itemx u
5415 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5416 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5417 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5418 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5419 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5420 than the address of the jump.
5421
5422 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5423 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5424 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5425 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5426 through the next iteration.
5427
5428 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5429 stack frame.
5430
5431 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5432 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5433 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5434 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5435 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5436
5437 @smallexample
5438 (@value{GDBP}) f
5439 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5440 206 expand_input();
5441 (@value{GDBP}) until
5442 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5443 @end smallexample
5444
5445 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5446 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5447 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5448 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5449 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5450 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5451 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5452
5453 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5454 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5455 argument.
5456
5457 @item until @var{location}
5458 @itemx u @var{location}
5459 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5460 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5461 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5462 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5463 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5464 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5465 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5466 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5467 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5468 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5469 invocations have returned.
5470
5471 @smallexample
5472 94 int factorial (int value)
5473 95 @{
5474 96 if (value > 1) @{
5475 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5476 98 @}
5477 99 return (value);
5478 100 @}
5479 @end smallexample
5480
5481
5482 @kindex advance @var{location}
5483 @item advance @var{location}
5484 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5485 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5486 @ref{Specify Location}.
5487 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5488 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5489 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5490 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5491
5492
5493 @kindex stepi
5494 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5495 @item stepi
5496 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5497 @itemx si
5498 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5499
5500 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5501 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5502 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5503 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5504
5505 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5506
5507 @need 750
5508 @kindex nexti
5509 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5510 @item nexti
5511 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5512 @itemx ni
5513 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5514 proceed until the function returns.
5515
5516 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5517
5518 @end table
5519
5520 @anchor{range stepping}
5521 @cindex range stepping
5522 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5523 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5524 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5525 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5526 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5527 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5528 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5529 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5530 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5531 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5532 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5533 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5534 if necessary:
5535
5536 @table @code
5537 @kindex set range-stepping
5538 @kindex show range-stepping
5539 @item set range-stepping
5540 @itemx show range-stepping
5541 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5542
5543 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5544 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5545 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5546 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5547 default is @code{on}.
5548
5549 @end table
5550
5551 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5552 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5553 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5554
5555 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5556 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5557 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5558 a particular file when stepping.
5559
5560 For example, consider the following C function:
5561
5562 @smallexample
5563 101 int func()
5564 102 @{
5565 103 foo(boring());
5566 104 bar(boring());
5567 105 @}
5568 @end smallexample
5569
5570 @noindent
5571 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5572 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5573 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5574 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5575
5576 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5577 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5578 is called from many places.
5579
5580 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5581 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5582 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5583 @code{foo}.
5584
5585 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5586 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5587 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5588
5589 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5590 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5591 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5592 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5593 the underlying system.
5594 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5595 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5596
5597 @table @code
5598 @kindex skip
5599 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5600 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5601 that specify what to skip.
5602 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5603
5604 @table @code
5605 @item -file @var{file}
5606 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5607 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5608
5609 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5610 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5611 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5612 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5613 over when stepping.
5614
5615 @smallexample
5616 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5617 @end smallexample
5618
5619 @item -function @var{linespec}
5620 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5621 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5622 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5623 @xref{Specify Location}.
5624
5625 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5626 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5627 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5628 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5629
5630 This form is useful for complex function names.
5631 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5632 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5633 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5634 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5635 regular expression makes this easier.
5636
5637 @smallexample
5638 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5639 @end smallexample
5640
5641 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5642 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5643
5644 @smallexample
5645 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5646 @end smallexample
5647 @end table
5648
5649 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5650 will be skipped.
5651
5652 @kindex skip function
5653 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5654 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5655 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5656 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5657
5658 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5659 will be skipped.
5660
5661 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5662 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5663
5664 @kindex skip file
5665 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5666 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5667 will be skipped over when stepping.
5668
5669 @smallexample
5670 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5671 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5672 @end smallexample
5673
5674 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5675 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5676 @end table
5677
5678 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5679 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5680
5681 @table @code
5682 @kindex info skip
5683 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5684 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5685 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5686 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5687
5688 @table @emph
5689 @item Identifier
5690 A number identifying this skip.
5691 @item Enabled or Disabled
5692 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5693 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5694 @item Glob
5695 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5696 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5697 @item File
5698 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5699 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5700 @item RE
5701 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5702 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5703 @item Function
5704 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5705 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5706 @end table
5707
5708 @kindex skip delete
5709 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5710 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5711 skips.
5712
5713 @kindex skip enable
5714 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5715 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5716 skips.
5717
5718 @kindex skip disable
5719 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5720 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5721 skips.
5722
5723 @end table
5724
5725 @node Signals
5726 @section Signals
5727 @cindex signals
5728
5729 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5730 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5731 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5732 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5733 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5734 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5735 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5736 requested an alarm).
5737
5738 @cindex fatal signals
5739 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5740 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5741 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5742 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5743 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5744 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5745
5746 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5747 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5748 signal.
5749
5750 @cindex handling signals
5751 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5752 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5753 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5754 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5755 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5756
5757 @table @code
5758 @kindex info signals
5759 @kindex info handle
5760 @item info signals
5761 @itemx info handle
5762 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5763 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5764 the defined types of signals.
5765
5766 @item info signals @var{sig}
5767 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5768
5769 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5770
5771 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5772 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5773 for details about this command.
5774
5775 @kindex handle
5776 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5777 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5778 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5779 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5780 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5781 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5782 say what change to make.
5783 @end table
5784
5785 @c @group
5786 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5787 Their full names are:
5788
5789 @table @code
5790 @item nostop
5791 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5792 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5793
5794 @item stop
5795 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5796 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5797
5798 @item print
5799 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5800
5801 @item noprint
5802 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5803 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5804
5805 @item pass
5806 @itemx noignore
5807 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5808 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5809 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5810
5811 @item nopass
5812 @itemx ignore
5813 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5814 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5815 @end table
5816 @c @end group
5817
5818 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5819 program until you
5820 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5821 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5822 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5823 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5824 program sees that signal when you continue.
5825
5826 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5827 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5828 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5829 erroneous signals.
5830
5831 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5832 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5833 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5834 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5835 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5836 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5837 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5838 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5839 Program a Signal}.
5840
5841 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5842 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5843
5844 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5845 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5846 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5847 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5848 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5849 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5850 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5851 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5852 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5853 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5854 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5855 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5856 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5857
5858 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5859
5860 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5861 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5862 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5863 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5864
5865 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5866 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5867 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5868 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5869
5870 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5871 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5872
5873 @smallexample
5874 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5875 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5876 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5877 (@value{GDBP}) c
5878 Continuing.
5879
5880 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5881 main () sigusr1.c:28
5882 28 p = 0;
5883 (@value{GDBP}) si
5884 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5885 9 @{
5886 @end smallexample
5887
5888 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5889 program to receive the signal first:
5890
5891 @smallexample
5892 (@value{GDBP}) n
5893 28 p = 0;
5894 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5895 (@value{GDBP}) si
5896 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5897 9 @{
5898 (@value{GDBP})
5899 @end smallexample
5900
5901 @cindex extra signal information
5902 @anchor{extra signal information}
5903
5904 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5905 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5906 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5907 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5908 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5909 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5910 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5911 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5912 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5913 system header.
5914
5915 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5916 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5917
5918 @smallexample
5919 @group
5920 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5921 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5922 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5923 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5924 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5925 type = struct @{
5926 int si_signo;
5927 int si_errno;
5928 int si_code;
5929 union @{
5930 int _pad[28];
5931 struct @{...@} _kill;
5932 struct @{...@} _timer;
5933 struct @{...@} _rt;
5934 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5935 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5936 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5937 @} _sifields;
5938 @}
5939 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5940 type = struct @{
5941 void *si_addr;
5942 @}
5943 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5944 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5945 @end group
5946 @end smallexample
5947
5948 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5949
5950 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5951 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5952 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5953 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5954 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5955 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5956 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5957 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5958 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5959 information is displayed.
5960
5961 The usual output of a segfault is:
5962 @smallexample
5963 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5964 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5965 68 value = *(p + len);
5966 @end smallexample
5967
5968 While a bound violation is presented as:
5969 @smallexample
5970 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5971 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5972 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5973 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5974 68 value = *(p + len);
5975 @end smallexample
5976
5977 @node Thread Stops
5978 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5979
5980 @cindex stopped threads
5981 @cindex threads, stopped
5982
5983 @cindex continuing threads
5984 @cindex threads, continuing
5985
5986 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5987 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5988 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5989 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5990 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5991 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5992 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5993 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5994 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5995
5996 @menu
5997 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5998 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5999 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6000 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6001 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6002 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6003 @end menu
6004
6005 @node All-Stop Mode
6006 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6007
6008 @cindex all-stop mode
6009
6010 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6011 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6012 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6013 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6014 underfoot.
6015
6016 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6017 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6018 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6019
6020 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6021 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6022 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6023 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6024 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6025 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6026 stops.
6027
6028 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6029 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6030 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6031 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6032
6033 @cindex automatic thread selection
6034 @cindex switching threads automatically
6035 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6036 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6037 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6038 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6039 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6040 thread.
6041
6042 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6043 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6044
6045 @table @code
6046 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6047 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6048 @cindex lock scheduler
6049 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6050 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6051 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6052 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6053 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6054 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6055 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6056 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6057 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6058 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6059 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6060 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6061 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6062 @code{on} in replay mode.
6063
6064 @item show scheduler-locking
6065 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6066 @end table
6067
6068 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6069 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6070 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6071 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6072 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6073 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6074 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6075 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6076 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6077 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6078 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6079 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6080 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6081 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6082
6083 @table @code
6084 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6085 @item set schedule-multiple
6086 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6087 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6088 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6089 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6090 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6091 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6092
6093 @item show schedule-multiple
6094 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6095 multiple processes.
6096 @end table
6097
6098 @node Non-Stop Mode
6099 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6100
6101 @cindex non-stop mode
6102
6103 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6104 @c with more details.
6105
6106 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6107 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6108 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6109 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6110 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6111 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6112
6113 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6114 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6115 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6116 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6117 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6118 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6119 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6120 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6121 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6122 independently and simultaneously.
6123
6124 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6125 or attach to your program:
6126
6127 @smallexample
6128 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6129 set pagination off
6130
6131 # Finally, turn it on!
6132 set non-stop on
6133 @end smallexample
6134
6135 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6136
6137 @table @code
6138 @kindex set non-stop
6139 @item set non-stop on
6140 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6141 @item set non-stop off
6142 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6143 @kindex show non-stop
6144 @item show non-stop
6145 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6146 @end table
6147
6148 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6149 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6150 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6151 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6152 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6153 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6154 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6155 default.
6156
6157 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6158 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6159 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6160
6161 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6162 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6163 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6164 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6165 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6166
6167 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6168 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6169 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6170 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6171 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6172
6173 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6174
6175 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6176 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6177 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6178 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6179 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6180 previously current thread.
6181
6182 @node Background Execution
6183 @subsection Background Execution
6184
6185 @cindex foreground execution
6186 @cindex background execution
6187 @cindex asynchronous execution
6188 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6189
6190 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6191 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6192 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6193 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6194 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6195 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6196
6197 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6198 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6199
6200 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6201 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6202 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6203 are:
6204
6205 @table @code
6206 @kindex run&
6207 @item run
6208 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6209
6210 @item attach
6211 @kindex attach&
6212 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6213
6214 @item step
6215 @kindex step&
6216 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6217
6218 @item stepi
6219 @kindex stepi&
6220 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6221
6222 @item next
6223 @kindex next&
6224 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6225
6226 @item nexti
6227 @kindex nexti&
6228 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6229
6230 @item continue
6231 @kindex continue&
6232 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6233
6234 @item finish
6235 @kindex finish&
6236 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6237
6238 @item until
6239 @kindex until&
6240 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6241
6242 @end table
6243
6244 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6245 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6246 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6247 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6248 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6249 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6250
6251 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6252 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6253
6254 @table @code
6255 @kindex interrupt
6256 @item interrupt
6257 @itemx interrupt -a
6258
6259 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6260 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6261 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6262 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6263 @end table
6264
6265 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6266 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6267
6268 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6269 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6270 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6271
6272 @table @code
6273 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6274 @cindex thread breakpoints
6275 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6276 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6277 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6278 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6279 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6280 specify some source line.
6281
6282 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6283 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6284 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6285 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6286 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6287
6288 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6289 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6290 program.
6291
6292 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6293 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6294 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6295
6296 @smallexample
6297 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6298 @end smallexample
6299
6300 @end table
6301
6302 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6303 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6304 thread list. For example:
6305
6306 @smallexample
6307 (@value{GDBP}) c
6308 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6309 @end smallexample
6310
6311 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6312 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6313 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6314 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6315 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6316 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6317 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6318 command.
6319
6320 @node Interrupted System Calls
6321 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6322
6323 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6324 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6325 @cindex premature return from system calls
6326 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6327 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6328 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6329 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6330 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6331 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6332 stop execution.
6333
6334 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6335 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6336 style anyways.
6337
6338 For example, do not write code like this:
6339
6340 @smallexample
6341 sleep (10);
6342 @end smallexample
6343
6344 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6345 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6346
6347 Instead, write this:
6348
6349 @smallexample
6350 int unslept = 10;
6351 while (unslept > 0)
6352 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6353 @end smallexample
6354
6355 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6356 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6357 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6358 @value{GDBN}.
6359
6360 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6361 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6362 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6363 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6364
6365 @node Observer Mode
6366 @subsection Observer Mode
6367
6368 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6369 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6370 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6371 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6372 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6373
6374 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6375 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6376 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6377 mode.
6378
6379 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6380 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6381 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6382 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6383 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6384
6385 @table @code
6386
6387 @kindex observer
6388 @item set observer on
6389 @itemx set observer off
6390 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6391 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6392 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6393 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6394
6395 @item show observer
6396 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6397
6398 @kindex may-write-registers
6399 @item set may-write-registers on
6400 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6401 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6402 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6403 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6404
6405 @item show may-write-registers
6406 Show the current permission to write registers.
6407
6408 @kindex may-write-memory
6409 @item set may-write-memory on
6410 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6411 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6412 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6413 defaults to @code{on}.
6414
6415 @item show may-write-memory
6416 Show the current permission to write memory.
6417
6418 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6419 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6420 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6421 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6422 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6423 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6424
6425 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6426 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6427
6428 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6429 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6430 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6431 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6432 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6433 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6434 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6435
6436 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6437 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6438
6439 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6440 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6441 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6442 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6443 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6444 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6445 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6446
6447 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6448 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6449
6450 @kindex may-interrupt
6451 @item set may-interrupt on
6452 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6453 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6454 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6455 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6456 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6457
6458 @item show may-interrupt
6459 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6460
6461 @end table
6462
6463 @node Reverse Execution
6464 @chapter Running programs backward
6465 @cindex reverse execution
6466 @cindex running programs backward
6467
6468 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6469 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6470 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6471 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6472
6473 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6474 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6475 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6476 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6477 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6478 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6479
6480 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6481 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6482 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6483 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6484 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6485 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6486 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6487 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6488 prior values@footnote{
6489 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6490 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6491 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6492
6493 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6494 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6495 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6496 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6497 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6498 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6499 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6500 }.
6501
6502 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6503 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6504
6505 @table @code
6506 @kindex reverse-continue
6507 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6508 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6509 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6510 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6511 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6512 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6513 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6514
6515 @kindex reverse-step
6516 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6517 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6518 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6519 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6520
6521 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6522 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6523 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6524 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6525 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6526 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6527
6528 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6529 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6530
6531 @kindex reverse-stepi
6532 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6533 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6534 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6535 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6536 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6537 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6538 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6539
6540 @kindex reverse-next
6541 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6542 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6543 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6544 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6545 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6546 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6547 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6548 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6549 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6550 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6551
6552 @kindex reverse-nexti
6553 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6554 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6555 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6556 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6557 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6558 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6559 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6560 frame) is reached.
6561
6562 @kindex reverse-finish
6563 @item reverse-finish
6564 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6565 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6566 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6567 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6568
6569 @kindex set exec-direction
6570 @item set exec-direction
6571 Set the direction of target execution.
6572 @item set exec-direction reverse
6573 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6574 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6575 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6576 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6577 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6578 @item set exec-direction forward
6579 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6580 This is the default.
6581 @end table
6582
6583
6584 @node Process Record and Replay
6585 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6586 @cindex process record and replay
6587 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6588
6589 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6590 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6591 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6592
6593 @cindex replay mode
6594 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6595 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6596 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6597 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6598 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6599 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6600 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6601 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6602 execution log.
6603
6604 @cindex record mode
6605 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6606 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6607 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6608 for future replay.
6609
6610 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6611 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6612 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6613 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6614 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6615 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6616
6617 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6618 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6619 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6620 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6621
6622 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6623 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6624
6625 @table @code
6626 @kindex target record
6627 @kindex target record-full
6628 @kindex target record-btrace
6629 @kindex record
6630 @kindex record full
6631 @kindex record btrace
6632 @kindex record btrace bts
6633 @kindex record btrace pt
6634 @kindex record bts
6635 @kindex record pt
6636 @kindex rec
6637 @kindex rec full
6638 @kindex rec btrace
6639 @kindex rec btrace bts
6640 @kindex rec btrace pt
6641 @kindex rec bts
6642 @kindex rec pt
6643 @item record @var{method}
6644 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6645 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6646 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6647 recording methods are available:
6648
6649 @table @code
6650 @item full
6651 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6652 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6653 execution.
6654
6655 @item btrace @var{format}
6656 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6657 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6658 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6659 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6660 execution.
6661
6662 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6663 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6664 formats are available:
6665
6666 @table @code
6667 @item bts
6668 @cindex branch trace store
6669 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6670 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6671 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6672
6673 @item pt
6674 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6675 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6676 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6677 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6678
6679 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6680 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6681 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6682
6683 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6684 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6685 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6686 buffer-size with care.
6687 @end table
6688
6689 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6690 @end table
6691
6692 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6693 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6694 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6695 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6696
6697 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6698 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6699 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6700 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6701 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6702
6703 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6704 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6705 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6706 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6707 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6708 does not support these two modes.
6709
6710 @kindex record stop
6711 @kindex rec s
6712 @item record stop
6713 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6714 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6715 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6716
6717 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6718 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6719 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6720 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6721 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6722
6723 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6724 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6725 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6726 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6727 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6728
6729 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6730 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6731
6732 @kindex record goto
6733 @item record goto
6734 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6735 ways to specify the location to go to:
6736
6737 @table @code
6738 @item record goto begin
6739 @itemx record goto start
6740 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6741
6742 @item record goto end
6743 Go to the end of the execution log.
6744
6745 @item record goto @var{n}
6746 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6747 @end table
6748
6749 @kindex record save
6750 @item record save @var{filename}
6751 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6752 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6753 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6754
6755 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6756
6757 @kindex record restore
6758 @item record restore @var{filename}
6759 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6760 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6761
6762 @kindex set record full
6763 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6764 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6765 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6766 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6767
6768 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6769 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6770 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6771 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6772 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6773 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6774 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6775 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6776
6777 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6778 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6779 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6780
6781 @kindex show record full
6782 @item show record full insn-number-max
6783 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6784 recording method.
6785
6786 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6787 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6788 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6789 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6790 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6791 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6792 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6793 oldest one to be deleted.
6794
6795 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6796 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6797
6798 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6799 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6800
6801 @item set record full memory-query
6802 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6803 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6804 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6805 case.
6806
6807 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6808 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6809 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6810 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6811 results.
6812
6813 @item show record full memory-query
6814 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6815
6816 @kindex set record btrace
6817 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6818 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6819 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6820 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6821 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6822 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6823 You can use the following command for that:
6824
6825 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6826 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6827 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6828 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6829 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6830 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6831 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6832 position.
6833
6834 @kindex show record btrace
6835 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6836 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6837
6838 @kindex set record btrace bts
6839 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6840 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6841 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6842 format. Default is 64KB.
6843
6844 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6845 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6846 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6847 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6848 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6849 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6850 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6851
6852 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6853 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6854
6855 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6856 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6857
6858 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6859 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6860 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6861
6862 @kindex set record btrace pt
6863 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6864 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6865 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6866 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6867
6868 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6869 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6870 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6871 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6872 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6873 actual buffer size for each thread.
6874
6875 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6876 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6877
6878 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6879 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6880
6881 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6882 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6883 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6884
6885 @kindex info record
6886 @item info record
6887 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6888 method:
6889
6890 @table @code
6891 @item full
6892 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6893 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6894
6895 @itemize @bullet
6896 @item
6897 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6898 @item
6899 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6900 @item
6901 Highest recorded instruction number.
6902 @item
6903 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6904 @item
6905 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6906 @item
6907 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6908 @end itemize
6909
6910 @item btrace
6911 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6912
6913 @itemize @bullet
6914 @item
6915 Recording format.
6916 @item
6917 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6918 @item
6919 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6920 instructions.
6921 @item
6922 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6923 @end itemize
6924
6925 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6926 @itemize @bullet
6927 @item
6928 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6929 @end itemize
6930
6931 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6932 @itemize @bullet
6933 @item
6934 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6935 @end itemize
6936 @end table
6937
6938 @kindex record delete
6939 @kindex rec del
6940 @item record delete
6941 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6942 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6943 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6944 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6945
6946 @kindex record instruction-history
6947 @kindex rec instruction-history
6948 @item record instruction-history
6949 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6950 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6951 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6952 are printed in execution order.
6953
6954 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6955 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6956 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6957
6958 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6959 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6960 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6961 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6962 @code{/p} modifier.
6963
6964 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6965 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6966 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6967
6968 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6969 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6970
6971 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6972 disassemble:
6973
6974 @table @code
6975 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6976 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6977 @var{insn}.
6978
6979 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6980 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6981 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6982 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6983 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6984 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6985
6986 @item record instruction-history
6987 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6988
6989 @item record instruction-history -
6990 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6991
6992 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6993 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6994 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6995 number @var{end} is included.
6996 @end table
6997
6998 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6999
7000 @kindex set record
7001 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7002 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7003 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7004 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7005 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7006
7007 @kindex show record
7008 @item show record instruction-history-size
7009 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7010 instruction-history} command.
7011
7012 @kindex record function-call-history
7013 @kindex rec function-call-history
7014 @item record function-call-history
7015 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7016 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7017 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7018 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7019 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7020 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7021 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7022 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7023 given together.
7024
7025 @smallexample
7026 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7027 1 void foo (void)
7028 2 @{
7029 3 @}
7030 4
7031 5 void bar (void)
7032 6 @{
7033 7 ...
7034 8 foo ();
7035 9 ...
7036 10 @}
7037 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7038 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7039 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7040 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7041 @end smallexample
7042
7043 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7044 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7045 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7046 to print:
7047
7048 @table @code
7049 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7050 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7051
7052 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7053 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7054 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7055 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7056 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7057
7058 @item record function-call-history
7059 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7060
7061 @item record function-call-history -
7062 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7063
7064 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7065 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7066 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7067 @end table
7068
7069 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7070
7071 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7072 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7073 Define how many lines to print in the
7074 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7075 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7076
7077 @item show record function-call-history-size
7078 Show how many lines to print in the
7079 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7080 @end table
7081
7082
7083 @node Stack
7084 @chapter Examining the Stack
7085
7086 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7087 stopped and how it got there.
7088
7089 @cindex call stack
7090 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7091 is generated.
7092 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7093 the arguments of the call,
7094 and the local variables of the function being called.
7095 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7096 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7097 stack}.
7098
7099 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7100 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7101
7102 @cindex selected frame
7103 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7104 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7105 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7106 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7107 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7108 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7109
7110 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7111 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7112 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7113
7114 @menu
7115 * Frames:: Stack frames
7116 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7117 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7118 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7119 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7120
7121 @end menu
7122
7123 @node Frames
7124 @section Stack Frames
7125
7126 @cindex frame, definition
7127 @cindex stack frame
7128 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7129 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7130 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7131 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7132 which the function is executing.
7133
7134 @cindex initial frame
7135 @cindex outermost frame
7136 @cindex innermost frame
7137 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7138 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7139 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7140 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7141 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7142 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7143 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7144 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7145
7146 @cindex frame pointer
7147 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7148 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7149 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7150 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7151 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7152 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7153
7154 @cindex frame number
7155 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7156 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7157 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7158 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7159 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7160
7161 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7162 @c underflow problems.
7163 @cindex frameless execution
7164 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7165 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7166 @smallexample
7167 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7168 @end smallexample
7169 generates functions without a frame.)
7170 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7171 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7172 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7173 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7174 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7175 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7176 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7177
7178 @node Backtrace
7179 @section Backtraces
7180
7181 @cindex traceback
7182 @cindex call stack traces
7183 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7184 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7185 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7186 stack.
7187
7188 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7189 @table @code
7190 @kindex backtrace
7191 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7192 @item backtrace
7193 @itemx bt
7194 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7195 frames in the stack.
7196
7197 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7198 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7199
7200 @item backtrace @var{n}
7201 @itemx bt @var{n}
7202 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7203
7204 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7205 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7206 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7207
7208 @item backtrace full
7209 @itemx bt full
7210 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7211 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7212 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7213 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7214
7215 @item backtrace no-filters
7216 @itemx bt no-filters
7217 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7218 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7219 @itemx bt no-filters full
7220 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7221 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7222 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7223 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7224 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7225 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7226 support.
7227 @end table
7228
7229 @kindex where
7230 @kindex info stack
7231 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7232 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7233
7234 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7235 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7236 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7237 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7238 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7239 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7240 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7241 multi-threaded program.
7242
7243 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7244 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7245 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7246 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7247 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7248 line number.
7249
7250 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7251 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7252
7253 @smallexample
7254 @group
7255 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7256 at builtin.c:993
7257 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7258 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7259 at macro.c:71
7260 (More stack frames follow...)
7261 @end group
7262 @end smallexample
7263
7264 @noindent
7265 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7266 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7267 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7268
7269 @noindent
7270 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7271 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7272 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7273 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7274 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7275
7276 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7277 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7278 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7279 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7280 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7281 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7282 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7283 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7284 such a backtrace might look like:
7285
7286 @smallexample
7287 @group
7288 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7289 at builtin.c:993
7290 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7291 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7292 at macro.c:71
7293 (More stack frames follow...)
7294 @end group
7295 @end smallexample
7296
7297 @noindent
7298 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7299 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7300
7301 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7302 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7303 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7304
7305 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7306 @cindex program entry point
7307 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7308 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7309 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7310 @code{main}@footnote{
7311 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7312 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7313 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7314 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7315 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7316 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7317
7318 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7319 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7320
7321 @table @code
7322 @item set backtrace past-main
7323 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7324 @kindex set backtrace
7325 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7326
7327 @item set backtrace past-main off
7328 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7329 default.
7330
7331 @item show backtrace past-main
7332 @kindex show backtrace
7333 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7334
7335 @item set backtrace past-entry
7336 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7337 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7338 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7339 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7340
7341 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7342 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7343 application. This is the default.
7344
7345 @item show backtrace past-entry
7346 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7347
7348 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7349 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7350 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7351 @cindex backtrace limit
7352 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7353 or zero means unlimited levels.
7354
7355 @item show backtrace limit
7356 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7357 @end table
7358
7359 You can control how file names are displayed.
7360
7361 @table @code
7362 @item set filename-display
7363 @itemx set filename-display relative
7364 @cindex filename-display
7365 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7366
7367 @item set filename-display basename
7368 Display only basename of a filename.
7369
7370 @item set filename-display absolute
7371 Display an absolute filename.
7372
7373 @item show filename-display
7374 Show the current way to display filenames.
7375 @end table
7376
7377 @node Selection
7378 @section Selecting a Frame
7379
7380 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7381 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7382 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7383 of the stack frame just selected.
7384
7385 @table @code
7386 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7387 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7388 @item frame @var{n}
7389 @itemx f @var{n}
7390 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7391 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7392 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7393 @code{main}.
7394
7395 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7396 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7397 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7398 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7399 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7400 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7401 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7402 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7403
7404 @kindex up
7405 @item up @var{n}
7406 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7407 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7408 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7409
7410 @kindex down
7411 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7412 @item down @var{n}
7413 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7414 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7415 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7416 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7417 @end table
7418
7419 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7420 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7421 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7422 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7423
7424 @need 1000
7425 For example:
7426
7427 @smallexample
7428 @group
7429 (@value{GDBP}) up
7430 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7431 at env.c:10
7432 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7433 @end group
7434 @end smallexample
7435
7436 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7437 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7438 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7439 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7440 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7441 for details.
7442
7443 @table @code
7444 @kindex select-frame
7445 @item select-frame
7446 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7447 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7448 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7449 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7450
7451 @kindex down-silently
7452 @kindex up-silently
7453 @item up-silently @var{n}
7454 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7455 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7456 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7457 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7458 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7459 distracting.
7460 @end table
7461
7462 @node Frame Info
7463 @section Information About a Frame
7464
7465 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7466 stack frame.
7467
7468 @table @code
7469 @item frame
7470 @itemx f
7471 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7472 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7473 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7474 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7475 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7476
7477 @kindex info frame
7478 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7479 @item info frame
7480 @itemx info f
7481 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7482 including:
7483
7484 @itemize @bullet
7485 @item
7486 the address of the frame
7487 @item
7488 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7489 @item
7490 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7491 @item
7492 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7493 @item
7494 the address of the frame's arguments
7495 @item
7496 the address of the frame's local variables
7497 @item
7498 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7499 @item
7500 which registers were saved in the frame
7501 @end itemize
7502
7503 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7504 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7505 the usual conventions.
7506
7507 @item info frame @var{addr}
7508 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7509 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7510 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7511 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7512 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7513 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7514
7515 @kindex info args
7516 @item info args
7517 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7518
7519 @item info locals
7520 @kindex info locals
7521 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7522 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7523 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7524
7525 @end table
7526
7527 @node Frame Filter Management
7528 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7529 @cindex managing frame filters
7530
7531 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7532 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7533
7534 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7535 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7536
7537 @table @code
7538 @kindex info frame-filter
7539 @item info frame-filter
7540 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7541 their name, priority and enabled status.
7542
7543 @kindex disable frame-filter
7544 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7545 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7546 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7547 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7548 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7549 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7550 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7551 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7552 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7553 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7554 may be enabled again later.
7555
7556 @kindex enable frame-filter
7557 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7558 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7559 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7560 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7561 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7562 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7563 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7564 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7565 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7566
7567 Example:
7568
7569 @smallexample
7570 (gdb) info frame-filter
7571
7572 global frame-filters:
7573 Priority Enabled Name
7574 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7575 100 Yes Reverse
7576
7577 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7578 Priority Enabled Name
7579 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7580
7581 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7582 Priority Enabled Name
7583 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7584
7585 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7586 (gdb) info frame-filter
7587
7588 global frame-filters:
7589 Priority Enabled Name
7590 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7591 100 Yes Reverse
7592
7593 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7594 Priority Enabled Name
7595 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7596
7597 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7598 Priority Enabled Name
7599 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7600
7601 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7602 (gdb) info frame-filter
7603
7604 global frame-filters:
7605 Priority Enabled Name
7606 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7607 100 Yes Reverse
7608
7609 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7610 Priority Enabled Name
7611 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7612
7613 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7614 Priority Enabled Name
7615 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7616 @end smallexample
7617
7618 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7619 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7620 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7621 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7622 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7623 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7624 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7625
7626 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7627 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7628 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7629 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7630 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7631 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7632 dictionary resides.
7633
7634 Example:
7635
7636 @smallexample
7637 (gdb) info frame-filter
7638
7639 global frame-filters:
7640 Priority Enabled Name
7641 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7642 100 Yes Reverse
7643
7644 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7645 Priority Enabled Name
7646 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7647
7648 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7649 Priority Enabled Name
7650 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7651
7652 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7653 (gdb) info frame-filter
7654
7655 global frame-filters:
7656 Priority Enabled Name
7657 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7658 50 Yes Reverse
7659
7660 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7661 Priority Enabled Name
7662 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7663
7664 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7665 Priority Enabled Name
7666 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7667 @end smallexample
7668 @end table
7669
7670 @node Source
7671 @chapter Examining Source Files
7672
7673 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7674 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7675 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7676 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7677 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7678 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7679 source files by explicit command.
7680
7681 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7682 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7683 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7684
7685 @menu
7686 * List:: Printing source lines
7687 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7688 * Edit:: Editing source files
7689 * Search:: Searching source files
7690 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7691 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7692 @end menu
7693
7694 @node List
7695 @section Printing Source Lines
7696
7697 @kindex list
7698 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7699 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7700 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7701 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7702 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7703
7704 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7705
7706 @table @code
7707 @item list @var{linenum}
7708 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7709 current source file.
7710
7711 @item list @var{function}
7712 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7713 @var{function}.
7714
7715 @item list
7716 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7717 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7718 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7719 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7720 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7721
7722 @item list -
7723 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7724 @end table
7725
7726 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7727 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7728 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7729
7730 @table @code
7731 @kindex set listsize
7732 @item set listsize @var{count}
7733 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7734 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7735 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7736 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7737
7738 @kindex show listsize
7739 @item show listsize
7740 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7741 @end table
7742
7743 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7744 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7745 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7746 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7747 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7748
7749 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7750 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7751 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7752 to specify some source line.
7753
7754 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7755
7756 @table @code
7757 @item list @var{location}
7758 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7759
7760 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7761 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7762 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7763 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7764 the same source file as the first location.
7765
7766 @item list ,@var{last}
7767 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7768
7769 @item list @var{first},
7770 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7771
7772 @item list +
7773 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7774
7775 @item list -
7776 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7777
7778 @item list
7779 As described in the preceding table.
7780 @end table
7781
7782 @node Specify Location
7783 @section Specifying a Location
7784 @cindex specifying location
7785 @cindex location
7786 @cindex source location
7787
7788 @menu
7789 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7790 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7791 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7792 @end menu
7793
7794 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7795 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7796 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7797 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7798 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7799
7800 @node Linespec Locations
7801 @subsection Linespec Locations
7802 @cindex linespec locations
7803
7804 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7805 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7806 specifying a linespec:
7807
7808 @table @code
7809 @item @var{linenum}
7810 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7811
7812 @item -@var{offset}
7813 @itemx +@var{offset}
7814 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7815 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7816 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7817 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7818 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7819 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7820 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7821 linespec.
7822
7823 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7824 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7825 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7826 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7827 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7828 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7829 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7830
7831 @item @var{function}
7832 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7833 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7834
7835 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7836 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7837
7838 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7839 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7840 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7841 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7842 functions in different source files.
7843
7844 @item @var{label}
7845 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7846 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7847 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7848 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7849
7850 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7851 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7852 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7853 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7854 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7855 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7856
7857 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7858 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7859 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7860 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7861 each one of those probes.
7862 @end table
7863
7864 @node Explicit Locations
7865 @subsection Explicit Locations
7866 @cindex explicit locations
7867
7868 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7869 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7870
7871 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7872 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7873 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7874 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7875 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7876
7877 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7878 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7879 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7880 the symbol table to know.
7881
7882 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7883 following table:
7884
7885 @table @code
7886 @item -source @var{filename}
7887 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7888 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7889 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7890 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7891 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7892
7893 @item -function @var{function}
7894 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7895 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7896 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7897 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7898
7899 @item -label @var{label}
7900 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7901 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7902 selected stack frame.
7903
7904 @item -line @var{number}
7905 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7906 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7907 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7908 relative to the current line.
7909 @end table
7910
7911 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7912 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7913
7914 @node Address Locations
7915 @subsection Address Locations
7916 @cindex address locations
7917
7918 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7919 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7920
7921 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7922 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7923 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7924 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7925 source files.
7926
7927 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7928 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7929 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7930 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7931 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7932 of @var{address}:
7933
7934 @table @code
7935 @item @var{expression}
7936 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7937
7938 @item @var{funcaddr}
7939 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7940 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7941 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7942 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7943 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7944 (although the Pascal form also works).
7945
7946 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7947 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7948
7949 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7950 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7951 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7952 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7953 functions with identical names in different source files.
7954 @end table
7955
7956 @node Edit
7957 @section Editing Source Files
7958 @cindex editing source files
7959
7960 @kindex edit
7961 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7962 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7963 The editing program of your choice
7964 is invoked with the current line set to
7965 the active line in the program.
7966 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7967 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7968
7969 @table @code
7970 @item edit @var{location}
7971 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7972 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7973 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7974 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7975 command most commonly used:
7976
7977 @table @code
7978 @item edit @var{number}
7979 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7980
7981 @item edit @var{function}
7982 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7983 @end table
7984
7985 @end table
7986
7987 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7988 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7989 @footnote{
7990 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7991 following command-line syntax:
7992 @smallexample
7993 ex +@var{number} file
7994 @end smallexample
7995 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7996 the file where to start editing.}.
7997 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7998 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7999 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8000 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8001 @smallexample
8002 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8003 export EDITOR
8004 gdb @dots{}
8005 @end smallexample
8006 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8007 @smallexample
8008 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8009 gdb @dots{}
8010 @end smallexample
8011
8012 @node Search
8013 @section Searching Source Files
8014 @cindex searching source files
8015
8016 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8017 regular expression.
8018
8019 @table @code
8020 @kindex search
8021 @kindex forward-search
8022 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8023 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8024 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8025 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8026 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8027 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8028 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8029 @code{fo}.
8030
8031 @kindex reverse-search
8032 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8033 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8034 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8035 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8036 this command as @code{rev}.
8037 @end table
8038
8039 @node Source Path
8040 @section Specifying Source Directories
8041
8042 @cindex source path
8043 @cindex directories for source files
8044 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8045 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8046 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8047 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8048 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8049 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8050 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8051
8052 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8053 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8054 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8055 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8056 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8057 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8058 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8059 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8060 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8061 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8062 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8063
8064 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8065 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8066 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8067 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8068 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8069 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8070
8071 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8072 source files.
8073
8074 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8075 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8076 each line is in the file.
8077
8078 @kindex directory
8079 @kindex dir
8080 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8081 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8082 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8083
8084 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8085 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8086
8087 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8088 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8089 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8090 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8091 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8092 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8093 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8094 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8095 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8096 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8097 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8098 name to look up the sources.
8099
8100 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8101 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8102 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8103 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8104 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8105 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8106 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8107 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8108
8109 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8110 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8111 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8112 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8113 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8114 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8115 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8116
8117 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8118 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8119 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8120 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8121 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8122 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8123 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8124 command.
8125
8126 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8127 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8128 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8129 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8130 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8131 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8132 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8133
8134 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8135 @cindex default source path substitution
8136 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8137 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8138 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8139 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8140 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8141 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8142 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8143 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8144 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8145 together.
8146
8147 @table @code
8148 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8149 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8150 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8151 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8152 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8153 part of absolute file names) or
8154 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8155 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8156
8157 @kindex cdir
8158 @kindex cwd
8159 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8160 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8161 @cindex compilation directory
8162 @cindex current directory
8163 @cindex working directory
8164 @cindex directory, current
8165 @cindex directory, compilation
8166 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8167 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8168 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8169 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8170 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8171 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8172
8173 @item directory
8174 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8175
8176 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8177 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8178
8179 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8180 @kindex set directories
8181 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8182 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8183
8184 @item show directories
8185 @kindex show directories
8186 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8187
8188 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8189 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8190 @kindex set substitute-path
8191 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8192 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8193 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8194
8195 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8196 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8197
8198 @smallexample
8199 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8200 @end smallexample
8201
8202 @noindent
8203 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8204 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8205 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8206
8207 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8208 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8209 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8210 the substitution.
8211
8212 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8213
8214 @smallexample
8215 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8216 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8217 @end smallexample
8218
8219 @noindent
8220 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8221 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8222 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8223 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8224
8225
8226 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8227 @kindex unset substitute-path
8228 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8229 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8230 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8231
8232 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8233
8234 @item show substitute-path [path]
8235 @kindex show substitute-path
8236 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8237 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8238
8239 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8240 rules.
8241
8242 @end table
8243
8244 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8245 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8246 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8247
8248 @enumerate
8249 @item
8250 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8251
8252 @item
8253 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8254 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8255 directories in one command.
8256 @end enumerate
8257
8258 @node Machine Code
8259 @section Source and Machine Code
8260 @cindex source line and its code address
8261
8262 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8263 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8264 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8265 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8266 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8267 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8268 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8269 well as hex.
8270
8271 @table @code
8272 @kindex info line
8273 @item info line @var{location}
8274 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8275 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8276 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8277 @end table
8278
8279 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8280 the object code for the first line of function
8281 @code{m4_changequote}:
8282
8283 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8284 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8285 @smallexample
8286 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8287 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8288 @end smallexample
8289
8290 @noindent
8291 @cindex code address and its source line
8292 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8293 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8294 @smallexample
8295 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8296 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8297 @end smallexample
8298
8299 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8300 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8301 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8302 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8303 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8304 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8305 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8306 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8307 Variables}).
8308
8309 @table @code
8310 @kindex disassemble
8311 @cindex assembly instructions
8312 @cindex instructions, assembly
8313 @cindex machine instructions
8314 @cindex listing machine instructions
8315 @item disassemble
8316 @itemx disassemble /m
8317 @itemx disassemble /s
8318 @itemx disassemble /r
8319 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8320 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8321 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8322 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8323 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8324 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8325 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8326 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8327 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8328 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8329
8330 @table @code
8331 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8332 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8333 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8334 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8335 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8336 @end table
8337
8338 @noindent
8339 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8340 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8341
8342 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8343 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8344
8345 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8346 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8347 @end table
8348
8349 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8350 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8351
8352 @smallexample
8353 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8354 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8355 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8356 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8357 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8358 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8359 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8360 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8361 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8362 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8363 End of assembler dump.
8364 @end smallexample
8365
8366 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8367 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8368 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8369
8370 @smallexample
8371 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8372 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8373 5 @{
8374 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8375 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8376 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8377 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8378 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8379
8380 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8381 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8382 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8383
8384 7 return 0;
8385 8 @}
8386 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8387 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8388 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8389
8390 End of assembler dump.
8391 @end smallexample
8392
8393 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8394 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8395 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8396 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8397 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8398 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8399 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8400 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8401 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8402
8403 @file{foo.h}:
8404
8405 @smallexample
8406 int
8407 foo (int a)
8408 @{
8409 if (a < 0)
8410 return a * 2;
8411 if (a == 0)
8412 return 1;
8413 return a + 10;
8414 @}
8415 @end smallexample
8416
8417 @file{foo.c}:
8418
8419 @smallexample
8420 #include "foo.h"
8421 volatile int x, y;
8422 int
8423 main ()
8424 @{
8425 x = foo (y);
8426 return 0;
8427 @}
8428 @end smallexample
8429
8430 @smallexample
8431 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8432 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8433 5 @{
8434
8435 6 x = foo (y);
8436 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8437 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8438
8439 7 return 0;
8440 8 @}
8441 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8442 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8443 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8444 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8445
8446 End of assembler dump.
8447 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8448 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8449 foo.c:
8450 5 @{
8451 6 x = foo (y);
8452 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8453
8454 foo.h:
8455 4 if (a < 0)
8456 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8457 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8458
8459 6 if (a == 0)
8460 7 return 1;
8461 8 return a + 10;
8462 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8463 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8464 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8465 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8466
8467 foo.c:
8468 6 x = foo (y);
8469 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8470
8471 7 return 0;
8472 8 @}
8473 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8474 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8475
8476 foo.h:
8477 5 return a * 2;
8478 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8479 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8480 End of assembler dump.
8481 @end smallexample
8482
8483 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8484
8485 @smallexample
8486 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8487 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8488 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8489 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8490 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8491 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8492 End of assembler dump.
8493 @end smallexample
8494
8495 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8496 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8497 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8498 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8499
8500 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8501 mnemonics or other syntax.
8502
8503 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8504 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8505 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8506 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8507 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8508
8509 @table @code
8510 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8511 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8512 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8513 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8514 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8515 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8516
8517 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8518 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8519 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8520 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8521
8522 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8523 @item show disassembly-flavor
8524 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8525 @end table
8526
8527 @table @code
8528 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8529 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8530 @item set disassemble-next-line
8531 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8532 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8533 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8534 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8535 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8536 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8537 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8538 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8539 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8540 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8541 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8542 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8543 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8544 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8545 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8546 instruction.
8547 @end table
8548
8549
8550 @node Data
8551 @chapter Examining Data
8552
8553 @cindex printing data
8554 @cindex examining data
8555 @kindex print
8556 @kindex inspect
8557 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8558 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8559 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8560 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8561 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8562 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8563
8564 @table @code
8565 @item print @var{expr}
8566 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8567 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8568 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8569 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8570 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8571 Formats}.
8572
8573 @item print
8574 @itemx print /@var{f}
8575 @cindex reprint the last value
8576 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8577 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8578 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8579 @end table
8580
8581 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8582 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8583 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8584
8585 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8586 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8587 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8588 Table}.
8589
8590 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8591 @kindex explore
8592 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8593 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8594 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8595 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8596 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8597 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8598 embedded in the higher level data types.
8599
8600 @table @code
8601 @item explore @var{arg}
8602 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8603 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8604 @end table
8605
8606 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8607 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8608 C program as
8609
8610 @smallexample
8611 struct SimpleStruct
8612 @{
8613 int i;
8614 double d;
8615 @};
8616
8617 struct ComplexStruct
8618 @{
8619 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8620 int arr[10];
8621 @};
8622 @end smallexample
8623
8624 @noindent
8625 followed by variable declarations as
8626
8627 @smallexample
8628 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8629 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8630 @end smallexample
8631
8632 @noindent
8633 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8634 @code{explore} command as follows.
8635
8636 @smallexample
8637 (gdb) explore cs
8638 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8639 the following fields:
8640
8641 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8642 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8643
8644 Enter the field number of choice:
8645 @end smallexample
8646
8647 @noindent
8648 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8649 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8650 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8651 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8652 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8653 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8654 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8655 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8656
8657 @smallexample
8658 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8659 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8660 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8661 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8662
8663 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8664 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8665
8666 Press enter to return to parent value:
8667 @end smallexample
8668
8669 @noindent
8670 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8671 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8672 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8673 to explore.
8674
8675 @smallexample
8676 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8677 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8678
8679 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8680
8681 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8682
8683 Press enter to return to parent value:
8684 @end smallexample
8685
8686 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8687 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8688 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8689 level data structure).
8690
8691 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8692 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8693 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8694 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8695 same example as above, your can explore the type
8696 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8697 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8698
8699 @smallexample
8700 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8701 @end smallexample
8702
8703 @noindent
8704 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8705 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8706 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8707 example.
8708
8709 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8710 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8711 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8712 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8713 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8714
8715 @table @code
8716 @item explore value @var{expr}
8717 @cindex explore value
8718 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8719 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8720 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8721 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8722 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8723
8724 @item explore type @var{arg}
8725 @cindex explore type
8726 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8727 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8728 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8729 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8730 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8731 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8732 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8733 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8734 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8735 @end table
8736
8737 @menu
8738 * Expressions:: Expressions
8739 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8740 * Variables:: Program variables
8741 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8742 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8743 * Memory:: Examining memory
8744 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8745 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8746 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8747 * Value History:: Value history
8748 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8749 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8750 * Registers:: Registers
8751 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8752 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8753 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8754 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8755 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8756 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8757 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8758 character set than GDB does
8759 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8760 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8761 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8762 @end menu
8763
8764 @node Expressions
8765 @section Expressions
8766
8767 @cindex expressions
8768 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8769 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8770 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8771 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8772 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8773 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8774 @ref{Compilation}.
8775
8776 @cindex arrays in expressions
8777 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8778 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8779 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8780 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8781 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8782 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8783
8784 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8785 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8786 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8787 languages.
8788
8789 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8790 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8791
8792 @cindex casts, in expressions
8793 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8794 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8795 at that address in memory.
8796 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8797
8798 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8799 to programming languages:
8800
8801 @table @code
8802 @item @@
8803 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8804 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8805
8806 @item ::
8807 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8808 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8809
8810 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8811 @cindex type casting memory
8812 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8813 @cindex casts, to view memory
8814 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8815 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8816 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8817 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8818 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8819 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8820 @end table
8821
8822 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8823 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8824 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8825
8826 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8827 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8828 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8829 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8830 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8831 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8832 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8833
8834 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8835 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8836 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8837 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8838 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8839 as well.
8840
8841 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8842 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8843 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8844 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8845 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8846 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8847 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8848 choices.
8849
8850 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8851 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8852 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8853
8854 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8855 @smallexample
8856 @group
8857 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8858 [0] cancel
8859 [1] all
8860 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8861 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8862 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8863 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8864 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8865 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8866 > 2 4 6
8867 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8868 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8869 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8870 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8871 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8872 breakpoints.
8873 (@value{GDBP})
8874 @end group
8875 @end smallexample
8876
8877 @table @code
8878 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8879 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8880 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8881
8882 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8883 is ambiguous.
8884
8885 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8886 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8887 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8888 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8889 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8890 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8891 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8892 in the use of the menu.
8893
8894 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8895 when an ambiguity is detected.
8896
8897 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8898 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8899
8900 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8901 @item show multiple-symbols
8902 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8903 @end table
8904
8905 @node Variables
8906 @section Program Variables
8907
8908 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8909 in your program.
8910
8911 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8912 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8913
8914 @itemize @bullet
8915 @item
8916 global (or file-static)
8917 @end itemize
8918
8919 @noindent or
8920
8921 @itemize @bullet
8922 @item
8923 visible according to the scope rules of the
8924 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8925 @end itemize
8926
8927 @noindent This means that in the function
8928
8929 @smallexample
8930 foo (a)
8931 int a;
8932 @{
8933 bar (a);
8934 @{
8935 int b = test ();
8936 bar (b);
8937 @}
8938 @}
8939 @end smallexample
8940
8941 @noindent
8942 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8943 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8944 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8945 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8946
8947 @cindex variable name conflict
8948 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8949 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8950 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8951 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8952 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8953 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8954 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8955
8956 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8957 @ifnotinfo
8958 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8959 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8960 @end ifnotinfo
8961 @smallexample
8962 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8963 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8964 @end smallexample
8965
8966 @noindent
8967 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8968 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8969 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8970 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8971
8972 @smallexample
8973 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8974 @end smallexample
8975
8976 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8977 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8978 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8979 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8980 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8981
8982 @smallexample
8983 void
8984 foo (int a)
8985 @{
8986 if (a < 10)
8987 bar (a);
8988 else
8989 process (a); /* Stop here */
8990 @}
8991
8992 int
8993 bar (int a)
8994 @{
8995 foo (a + 5);
8996 @}
8997 @end smallexample
8998
8999 @noindent
9000 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9001 here is what you might see
9002 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9003
9004 @smallexample
9005 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9006 $1 = 10
9007 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9008 $2 = 5
9009 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9010 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9011 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9012 $3 = 5
9013 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9014 $4 = 0
9015 @end smallexample
9016
9017 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9018 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9019 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9020 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9021 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9022
9023 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9024 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9025 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9026 @code{some_global}.
9027
9028 @smallexample
9029 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9030 $1 = 23
9031 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9032 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9033 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9034 $2 = 27
9035 @end smallexample
9036
9037 @cindex wrong values
9038 @cindex variable values, wrong
9039 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9040 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9041 @quotation
9042 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9043 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9044 scope, and just before exit.
9045 @end quotation
9046 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9047 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9048 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9049 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9050 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9051 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9052 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9053 variable definitions may be gone.
9054
9055 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9056 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9057 when compiling.
9058
9059 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9060 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9061 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9062 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9063 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9064 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9065 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9066
9067 @smallexample
9068 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9069 @end smallexample
9070
9071 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9072 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9073 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9074 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9075 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9076
9077 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9078 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9079 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9080 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9081
9082 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9083 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9084 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9085 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9086 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9087
9088 @smallexample
9089 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9090 29 i++;
9091 (gdb) next
9092 30 e (i);
9093 (gdb) print i
9094 $1 = 31
9095 (gdb) print i@@entry
9096 $2 = 30
9097 @end smallexample
9098
9099 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9100 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9101 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9102 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9103 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9104 For program code
9105
9106 @smallexample
9107 char var0[] = "A";
9108 signed char var1[] = "A";
9109 @end smallexample
9110
9111 You get during debugging
9112 @smallexample
9113 (gdb) print var0
9114 $1 = "A"
9115 (gdb) print var1
9116 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9117 @end smallexample
9118
9119 @node Arrays
9120 @section Artificial Arrays
9121
9122 @cindex artificial array
9123 @cindex arrays
9124 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9125 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9126 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9127 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9128 program.
9129
9130 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9131 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9132 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9133 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9134 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9135 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9136 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9137 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9138 example. If a program says
9139
9140 @smallexample
9141 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9142 @end smallexample
9143
9144 @noindent
9145 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9146
9147 @smallexample
9148 p *array@@len
9149 @end smallexample
9150
9151 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9152 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9153 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9154 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9155 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9156
9157 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9158 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9159 The value need not be in memory:
9160 @smallexample
9161 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9162 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9163 @end smallexample
9164
9165 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9166 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9167 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9168 @smallexample
9169 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9170 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9171 @end smallexample
9172
9173 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9174 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9175 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9176 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9177 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9178 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9179 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9180 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9181 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9182 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9183
9184 @smallexample
9185 set $i = 0
9186 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9187 @key{RET}
9188 @key{RET}
9189 @dots{}
9190 @end smallexample
9191
9192 @node Output Formats
9193 @section Output Formats
9194
9195 @cindex formatted output
9196 @cindex output formats
9197 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9198 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9199 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9200 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9201 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9202
9203 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9204 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9205 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9206 letters supported are:
9207
9208 @table @code
9209 @item x
9210 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9211 hexadecimal.
9212
9213 @item d
9214 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9215
9216 @item u
9217 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9218
9219 @item o
9220 Print as integer in octal.
9221
9222 @item t
9223 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9224 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9225 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9226 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9227
9228 @item a
9229 @cindex unknown address, locating
9230 @cindex locate address
9231 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9232 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9233 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9234
9235 @smallexample
9236 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9237 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9238 @end smallexample
9239
9240 @noindent
9241 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9242 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9243
9244 @item c
9245 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9246 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9247 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9248 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9249
9250 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9251 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9252 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9253 data.
9254
9255 @item f
9256 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9257 using typical floating point syntax.
9258
9259 @item s
9260 @cindex printing strings
9261 @cindex printing byte arrays
9262 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9263 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9264 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9265 natural types.
9266
9267 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9268 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9269 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9270 array.
9271
9272 @item z
9273 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9274 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9275 to the size of the integer type.
9276
9277 @item r
9278 @cindex raw printing
9279 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9280 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9281 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9282 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9283 pretty-printer which might exist.
9284 @end table
9285
9286 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9287
9288 @smallexample
9289 p/x $pc
9290 @end smallexample
9291
9292 @noindent
9293 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9294 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9295
9296 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9297 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9298 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9299
9300 @node Memory
9301 @section Examining Memory
9302
9303 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9304 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9305
9306 @cindex examining memory
9307 @table @code
9308 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9309 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9310 @itemx x @var{addr}
9311 @itemx x
9312 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9313 @end table
9314
9315 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9316 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9317 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9318 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9319 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9320
9321 @table @r
9322 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9323 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9324 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9325 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9326 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9327 @c 4.1.2.
9328
9329 @item @var{f}, the display format
9330 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9331 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9332 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9333 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9334 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9335
9336 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9337 The unit size is any of
9338
9339 @table @code
9340 @item b
9341 Bytes.
9342 @item h
9343 Halfwords (two bytes).
9344 @item w
9345 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9346 @item g
9347 Giant words (eight bytes).
9348 @end table
9349
9350 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9351 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9352 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9353 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9354 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9355 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9356 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9357 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9358 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9359 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9360 be altered.
9361
9362 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9363 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9364 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9365 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9366 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9367 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9368 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9369 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9370 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9371 a value from memory).
9372 @end table
9373
9374 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9375 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9376 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9377 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9378 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9379
9380 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9381 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9382 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9383
9384 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9385 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9386 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9387 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9388 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9389
9390 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9391 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9392 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9393 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9394 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9395 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9396 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9397 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9398 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9399
9400 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9401 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9402 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9403 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9404 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9405 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9406
9407 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9408 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9409 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9410 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9411 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9412 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9413 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9414
9415 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9416 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9417
9418 @smallexample
9419 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9420 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9421 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9422 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9423 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9424 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9425 @end smallexample
9426
9427 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9428 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9429 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9430 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9431 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9432 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9433 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9434 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9435 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9436
9437 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9438 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9439 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9440
9441 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9442 @cindex addressable memory unit
9443 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9444 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9445 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9446 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9447 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9448 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9449 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9450 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9451 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9452
9453 @cindex remote memory comparison
9454 @cindex target memory comparison
9455 @cindex verify remote memory image
9456 @cindex verify target memory image
9457 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9458 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9459 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9460 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9461 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9462 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9463
9464 @table @code
9465 @kindex compare-sections
9466 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9467 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9468 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9469 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9470 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9471 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9472
9473 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9474 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9475 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9476 @end table
9477
9478 @node Auto Display
9479 @section Automatic Display
9480 @cindex automatic display
9481 @cindex display of expressions
9482
9483 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9484 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9485 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9486 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9487 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9488 The automatic display looks like this:
9489
9490 @smallexample
9491 2: foo = 38
9492 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9493 @end smallexample
9494
9495 @noindent
9496 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9497 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9498 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9499 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9500 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9501 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9502
9503 @table @code
9504 @kindex display
9505 @item display @var{expr}
9506 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9507 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9508
9509 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9510
9511 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9512 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9513 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9514 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9515 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9516
9517 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9518 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9519 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9520 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9521 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9522 @end table
9523
9524 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9525 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9526 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9527
9528 @table @code
9529 @kindex delete display
9530 @kindex undisplay
9531 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9532 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9533 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9534 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9535 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9536 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9537 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9538
9539 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9540 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9541
9542 @kindex disable display
9543 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9544 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9545 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9546 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9547 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9548 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9549 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9550 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9551
9552 @kindex enable display
9553 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9554 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9555 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9556 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9557 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9558 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9559 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9560
9561 @item display
9562 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9563 done when your program stops.
9564
9565 @kindex info display
9566 @item info display
9567 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9568 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9569 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9570 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9571 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9572 @end table
9573
9574 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9575 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9576 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9577 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9578 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9579 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9580 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9581 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9582 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9583 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9584 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9585
9586 @node Print Settings
9587 @section Print Settings
9588
9589 @cindex format options
9590 @cindex print settings
9591 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9592 and symbols are printed.
9593
9594 @noindent
9595 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9596
9597 @table @code
9598 @kindex set print
9599 @item set print address
9600 @itemx set print address on
9601 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9602 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9603 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9604 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9605 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9606 @code{set print address on}:
9607
9608 @smallexample
9609 @group
9610 (@value{GDBP}) f
9611 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9612 at input.c:530
9613 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9614 @end group
9615 @end smallexample
9616
9617 @item set print address off
9618 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9619 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9620
9621 @smallexample
9622 @group
9623 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9624 (@value{GDBP}) f
9625 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9626 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9627 @end group
9628 @end smallexample
9629
9630 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9631 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9632 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9633 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9634
9635 @kindex show print
9636 @item show print address
9637 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9638 @end table
9639
9640 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9641 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9642 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9643 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9644 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9645 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9646 it prints a symbolic address:
9647
9648 @table @code
9649 @item set print symbol-filename on
9650 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9651 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9652 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9653 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9654
9655 @item set print symbol-filename off
9656 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9657 default.
9658
9659 @item show print symbol-filename
9660 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9661 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9662 @end table
9663
9664 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9665 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9666 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9667
9668 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9669 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9670
9671 @table @code
9672 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9673 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9674 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9675 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9676 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9677 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9678 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9679 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9680
9681 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9682 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9683 symbolic address.
9684 @end table
9685
9686 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9687 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9688 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9689 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9690 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9691 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9692 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9693 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9694
9695 @smallexample
9696 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9697 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9698 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9699 @end smallexample
9700
9701 @quotation
9702 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9703 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9704 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9705 @end quotation
9706
9707 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9708 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9709
9710 @table @code
9711 @item set print symbol on
9712 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9713 one exists.
9714
9715 @item set print symbol off
9716 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9717 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9718 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9719
9720 @item show print symbol
9721 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9722 address.
9723 @end table
9724
9725 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9726
9727 @table @code
9728 @item set print array
9729 @itemx set print array on
9730 @cindex pretty print arrays
9731 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9732 but uses more space. The default is off.
9733
9734 @item set print array off
9735 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9736
9737 @item show print array
9738 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9739 arrays.
9740
9741 @cindex print array indexes
9742 @item set print array-indexes
9743 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9744 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9745 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9746 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9747
9748 @item set print array-indexes off
9749 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9750
9751 @item show print array-indexes
9752 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9753 arrays.
9754
9755 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9756 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9757 @cindex number of array elements to print
9758 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9759 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9760 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9761 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9762 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9763 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9764 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9765 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9766
9767 @item show print elements
9768 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9769 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9770
9771 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9772 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9773 @cindex printing frame argument values
9774 @cindex print all frame argument values
9775 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9776 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9777 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9778 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9779 values are:
9780
9781 @table @code
9782 @item all
9783 The values of all arguments are printed.
9784
9785 @item scalars
9786 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9787 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9788 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9789 only scalar arguments are shown:
9790
9791 @smallexample
9792 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9793 at frame-args.c:23
9794 @end smallexample
9795
9796 @item none
9797 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9798 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9799
9800 @smallexample
9801 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9802 at frame-args.c:23
9803 @end smallexample
9804 @end table
9805
9806 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9807 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9808 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9809 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9810 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9811 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9812 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9813 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9814 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9815 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9816
9817 @item show print frame-arguments
9818 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9819
9820 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9821 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9822
9823 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9824 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9825 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9826 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9827 This is the default.
9828
9829 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9830 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9831
9832 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9833 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9834 @kindex set print entry-values
9835 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9836 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9837 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9838 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9839 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9840
9841 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9842 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9843 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9844 @code{no} setting.
9845
9846 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9847 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9848 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9849 this information.
9850
9851 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9852
9853 @table @code
9854 @item no
9855 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9856 point.
9857 @smallexample
9858 #0 equal (val=5)
9859 #0 different (val=6)
9860 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9861 #0 born (val=10)
9862 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9863 @end smallexample
9864
9865 @item only
9866 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9867 values are never printed.
9868 @smallexample
9869 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9870 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9871 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9872 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9873 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9874 @end smallexample
9875
9876 @item preferred
9877 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9878 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9879 value for such parameter.
9880 @smallexample
9881 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9882 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9883 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9884 #0 born (val=10)
9885 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9886 @end smallexample
9887
9888 @item if-needed
9889 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9890 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9891 parameter.
9892 @smallexample
9893 #0 equal (val=5)
9894 #0 different (val=6)
9895 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9896 #0 born (val=10)
9897 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9898 @end smallexample
9899
9900 @item both
9901 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9902 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9903 optimizations.
9904 @smallexample
9905 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9906 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9907 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9908 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9909 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9910 @end smallexample
9911
9912 @item compact
9913 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9914 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9915 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9916 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9917 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9918 @smallexample
9919 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9920 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9921 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9922 #0 born (val=10)
9923 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9924 @end smallexample
9925
9926 @item default
9927 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9928 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9929 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9930 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9931 @smallexample
9932 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9933 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9934 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9935 #0 born (val=10)
9936 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9937 @end smallexample
9938 @end table
9939
9940 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9941 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9942
9943 @item show print entry-values
9944 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9945 entry.
9946
9947 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9948 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9949 @cindex repeated array elements
9950 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9951 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9952 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9953 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9954 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9955 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9956 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9957 is 10.
9958
9959 @item show print repeats
9960 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9961 elements.
9962
9963 @item set print null-stop
9964 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9965 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9966 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9967 contain only short strings.
9968 The default is off.
9969
9970 @item show print null-stop
9971 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9972 @sc{null} character.
9973
9974 @item set print pretty on
9975 @cindex print structures in indented form
9976 @cindex indentation in structure display
9977 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9978 per line, like this:
9979
9980 @smallexample
9981 @group
9982 $1 = @{
9983 next = 0x0,
9984 flags = @{
9985 sweet = 1,
9986 sour = 1
9987 @},
9988 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9989 @}
9990 @end group
9991 @end smallexample
9992
9993 @item set print pretty off
9994 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9995
9996 @smallexample
9997 @group
9998 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9999 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10000 @end group
10001 @end smallexample
10002
10003 @noindent
10004 This is the default format.
10005
10006 @item show print pretty
10007 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10008
10009 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10010 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10011 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10012 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10013 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10014 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10015 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10016 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10017
10018 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10019 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10020 international character sets, and is the default.
10021
10022 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10023 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10024
10025 @item set print union on
10026 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10027 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10028 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10029
10030 @item set print union off
10031 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10032 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10033 instead.
10034
10035 @item show print union
10036 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10037 structures and other unions.
10038
10039 For example, given the declarations
10040
10041 @smallexample
10042 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10043 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10044 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10045 Bug_forms;
10046
10047 struct thing @{
10048 Species it;
10049 union @{
10050 Tree_forms tree;
10051 Bug_forms bug;
10052 @} form;
10053 @};
10054
10055 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10056 @end smallexample
10057
10058 @noindent
10059 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10060
10061 @smallexample
10062 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10063 @end smallexample
10064
10065 @noindent
10066 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10067
10068 @smallexample
10069 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10070 @end smallexample
10071
10072 @noindent
10073 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10074 and in Pascal.
10075 @end table
10076
10077 @need 1000
10078 @noindent
10079 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10080
10081 @table @code
10082 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10083 @item set print demangle
10084 @itemx set print demangle on
10085 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10086 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10087 linkage. The default is on.
10088
10089 @item show print demangle
10090 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10091
10092 @item set print asm-demangle
10093 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10094 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10095 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10096 The default is off.
10097
10098 @item show print asm-demangle
10099 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10100 or demangled form.
10101
10102 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10103 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10104 @kindex set demangle-style
10105 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10106 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10107 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10108
10109 @table @code
10110 @item auto
10111 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10112 This is the default.
10113
10114 @item gnu
10115 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10116
10117 @item hp
10118 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10119
10120 @item lucid
10121 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10122
10123 @item arm
10124 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10125 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10126 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10127 require further enhancement to permit that.
10128
10129 @end table
10130 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10131
10132 @item show demangle-style
10133 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10134
10135 @item set print object
10136 @itemx set print object on
10137 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10138 @cindex display derived types
10139 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10140 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10141 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10142 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10143 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10144 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10145 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10146
10147 @item set print object off
10148 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10149 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10150
10151 @item show print object
10152 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10153
10154 @item set print static-members
10155 @itemx set print static-members on
10156 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10157 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10158
10159 @item set print static-members off
10160 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10161
10162 @item show print static-members
10163 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10164
10165 @item set print pascal_static-members
10166 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10167 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10168 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10169 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10170
10171 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10172 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10173
10174 @item show print pascal_static-members
10175 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10176
10177 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10178 @item set print vtbl
10179 @itemx set print vtbl on
10180 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10181 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10182 @cindex VTBL display
10183 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10184 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10185 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10186
10187 @item set print vtbl off
10188 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10189
10190 @item show print vtbl
10191 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10192 @end table
10193
10194 @node Pretty Printing
10195 @section Pretty Printing
10196
10197 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10198 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10199 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10200
10201 @menu
10202 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10203 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10204 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10205 @end menu
10206
10207 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10208 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10209
10210 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10211 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10212 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10213
10214 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10215 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10216 pretty-printers with their names.
10217 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10218 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10219 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10220 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10221
10222 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10223 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10224 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10225 do anything special.
10226
10227 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10228
10229 @itemize @bullet
10230 @item
10231 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10232 all inferiors.
10233
10234 @item
10235 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10236 when debugging that program.
10237 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10238
10239 @item
10240 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10241 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10242 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10243 @end itemize
10244
10245 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10246 pretty-printers are selected,
10247
10248 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10249 for new types.
10250
10251 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10252 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10253
10254 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10255
10256 @smallexample
10257 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10258 $1 = @{
10259 static npos = 4294967295,
10260 _M_dataplus = @{
10261 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10262 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10263 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10264 @},
10265 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10266 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10267 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10268 @}
10269 @}
10270 @end smallexample
10271
10272 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10273
10274 @smallexample
10275 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10276 $2 = "abcd"
10277 @end smallexample
10278
10279 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10280 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10281 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10282
10283 @table @code
10284 @kindex info pretty-printer
10285 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10286 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10287 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10288
10289 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10290 whose pretty-printers to list.
10291 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10292 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10293 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10294 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10295 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10296
10297 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10298 to list.
10299
10300 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10301 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10302 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10303 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10304
10305 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10306 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10307 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10308 @end table
10309
10310 Example:
10311
10312 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10313 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10314 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10315 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10316
10317 @smallexample
10318 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10319 library1.so:
10320 foo
10321 library2.so:
10322 bar
10323 bar1
10324 bar2
10325 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10326 library2.so:
10327 bar
10328 bar1
10329 bar2
10330 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10331 1 printer disabled
10332 2 of 3 printers enabled
10333 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10334 library1.so:
10335 foo [disabled]
10336 library2.so:
10337 bar
10338 bar1
10339 bar2
10340 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10341 1 printer disabled
10342 1 of 3 printers enabled
10343 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10344 library1.so:
10345 foo [disabled]
10346 library2.so:
10347 bar
10348 bar1 [disabled]
10349 bar2
10350 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10351 1 printer disabled
10352 0 of 3 printers enabled
10353 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10354 library1.so:
10355 foo [disabled]
10356 library2.so:
10357 bar [disabled]
10358 bar1 [disabled]
10359 bar2
10360 @end smallexample
10361
10362 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10363 as can each individual subprinter.
10364
10365 @node Value History
10366 @section Value History
10367
10368 @cindex value history
10369 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10370 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10371 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10372 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10373 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10374 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10375 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10376 symbol table.
10377
10378 @cindex @code{$}
10379 @cindex @code{$$}
10380 @cindex history number
10381 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10382 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10383 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10384 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10385 history number.
10386
10387 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10388 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10389 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10390 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10391 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10392 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10393 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10394
10395 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10396 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10397
10398 @smallexample
10399 p *$
10400 @end smallexample
10401
10402 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10403 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10404
10405 @smallexample
10406 p *$.next
10407 @end smallexample
10408
10409 @noindent
10410 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10411 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10412
10413 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10414 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10415
10416 @smallexample
10417 print x
10418 set x=5
10419 @end smallexample
10420
10421 @noindent
10422 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10423 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10424
10425 @table @code
10426 @kindex show values
10427 @item show values
10428 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10429 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10430 values} does not change the history.
10431
10432 @item show values @var{n}
10433 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10434
10435 @item show values +
10436 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10437 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10438 @end table
10439
10440 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10441 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10442
10443 @node Convenience Vars
10444 @section Convenience Variables
10445
10446 @cindex convenience variables
10447 @cindex user-defined variables
10448 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10449 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10450 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10451 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10452 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10453
10454 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10455 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10456 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10457 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10458 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10459
10460 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10461 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10462 For example:
10463
10464 @smallexample
10465 set $foo = *object_ptr
10466 @end smallexample
10467
10468 @noindent
10469 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10470 @code{object_ptr}.
10471
10472 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10473 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10474 value with another assignment at any time.
10475
10476 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10477 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10478 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10479 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10480
10481 @table @code
10482 @kindex show convenience
10483 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10484 @item show convenience
10485 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10486 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10487 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10488
10489 @kindex init-if-undefined
10490 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10491 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10492 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10493 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10494 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10495 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10496 override default values used in a command script.
10497
10498 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10499 any side-effects do not occur.
10500 @end table
10501
10502 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10503 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10504 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10505
10506 @smallexample
10507 set $i = 0
10508 print bar[$i++]->contents
10509 @end smallexample
10510
10511 @noindent
10512 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10513
10514 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10515 values likely to be useful.
10516
10517 @table @code
10518 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10519 @item $_
10520 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10521 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10522 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10523 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10524 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10525 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10526 to the type of @code{$__}.
10527
10528 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10529 @item $__
10530 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10531 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10532 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10533
10534 @item $_exitcode
10535 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10536 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10537 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10538 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10539
10540 @item $_exitsignal
10541 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10542 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10543 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10544 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10545
10546 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10547 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10548 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10549 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10550 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10551
10552 @smallexample
10553 #include <signal.h>
10554
10555 int
10556 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10557 @{
10558 raise (SIGALRM);
10559 return 0;
10560 @}
10561 @end smallexample
10562
10563 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10564 or signalled would be:
10565
10566 @smallexample
10567 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10568 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10569 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10570 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10571 >echo The program has exited\n
10572 >else
10573 >echo The program has signalled\n
10574 >end
10575 >end
10576 (@value{GDBP}) run
10577 Starting program:
10578
10579 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10580 The program no longer exists.
10581 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10582 The program has signalled
10583 @end smallexample
10584
10585 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10586 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10587 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10588 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10589
10590 @smallexample
10591 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10592 The program has exited
10593 @end smallexample
10594
10595 @item $_exception
10596 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10597 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10598
10599 @item $_probe_argc
10600 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10601 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10602
10603 @item $_sdata
10604 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10605 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10606 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10607 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10608 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10609
10610 @item $_siginfo
10611 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10612 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10613 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10614 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10615 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10616
10617 @item $_tlb
10618 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10619 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10620 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10621 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10622 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10623 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10624
10625 @item $_inferior
10626 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10627 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10628
10629 @item $_thread
10630 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10631
10632 @item $_gthread
10633 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10634
10635 @end table
10636
10637 @node Convenience Funs
10638 @section Convenience Functions
10639
10640 @cindex convenience functions
10641 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10642 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10643 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10644 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10645 @value{GDBN}.
10646
10647 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10648 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10649
10650 @table @code
10651
10652 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10653 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10654 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10655 returns zero.
10656
10657 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10658 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10659 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10660 it is @code{void}:
10661
10662 @smallexample
10663 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10664 $1 = void
10665 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10666 $2 = 1
10667 (@value{GDBP}) run
10668 Starting program: ./a.out
10669 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10670 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10671 $3 = 0
10672 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10673 $4 = 0
10674 @end smallexample
10675
10676 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10677 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10678 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10679 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10680 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10681 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10682 anymore.
10683
10684 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10685 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10686
10687 @smallexample
10688 void
10689 foo (void)
10690 @{
10691 @}
10692 @end smallexample
10693
10694 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10695
10696 @smallexample
10697 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10698 $1 = void
10699 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10700 $2 = 1
10701 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10702 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10703 $3 = void
10704 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10705 $4 = 1
10706 @end smallexample
10707
10708 @end table
10709
10710 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10711 @code{Python} support.
10712
10713 @table @code
10714
10715 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10716 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10717 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10718 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10719 Otherwise it returns zero.
10720
10721 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10722 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10723 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10724 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10725 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10726 regular expression support.
10727
10728 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10729 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10730 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10731 Otherwise it returns zero.
10732
10733 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10734 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10735 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10736
10737 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10738 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10739 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10740 Otherwise it returns zero.
10741
10742 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10743 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10744 The default is 1.
10745
10746 Example:
10747
10748 @smallexample
10749 (gdb) backtrace
10750 #0 bottom_func ()
10751 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10752 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10753 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10754 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10755 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10756 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10757 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10758 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10759 $1 = 1
10760 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10761 $1 = 1
10762 @end smallexample
10763
10764 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10765 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10766 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10767 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10768
10769 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10770 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10771 The default is 1.
10772
10773 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10774 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10775 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10776 Otherwise it returns zero.
10777
10778 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10779 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10780 The default is 1.
10781
10782 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10783 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10784 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10785 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10786
10787 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10788 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10789 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10790 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10791
10792 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10793 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10794 The default is 1.
10795
10796 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10797 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10798 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10799 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10800
10801 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10802 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10803 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10804
10805 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10806 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10807 an enumerated type:
10808
10809 @smallexample
10810 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10811 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10812 @end smallexample
10813
10814 @end table
10815
10816 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10817 convenience functions.
10818
10819 @table @code
10820 @item help function
10821 @kindex help function
10822 @cindex show all convenience functions
10823 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10824 @end table
10825
10826 @node Registers
10827 @section Registers
10828
10829 @cindex registers
10830 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10831 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10832 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10833 your machine.
10834
10835 @table @code
10836 @kindex info registers
10837 @item info registers
10838 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10839 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10840
10841 @kindex info all-registers
10842 @cindex floating point registers
10843 @item info all-registers
10844 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10845 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10846
10847 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10848 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10849 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10850 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10851 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10852 @end table
10853
10854 @anchor{standard registers}
10855 @cindex stack pointer register
10856 @cindex program counter register
10857 @cindex process status register
10858 @cindex frame pointer register
10859 @cindex standard registers
10860 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10861 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10862 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10863 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10864 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10865 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10866 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10867 you could print the program counter in hex with
10868
10869 @smallexample
10870 p/x $pc
10871 @end smallexample
10872
10873 @noindent
10874 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10875
10876 @smallexample
10877 x/i $pc
10878 @end smallexample
10879
10880 @noindent
10881 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10882 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10883 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10884 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10885 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10886 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10887 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10888
10889 @smallexample
10890 set $sp += 4
10891 @end smallexample
10892
10893 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10894 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10895 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10896 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10897 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10898 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10899 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10900
10901 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10902 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10903 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10904 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10905 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10906 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10907 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10908
10909 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10910 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10911 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10912 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10913 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10914 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10915 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10916 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10917 prints the data in both formats.
10918
10919 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10920 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10921 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10922 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10923 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10924 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10925 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10926
10927 @smallexample
10928 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10929 $1 = @{
10930 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10931 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10932 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10933 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10934 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10935 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10936 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10937 @}
10938 @end smallexample
10939
10940 @noindent
10941 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10942 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10943 value to a @code{struct} member:
10944
10945 @smallexample
10946 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10947 @end smallexample
10948
10949 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10950 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10951 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10952 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10953 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10954 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10955
10956 @cindex caller-saved registers
10957 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10958 @cindex volatile registers
10959 @cindex <not saved> values
10960 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10961 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10962 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10963 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10964 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10965 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10966 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10967 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10968 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10969 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10970 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10971 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10972 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10973 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10974 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10975 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10976 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10977 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10978 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10979 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10980 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10981 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10982 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10983
10984 @node Floating Point Hardware
10985 @section Floating Point Hardware
10986 @cindex floating point
10987
10988 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10989 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10990
10991 @table @code
10992 @kindex info float
10993 @item info float
10994 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10995 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10996 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10997 the ARM and x86 machines.
10998 @end table
10999
11000 @node Vector Unit
11001 @section Vector Unit
11002 @cindex vector unit
11003
11004 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11005 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11006
11007 @table @code
11008 @kindex info vector
11009 @item info vector
11010 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11011 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11012 @end table
11013
11014 @node OS Information
11015 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11016 @cindex OS information
11017
11018 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11019 you debug your program.
11020
11021 @cindex auxiliary vector
11022 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11023 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11024 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11025 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11026 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11027 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11028 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11029 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11030 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11031 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11032 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11033 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11034
11035 @table @code
11036 @kindex info auxv
11037 @item info auxv
11038 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11039 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11040 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11041 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11042 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11043 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11044 an unrecognized tag.
11045 @end table
11046
11047 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11048 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11049 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11050 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11051 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11052 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11053 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11054
11055 @table @code
11056 @kindex info os
11057 @item info os @var{infotype}
11058
11059 Display OS information of the requested type.
11060
11061 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11062
11063 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11064 @table @code
11065 @kindex info os cpus
11066 @item cpus
11067 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11068 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11069 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11070 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11071 kernel initialization.
11072
11073 @kindex info os files
11074 @item files
11075 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11076 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11077 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11078 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11079
11080 @kindex info os modules
11081 @item modules
11082 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11083 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11084 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11085 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11086 in memory.
11087
11088 @kindex info os msg
11089 @item msg
11090 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11091 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11092 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11093 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11094 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11095 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11096 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11097 the message queue was last changed.
11098
11099 @kindex info os processes
11100 @item processes
11101 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11102 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11103 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11104 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11105 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11106 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11107
11108 @kindex info os procgroups
11109 @item procgroups
11110 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11111 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11112 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11113 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11114 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11115 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11116 and the process group leader is listed first.
11117
11118 @kindex info os semaphores
11119 @item semaphores
11120 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11121 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11122 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11123 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11124 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11125
11126 @kindex info os shm
11127 @item shm
11128 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11129 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11130 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11131 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11132 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11133 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11134 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11135
11136 @kindex info os sockets
11137 @item sockets
11138 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11139 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11140 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11141 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11142 connection.
11143
11144 @kindex info os threads
11145 @item threads
11146 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11147 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11148 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11149 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11150 process is not listed.
11151 @end table
11152
11153 @item info os
11154 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11155 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11156 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11157 types, this command will report an error.
11158 @end table
11159
11160 @node Memory Region Attributes
11161 @section Memory Region Attributes
11162 @cindex memory region attributes
11163
11164 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11165 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11166 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11167 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11168 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11169 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11170 user can override the fetched regions.
11171
11172 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11173 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11174 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11175 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11176 all memory.
11177
11178 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11179 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11180
11181 @table @code
11182 @kindex mem
11183 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11184 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11185 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11186 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11187 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11188 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11189
11190 @item mem auto
11191 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11192 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11193
11194 @kindex delete mem
11195 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11196 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11197 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11198
11199 @kindex disable mem
11200 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11201 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11202 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11203 It may be enabled again later.
11204
11205 @kindex enable mem
11206 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11207 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11208
11209 @kindex info mem
11210 @item info mem
11211 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11212 for each region:
11213
11214 @table @emph
11215 @item Memory Region Number
11216 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11217 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11218 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11219
11220 @item Lo Address
11221 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11222
11223 @item Hi Address
11224 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11225
11226 @item Attributes
11227 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11228 @end table
11229 @end table
11230
11231
11232 @subsection Attributes
11233
11234 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11235 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11236 write accesses to a memory region.
11237
11238 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11239 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11240 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11241
11242 @table @code
11243 @item ro
11244 Memory is read only.
11245 @item wo
11246 Memory is write only.
11247 @item rw
11248 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11249 @end table
11250
11251 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11252 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11253 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11254 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11255 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11256
11257 @table @code
11258 @item 8
11259 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11260 @item 16
11261 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11262 @item 32
11263 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11264 @item 64
11265 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11266 @end table
11267
11268 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11269 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11270 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11271 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11272 @c
11273 @c @table @code
11274 @c @item hwbreak
11275 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11276 @c @item swbreak (default)
11277 @c @end table
11278
11279 @subsubsection Data Cache
11280 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11281 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11282 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11283 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11284 registers.
11285
11286 @table @code
11287 @item cache
11288 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11289 @item nocache
11290 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11291 @end table
11292
11293 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11294 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11295 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11296 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11297 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11298
11299 @table @code
11300 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11301 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11302 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11303 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11304 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11305 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11306 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11307 The default value is @code{on}.
11308 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11309 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11310 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11311 @end table
11312
11313
11314 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11315 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11316 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11317 @c
11318 @c @table @code
11319 @c @item verify
11320 @c @item noverify (default)
11321 @c @end table
11322
11323 @node Dump/Restore Files
11324 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11325 @cindex dump/restore files
11326 @cindex append data to a file
11327 @cindex dump data to a file
11328 @cindex restore data from a file
11329
11330 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11331 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11332 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11333 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11334 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11335 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11336 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11337
11338 @table @code
11339
11340 @kindex dump
11341 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11342 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11343 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11344 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11345
11346 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11347 @table @code
11348 @item binary
11349 Raw binary form.
11350 @item ihex
11351 Intel hex format.
11352 @item srec
11353 Motorola S-record format.
11354 @item tekhex
11355 Tektronix Hex format.
11356 @item verilog
11357 Verilog Hex format.
11358 @end table
11359
11360 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11361 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11362 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11363 form.
11364
11365 @kindex append
11366 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11367 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11368 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11369 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11370 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11371
11372 @kindex restore
11373 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11374 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11375 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11376 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11377 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11378
11379 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11380 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11381 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11382 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11383 from that location.
11384
11385 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11386 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11387 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11388 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11389
11390 @end table
11391
11392 @node Core File Generation
11393 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11394 @cindex dump core from inferior
11395
11396 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11397 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11398 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11399 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11400 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11401 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11402 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11403
11404 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11405 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11406 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11407
11408 @table @code
11409 @kindex gcore
11410 @kindex generate-core-file
11411 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11412 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11413 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11414 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11415 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11416 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11417
11418 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11419 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11420
11421 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11422 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11423 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11424
11425 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11426 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11427 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11428 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11429 Enable or disable the use of the file
11430 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11431 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11432 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11433 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11434
11435 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11436 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11437 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11438 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11439 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11440 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11441 about the bits that can be set in the
11442 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11443 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11444
11445 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11446 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11447 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11448 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11449 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11450 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11451 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11452 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11453 @end table
11454
11455 @node Character Sets
11456 @section Character Sets
11457 @cindex character sets
11458 @cindex charset
11459 @cindex translating between character sets
11460 @cindex host character set
11461 @cindex target character set
11462
11463 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11464 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11465 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11466 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11467 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11468 @dfn{target character set}.
11469
11470 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11471 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11472 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11473 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11474 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11475 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11476 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11477 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11478 character and string literals in expressions.
11479
11480 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11481 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11482 target-charset} command, described below.
11483
11484 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11485 support:
11486
11487 @table @code
11488 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11489 @kindex set target-charset
11490 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11491 list of supported target character sets, type
11492 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11493
11494 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11495 @kindex set host-charset
11496 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11497
11498 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11499 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11500 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11501 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11502 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11503
11504 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11505 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11506 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11507
11508 @item set charset @var{charset}
11509 @kindex set charset
11510 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11511 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11512 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11513 for both host and target.
11514
11515 @item show charset
11516 @kindex show charset
11517 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11518
11519 @item show host-charset
11520 @kindex show host-charset
11521 Show the name of the current host character set.
11522
11523 @item show target-charset
11524 @kindex show target-charset
11525 Show the name of the current target character set.
11526
11527 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11528 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11529 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11530 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11531 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11532 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11533
11534 @item show target-wide-charset
11535 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11536 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11537 @end table
11538
11539 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11540 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11541 @file{charset-test.c}:
11542
11543 @smallexample
11544 #include <stdio.h>
11545
11546 char ascii_hello[]
11547 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11548 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11549 char ibm1047_hello[]
11550 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11551 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11552
11553 main ()
11554 @{
11555 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11556 @}
11557 @end smallexample
11558
11559 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11560 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11561 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11562
11563 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11564
11565 @smallexample
11566 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11567 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11568 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11569 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11570 @dots{}
11571 (@value{GDBP})
11572 @end smallexample
11573
11574 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11575 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11576 strings:
11577
11578 @smallexample
11579 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11580 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11581 (@value{GDBP})
11582 @end smallexample
11583
11584 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11585 initial character set:
11586 @smallexample
11587 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11588 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11589 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11590 (@value{GDBP})
11591 @end smallexample
11592
11593 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11594 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11595 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11596 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11597 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11598
11599 @smallexample
11600 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11601 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11602 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11603 $2 = 72 'H'
11604 (@value{GDBP})
11605 @end smallexample
11606
11607 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11608 literals you use in expressions:
11609
11610 @smallexample
11611 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11612 $3 = 43 '+'
11613 (@value{GDBP})
11614 @end smallexample
11615
11616 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11617 character.
11618
11619 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11620 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11621 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11622
11623 @smallexample
11624 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11625 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11626 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11627 $5 = 200 '\310'
11628 (@value{GDBP})
11629 @end smallexample
11630
11631 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11632 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11633
11634 @smallexample
11635 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11636 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11637 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11638 @end smallexample
11639
11640 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11641 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11642 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11643 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11644 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11645
11646 @smallexample
11647 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11648 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11649 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11650 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11651 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11652 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11653 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11654 $7 = 72 '\110'
11655 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11656 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11657 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11658 $9 = 200 'H'
11659 (@value{GDBP})
11660 @end smallexample
11661
11662 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11663 string literals you use in expressions:
11664
11665 @smallexample
11666 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11667 $10 = 78 '+'
11668 (@value{GDBP})
11669 @end smallexample
11670
11671 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11672 character.
11673
11674 @node Caching Target Data
11675 @section Caching Data of Targets
11676 @cindex caching data of targets
11677
11678 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11679 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11680 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11681 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11682 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11683 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11684 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11685 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11686 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11687 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11688 is executing.
11689 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11690 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11691 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11692 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11693 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11694 in the code segment.
11695 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11696 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11697
11698 @table @code
11699 @kindex set remotecache
11700 @item set remotecache on
11701 @itemx set remotecache off
11702 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11703 with old scripts.
11704
11705 @kindex show remotecache
11706 @item show remotecache
11707 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11708
11709 @kindex set stack-cache
11710 @item set stack-cache on
11711 @itemx set stack-cache off
11712 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11713 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11714
11715 @kindex show stack-cache
11716 @item show stack-cache
11717 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11718
11719 @kindex set code-cache
11720 @item set code-cache on
11721 @itemx set code-cache off
11722 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11723 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11724 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11725
11726 @kindex show code-cache
11727 @item show code-cache
11728 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11729 accesses.
11730
11731 @kindex info dcache
11732 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11733 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11734 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11735 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11736 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11737 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11738
11739 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11740 printed in hex.
11741
11742 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11743 @cindex dcache size
11744 @kindex set dcache size
11745 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11746
11747 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11748 @cindex dcache line-size
11749 @kindex set dcache line-size
11750 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11751 Must be a power of 2.
11752
11753 @item show dcache size
11754 @kindex show dcache size
11755 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11756
11757 @item show dcache line-size
11758 @kindex show dcache line-size
11759 Show default size of dcache lines.
11760
11761 @end table
11762
11763 @node Searching Memory
11764 @section Search Memory
11765 @cindex searching memory
11766
11767 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11768 @code{find} command.
11769
11770 @table @code
11771 @kindex find
11772 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11773 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11774 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11775 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11776 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11777 @end table
11778
11779 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11780 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11781
11782 @table @r
11783 @item @var{s}, search query size
11784 The size of each search query value.
11785
11786 @table @code
11787 @item b
11788 bytes
11789 @item h
11790 halfwords (two bytes)
11791 @item w
11792 words (four bytes)
11793 @item g
11794 giant words (eight bytes)
11795 @end table
11796
11797 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11798 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11799 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11800
11801 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11802 value's type in the current language.
11803 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11804 pattern as a mixture of types.
11805 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11806 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11807 which is typically four bytes.
11808
11809 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11810 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11811 @end table
11812
11813 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11814 (@code{"}).
11815 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11816 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11817
11818 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11819 number of matches found.
11820
11821 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11822 @samp{$_}.
11823 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11824
11825 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11826
11827 @smallexample
11828 void
11829 hello ()
11830 @{
11831 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11832 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11833 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11834 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11835 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11836 @}
11837 @end smallexample
11838
11839 @noindent
11840 you get during debugging:
11841
11842 @smallexample
11843 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11844 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11845 1 pattern found
11846 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11847 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11848 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11849 2 patterns found
11850 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11851 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11852 1 pattern found
11853 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11854 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11855 1 pattern found
11856 (gdb) print $numfound
11857 $1 = 1
11858 (gdb) print $_
11859 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11860 @end smallexample
11861
11862 @node Value Sizes
11863 @section Value Sizes
11864
11865 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11866 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11867 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11868 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11869 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11870
11871 @table @code
11872 @kindex set max-value-size
11873 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11874 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11875 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11876 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11877 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11878
11879 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11880 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11881
11882 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11883 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11884 currently 16 bytes.
11885
11886 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11887 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11888 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11889 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11890 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11891 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11892 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11893 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11894
11895 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11896
11897 @kindex show max-value-size
11898 @item show max-value-size
11899 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11900 allocate for the contents of a value.
11901 @end table
11902
11903 @node Optimized Code
11904 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11905 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11906 @cindex debugging optimized code
11907
11908 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11909 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11910 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11911 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11912 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11913 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11914 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11915
11916 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11917 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11918 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11919 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11920
11921 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11922 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11923 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11924 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11925 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11926 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11927
11928 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11929 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11930 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11931 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11932 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11933
11934 @menu
11935 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11936 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11937 @end menu
11938
11939 @node Inline Functions
11940 @section Inline Functions
11941 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11942
11943 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11944 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11945 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11946 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11947 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11948 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11949 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11950 @code{info frame} command.
11951
11952 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11953 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11954 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11955 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11956 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11957 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11958 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11959 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11960 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11961 local variables in the caller.
11962
11963 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11964 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11965 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11966 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11967 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11968 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11969 instructions are executed.
11970
11971 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11972 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11973 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11974 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11975
11976 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11977 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11978
11979 @itemize @bullet
11980 @item
11981 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11982 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11983 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11984 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11985 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11986 or inside the inlined function instead.
11987
11988 @item
11989 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11990 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11991 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11992 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11993
11994 @end itemize
11995
11996 @node Tail Call Frames
11997 @section Tail Call Frames
11998 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11999
12000 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12001 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12002 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12003 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12004 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12005
12006 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12007 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12008 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12009 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12010 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12011 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12012 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12013
12014 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12015 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
12016 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12017 this information.
12018
12019 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12020 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12021
12022 @smallexample
12023 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12024 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12025 (gdb) info frame
12026 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12027 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12028 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12029 source language c++.
12030 Arglist at unknown address.
12031 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12032 @end smallexample
12033
12034 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12035 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12036 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12037 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12038 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12039 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12040
12041 @table @code
12042 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12043 @item set debug entry-values
12044 @kindex set debug entry-values
12045 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12046 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12047 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12048 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12049 result.
12050
12051 @item show debug entry-values
12052 @kindex show debug entry-values
12053 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12054 values at function entry and tail calls.
12055 @end table
12056
12057 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12058 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12059 reference by variable @code{x}):
12060
12061 @smallexample
12062 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12063 void (*x) (void) = c;
12064 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12065 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12066 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12067
12068 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
12069 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
12070 a () at t.c:3
12071 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12072 (gdb) bt
12073 #0 a () at t.c:3
12074 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12075 @end smallexample
12076
12077 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12078
12079 @smallexample
12080 int i;
12081 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12082 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12083 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12084 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12085 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12086 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12087 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12088 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12089
12090 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12091 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12092 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12093 (gdb) bt
12094 #0 f () at t.c:2
12095 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12096 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12097 @end smallexample
12098
12099 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12100 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12101
12102 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12103 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12104 @set ARROW @click{}
12105 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12106 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12107 @end ifset
12108 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12109 @set ARROW ->
12110 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12111 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12112 @end ifclear
12113
12114 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12115 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12116 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12117
12118 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12119 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12120 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12121 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12122 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12123 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12124
12125 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12126 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12127 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12128 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12129 omitted.
12130
12131 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12132 entry may fail:
12133
12134 @smallexample
12135 int v;
12136 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12137 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12138 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12139 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12140 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12141 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12142
12143 (gdb) bt
12144 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12145 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
12146 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12147 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12148 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12149 @end smallexample
12150
12151 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12152 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12153 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12154 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12155 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12156
12157 @node Macros
12158 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12159
12160 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12161 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12162 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12163 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12164 where it was defined.
12165
12166 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12167 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12168 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12169 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12170
12171 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12172 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12173 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12174 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12175 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12176 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12177 see @ref{List}.
12178
12179 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12180 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12181 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12182
12183 @table @code
12184
12185 @kindex macro expand
12186 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12187 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12188 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12189 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12190 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12191 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12192 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12193 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12194 it can be any string of tokens.
12195
12196 @kindex macro exp1
12197 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12198 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12199 @cindex expand macro once
12200 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12201 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12202 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12203 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12204 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12205 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12206 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12207 can be any string of tokens.
12208
12209 @kindex info macro
12210 @cindex macro definition, showing
12211 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12212 @cindex macros, from debug info
12213 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12214 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12215 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12216 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12217 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12218 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12219
12220 @kindex info macros
12221 @item info macros @var{location}
12222 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12223 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12224 command-line where those definitions were established.
12225
12226 @kindex macro define
12227 @cindex user-defined macros
12228 @cindex defining macros interactively
12229 @cindex macros, user-defined
12230 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12231 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12232 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12233 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12234 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12235 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12236 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12237 @var{arglist}.
12238
12239 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12240 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12241 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12242 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12243 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12244
12245 @kindex macro undef
12246 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12247 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12248 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12249 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12250 in the program being debugged.
12251
12252 @kindex macro list
12253 @item macro list
12254 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12255 @end table
12256
12257 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12258 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12259 show our source files:
12260
12261 @smallexample
12262 $ cat sample.c
12263 #include <stdio.h>
12264 #include "sample.h"
12265
12266 #define M 42
12267 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12268
12269 main ()
12270 @{
12271 #define N 28
12272 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12273 #undef N
12274 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12275 #define N 1729
12276 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12277 @}
12278 $ cat sample.h
12279 #define Q <
12280 $
12281 @end smallexample
12282
12283 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12284 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12285 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12286 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12287 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12288 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12289 information.
12290
12291 @smallexample
12292 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12293 $
12294 @end smallexample
12295
12296 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12297
12298 @smallexample
12299 $ gdb -nw sample
12300 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12301 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12302 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12303 (@value{GDBP})
12304 @end smallexample
12305
12306 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12307 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12308 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12309
12310 @smallexample
12311 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12312 3
12313 4 #define M 42
12314 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12315 6
12316 7 main ()
12317 8 @{
12318 9 #define N 28
12319 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12320 11 #undef N
12321 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12322 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12323 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12324 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12325 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12326 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12327 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12328 #define Q <
12329 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12330 expands to: (42 + 1)
12331 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12332 expands to: once (M + 1)
12333 (@value{GDBP})
12334 @end smallexample
12335
12336 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12337 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12338 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12339 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12340
12341 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12342 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12343
12344 @smallexample
12345 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12346 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12347 (@value{GDBP}) run
12348 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12349
12350 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12351 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12352 (@value{GDBP})
12353 @end smallexample
12354
12355 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12356
12357 @smallexample
12358 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12359 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12360 #define N 28
12361 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12362 expands to: 28 < 42
12363 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12364 $1 = 1
12365 (@value{GDBP})
12366 @end smallexample
12367
12368 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12369 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12370 thereof) in force at each point:
12371
12372 @smallexample
12373 (@value{GDBP}) next
12374 Hello, world!
12375 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12376 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12377 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12378 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12379 (@value{GDBP}) next
12380 We're so creative.
12381 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12382 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12383 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12384 #define N 1729
12385 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12386 expands to: 1729 < 42
12387 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12388 $2 = 0
12389 (@value{GDBP})
12390 @end smallexample
12391
12392 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12393 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12394 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12395 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12396
12397 @smallexample
12398 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12399 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12400 -D__STDC__=1
12401 (@value{GDBP})
12402 @end smallexample
12403
12404
12405 @node Tracepoints
12406 @chapter Tracepoints
12407 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12408 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12409
12410 @cindex tracepoints
12411 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12412 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12413 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12414 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12415 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12416 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12417 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12418
12419 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12420 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12421 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12422 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12423 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12424 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12425 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12426 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12427 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12428 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12429 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12430
12431 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12432 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12433 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12434 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12435 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12436 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12437 Packets}.
12438
12439 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12440 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12441 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12442
12443 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12444
12445 @menu
12446 * Set Tracepoints::
12447 * Analyze Collected Data::
12448 * Tracepoint Variables::
12449 * Trace Files::
12450 @end menu
12451
12452 @node Set Tracepoints
12453 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12454
12455 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12456 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12457 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12458 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12459 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12460 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12461 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12462
12463 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12464 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12465 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12466 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12467 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12468 tracepoint was hit.
12469
12470 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12471 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12472 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12473 either.
12474
12475 @cindex fast tracepoints
12476 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12477 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12478 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12479
12480 @cindex static tracepoints
12481 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12482 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12483 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12484 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12485 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12486 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12487 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12488 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12489 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12490 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12491 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12492 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12493 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12494 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12495 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12496 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12497 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12498 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12499 static tracepoint marker.
12500
12501 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12502 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12503
12504 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12505 conditions and actions.
12506
12507 @menu
12508 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12509 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12510 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12511 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12512 * Trace State Variables::
12513 * Tracepoint Actions::
12514 * Listing Tracepoints::
12515 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12516 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12517 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12518 @end menu
12519
12520 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12521 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12522
12523 @table @code
12524 @cindex set tracepoint
12525 @kindex trace
12526 @item trace @var{location}
12527 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12528 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12529 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12530 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12531 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12532 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12533 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12534 in tracing}).
12535 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12536 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12537 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12538 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12539 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12540 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12541 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12542 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12543 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12544 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12545 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12546 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12547
12548 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12549
12550 @smallexample
12551 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12552
12553 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12554
12555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12556
12557 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12558
12559 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12560 @end smallexample
12561
12562 @noindent
12563 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12564
12565 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12566 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12567 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12568 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12569 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12570 information on tracepoint conditions.
12571
12572 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12573 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12574 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12575 @kindex ftrace
12576 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12577 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12578 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12579 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12580 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12581 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12582 message.
12583
12584 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12585 @code{trace}.
12586
12587 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12588 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12589 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12590 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12591 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12592 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12593 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12594 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12595
12596 @example
12597 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12598 @end example
12599
12600 @noindent
12601 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12602 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12603
12604 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12605 @cindex set static tracepoint
12606 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12607 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12608 @kindex strace
12609 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12610 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12611 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12612 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12613 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12614
12615 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12616 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12617 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12618 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12619 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12620 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12621 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12622 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12623 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12624 tracing engine:
12625
12626 @smallexample
12627 main ()
12628 @{
12629 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12630 @}
12631 @end smallexample
12632
12633 @noindent
12634 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12635 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12636
12637 @smallexample
12638 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12639 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12640 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12641 Data: "str %s"
12642 [etc...]
12643 @end smallexample
12644
12645 @noindent
12646 so you may probe the marker above with:
12647
12648 @smallexample
12649 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12650 @end smallexample
12651
12652 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12653 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12654 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12655 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12656 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12657 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12658 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12659 the @samp{Data:} field.
12660
12661 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12662 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12663 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12664
12665 @vindex $tpnum
12666 @cindex last tracepoint number
12667 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12668 @cindex tracepoint number
12669 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12670 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12671
12672 @kindex delete tracepoint
12673 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12674 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12675 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12676 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12677 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12678
12679 Examples:
12680
12681 @smallexample
12682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12683
12684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12685 @end smallexample
12686
12687 @noindent
12688 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12689 @end table
12690
12691 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12692 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12693
12694 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12695
12696 @table @code
12697 @kindex disable tracepoint
12698 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12699 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12700 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12701 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12702 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12703 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12704 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12705 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12706 next trace experiment.
12707
12708 @kindex enable tracepoint
12709 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12710 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12711 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12712 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12713 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12714 next time a trace experiment is run.
12715 @end table
12716
12717 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12718 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12719
12720 @table @code
12721 @kindex passcount
12722 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12723 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12724 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12725 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12726 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12727 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12728 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12729 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12730 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12731 user.
12732
12733 Examples:
12734
12735 @smallexample
12736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12737 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12738
12739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12740 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12747 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12748 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12749 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12750 @end smallexample
12751 @end table
12752
12753 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12754 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12755 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12756 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12757
12758 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12759 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12760 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12761 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12762 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12763 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12764 is true.
12765
12766 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12767 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12768 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12769 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12770 just as with breakpoints.
12771
12772 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12773 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12774 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12775 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12776 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12777 accesses, and so forth.
12778
12779 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12780 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12781 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12782 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12783 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12784 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12785 search through.
12786
12787 @smallexample
12788 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12789 @end smallexample
12790
12791 @node Trace State Variables
12792 @subsection Trace State Variables
12793 @cindex trace state variables
12794
12795 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12796 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12797 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12798 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12799 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12800 integers.
12801
12802 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12803 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12804 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12805 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12806
12807 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12808 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12809 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12810 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12811 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12812 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12813 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12814 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12815 variable with the same name.
12816
12817 @table @code
12818
12819 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12820 @kindex tvariable
12821 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12822 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12823 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12824 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12825 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12826 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12827 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12828 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12829 value. The default initial value is 0.
12830
12831 @item info tvariables
12832 @kindex info tvariables
12833 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12834 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12835 currently running.
12836
12837 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12838 @kindex delete tvariable
12839 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12840 are specified.
12841
12842 @end table
12843
12844 @node Tracepoint Actions
12845 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12846
12847 @table @code
12848 @kindex actions
12849 @cindex tracepoint actions
12850 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12851 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12852 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12853 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12854 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12855 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12856 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12857 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12858 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12859 @code{while-stepping}.
12860
12861 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12862 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12863 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12864
12865 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12866 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12867 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12868
12869 @smallexample
12870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12871
12872 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12873
12874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12875 @end smallexample
12876
12877 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12878 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12879 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12880 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12881 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12882 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12883 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12884 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12885
12886 @smallexample
12887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12888 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12889 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12890 > collect bar,baz
12891 > collect $regs
12892 > while-stepping 12
12893 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12894 > end
12895 end
12896 @end smallexample
12897
12898 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12899 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12900 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12901 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12902 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12903 special arguments are supported:
12904
12905 @table @code
12906 @item $regs
12907 Collect all registers.
12908
12909 @item $args
12910 Collect all function arguments.
12911
12912 @item $locals
12913 Collect all local variables.
12914
12915 @item $_ret
12916 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12917 of a backtrace.
12918
12919 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12920 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12921 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12922 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12923 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12924 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12925
12926 @item $_probe_argc
12927 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12928 tracepoint is located.
12929 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12930
12931 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12932 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12933 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12934 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12935
12936 @item $_sdata
12937 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12938 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12939 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12940 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12941 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12942 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12943 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12944 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12945 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12946
12947 @smallexample
12948 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12949 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12950 @end smallexample
12951
12952 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12953 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12954 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12955 @value{GDBN}.
12956 @end table
12957
12958 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12959 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12960 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12961
12962 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12963 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12964 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12965 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12966 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12967 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12968 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12969 @samp{mystr}.
12970
12971 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12972 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12973
12974 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12975 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12976 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12977 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12978 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12979 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12980 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12981 action were used.
12982
12983 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12984 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12985 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12986 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12987 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12988 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12989
12990 @smallexample
12991 > while-stepping 12
12992 > collect $regs, myglobal
12993 > end
12994 >
12995 @end smallexample
12996
12997 @noindent
12998 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12999 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13000 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13001 @code{stepping}.
13002
13003 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13004 @kindex set default-collect
13005 @cindex default collection action
13006 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13007 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13008 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13009 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13010 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13011 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13012
13013 @item show default-collect
13014 @kindex show default-collect
13015 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13016 tracepoint hit.
13017
13018 @end table
13019
13020 @node Listing Tracepoints
13021 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13022
13023 @table @code
13024 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13025 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13026 @cindex information about tracepoints
13027 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13028 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13029 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13030 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13031 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13032 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13033
13034 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13035 tracing:
13036
13037 @itemize @bullet
13038 @item
13039 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13040
13041 @item
13042 the state about installed on target of each location
13043 @end itemize
13044
13045 @smallexample
13046 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13047 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13048 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13049 while-stepping 20
13050 collect globfoo, $regs
13051 end
13052 collect globfoo2
13053 end
13054 pass count 1200
13055 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13056 collect $eip
13057 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13058 installed on target
13059 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13060 installed on target
13061 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13062 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13063 not installed on target
13064 (@value{GDBP})
13065 @end smallexample
13066
13067 @noindent
13068 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13069 @end table
13070
13071 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13072 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13073
13074 @table @code
13075 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13076 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13077 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13078 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13079 program.
13080
13081 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13082
13083 @table @emph
13084 @item Count
13085 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13086 stable identifier.
13087 @item ID
13088 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13089 @item Enabled or Disabled
13090 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13091 that are not enabled.
13092 @item Address
13093 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13094 @item What
13095 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13096 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13097 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13098 will be left blank.
13099 @end table
13100
13101 @noindent
13102 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13103
13104 @table @emph
13105 @item Data
13106 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13107 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13108 marker call.
13109 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13110 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13111 @end table
13112
13113 @smallexample
13114 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13115 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13116 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13117 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13118 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13119 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13120 Data: str %s
13121 (@value{GDBP})
13122 @end smallexample
13123 @end table
13124
13125 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13126 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13127
13128 @table @code
13129 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13130 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13131 @cindex collected data discarded
13132 @item tstart
13133 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13134 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13135 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13136 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13137 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13138 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13139 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13140 information, and so forth.
13141
13142 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13143 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13144 @item tstop
13145 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13146 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13147 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13148 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13149 needs to be stopped quickly.
13150
13151 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13152 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13153 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13154
13155 @kindex tstatus
13156 @cindex status of trace data collection
13157 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13158 @item tstatus
13159 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13160 collection.
13161 @end table
13162
13163 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13164
13165 @smallexample
13166 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13167 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13168 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13169 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13170 > while-stepping 11
13171 > collect $regs
13172 > end
13173 > end
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13175 [time passes @dots{}]
13176 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13177 @end smallexample
13178
13179 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13180 @cindex disconnected tracing
13181 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13182 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13183 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13184 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13185 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13186 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13187 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13188 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13189
13190 @table @code
13191 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13192 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13193 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13194 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13195 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13196 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13197 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13198 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13199
13200 @item show disconnected-tracing
13201 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13202 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13203
13204 @end table
13205
13206 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13207 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13208 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13209 it will continue after reconnection.
13210
13211 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13212 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13213 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13214 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13215 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13216 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13217 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13218 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13219 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13220 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13221
13222 @cindex circular trace buffer
13223 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13224 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13225 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13226 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13227 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13228 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13229 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13230 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13231 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13232 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13233 the next run.
13234
13235 @table @code
13236 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13237 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13238 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13239 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13240 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13241 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13242 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13243
13244 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13245 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13246 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13247 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13248 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13249 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13250
13251 @end table
13252
13253 @table @code
13254 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13255 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13256 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13257 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13258 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13259 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13260 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13261 likes. This is also the default.
13262
13263 @item show trace-buffer-size
13264 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13265 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13266 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13267 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13268 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13269 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13270 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13271 @end table
13272
13273 @table @code
13274 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13275 @kindex set trace-user
13276
13277 @item show trace-user
13278 @kindex show trace-user
13279
13280 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13281 @kindex set trace-notes
13282 Set the trace run's notes.
13283
13284 @item show trace-notes
13285 @kindex show trace-notes
13286 Show the trace run's notes.
13287
13288 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13289 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13290 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13291 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13292 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13293
13294 @item show trace-stop-notes
13295 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13296 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13297
13298 @end table
13299
13300 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13301 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13302
13303 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13304 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13305 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13306 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13307 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13308 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13309 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13310 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13311 mentioned here.
13312
13313 @itemize @bullet
13314
13315 @item
13316 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13317 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13318 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13319 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13320 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13321 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13322 cannot be collected either.
13323
13324 @item
13325 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13326 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13327 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13328 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13329 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13330 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13331 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13332 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13333 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13334 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13335
13336 @item
13337 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13338 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13339 in a misleading way.
13340
13341 @item
13342 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13343 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13344 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13345 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13346 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13347 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13348 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13349 by @code{ptr}.
13350
13351 @item
13352 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13353 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13354 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13355 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13356 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13357 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13358 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13359 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13360 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13361 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13362 invalid address.
13363
13364 @item
13365 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13366 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13367 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13368 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13369 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13370 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13371 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13372 it to zero.
13373
13374 @end itemize
13375
13376 @node Analyze Collected Data
13377 @section Using the Collected Data
13378
13379 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13380 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13381 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13382 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13383 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13384 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13385 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13386 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13387 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13388 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13389 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13390 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13391 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13392 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13393 the buffer will fail.
13394
13395 @menu
13396 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13397 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13398 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13399 @end menu
13400
13401 @node tfind
13402 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13403
13404 @kindex tfind
13405 @cindex select trace snapshot
13406 @cindex find trace snapshot
13407 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13408 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13409 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13410 snapshot is selected.
13411
13412 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13413
13414 @table @code
13415 @item tfind start
13416 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13417 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13418
13419 @item tfind none
13420 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13421
13422 @item tfind end
13423 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13424
13425 @item tfind
13426 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13427 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13428
13429 @item tfind -
13430 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13431 retracing earlier steps.
13432
13433 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13434 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13435 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13436 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13437 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13438
13439 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13440 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13441 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13442 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13443 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13444
13445 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13446 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13447 addresses (exclusive).
13448
13449 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13450 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13451 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13452
13453 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13454 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13455 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13456 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13457 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13458 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13459 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13460 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13461 @end table
13462
13463 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13464 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13465 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13466 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13467 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13468 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13469 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13470 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13471 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13472 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13473 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13474 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13475 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13476 tracepoint as the current one.
13477
13478 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13479 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13480 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13481 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13482 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13483
13484 @smallexample
13485 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13486 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13487 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13488 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13489 > tfind
13490 > end
13491
13492 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13493 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13494 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13495 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13496 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13497 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13498 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13499 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13500 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13501 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13502 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13503 @end smallexample
13504
13505 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13506 the buffer:
13507
13508 @smallexample
13509 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13510 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13511 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13512 > tfind line
13513 > end
13514
13515 Frame 0, X = 1
13516 Frame 7, X = 2
13517 Frame 13, X = 255
13518 @end smallexample
13519
13520 @node tdump
13521 @subsection @code{tdump}
13522 @kindex tdump
13523 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13524 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13525
13526 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13527 the current trace snapshot.
13528
13529 @smallexample
13530 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13531 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13532 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13533 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13534 > end
13535
13536 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13537
13538 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13539 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13540 at gdb_test.c:444
13541 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13542
13543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13544 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13545 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13546 d1 0x18 24
13547 d2 0x80 128
13548 d3 0x33 51
13549 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13550 d5 0x22 34
13551 d6 0xe0 224
13552 d7 0x380035 3670069
13553 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13554 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13555 a2 0x100 256
13556 a3 0x322000 3284992
13557 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13558 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13559 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13560 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13561 ps 0x0 0
13562 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13563 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13564 fpstatus 0x0 0
13565 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13566 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13567 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13568 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13569 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13570 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13571 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13572 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13573 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13574
13575 (@value{GDBP})
13576 @end smallexample
13577
13578 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13579 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13580 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13581 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13582
13583 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13584 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13585 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13586 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13587 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13588 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13589 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13590 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13591 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13592 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13593
13594 @node save tracepoints
13595 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13596 @kindex save tracepoints
13597 @kindex save-tracepoints
13598 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13599
13600 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13601 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13602 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13603 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13604 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13605 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13606
13607 @node Tracepoint Variables
13608 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13609 @cindex tracepoint variables
13610 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13611
13612 @table @code
13613 @vindex $trace_frame
13614 @item (int) $trace_frame
13615 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13616 snapshot is selected.
13617
13618 @vindex $tracepoint
13619 @item (int) $tracepoint
13620 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13621
13622 @vindex $trace_line
13623 @item (int) $trace_line
13624 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13625
13626 @vindex $trace_file
13627 @item (char []) $trace_file
13628 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13629
13630 @vindex $trace_func
13631 @item (char []) $trace_func
13632 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13633 @end table
13634
13635 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13636 use @code{output} instead.
13637
13638 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13639 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13640 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13641 which are managed by the target.
13642
13643 @smallexample
13644 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13645
13646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13647 > output $trace_file
13648 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13649 > tfind
13650 > end
13651 @end smallexample
13652
13653 @node Trace Files
13654 @section Using Trace Files
13655 @cindex trace files
13656
13657 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13658 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13659 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13660 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13661 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13662
13663 @table @code
13664
13665 @kindex tsave
13666 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13667 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13668 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13669 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13670 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13671 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13672 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13673 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13674 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13675 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13676 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13677 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13678 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13679 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13680 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13681
13682 @kindex target tfile
13683 @kindex tfile
13684 @kindex target ctf
13685 @kindex ctf
13686 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13687 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13688 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13689 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13690 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13691 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13692 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13693 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13694 the host.
13695
13696 @smallexample
13697 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13698 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13699 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13700 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13701 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13702 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13703 i = 0
13704 a = 0
13705 b = 1 '\001'
13706 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13707 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13708 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13709 $1 = 1
13710 @end smallexample
13711
13712 @end table
13713
13714 @node Overlays
13715 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13716 @cindex overlays
13717
13718 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13719 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13720 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13721 use overlays.
13722
13723 @menu
13724 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13725 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13726 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13727 mapped by asking the inferior.
13728 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13729 @end menu
13730
13731 @node How Overlays Work
13732 @section How Overlays Work
13733 @cindex mapped overlays
13734 @cindex unmapped overlays
13735 @cindex load address, overlay's
13736 @cindex mapped address
13737 @cindex overlay area
13738
13739 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13740 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13741 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13742 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13743 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13744
13745 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13746 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13747 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13748 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13749 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13750 largest overlay as well.
13751
13752 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13753 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13754 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13755 there.
13756
13757 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13758 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13759 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13760
13761 @smallexample
13762 @group
13763 Data Instruction Larger
13764 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13765 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13766 | | | | | |
13767 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13768 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13769 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13770 | and heap | | | | | |
13771 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13772 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13773 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13774 | | | | | |
13775 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13776 address | | | | | |
13777 | overlay | <-' | | |
13778 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13779 | | <---. | | load address
13780 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13781 | | | |
13782 +-----------+ | |
13783 +-----------+
13784 | |
13785 +-----------+
13786
13787 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13788 @end group
13789 @end smallexample
13790
13791 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13792 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13793 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13794 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13795 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13796 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13797 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13798 program and the overlay area.
13799
13800 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13801 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13802 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13803 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13804 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13805 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13806 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13807
13808 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13809 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13810 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13811
13812 @itemize @bullet
13813
13814 @item
13815 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13816 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13817 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13818 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13819
13820 @item
13821 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13822 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13823 your program's performance.
13824
13825 @item
13826 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13827 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13828 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13829 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13830 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13831 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13832 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13833
13834 @item
13835 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13836 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13837 instruction and data spaces.
13838
13839 @end itemize
13840
13841 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13842 improved in many ways:
13843
13844 @itemize @bullet
13845
13846 @item
13847 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13848 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13849 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13850 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13851 area in the usual way.
13852
13853 @item
13854 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13855 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13856
13857 @item
13858 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13859 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13860 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13861 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13862 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13863 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13864 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13865
13866 @end itemize
13867
13868
13869 @node Overlay Commands
13870 @section Overlay Commands
13871
13872 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13873 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13874 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13875 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13876 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13877 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13878
13879 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13880 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13881
13882 @table @code
13883 @item overlay off
13884 @kindex overlay
13885 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13886 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13887 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13888 overlay support is disabled.
13889
13890 @item overlay manual
13891 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13892 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13893 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13894 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13895 commands described below.
13896
13897 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13898 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13899 @cindex map an overlay
13900 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13901 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13902 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13903 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13904 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13905 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13906
13907 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13908 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13909 @cindex unmap an overlay
13910 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13911 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13912 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13913 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13914
13915 @item overlay auto
13916 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13917 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13918 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13919 Overlay Debugging}.
13920
13921 @item overlay load-target
13922 @itemx overlay load
13923 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13924 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13925 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13926 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13927 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13928 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13929
13930 @item overlay list-overlays
13931 @itemx overlay list
13932 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13933 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13934 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13935
13936 @end table
13937
13938 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13939 of the function the address falls in:
13940
13941 @smallexample
13942 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13943 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13944 @end smallexample
13945 @noindent
13946 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13947 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13948 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13949 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13950
13951 @smallexample
13952 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13953 No sections are mapped.
13954 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13955 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13956 @end smallexample
13957 @noindent
13958 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13959 name normally:
13960
13961 @smallexample
13962 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13963 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13964 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13965 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13966 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13967 @end smallexample
13968
13969 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13970 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13971 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13972 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13973 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13974
13975 @itemize @bullet
13976 @item
13977 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13978 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13979 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13980 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13981 @item
13982 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13983 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13984 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13985 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13986 breakpoints properly.
13987 @end itemize
13988
13989
13990 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13991 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13992 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13993
13994 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13995 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13996 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13997 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13998 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13999 current state of the overlays.
14000
14001 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14002 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14003
14004 @table @asis
14005
14006 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14007 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14008
14009 @smallexample
14010 struct
14011 @{
14012 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14013 unsigned long vma;
14014
14015 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14016 unsigned long size;
14017
14018 /* The overlay's load address. */
14019 unsigned long lma;
14020
14021 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14022 zero otherwise. */
14023 unsigned long mapped;
14024 @}
14025 @end smallexample
14026
14027 @item @code{_novlys}:
14028 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14029 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14030
14031 @end table
14032
14033 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14034 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14035 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14036 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14037 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14038 currently mapped.
14039
14040 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14041 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14042 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14043 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14044 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14045 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14046 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14047 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14048 are not being executed.
14049
14050 @node Overlay Sample Program
14051 @section Overlay Sample Program
14052 @cindex overlay example program
14053
14054 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14055 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14056 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14057 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14058 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14059 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14060 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14061
14062 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14063 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14064 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14065 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14066
14067 @table @file
14068 @item overlays.c
14069 The main program file.
14070 @item ovlymgr.c
14071 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14072 @item foo.c
14073 @itemx bar.c
14074 @itemx baz.c
14075 @itemx grbx.c
14076 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14077 @item d10v.ld
14078 @itemx m32r.ld
14079 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14080 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14081 @end table
14082
14083 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14084 cross-compiler like this:
14085
14086 @smallexample
14087 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14088 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14089 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14090 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14091 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14092 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14093 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14094 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14095 @end smallexample
14096
14097 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14098 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14099 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14100
14101
14102 @node Languages
14103 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14104 @cindex languages
14105
14106 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14107 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14108 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14109 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14110 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14111 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14112
14113 @cindex working language
14114 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14115 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14116 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14117 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14118 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14119 language}.
14120
14121 @menu
14122 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14123 * Show:: Displaying the language
14124 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14125 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14126 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14127 @end menu
14128
14129 @node Setting
14130 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14131
14132 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14133 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14134 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14135 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14136 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14137 are printed, etc.
14138
14139 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14140 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14141 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14142 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14143 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14144 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14145 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14146 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14147 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14148 Displaying the Language}.
14149
14150 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14151 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14152 another language. In that case, make the
14153 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14154 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14155 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14156
14157 @menu
14158 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14159 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14160 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14161 @end menu
14162
14163 @node Filenames
14164 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14165
14166 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14167 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14168
14169 @table @file
14170 @item .ada
14171 @itemx .ads
14172 @itemx .adb
14173 @itemx .a
14174 Ada source file.
14175
14176 @item .c
14177 C source file
14178
14179 @item .C
14180 @itemx .cc
14181 @itemx .cp
14182 @itemx .cpp
14183 @itemx .cxx
14184 @itemx .c++
14185 C@t{++} source file
14186
14187 @item .d
14188 D source file
14189
14190 @item .m
14191 Objective-C source file
14192
14193 @item .f
14194 @itemx .F
14195 Fortran source file
14196
14197 @item .mod
14198 Modula-2 source file
14199
14200 @item .s
14201 @itemx .S
14202 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14203 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14204 @end table
14205
14206 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14207 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14208
14209 @node Manually
14210 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14211
14212 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14213 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14214 your program.
14215
14216 @kindex set language
14217 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14218 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14219 a language, such as
14220 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14221 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14222
14223 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14224 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14225 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14226 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14227 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14228 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14229 command such as:
14230
14231 @smallexample
14232 print a = b + c
14233 @end smallexample
14234
14235 @noindent
14236 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14237 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14238 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14239 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14240
14241 @node Automatically
14242 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14243
14244 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14245 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14246 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14247 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14248 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14249 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14250 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14251 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14252 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14253
14254 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14255 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14256 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14257 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14258 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14259
14260 @node Show
14261 @section Displaying the Language
14262
14263 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14264 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14265
14266 @table @code
14267 @item show language
14268 @anchor{show language}
14269 @kindex show language
14270 Display the current working language. This is the
14271 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14272 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14273
14274 @item info frame
14275 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14276 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14277 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14278 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14279 information listed here.
14280
14281 @item info source
14282 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14283 Display the source language of this source file.
14284 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14285 information listed here.
14286 @end table
14287
14288 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14289 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14290 with a language explicitly:
14291
14292 @table @code
14293 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14294 @kindex set extension-language
14295 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14296 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14297
14298 @item info extensions
14299 @kindex info extensions
14300 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14301 @end table
14302
14303 @node Checks
14304 @section Type and Range Checking
14305
14306 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14307 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14308 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14309 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14310 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14311 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14312 errors when your program is running.
14313
14314 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14315 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14316 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14317 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14318
14319 @menu
14320 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14321 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14322 @end menu
14323
14324 @cindex type checking
14325 @cindex checks, type
14326 @node Type Checking
14327 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14328
14329 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14330 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14331 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14332 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14333
14334 @smallexample
14335 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14336
14337 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14338 $1 = 2
14339 @exdent but
14340 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14341 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14342 @end smallexample
14343
14344 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14345 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14346
14347 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14348 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14349 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14350 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14351 expressions like the second example above.
14352
14353 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14354 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14355 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14356 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14357 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14358 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14359
14360 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14361
14362 @kindex set check type
14363 @kindex show check type
14364 @table @code
14365 @item set check type on
14366 @itemx set check type off
14367 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14368 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14369 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14370
14371 @item show check type
14372 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14373 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14374 @end table
14375
14376 @cindex range checking
14377 @cindex checks, range
14378 @node Range Checking
14379 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14380
14381 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14382 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14383 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14384 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14385 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14386
14387 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14388 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14389 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14390 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14391
14392 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14393 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14394 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14395 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14396 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14397 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14398
14399 @smallexample
14400 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14401 @end smallexample
14402
14403 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14404 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14405 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14406
14407 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14408
14409 @kindex set check range
14410 @kindex show check range
14411 @table @code
14412 @item set check range auto
14413 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14414 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14415 each language.
14416
14417 @item set check range on
14418 @itemx set check range off
14419 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14420 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14421 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14422 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14423
14424 @item set check range warn
14425 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14426 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14427 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14428 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14429 systems).
14430
14431 @item show range
14432 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14433 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14434 @end table
14435
14436 @node Supported Languages
14437 @section Supported Languages
14438
14439 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14440 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14441 @c This is false ...
14442 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14443 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14444 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14445 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14446 language.
14447
14448 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14449 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14450 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14451 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14452 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14453 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14454 language reference or tutorial.
14455
14456 @menu
14457 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14458 * D:: D
14459 * Go:: Go
14460 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14461 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14462 * Fortran:: Fortran
14463 * Pascal:: Pascal
14464 * Rust:: Rust
14465 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14466 * Ada:: Ada
14467 @end menu
14468
14469 @node C
14470 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14471
14472 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14473 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14474
14475 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14476 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14477 together.
14478
14479 @cindex C@t{++}
14480 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14481 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14482 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14483 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14484 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14485 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14486 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14487
14488 @menu
14489 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14490 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14491 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14492 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14493 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14494 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14495 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14496 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14497 @end menu
14498
14499 @node C Operators
14500 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14501
14502 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14503
14504 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14505 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14506 often defined on groups of types.
14507
14508 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14509
14510 @itemize @bullet
14511
14512 @item
14513 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14514 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14515
14516 @item
14517 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14518 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14519
14520 @item
14521 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14522
14523 @item
14524 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14525
14526 @end itemize
14527
14528 @noindent
14529 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14530 in order of increasing precedence:
14531
14532 @table @code
14533 @item ,
14534 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14535 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14536 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14537
14538 @item =
14539 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14540 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14541
14542 @item @var{op}=
14543 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14544 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14545 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14546 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14547 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14548
14549 @item ?:
14550 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14551 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14552 should be of an integral type.
14553
14554 @item ||
14555 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14556
14557 @item &&
14558 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14559
14560 @item |
14561 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14562
14563 @item ^
14564 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14565
14566 @item &
14567 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14568
14569 @item ==@r{, }!=
14570 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14571 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14572
14573 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14574 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14575 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14576 and non-zero for true.
14577
14578 @item <<@r{, }>>
14579 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14580
14581 @item @@
14582 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14583
14584 @item +@r{, }-
14585 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14586 pointer types.
14587
14588 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14589 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14590 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14591 integral types.
14592
14593 @item ++@r{, }--
14594 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14595 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14596 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14597 operation takes place.
14598
14599 @item *
14600 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14601 @code{++}.
14602
14603 @item &
14604 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14605
14606 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14607 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14608 to examine the address
14609 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14610 stored.
14611
14612 @item -
14613 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14614 precedence as @code{++}.
14615
14616 @item !
14617 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14618 @code{++}.
14619
14620 @item ~
14621 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14622 @code{++}.
14623
14624
14625 @item .@r{, }->
14626 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14627 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14628 pointer based on the stored type information.
14629 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14630
14631 @item .*@r{, }->*
14632 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14633
14634 @item []
14635 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14636 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14637
14638 @item ()
14639 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14640
14641 @item ::
14642 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14643 and @code{class} types.
14644
14645 @item ::
14646 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14647 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14648 above.
14649 @end table
14650
14651 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14652 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14653 predefined meaning.
14654
14655 @node C Constants
14656 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14657
14658 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14659
14660 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14661 following ways:
14662
14663 @itemize @bullet
14664 @item
14665 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14666 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14667 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14668 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14669 @code{long} value.
14670
14671 @item
14672 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14673 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14674 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14675 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14676 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14677 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14678 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14679 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14680 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14681 constant.
14682
14683 @item
14684 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14685 integral equivalents.
14686
14687 @item
14688 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14689 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14690 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14691 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14692 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14693 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14694 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14695 @samp{\n} for newline.
14696
14697 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14698 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14699 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14700 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14701
14702 @item
14703 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14704 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14705 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14706 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14707 characters.
14708
14709 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14710 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14711 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14712
14713 @item
14714 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14715 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14716
14717 @item
14718 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14719 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14720 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14721 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14722 @end itemize
14723
14724 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14725 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14726
14727 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14728 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14729
14730 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14731 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14732 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14733 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14734 @quotation
14735 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14736 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14737 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14738 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14739 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14740 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14741 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14742 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14743 @end quotation
14744
14745 @enumerate
14746
14747 @cindex member functions
14748 @item
14749 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14750
14751 @smallexample
14752 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14753 @end smallexample
14754
14755 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14756 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14757 @item
14758 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14759 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14760 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14761 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14762 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14763
14764 @cindex call overloaded functions
14765 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14766 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14767 @item
14768 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14769 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14770 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14771 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14772 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14773 default arguments.
14774
14775 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14776 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14777 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14778 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14779 number of function arguments.
14780
14781 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14782 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14783 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14784
14785 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14786 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14787 @smallexample
14788 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14789 @end smallexample
14790
14791 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14792 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14793
14794 @cindex reference declarations
14795 @item
14796 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14797 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14798 dereferenced.
14799
14800 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14801 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14802 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14803 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14804 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14805
14806 @item
14807 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14808 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14809 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14810 necessary, for example in an expression like
14811 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14812 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14813 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14814
14815 @item
14816 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14817 specification.
14818 @end enumerate
14819
14820 @node C Defaults
14821 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14822
14823 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14824
14825 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14826 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14827 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14828 selects the working language.
14829
14830 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14831 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14832 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14833 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14834 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14835 for further details.
14836
14837 @node C Checks
14838 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14839
14840 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14841
14842 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14843 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14844 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14845 constants to pointers.
14846
14847 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14848 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14849 that is not itself an array.
14850
14851 @node Debugging C
14852 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14853
14854 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14855 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14856 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14857 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14858
14859 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14860 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14861 ,Expressions}.
14862
14863 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14864 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14865
14866 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14867
14868 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14869 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14870
14871 @table @code
14872 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14873 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14874 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14875 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14876 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14877 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14878
14879 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14880 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14881 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14882 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14883 classes.
14884 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14885
14886 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14887 @item catch throw
14888 @itemx catch rethrow
14889 @itemx catch catch
14890 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14891 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14892
14893 @cindex inheritance
14894 @item ptype @var{typename}
14895 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14896 @var{typename}.
14897 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14898
14899 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14900 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14901 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14902 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14903 multiple inheritance is in use.
14904
14905 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14906 @item demangle @var{name}
14907 Demangle @var{name}.
14908 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14909
14910 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14911 @item set print demangle
14912 @itemx show print demangle
14913 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14914 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14915 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14916 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14917 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14918
14919 @item set print object
14920 @itemx show print object
14921 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14922 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14923
14924 @item set print vtbl
14925 @itemx show print vtbl
14926 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14927 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14928 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14929 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14930
14931 @kindex set overload-resolution
14932 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14933 @item set overload-resolution on
14934 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14935 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14936 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14937 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14938 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14939 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14940
14941 @item set overload-resolution off
14942 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14943 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14944 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14945 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14946 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14947 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14948 argument types.
14949
14950 @kindex show overload-resolution
14951 @item show overload-resolution
14952 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14953
14954 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14955 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14956 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14957 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14958 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14959 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14960 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14961 @end table
14962
14963 @node Decimal Floating Point
14964 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14965 @cindex decimal floating point format
14966
14967 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14968 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14969 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14970 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14971
14972 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14973 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14974 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14975 configured target.
14976
14977 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14978 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14979 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14980
14981 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14982 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14983 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14984
14985 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14986 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14987 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14988
14989 @node D
14990 @subsection D
14991
14992 @cindex D
14993 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14994 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14995 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14996
14997 @node Go
14998 @subsection Go
14999
15000 @cindex Go (programming language)
15001 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15002 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15003
15004 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15005
15006 @table @code
15007 @cindex current Go package
15008 @item The current Go package
15009 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15010 specifying global variables and functions.
15011
15012 For example, given the program:
15013
15014 @example
15015 package main
15016 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15017 func main () @{
15018 // ...
15019 @}
15020 @end example
15021
15022 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15023
15024 @example
15025 (gdb) p myglob
15026 (gdb) p main.myglob
15027 @end example
15028
15029 @cindex builtin Go types
15030 @item Builtin Go types
15031 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15032 as a string.
15033
15034 @cindex builtin Go functions
15035 @item Builtin Go functions
15036 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15037 function and handles it internally.
15038
15039 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15040 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15041 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15042 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15043 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15044 @end table
15045
15046 @node Objective-C
15047 @subsection Objective-C
15048
15049 @cindex Objective-C
15050 This section provides information about some commands and command
15051 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15052 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15053 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15054
15055 @menu
15056 * Method Names in Commands::
15057 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15058 @end menu
15059
15060 @node Method Names in Commands
15061 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15062
15063 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15064 names as line specifications:
15065
15066 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15067 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15068 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15069 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15070 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15071 @itemize
15072 @item @code{clear}
15073 @item @code{break}
15074 @item @code{info line}
15075 @item @code{jump}
15076 @item @code{list}
15077 @end itemize
15078
15079 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15080
15081 @smallexample
15082 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15083 @end smallexample
15084
15085 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15086 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15087 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15088 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15089 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15090 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15091 debugged, enter:
15092
15093 @smallexample
15094 break -[Fruit create]
15095 @end smallexample
15096
15097 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15098 enter:
15099
15100 @smallexample
15101 list +[NSText initialize]
15102 @end smallexample
15103
15104 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15105 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15106 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15107 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15108
15109 @smallexample
15110 break create
15111 @end smallexample
15112
15113 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15114 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15115 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15116 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15117 none apply.
15118
15119 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15120 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15121
15122 @smallexample
15123 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15124 @end smallexample
15125
15126 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15127 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15128 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15129 @kindex print-object
15130 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15131
15132 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15133
15134 @smallexample
15135 print -[@var{object} hash]
15136 @end smallexample
15137
15138 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15139 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15140 @noindent
15141 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15142 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15143 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15144 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15145 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15146 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15147
15148 @node OpenCL C
15149 @subsection OpenCL C
15150
15151 @cindex OpenCL C
15152 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15153
15154 @menu
15155 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15156 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15157 * OpenCL C Operators::
15158 @end menu
15159
15160 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15161 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15162
15163 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15164 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15165 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15166 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15167 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15168
15169 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15170 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15171
15172 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15173 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15174 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15175 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15176
15177 @node OpenCL C Operators
15178 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15179
15180 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15181 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15182 vector data types.
15183
15184 @node Fortran
15185 @subsection Fortran
15186 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15187
15188 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15189 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15190
15191 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15192 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15193 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15194 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15195 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15196 underscore.
15197
15198 @menu
15199 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15200 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15201 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15202 @end menu
15203
15204 @node Fortran Operators
15205 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15206
15207 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15208
15209 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15210 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15211 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15212
15213 @table @code
15214 @item **
15215 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15216 of the second one.
15217
15218 @item :
15219 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15220 represent a section of array.
15221
15222 @item %
15223 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15224 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15225 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15226 union type.
15227 @end table
15228
15229 @node Fortran Defaults
15230 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15231
15232 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15233
15234 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15235 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15236 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15237 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15238
15239 @node Special Fortran Commands
15240 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15241
15242 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15243
15244 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15245 such as displaying common blocks.
15246
15247 @table @code
15248 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15249 @kindex info common
15250 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15251 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15252 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15253 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15254 printed.
15255 @end table
15256
15257 @node Pascal
15258 @subsection Pascal
15259
15260 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15261 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15262 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15263 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15264 syntax.
15265
15266 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15267 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15268 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15269
15270 @node Rust
15271 @subsection Rust
15272
15273 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15274 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15275 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15276 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15277
15278 @itemize @bullet
15279 @item
15280 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15281 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15282 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15283
15284 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15285 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15286 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15287 @samp{B}.
15288
15289 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15290 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15291
15292 @item
15293 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15294 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15295 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15296 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15297 @samp{K::x::y}.
15298
15299 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15300 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15301 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15302 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15303 scope.
15304
15305 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15306 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15307
15308 @item
15309 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15310 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15311
15312 @item
15313 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15314
15315 @item
15316 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15317 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15318 never be destroyed.
15319
15320 @item
15321 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15322 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15323 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15324
15325 @item
15326 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15327 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15328 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15329 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15330 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15331 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15332 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15333 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15334
15335 @item
15336 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15337 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15338 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15339 @itemize @bullet
15340
15341 @item
15342 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15343
15344 @item
15345 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15346
15347 @item
15348 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15349
15350 @item
15351 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15352 type names.
15353
15354 @item
15355 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15356
15357 @item
15358 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15359 available in the crate.
15360 @end itemize
15361 @end itemize
15362
15363 @node Modula-2
15364 @subsection Modula-2
15365
15366 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15367
15368 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15369 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15370 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15371 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15372 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15373 table.
15374
15375 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15376 @menu
15377 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15378 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15379 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15380 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15381 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15382 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15383 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15384 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15385 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15386 @end menu
15387
15388 @node M2 Operators
15389 @subsubsection Operators
15390 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15391
15392 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15393 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15394 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15395 following definitions hold:
15396
15397 @itemize @bullet
15398
15399 @item
15400 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15401 their subranges.
15402
15403 @item
15404 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15405
15406 @item
15407 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15408
15409 @item
15410 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15411 @var{type}}.
15412
15413 @item
15414 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15415
15416 @item
15417 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15418
15419 @item
15420 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15421 @end itemize
15422
15423 @noindent
15424 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15425 increasing precedence:
15426
15427 @table @code
15428 @item ,
15429 Function argument or array index separator.
15430
15431 @item :=
15432 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15433 @var{value}.
15434
15435 @item <@r{, }>
15436 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15437 types.
15438
15439 @item <=@r{, }>=
15440 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15441 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15442 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15443
15444 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15445 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15446 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15447 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15448 comment character.
15449
15450 @item IN
15451 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15452 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15453
15454 @item OR
15455 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15456
15457 @item AND@r{, }&
15458 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15459
15460 @item @@
15461 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15462
15463 @item +@r{, }-
15464 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15465 and difference on set types.
15466
15467 @item *
15468 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15469 on set types.
15470
15471 @item /
15472 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15473 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15474
15475 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15476 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15477 precedence as @code{*}.
15478
15479 @item -
15480 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15481
15482 @item ^
15483 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15484
15485 @item NOT
15486 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15487 @code{^}.
15488
15489 @item .
15490 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15491 precedence as @code{^}.
15492
15493 @item []
15494 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15495
15496 @item ()
15497 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15498 as @code{^}.
15499
15500 @item ::@r{, }.
15501 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15502 @end table
15503
15504 @quotation
15505 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15506 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15507 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15508 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15509 @end quotation
15510
15511
15512 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15513 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15514 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15515
15516 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15517 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15518
15519 @table @var
15520
15521 @item a
15522 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15523
15524 @item c
15525 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15526
15527 @item i
15528 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15529
15530 @item m
15531 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15532 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15533 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15534
15535 @item n
15536 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15537
15538 @item r
15539 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15540
15541 @item t
15542 represents a type.
15543
15544 @item v
15545 represents a variable.
15546
15547 @item x
15548 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15549 explanation of the function for details.
15550 @end table
15551
15552 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15553
15554 @table @code
15555 @item ABS(@var{n})
15556 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15557
15558 @item CAP(@var{c})
15559 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15560 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15561
15562 @item CHR(@var{i})
15563 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15564
15565 @item DEC(@var{v})
15566 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15567
15568 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15569 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15570 new value.
15571
15572 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15573 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15574 set.
15575
15576 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15577 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15578
15579 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15580 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15581
15582 @item INC(@var{v})
15583 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15584
15585 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15586 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15587 new value.
15588
15589 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15590 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15591 there. Returns the new set.
15592
15593 @item MAX(@var{t})
15594 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15595
15596 @item MIN(@var{t})
15597 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15598
15599 @item ODD(@var{i})
15600 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15601
15602 @item ORD(@var{x})
15603 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15604 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15605 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15606 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15607
15608 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15609 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15610 variable or a type.
15611
15612 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15613 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15614
15615 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15616 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15617 variable or a type.
15618
15619 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15620 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15621 @end table
15622
15623 @quotation
15624 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15625 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15626 an error.
15627 @end quotation
15628
15629 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15630 @node M2 Constants
15631 @subsubsection Constants
15632
15633 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15634 ways:
15635
15636 @itemize @bullet
15637
15638 @item
15639 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15640 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15641 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15642 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15643
15644 @item
15645 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15646 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15647 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15648 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15649 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15650 digits.
15651
15652 @item
15653 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15654 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15655 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15656 followed by a @samp{C}.
15657
15658 @item
15659 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15660 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15661 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15662 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15663 sequences.
15664
15665 @item
15666 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15667
15668 @item
15669 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15670 @code{FALSE}.
15671
15672 @item
15673 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15674
15675 @item
15676 Set constants are not yet supported.
15677 @end itemize
15678
15679 @node M2 Types
15680 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15681 @cindex Modula-2 types
15682
15683 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15684 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15685 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15686 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15687 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15688 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15689
15690 The first example contains the following section of code:
15691
15692 @smallexample
15693 VAR
15694 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15695 r: [20..40] ;
15696 @end smallexample
15697
15698 @noindent
15699 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15700 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15701
15702 @smallexample
15703 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15704 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15705 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15706 SET OF CHAR
15707 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15708 21
15709 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15710 [20..40]
15711 @end smallexample
15712
15713 @noindent
15714 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15715
15716 @smallexample
15717 VAR
15718 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15719 @end smallexample
15720
15721 @noindent
15722 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15723
15724 @smallexample
15725 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15726 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15727 @end smallexample
15728
15729 @noindent
15730 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15731 expressions using the debugger.
15732
15733 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15734 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15735
15736 @smallexample
15737 VAR
15738 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15739 @end smallexample
15740
15741 @smallexample
15742 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15743 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15744 @end smallexample
15745
15746 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15747 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15748 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15749 above.
15750
15751 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15752
15753 @smallexample
15754 TYPE
15755 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15756 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15757 VAR
15758 s: t ;
15759 BEGIN
15760 s := blue ;
15761 @end smallexample
15762
15763 @noindent
15764 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15765 and value of a variable.
15766
15767 @smallexample
15768 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15769 $1 = blue
15770 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15771 type = [blue..yellow]
15772 @end smallexample
15773
15774 @noindent
15775 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15776 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15777 their @code{C} counterparts.
15778
15779 @smallexample
15780 VAR
15781 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15782 BEGIN
15783 s[1] := 1 ;
15784 @end smallexample
15785
15786 @smallexample
15787 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15788 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15789 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15790 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15791 @end smallexample
15792
15793 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15794 pointer types as shown in this example:
15795
15796 @smallexample
15797 VAR
15798 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15799 BEGIN
15800 NEW(s) ;
15801 s^[1] := 1 ;
15802 @end smallexample
15803
15804 @noindent
15805 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15806
15807 @smallexample
15808 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15809 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15810 @end smallexample
15811
15812 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15813 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15814 types:
15815
15816 @smallexample
15817 TYPE
15818 foo = RECORD
15819 f1: CARDINAL ;
15820 f2: CHAR ;
15821 f3: myarray ;
15822 END ;
15823
15824 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15825 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15826 VAR
15827 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15828 @end smallexample
15829
15830 @noindent
15831 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15832 below.
15833
15834 @smallexample
15835 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15836 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15837 f1 : CARDINAL;
15838 f2 : CHAR;
15839 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15840 END
15841 @end smallexample
15842
15843 @node M2 Defaults
15844 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15845 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15846
15847 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15848 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15849 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15850 selected the working language.
15851
15852 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15853 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15854 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15855 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15856
15857 @node Deviations
15858 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15859 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15860
15861 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15862 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15863
15864 @itemize @bullet
15865 @item
15866 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15867 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15868 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15869 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15870 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15871 returned a pointer.)
15872
15873 @item
15874 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15875 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15876 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15877 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15878
15879 @item
15880 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15881 argument.
15882
15883 @item
15884 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15885 @end itemize
15886
15887 @node M2 Checks
15888 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15889 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15890
15891 @quotation
15892 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15893 range checking.
15894 @end quotation
15895 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15896
15897 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15898
15899 @itemize @bullet
15900 @item
15901 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15902 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15903
15904 @item
15905 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15906 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15907 @end itemize
15908
15909 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15910 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15911
15912 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15913 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15914
15915 @node M2 Scope
15916 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15917 @cindex scope
15918 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15919 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15920 @ifinfo
15921 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15922 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15923 @end ifinfo
15924 @ifnotinfo
15925 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15926 @end ifnotinfo
15927
15928 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15929 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15930 similar syntax:
15931
15932 @smallexample
15933
15934 @var{module} . @var{id}
15935 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15936 @end smallexample
15937
15938 @noindent
15939 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15940 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15941 identifier within your program, except another module.
15942
15943 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15944 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15945 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15946 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15947
15948 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15949 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15950 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15951 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15952 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15953 @var{module}.
15954
15955 @node GDB/M2
15956 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15957
15958 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15959 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15960 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15961 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15962 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15963 analogue in Modula-2.
15964
15965 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15966 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15967 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15968 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15969 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15970 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15971
15972 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15973 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15974 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15975
15976 @node Ada
15977 @subsection Ada
15978 @cindex Ada
15979
15980 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15981 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15982 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15983 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15984 to be difficult.
15985
15986
15987 @cindex expressions in Ada
15988 @menu
15989 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15990 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15991 in @value{GDBN}.
15992 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15993 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15994 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15995 subprograms.
15996 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15997 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15998 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15999 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16000 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16001 Profile
16002 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16003 @end menu
16004
16005 @node Ada Mode Intro
16006 @subsubsection Introduction
16007 @cindex Ada mode, general
16008
16009 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16010 syntax, with some extensions.
16011 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16012
16013 @itemize @bullet
16014 @item
16015 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16016 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16017 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16018 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16019
16020 @item
16021 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16022 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16023
16024 @item
16025 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16026 @end itemize
16027
16028 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16029 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16030 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16031 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16032 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16033
16034 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16035 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16036 was translated from an Ada source file.
16037
16038 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16039 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16040 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16041 middle (to allow based literals).
16042
16043 @node Omissions from Ada
16044 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16045 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16046
16047 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16048
16049 @itemize @bullet
16050 @item
16051 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16052
16053 @itemize @minus
16054 @item
16055 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16056 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16057
16058 @item
16059 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16060
16061 @item
16062 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16063
16064 @item
16065 @t{'Tag}.
16066
16067 @item
16068 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16069 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16070
16071 @item
16072 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16073 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16074
16075 @item
16076 @t{'Address}.
16077 @end itemize
16078
16079 @item
16080 The names in
16081 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16082 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16083 not currently available.
16084
16085 @item
16086 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16087 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16088 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16089 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16090 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16091 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16092 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16093 indeterminate values.
16094
16095 @item
16096 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16097 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16098 are not implemented.
16099
16100 @item
16101 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16102 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16103 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16104 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16105 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16106
16107 @smallexample
16108 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16109 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16110 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16111 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16112 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16113 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16114 @end smallexample
16115
16116 Changing a
16117 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16118 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16119 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16120 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16121 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16122 declared to have a type such as:
16123
16124 @smallexample
16125 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16126 Id : Integer;
16127 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16128 end record;
16129 @end smallexample
16130
16131 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16132 assignments:
16133
16134 @smallexample
16135 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16136 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16137 @end smallexample
16138
16139 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16140 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16141 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16142 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16143 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16144 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16145 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16146 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16147
16148 @item
16149 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16150
16151 @item
16152 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16153 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16154 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16155 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16156 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16157 the proper resolution.
16158
16159 @item
16160 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16161
16162 @item
16163 Entry calls are not implemented.
16164
16165 @item
16166 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16167 formats are not supported.
16168
16169 @item
16170 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16171
16172 @item
16173 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16174 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16175 context.
16176 Should your program
16177 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16178 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16179 @end itemize
16180
16181 @node Additions to Ada
16182 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16183 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16184
16185 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16186 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16187
16188 @itemize @bullet
16189 @item
16190 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16191 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16192 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16193 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16194 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16195 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16196 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16197 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16198
16199 @item
16200 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16201 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16202 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16203
16204 @item
16205 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16206 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16207
16208 @item
16209 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16210 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16211 @end itemize
16212
16213 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16214 additions specific to Ada:
16215
16216 @itemize @bullet
16217 @item
16218 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16219 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16220
16221 @smallexample
16222 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16223 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16224 @end smallexample
16225
16226 @item
16227 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16228 the value of its right-hand operand.
16229 This allows, for example,
16230 complex conditional breaks:
16231
16232 @smallexample
16233 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16234 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16235 @end smallexample
16236
16237 @item
16238 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16239 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16240 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16241 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16242 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16243 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16244 in strings. For example,
16245 @smallexample
16246 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16247 @end smallexample
16248 @noindent
16249 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16250 after each period.
16251
16252 @item
16253 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16254 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16255 to write
16256
16257 @smallexample
16258 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16259 @end smallexample
16260
16261 @item
16262 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16263 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16264 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16265 of 3 might print as
16266
16267 @smallexample
16268 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16269 @end smallexample
16270
16271 @noindent
16272 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16273 clause.
16274
16275 @item
16276 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16277 multi-character subsequence of
16278 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16279 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16280 in place of @t{a'length}.
16281
16282 @item
16283 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16284 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16285 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16286 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16287 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16288 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16289 For example,
16290 @smallexample
16291 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16292 @end smallexample
16293
16294 @item
16295 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16296 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16297 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16298 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16299 object.
16300
16301 @end itemize
16302
16303 @node Overloading support for Ada
16304 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16305 @cindex overloading, Ada
16306
16307 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16308 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16309 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16310 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16311 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16312 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16313
16314 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16315 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16316 use, for instance:
16317
16318 @smallexample
16319 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16320 Multiple matches for f
16321 [0] cancel
16322 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16323 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16324 >
16325 @end smallexample
16326
16327 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16328 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16329 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16330
16331 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16332 case:
16333
16334 @table @code
16335
16336 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16337 @item set ada print-signatures
16338 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16339 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16340 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16341
16342 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16343 @item show ada print-signatures
16344 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16345 overloads selection menu.
16346 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16347
16348 @end table
16349
16350 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16351 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16352
16353 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16354 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16355 before reaching the main procedure.
16356 As defined in the Ada Reference
16357 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16358 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16359 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16360 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16361
16362 @node Ada Exceptions
16363 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16364
16365 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16366
16367 @table @code
16368 @kindex info exceptions
16369 @item info exceptions
16370 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16371 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16372 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16373 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16374 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16375 @end table
16376
16377 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16378 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16379 argument.
16380
16381 @smallexample
16382 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16383 All defined Ada exceptions:
16384 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16385 program_error: 0x613d20
16386 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16387 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16388 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16389 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16390 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16391 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16392 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16393 @end smallexample
16394
16395 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16396 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16397
16398 @node Ada Tasks
16399 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16400 @cindex Ada, tasking
16401
16402 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16403 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16404
16405 @table @code
16406 @kindex info tasks
16407 @item info tasks
16408 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16409
16410
16411 @smallexample
16412 @iftex
16413 @leftskip=0.5cm
16414 @end iftex
16415 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16416 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16417 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16418 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16419 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16420 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16421
16422 @end smallexample
16423
16424 @noindent
16425 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16426 task currently being inspected.
16427
16428 @table @asis
16429 @item ID
16430 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16431
16432 @item TID
16433 The Ada task ID.
16434
16435 @item P-ID
16436 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16437
16438 @item Pri
16439 The base priority of the task.
16440
16441 @item State
16442 Current state of the task.
16443
16444 @table @code
16445 @item Unactivated
16446 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16447 executing.
16448
16449 @item Runnable
16450 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16451 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16452
16453 @item Terminated
16454 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16455 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16456 terminated themselves.
16457
16458 @item Child Activation Wait
16459 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16460
16461 @item Accept Statement
16462 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16463
16464 @item Waiting on entry call
16465 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16466
16467 @item Async Select Wait
16468 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16469 select statement.
16470
16471 @item Delay Sleep
16472 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16473 alternative open.
16474
16475 @item Child Termination Wait
16476 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16477 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16478 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16479
16480 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16481 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16482 finish terminating.
16483
16484 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16485 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16486 @end table
16487
16488 @item Name
16489 Name of the task in the program.
16490
16491 @end table
16492
16493 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16494 @item info task @var{taskno}
16495 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16496 the following example:
16497 @smallexample
16498 @iftex
16499 @leftskip=0.5cm
16500 @end iftex
16501 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16502 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16503 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16504 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16505 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16506 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16507 Name: task_1
16508 Thread: 0x807f378
16509 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16510 Base Priority: 15
16511 State: Runnable
16512 @end smallexample
16513
16514 @item task
16515 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16516 @cindex current Ada task ID
16517 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16518
16519 @smallexample
16520 @iftex
16521 @leftskip=0.5cm
16522 @end iftex
16523 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16524 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16525 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16526 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16527 (@value{GDBP}) task
16528 [Current task is 2]
16529 @end smallexample
16530
16531 @item task @var{taskno}
16532 @cindex Ada task switching
16533 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16534 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16535 from the current task to the given task.
16536
16537 @smallexample
16538 @iftex
16539 @leftskip=0.5cm
16540 @end iftex
16541 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16542 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16543 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16544 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16545 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16546 [Switching to task 1]
16547 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16548 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16549 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16550 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16551 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16552 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16553 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16554 @end smallexample
16555
16556 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16557 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16558 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16559 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16560 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16561 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16562 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16563 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16564 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16565
16566 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16567 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16568 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16569 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16570 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16571
16572 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16573 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16574 program.
16575
16576 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16577 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16578 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16579
16580 For example,
16581
16582 @smallexample
16583 @iftex
16584 @leftskip=0.5cm
16585 @end iftex
16586 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16587 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16588 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16589 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16590 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16591 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16592 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16593 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16594 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16595 Continuing.
16596 task # 1 running
16597 task # 2 running
16598
16599 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16600 15 flush;
16601 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16602 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16603 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16604 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16605 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16606 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16607 @end smallexample
16608 @end table
16609
16610 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16611 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16612 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16613
16614 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16615 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16616 the platform being used.
16617 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16618 switching is not supported.
16619
16620 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16621 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16622 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16623 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16624 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16625 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16626
16627 @node Ravenscar Profile
16628 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16629 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16630
16631 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16632 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16633 requirements.
16634
16635 @table @code
16636 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16637 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16638 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16639 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16640 Profile. This is the default.
16641
16642 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16643 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16644 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16645 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16646 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16647 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16648 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16649
16650 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16651 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16652 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16653 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16654
16655 @end table
16656
16657 @node Ada Glitches
16658 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16659 @cindex Ada, problems
16660
16661 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16662 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16663 @value{GDBN},
16664 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16665 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16666
16667 @itemize @bullet
16668 @item
16669 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16670 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16671
16672 @item
16673 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16674 argument lists are treated as positional).
16675
16676 @item
16677 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16678
16679 @item
16680 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16681 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16682 the host machine.
16683
16684 @item
16685 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16686 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16687 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16688 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16689 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16690 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16691 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16692 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16693 you can usually resolve the confusion
16694 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16695 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16696 @end itemize
16697
16698 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16699 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16700 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16701 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16702 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16703 enabled.
16704
16705 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16706 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16707 @table @code
16708
16709 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16710 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16711 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16712 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16713 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16714 This is the default.
16715
16716 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16717 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16718 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16719 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16720 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16721 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16722 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16723
16724 @end table
16725
16726 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16727 @cindex GNAT encoding
16728 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16729 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16730 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16731 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16732 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16733 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16734
16735 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16736 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16737 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16738 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16739 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16740 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16741 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16742 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16743
16744 @table @code
16745
16746 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16747 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16748 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16749 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16750
16751 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16752 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16753 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16754
16755 @end table
16756
16757 @node Unsupported Languages
16758 @section Unsupported Languages
16759
16760 @cindex unsupported languages
16761 @cindex minimal language
16762 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16763 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16764 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16765 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16766 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16767 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16768
16769 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16770 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16771 language.
16772
16773 @node Symbols
16774 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16775
16776 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16777 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16778 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16779 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16780 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16781 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16782 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16783
16784 @cindex symbol names
16785 @cindex names of symbols
16786 @cindex quoting names
16787 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16788 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16789 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16790 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16791 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16792 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16793 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16794 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16795
16796 @smallexample
16797 p 'foo.c'::x
16798 @end smallexample
16799
16800 @noindent
16801 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16802
16803 @table @code
16804 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16805 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16806 @kindex set case-sensitive
16807 @item set case-sensitive on
16808 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16809 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16810 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16811 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16812 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16813 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16814 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16815 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16816 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16817 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16818 case-insensitive matches.
16819
16820 @kindex show case-sensitive
16821 @item show case-sensitive
16822 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16823 lookups.
16824
16825 @kindex set print type methods
16826 @item set print type methods
16827 @itemx set print type methods on
16828 @itemx set print type methods off
16829 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16830 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16831 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16832 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16833 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16834 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16835
16836 @kindex show print type methods
16837 @item show print type methods
16838 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16839 classes.
16840
16841 @kindex set print type typedefs
16842 @item set print type typedefs
16843 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16844 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16845
16846 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16847 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16848 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16849 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16850 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16851 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16852 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16853 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16854 types.
16855
16856 @kindex show print type typedefs
16857 @item show print type typedefs
16858 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16859 printing classes.
16860
16861 @kindex info address
16862 @cindex address of a symbol
16863 @item info address @var{symbol}
16864 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16865 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16866 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16867 is always stored.
16868
16869 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16870 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16871 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16872
16873 @kindex info symbol
16874 @cindex symbol from address
16875 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16876 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16877 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16878 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16879 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16880
16881 @smallexample
16882 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16883 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16884 @end smallexample
16885
16886 @noindent
16887 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16888 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16889
16890 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16891 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16892
16893 @smallexample
16894 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16895 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16896 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16897 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16898 @end smallexample
16899
16900 @kindex demangle
16901 @cindex demangle
16902 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16903 Demangle @var{name}.
16904 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16905 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16906
16907 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16908 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16909
16910 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16911 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16912
16913 @kindex whatis
16914 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16915 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16916 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16917 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16918
16919 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16920 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16921 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16922
16923 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16924 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16925 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16926 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16927 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16928 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16929 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16930 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16931 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16932
16933 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16934 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16935 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16936 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16937 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16938 unroll it.
16939
16940 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16941 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16942 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16943
16944 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16945 Available flags are:
16946
16947 @table @code
16948 @item r
16949 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16950 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16951 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16952
16953 @item m
16954 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16955
16956 @item M
16957 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16958 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16959
16960 @item t
16961 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16962 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16963 names are substituted when printing other types.
16964
16965 @item T
16966 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16967 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16968 @end table
16969
16970 @kindex ptype
16971 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16972 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16973 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16974 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16975
16976 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16977 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16978 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16979 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16980 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16981 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16982 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16983 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16984
16985 For example, for this variable declaration:
16986
16987 @smallexample
16988 typedef double real_t;
16989 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16990 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16991 complex_t var;
16992 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16993 @end smallexample
16994
16995 @noindent
16996 the two commands give this output:
16997
16998 @smallexample
16999 @group
17000 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17001 type = complex_t
17002 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17003 type = struct complex @{
17004 real_t real;
17005 double imag;
17006 @}
17007 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17008 type = struct complex
17009 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17010 type = struct complex
17011 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17012 type = struct complex @{
17013 real_t real;
17014 double imag;
17015 @}
17016 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17017 type = real_t *
17018 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17019 type = double *
17020 @end group
17021 @end smallexample
17022
17023 @noindent
17024 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17025 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17026
17027 @cindex incomplete type
17028 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17029 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17030 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17031 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17032 given these declarations:
17033
17034 @smallexample
17035 struct foo;
17036 struct foo *fooptr;
17037 @end smallexample
17038
17039 @noindent
17040 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17041
17042 @smallexample
17043 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17044 $1 = <incomplete type>
17045 @end smallexample
17046
17047 @noindent
17048 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17049 completely specified.
17050
17051 @kindex info types
17052 @item info types @var{regexp}
17053 @itemx info types
17054 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17055 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17056 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17057 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17058 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17059 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17060 name is @code{value}.
17061
17062 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17063 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17064 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17065
17066 @kindex info type-printers
17067 @item info type-printers
17068 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17069 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17070 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17071 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17072 type printers.
17073
17074 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17075
17076 @kindex enable type-printer
17077 @kindex disable type-printer
17078 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17079 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17080 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17081
17082 @kindex info scope
17083 @cindex local variables
17084 @item info scope @var{location}
17085 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17086 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17087 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17088 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17089 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17090
17091 @smallexample
17092 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17093 Scope for command_line_handler:
17094 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17095 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17096 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17097 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17098 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17099 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17100 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17101 @end smallexample
17102
17103 @noindent
17104 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17105 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17106 collect}.
17107
17108 @kindex info source
17109 @item info source
17110 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17111 the function containing the current point of execution:
17112 @itemize @bullet
17113 @item
17114 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17115 @item
17116 the directory it was compiled in,
17117 @item
17118 its length, in lines,
17119 @item
17120 which programming language it is written in,
17121 @item
17122 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17123 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17124 @item
17125 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17126 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17127 @item
17128 whether the debugging information includes information about
17129 preprocessor macros.
17130 @end itemize
17131
17132
17133 @kindex info sources
17134 @item info sources
17135 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17136 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17137 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17138
17139 @kindex info functions
17140 @item info functions
17141 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17142
17143 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17144 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17145 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17146 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17147 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17148 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17149 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17150 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17151
17152 @kindex info variables
17153 @item info variables
17154 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17155 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17156
17157 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17158 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17159 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17160 @var{regexp}.
17161
17162 @kindex info classes
17163 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17164 @item info classes
17165 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17166 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17167 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17168 expression.
17169
17170 @kindex info selectors
17171 @item info selectors
17172 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17173 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17174 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17175 expression.
17176
17177 @ignore
17178 This was never implemented.
17179 @kindex info methods
17180 @item info methods
17181 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17182 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17183 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17184 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17185 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17186 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17187 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17188 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17189 @end ignore
17190
17191 @cindex opaque data types
17192 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17193 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17194 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17195 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17196 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17197 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17198 another source file. The default is on.
17199
17200 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17201 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17202
17203 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17204 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17205 is printed as follows:
17206 @smallexample
17207 @{<no data fields>@}
17208 @end smallexample
17209
17210 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17211 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17212 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17213
17214 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17215 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17216 @item set print symbol-loading
17217 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17218 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17219 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17220 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17221 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17222 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17223 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17224 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17225 can be annoying.
17226 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17227 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17228 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17229 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17230
17231 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17232 @item show print symbol-loading
17233 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17234 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17235
17236 @kindex maint print symbols
17237 @cindex symbol dump
17238 @kindex maint print psymbols
17239 @cindex partial symbol dump
17240 @kindex maint print msymbols
17241 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17242 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
17243 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
17244 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
17245 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
17246 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
17247 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
17248 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
17249 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
17250 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
17251 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
17252 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
17253 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
17254 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
17255 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
17256 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
17257 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17258 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17259
17260 @kindex maint info symtabs
17261 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17262 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17263 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17264 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17265 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17266 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17267 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17268
17269 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17270 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17271 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17272 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17273 structure in more detail. For example:
17274
17275 @smallexample
17276 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17277 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17278 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17279 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17280 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17281 readin no
17282 fullname (null)
17283 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17284 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17285 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17286 dependencies (none)
17287 @}
17288 @}
17289 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17290 (@value{GDBP})
17291 @end smallexample
17292 @noindent
17293 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17294 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17295 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17296 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17297 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17298
17299 @smallexample
17300 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17301 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17302 line 1574.
17303 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17304 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17305 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17306 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17307 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17308 dirname (null)
17309 fullname (null)
17310 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17311 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17312 debugformat DWARF 2
17313 @}
17314 @}
17315 (@value{GDBP})
17316 @end smallexample
17317
17318 @kindex maint info line-table
17319 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17320 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17321 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17322
17323 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17324 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17325 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17326
17327 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17328 @cindex symbol cache size
17329 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17330 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17331 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17332 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17333 with different sizes.
17334
17335 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17336 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17337 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17338
17339 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17340 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17341 @item maint print symbol-cache
17342 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17343 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17344
17345 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17346 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17347 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17348 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17349 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17350
17351 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17352 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17353 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17354 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17355 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17356 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17357
17358 @end table
17359
17360 @node Altering
17361 @chapter Altering Execution
17362
17363 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17364 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17365 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17366 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17367 program.
17368
17369 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17370 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17371 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17372
17373 @menu
17374 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17375 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17376 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17377 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17378 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17379 * Patching:: Patching your program
17380 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17381 @end menu
17382
17383 @node Assignment
17384 @section Assignment to Variables
17385
17386 @cindex assignment
17387 @cindex setting variables
17388 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17389 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17390
17391 @smallexample
17392 print x=4
17393 @end smallexample
17394
17395 @noindent
17396 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17397 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17398 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17399 information on operators in supported languages.
17400
17401 @kindex set variable
17402 @cindex variables, setting
17403 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17404 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17405 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17406 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17407 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17408
17409 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17410 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17411 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17412 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17413 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17414 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17415 command @code{set width}:
17416
17417 @smallexample
17418 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17419 type = double
17420 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17421 $4 = 13
17422 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17423 Invalid syntax in expression.
17424 @end smallexample
17425
17426 @noindent
17427 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17428 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17429
17430 @smallexample
17431 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17432 @end smallexample
17433
17434 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17435 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17436 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17437 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17438 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17439 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17440
17441 @smallexample
17442 @group
17443 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17444 type = double
17445 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17446 $1 = 1
17447 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17448 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17449 $2 = 1
17450 (@value{GDBP}) r
17451 The program being debugged has been started already.
17452 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17453 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17454 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17455 Invalid bfd target.
17456 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17457 The current BFD target is "=4".
17458 @end group
17459 @end smallexample
17460
17461 @noindent
17462 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17463 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17464 @code{g}, use
17465
17466 @smallexample
17467 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17468 @end smallexample
17469
17470 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17471 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17472 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17473 same length or shorter.
17474 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17475 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17476
17477 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17478 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17479 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17480 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17481 and representation in memory), and
17482
17483 @smallexample
17484 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17485 @end smallexample
17486
17487 @noindent
17488 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17489
17490 @node Jumping
17491 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17492
17493 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17494 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17495 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17496
17497 @table @code
17498 @kindex jump
17499 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17500 @item jump @var{location}
17501 @itemx j @var{location}
17502 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17503 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17504 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17505 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17506 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17507
17508 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17509 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17510 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17511 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17512 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17513 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17514 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17515 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17516 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17517 @end table
17518
17519 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17520 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17521 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17522 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17523 example,
17524
17525 @smallexample
17526 set $pc = 0x485
17527 @end smallexample
17528
17529 @noindent
17530 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17531 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17532 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17533
17534 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17535 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17536 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17537 detail.
17538
17539 @c @group
17540 @node Signaling
17541 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17542 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17543
17544 @table @code
17545 @kindex signal
17546 @item signal @var{signal}
17547 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17548 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17549 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17550 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17551
17552 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17553 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17554 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17555 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17556 signal.
17557
17558 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17559 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17560 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17561 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17562 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17563 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17564 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17565 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17566
17567 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17568 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17569 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17570 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17571 passes the signal directly to your program.
17572
17573 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17574 after executing the command.
17575
17576 @kindex queue-signal
17577 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17578 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17579 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17580 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17581 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17582 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17583 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17584 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17585 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17586
17587 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17588 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17589 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17590 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17591 @code{continue} command.
17592
17593 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17594 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17595 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17596 (@pxref{Signals}).
17597 @end table
17598 @c @end group
17599
17600 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17601 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17602
17603 @node Returning
17604 @section Returning from a Function
17605
17606 @table @code
17607 @cindex returning from a function
17608 @kindex return
17609 @item return
17610 @itemx return @var{expression}
17611 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17612 command. If you give an
17613 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17614 value.
17615 @end table
17616
17617 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17618 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17619 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17620 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17621
17622 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17623 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17624 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17625 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17626 of functions.
17627
17628 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17629 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17630 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17631 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17632 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17633
17634 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17635 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17636 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17637 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17638 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17639 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17640 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17641 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17642 assignment into the right register(s).
17643
17644 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17645 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17646 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17647 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17648 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17649 into a @code{long long int}:
17650
17651 @smallexample
17652 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17653 29 return 31;
17654 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17655 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17656 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17657 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17658 (@value{GDBP})
17659 @end smallexample
17660
17661 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17662 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17663 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17664 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17665 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17666 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17667 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17668 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17669
17670 @smallexample
17671 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17672 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17673 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17674 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17675 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17676 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17677 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17678 (@value{GDBP})
17679 @end smallexample
17680
17681 @node Calling
17682 @section Calling Program Functions
17683
17684 @table @code
17685 @cindex calling functions
17686 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17687 @item print @var{expr}
17688 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17689 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17690 debugged.
17691
17692 @kindex call
17693 @item call @var{expr}
17694 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17695 returned values.
17696
17697 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17698 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17699 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17700 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17701 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17702 value history.
17703 @end table
17704
17705 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17706 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17707 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17708 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17709
17710 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17711 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17712 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17713 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17714 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17715 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17716 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17717 in that case is controlled by the
17718 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17719
17720 @table @code
17721 @item set unwindonsignal
17722 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17723 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17724 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17725 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17726 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17727 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17728 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17729 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17730 received.
17731
17732 @item show unwindonsignal
17733 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17734 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17735 @value{GDBN}.
17736
17737 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17738 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17739 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17740 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17741 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17742 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17743 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17744 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17745 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17746 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17747
17748 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17749 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17750 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17751 @value{GDBN}.
17752
17753 @end table
17754
17755 @cindex weak alias functions
17756 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17757 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17758 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17759 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17760 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17761 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17762 function instead.
17763
17764 @node Patching
17765 @section Patching Programs
17766
17767 @cindex patching binaries
17768 @cindex writing into executables
17769 @cindex writing into corefiles
17770
17771 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17772 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17773 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17774 patching your program's binary.
17775
17776 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17777 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17778 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17779 repairs.
17780
17781 @table @code
17782 @kindex set write
17783 @item set write on
17784 @itemx set write off
17785 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17786 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17787 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17788
17789 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17790 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17791 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17792
17793 @item show write
17794 @kindex show write
17795 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17796 as well as reading.
17797 @end table
17798
17799 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17800 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17801 @cindex injecting code
17802 @cindex writing into executables
17803 @cindex compiling code
17804
17805 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17806 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17807 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17808 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17809
17810 @table @code
17811 @kindex compile code
17812 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17813 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17814 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17815 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17816 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17817 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17818 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17819 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17820 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17821 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17822 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17823 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17824
17825 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17826 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17827 E.g.:
17828
17829 @smallexample
17830 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17831 @end smallexample
17832
17833 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17834 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17835 from actual source code. E.g.:
17836
17837 @smallexample
17838 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17839 @end smallexample
17840
17841 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17842 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17843 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17844 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17845 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17846 editor.
17847
17848 @smallexample
17849 compile code
17850 >printf ("hello\n");
17851 >printf ("world\n");
17852 >end
17853 @end smallexample
17854
17855 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17856 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17857 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17858 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17859 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17860 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17861 inferior symbols otherwise.
17862
17863 @kindex compile file
17864 @item compile file @var{filename}
17865 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17866 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17867
17868 @smallexample
17869 compile file /home/user/example.c
17870 @end smallexample
17871 @end table
17872
17873 @table @code
17874 @item compile print @var{expr}
17875 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17876 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17877 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17878 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17879 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17880 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17881 Formats}.
17882
17883 @item compile print
17884 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17885 @cindex reprint the last value
17886 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17887 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17888 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17889 multiple-line editor.
17890 @end table
17891
17892 @noindent
17893 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17894
17895 @table @code
17896 @anchor{set debug compile}
17897 @item set debug compile
17898 @cindex compile command debugging info
17899 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17900 injecting the code. The default is off.
17901
17902 @item show debug compile
17903 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17904 compiling and injecting the code.
17905 @end table
17906
17907 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17908
17909 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17910 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17911 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17912 injecting process.
17913
17914 @noindent
17915 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17916
17917 @table @asis
17918 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17919 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17920 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17921 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17922
17923 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17924 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17925 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17926 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17927 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17928 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17929 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17930 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17931
17932 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17933 @end table
17934
17935 @noindent
17936 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17937
17938 @table @code
17939 @item set compile-args
17940 @cindex compile command options override
17941 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17942 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17943 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17944 compilation.
17945
17946 @item show compile-args
17947 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17948 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17949 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17950 @end table
17951
17952 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17953
17954 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17955 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17956 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17957
17958 @table @asis
17959 @item C code examples and caveats
17960 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17961 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17962 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17963 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17964 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17965
17966 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17967 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17968 much like any other normal debugging session.
17969
17970 @smallexample
17971 void function1 (void)
17972 @{
17973 int i = 42;
17974 printf ("function 1\n");
17975 @}
17976
17977 void function2 (void)
17978 @{
17979 int j = 12;
17980 function1 ();
17981 @}
17982
17983 int main(void)
17984 @{
17985 int k = 6;
17986 int *p;
17987 function2 ();
17988 return 0;
17989 @}
17990 @end smallexample
17991
17992 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17993 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17994 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17995
17996 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17997 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17998 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17999 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18000 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18001
18002 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18003 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18004 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18005 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18006 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18007 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18008 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18009 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18010 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18011 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18012
18013 @smallexample
18014 compile code k = 3;
18015 @end smallexample
18016
18017 @noindent
18018 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18019 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18020 @code{compile} command changes it.
18021
18022 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18023 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18024 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18025 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18026 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18027
18028 @smallexample
18029 compile code j = 3;
18030 @end smallexample
18031
18032 @noindent
18033 will result in a compilation error message.
18034
18035 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18036 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18037 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18038
18039 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18040 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18041 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18042 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18043
18044 @smallexample
18045 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18046 @end smallexample
18047
18048 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18049 command has completed:
18050
18051 @smallexample
18052 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18053 @end smallexample
18054
18055 @noindent
18056 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18057 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18058 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18059 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18060 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18061
18062 @smallexample
18063 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18064 @end smallexample
18065
18066 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18067 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18068 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18069 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18070 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18071 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18072 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18073 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18074
18075 @smallexample
18076 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18077 @end smallexample
18078
18079 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18080 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18081 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18082 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18083 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18084 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18085 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18086
18087 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18088 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18089 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18090 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18091 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18092 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18093
18094 @smallexample
18095 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18096 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18097 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18098 Compilation failed.
18099 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18100 42
18101 @end smallexample
18102
18103 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18104 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18105 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18106 will print to the console.
18107 @end table
18108
18109 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18110
18111 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18112 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18113 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18114 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18115 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
18116 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18117 target architecture and operating system.
18118
18119 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18120 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18121 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18122 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18123 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18124 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18125 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18126
18127 @node GDB Files
18128 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18129
18130 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18131 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18132 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18133 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18134
18135 @menu
18136 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18137 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18138 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18139 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18140 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18141 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18142 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18143 @end menu
18144
18145 @node Files
18146 @section Commands to Specify Files
18147
18148 @cindex symbol table
18149 @cindex core dump file
18150
18151 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18152 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18153 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18154 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18155
18156 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18157 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18158 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18159 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18160 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18161 new files are useful.
18162
18163 @table @code
18164 @cindex executable file
18165 @kindex file
18166 @item file @var{filename}
18167 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18168 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18169 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18170 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18171 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18172 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18173 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18174 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18175
18176 @cindex unlinked object files
18177 @cindex patching object files
18178 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18179 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18180 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18181 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18182 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18183 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18184 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18185 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18186
18187 @item file
18188 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18189 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18190
18191 @kindex exec-file
18192 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18193 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18194 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18195 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18196 discard information on the executable file.
18197
18198 @kindex symbol-file
18199 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18200 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18201 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18202 table and program to run from the same file.
18203
18204 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18205 program's symbol table.
18206
18207 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18208 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18209 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18210 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18211 @value{GDBN}.
18212
18213 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18214 executing it once.
18215
18216 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18217 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18218 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18219 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18220 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18221 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18222 optimized code.
18223
18224 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18225 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18226 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18227 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18228 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18229
18230 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18231 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18232 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18233 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18234 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18235 Warnings and Messages}.)
18236
18237 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18238 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18239 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18240 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18241 in stabs format.
18242
18243 @kindex readnow
18244 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18245 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18246 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18247 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18248 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18249 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18250 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18251 entire symbol table available.
18252
18253 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18254 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18255 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18256 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18257 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18258 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18259 @c files.
18260
18261 @kindex core-file
18262 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18263 @itemx core
18264 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18265 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18266 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18267 executable file itself for other parts.
18268
18269 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18270 to be used.
18271
18272 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18273 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18274 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18275 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18276 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18277
18278 @kindex add-symbol-file
18279 @cindex dynamic linking
18280 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18281 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18282 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18283 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18284 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18285 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18286 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18287 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18288 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18289 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18290 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18291 @var{address} as an expression.
18292
18293 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18294 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18295 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18296 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18297
18298 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18299
18300 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18301 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18302 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18303 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18304 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18305 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18306 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18307 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18308 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18309
18310 @itemize @bullet
18311 @item
18312 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18313 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18314 @item
18315 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18316 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18317 @item
18318 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18319 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18320 @end itemize
18321
18322 @noindent
18323 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18324 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18325 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18326 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18327 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18328 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18329 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18330 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18331 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18332 way.
18333
18334 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18335
18336 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18337 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18338 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18339 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18340 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18341 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18342
18343 @smallexample
18344 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18345 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18346 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18347 (y or n) y
18348 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18349 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18350 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18351 (gdb)
18352 @end smallexample
18353
18354
18355 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18356
18357 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18358 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18359 @cindex load symbols from memory
18360 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18361 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18362 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18363 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18364 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18365 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18366 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18367 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18368 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18369
18370 @kindex section
18371 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18372 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18373 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18374 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18375 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18376 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18377 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18378 their addresses.
18379
18380 @kindex info files
18381 @kindex info target
18382 @item info files
18383 @itemx info target
18384 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18385 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18386 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18387 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18388 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18389 current ones.
18390
18391 @kindex maint info sections
18392 @item maint info sections
18393 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18394 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18395 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18396 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18397 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18398 may be arbitrarily combined):
18399
18400 @table @code
18401 @item ALLOBJ
18402 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18403 @item @var{sections}
18404 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18405 @item @var{section-flags}
18406 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18407 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18408 @table @code
18409 @item ALLOC
18410 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18411 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18412 @item LOAD
18413 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18414 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18415 @item RELOC
18416 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18417 @item READONLY
18418 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18419 @item CODE
18420 Section contains executable code only.
18421 @item DATA
18422 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18423 @item ROM
18424 Section will reside in ROM.
18425 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18426 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18427 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18428 Section is not empty.
18429 @item NEVER_LOAD
18430 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18431 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18432 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18433 COFF shared library information.
18434 @item IS_COMMON
18435 Section contains common symbols.
18436 @end table
18437 @end table
18438 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18439 @cindex read-only sections
18440 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18441 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18442 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18443 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18444 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18445 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18446 enhancement to debugging performance.
18447
18448 The default is off.
18449
18450 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18451 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18452 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18453 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18454
18455 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18456 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18457 @end table
18458
18459 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18460 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18461 name and remembers it that way.
18462
18463 @cindex shared libraries
18464 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18465 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18466 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18467 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18468
18469 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18470 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18471
18472 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18473 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18474 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18475 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18476 debugging a core file).
18477
18478 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18479 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18480 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18481
18482 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18483 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18484 particularly large or there are many of them.
18485
18486 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18487 commands:
18488
18489 @table @code
18490 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18491 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18492 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18493 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18494 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18495 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18496 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18497 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18498
18499 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18500 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18501 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18502 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18503 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18504 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18505 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18506 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18507 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18508
18509 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18510 @item show auto-solib-add
18511 Display the current autoloading mode.
18512 @end table
18513
18514 @cindex load shared library
18515 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18516 command:
18517
18518 @table @code
18519 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18520 @kindex info share
18521 @item info share @var{regex}
18522 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18523 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18524 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18525 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18526
18527 @kindex info dll
18528 @item info dll @var{regex}
18529 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18530
18531 @kindex sharedlibrary
18532 @kindex share
18533 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18534 @itemx share @var{regex}
18535 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18536 Unix regular expression.
18537 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18538 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18539 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18540 loaded.
18541
18542 @item nosharedlibrary
18543 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18544 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18545 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18546 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18547 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18548 discarded.
18549 @end table
18550
18551 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18552 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18553 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18554 Catchpoints}).
18555
18556 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18557 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18558 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18559 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18560
18561 @table @code
18562 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18563 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18564 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18565 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18566 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18567 shared library.
18568
18569 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18570 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18571 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18572 library events happen.
18573 @end table
18574
18575 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18576 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18577 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18578 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18579 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18580 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18581 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18582 not.
18583
18584 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18585 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18586 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18587 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18588 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18589
18590 @table @code
18591 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18592 @cindex system root, alternate
18593 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18594 @kindex set sysroot
18595 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18596 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18597 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18598 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18599 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18600 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18601 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18602 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18603 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18604 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18605 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18606 @var{path}.
18607
18608 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18609 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18610 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18611 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18612 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18613 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18614 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18615 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18616 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18617 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18618 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18619 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18620 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18621 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18622
18623 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18624 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18625 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18626 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18627 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18628
18629 @smallexample
18630 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18631 @end smallexample
18632
18633 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18634 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18635 system:
18636
18637 @smallexample
18638 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18639 @end smallexample
18640
18641 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18642 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18643 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18644 colons:
18645
18646 @smallexample
18647 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18648 @end smallexample
18649
18650 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18651 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18652 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18653 @samp{z}):
18654
18655 @smallexample
18656 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18657 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18658 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18659 @end smallexample
18660
18661 @noindent
18662 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18663 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18664 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18665
18666 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18667 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18668
18669 @smallexample
18670 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18671 @end smallexample
18672
18673 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18674 if you don't want or need to.
18675
18676 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18677 sysroot}.
18678
18679 @cindex default system root
18680 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18681 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18682 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18683 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18684 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18685 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18686 location.
18687
18688 @kindex show sysroot
18689 @item show sysroot
18690 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18691
18692 @kindex set solib-search-path
18693 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18694 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18695 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18696 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18697 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18698 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18699 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18700 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18701 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18702 of shared library symbols.
18703
18704 @kindex show solib-search-path
18705 @item show solib-search-path
18706 Display the current shared library search path.
18707
18708 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18709 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18710 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18711 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18712 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18713
18714 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18715 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18716 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18717 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18718 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18719 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18720 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18721 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18722 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18723 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18724 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18725 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18726 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18727 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18728 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18729 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18730 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18731 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18732 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18733 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18734 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18735 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18736
18737 @table @code
18738 @item unix
18739 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18740 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18741 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18742 the forward slash.
18743
18744 @item dos-based
18745 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18746 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18747 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18748 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18749 considered directory separators.
18750
18751 @item auto
18752 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18753 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18754 This is the default.
18755 @end table
18756 @end table
18757
18758 @cindex file name canonicalization
18759 @cindex base name differences
18760 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18761 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18762 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18763 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18764 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18765 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18766 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18767 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18768 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18769 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18770 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18771 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18772 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18773 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18774 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18775
18776 @table @code
18777 @item set basenames-may-differ
18778 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18779 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18780
18781 @item show basenames-may-differ
18782 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18783 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18784 @end table
18785
18786 @node File Caching
18787 @section File Caching
18788 @cindex caching of opened files
18789 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18790
18791 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18792 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18793 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18794 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18795
18796 @table @code
18797 @kindex maint info bfds
18798 @item maint info bfds
18799 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18800 @value{GDBN}.
18801
18802 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18803 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18804 @kindex bfd caching
18805 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18806 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18807 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18808 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18809 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18810 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18811 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18812 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18813 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18814
18815 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18816 @kindex bfd caching
18817 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18818 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18819
18820 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18821 @kindex bfd caching
18822 @item show debug bfd-cache
18823 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18824 @end table
18825
18826 @node Separate Debug Files
18827 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18828 @cindex separate debugging information files
18829 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18830 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18831 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18832 @cindex global debugging information directories
18833 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18834 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18835
18836 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18837 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18838 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18839 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18840 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18841 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18842 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18843
18844 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18845 file:
18846
18847 @itemize @bullet
18848 @item
18849 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18850 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18851 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18852 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18853 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18854 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18855 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18856 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18857
18858 @item
18859 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18860 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18861 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18862 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18863 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18864 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18865 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18866 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18867 below.
18868 @end itemize
18869
18870 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18871 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18872
18873 @itemize @bullet
18874 @item
18875 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18876 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18877 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18878 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18879 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18880
18881 @item
18882 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18883 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18884 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18885 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18886 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18887 hex characters, not 10.)
18888 @end itemize
18889
18890 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18891 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18892 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18893 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18894 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18895 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18896
18897 @itemize @minus
18898 @item
18899 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18900 @item
18901 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18902 @item
18903 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18904 @item
18905 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18906 @end itemize
18907
18908 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18909 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18910 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18911 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18912 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18913
18914 @table @code
18915
18916 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18917 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18918 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18919 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18920 concatenating them by a path separator.
18921
18922 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18923 @item show debug-file-directory
18924 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18925 information files.
18926
18927 @end table
18928
18929 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18930 @cindex debug link sections
18931 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18932 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18933
18934 @itemize
18935 @item
18936 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18937 a zero byte,
18938 @item
18939 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18940 boundary within the section, and
18941 @item
18942 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18943 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18944 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18945 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18946 @end itemize
18947
18948 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18949 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18950 described above.
18951
18952 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18953 @cindex build ID sections
18954 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18955 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18956 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18957 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18958 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18959 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18960 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18961 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18962 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18963
18964 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18965 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18966 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18967 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18968 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18969 in an ordinary executable.
18970
18971 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18972 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18973 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18974 following commands:
18975
18976 @smallexample
18977 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18978 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18979 @end smallexample
18980
18981 @noindent
18982 These commands remove the debugging
18983 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18984 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18985 two files:
18986
18987 @itemize @bullet
18988 @item
18989 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18990 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18991
18992 @smallexample
18993 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18994 @end smallexample
18995
18996 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18997 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18998 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18999 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19000
19001 @item
19002 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19003 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19004 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19005 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19006 @end itemize
19007
19008 @noindent
19009
19010 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19011 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19012 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19013
19014 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19015 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19016 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19017 @c different ways!
19018 @ifhtml
19019 @display
19020 @html
19021 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19022 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19023 @end html
19024 @end display
19025 @end ifhtml
19026 @ifnothtml
19027 @display
19028 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19029 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19030 @end display
19031 @end ifnothtml
19032
19033 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19034 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19035 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19036 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19037 CRC.
19038
19039 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19040 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19041 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19042 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19043 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19044
19045 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19046 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19047 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19048 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19049 @code{0xffffffff}.
19050
19051 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19052 @smallexample
19053 unsigned long
19054 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19055 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19056 @{
19057 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19058 @{
19059 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19060 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19061 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19062 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19063 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19064 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19065 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19066 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19067 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19068 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19069 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19070 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19071 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19072 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19073 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19074 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19075 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19076 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19077 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19078 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19079 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19080 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19081 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19082 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19083 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19084 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19085 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19086 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19087 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19088 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19089 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19090 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19091 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19092 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19093 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19094 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19095 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19096 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19097 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19098 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19099 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19100 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19101 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19102 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19103 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19104 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19105 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19106 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19107 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19108 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19109 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19110 0x2d02ef8d
19111 @};
19112 unsigned char *end;
19113
19114 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19115 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19116 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19117 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19118 @}
19119 @end smallexample
19120
19121 @noindent
19122 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19123
19124 @node MiniDebugInfo
19125 @section Debugging information in a special section
19126 @cindex separate debug sections
19127 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19128
19129 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19130 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19131 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19132 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19133
19134 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19135 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19136 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19137 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19138 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19139 debugging information might be included in the section.
19140
19141 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19142 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19143 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19144
19145 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19146 standard utilities:
19147
19148 @smallexample
19149 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19150 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19151 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19152 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19153
19154 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19155 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19156 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19157 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19158 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19159 | sort > funcsyms
19160
19161 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19162 # table.
19163 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19164
19165 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19166 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19167
19168 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19169 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19170 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19171 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19172
19173 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19174 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19175
19176 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19177 # original binary.
19178 xz mini_debuginfo
19179 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19180 @end smallexample
19181
19182 @node Index Files
19183 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19184 @cindex index files
19185 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19186
19187 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19188 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19189 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19190 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19191 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19192 startup.
19193
19194 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19195 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19196 using @command{objcopy}.
19197
19198 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19199
19200 @table @code
19201 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19202 @kindex save gdb-index
19203 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19204 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19205 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19206 @var{directory}.
19207 @end table
19208
19209 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19210 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19211
19212 @smallexample
19213 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19214 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19215 @end smallexample
19216
19217 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19218 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19219 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19220 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19221 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19222 The default is @code{off}.
19223 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19224 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19225
19226 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19227 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19228
19229 @smallexample
19230 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19231 @end smallexample
19232
19233 Instead you must do, for example,
19234
19235 @smallexample
19236 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19237 @end smallexample
19238
19239 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19240 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19241 currently work for programs using Ada.
19242
19243 @node Symbol Errors
19244 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19245
19246 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19247 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19248 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19249 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19250 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19251 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19252 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19253 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19254 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19255 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19256 Messages}).
19257
19258 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19259
19260 @table @code
19261 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19262
19263 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19264 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19265 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19266 in its outer scope blocks.
19267
19268 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19269 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19270 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19271 function.
19272
19273 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19274
19275 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19276 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19277 do so.
19278
19279 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19280 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19281 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19282 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19283 Messages}.)
19284
19285 @item bad block start address patched
19286
19287 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19288 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19289 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19290
19291 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19292 starting on the previous source line.
19293
19294 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19295
19296 @cindex foo
19297 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19298 larger than the size of the string table.
19299
19300 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19301 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19302 with this name.
19303
19304 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19305
19306 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19307 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19308 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19309
19310 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19311 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19312 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19313 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19314 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19315 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19316
19317 @item stub type has NULL name
19318
19319 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19320
19321 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19322 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19323 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19324 it.
19325
19326 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19327
19328 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19329
19330 @end table
19331
19332 @node Data Files
19333 @section GDB Data Files
19334
19335 @cindex prefix for data files
19336 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19337 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19338
19339 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19340 is currently using.
19341
19342 @table @code
19343 @kindex set data-directory
19344 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19345 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19346 to @var{directory}.
19347
19348 @kindex show data-directory
19349 @item show data-directory
19350 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19351 @end table
19352
19353 @cindex default data directory
19354 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19355 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19356 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19357 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19358 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19359 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19360 location.
19361
19362 The data directory may also be specified with the
19363 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19364 @xref{Mode Options}.
19365
19366 @node Targets
19367 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19368
19369 @cindex debugging target
19370 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19371
19372 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19373 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19374 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19375 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19376 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19377 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19378 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19379 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19380
19381 @cindex target architecture
19382 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19383 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19384 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19385 command.
19386
19387 @table @code
19388 @kindex set architecture
19389 @kindex show architecture
19390 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19391 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19392 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19393 supported architectures.
19394
19395 @item show architecture
19396 Show the current target architecture.
19397
19398 @item set processor
19399 @itemx processor
19400 @kindex set processor
19401 @kindex show processor
19402 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19403 and @code{show architecture}.
19404 @end table
19405
19406 @menu
19407 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19408 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19409 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19410 @end menu
19411
19412 @node Active Targets
19413 @section Active Targets
19414
19415 @cindex stacking targets
19416 @cindex active targets
19417 @cindex multiple targets
19418
19419 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19420 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19421 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19422 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19423 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19424 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19425 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19426 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19427 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19428
19429 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19430 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19431 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19432 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19433
19434 @node Target Commands
19435 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19436
19437 @table @code
19438 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19439 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19440 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19441 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19442 protocol of the target machine.
19443
19444 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19445 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19446 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19447
19448 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19449 after executing the command.
19450
19451 @kindex help target
19452 @item help target
19453 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19454 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19455 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19456
19457 @item help target @var{name}
19458 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19459 select it.
19460
19461 @kindex set gnutarget
19462 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19463 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19464 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19465 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19466 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19467 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19468
19469 @quotation
19470 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19471 you must know the actual BFD name.
19472 @end quotation
19473
19474 @noindent
19475 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19476
19477 @kindex show gnutarget
19478 @item show gnutarget
19479 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19480 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19481 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19482 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19483 @end table
19484
19485 @cindex common targets
19486 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19487 configuration):
19488
19489 @table @code
19490 @kindex target
19491 @item target exec @var{program}
19492 @cindex executable file target
19493 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19494 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19495
19496 @item target core @var{filename}
19497 @cindex core dump file target
19498 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19499 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19500
19501 @item target remote @var{medium}
19502 @cindex remote target
19503 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19504 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19505 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19506
19507 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19508 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19509
19510 @smallexample
19511 target remote /dev/ttya
19512 @end smallexample
19513
19514 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19515 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19516 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19517 clobbered by the download.
19518
19519 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19520 @cindex built-in simulator target
19521 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19522 In general,
19523 @smallexample
19524 target sim
19525 load
19526 run
19527 @end smallexample
19528 @noindent
19529 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19530 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19531 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19532 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19533 Processors}.
19534
19535 @item target native
19536 @cindex native target
19537 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19538 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19539 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19540 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19541
19542 @end table
19543
19544 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19545 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19546
19547 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19548 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19549 various aspects of this process.
19550
19551 @table @code
19552
19553 @item set hash
19554 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19555 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19556 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19557 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19558 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19559 monitor.
19560
19561 @item show hash
19562 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19563 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19564
19565 @item set debug monitor
19566 @kindex set debug monitor
19567 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19568 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19569 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19570
19571 @item show debug monitor
19572 @kindex show debug monitor
19573 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19574 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19575 @end table
19576
19577 @table @code
19578
19579 @kindex load @var{filename}
19580 @item load @var{filename}
19581 @anchor{load}
19582 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19583 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19584 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19585 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19586 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19587 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19588
19589 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19590 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19591 target is @dots{}}''
19592
19593 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19594 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19595 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19596 specifies a fixed address.
19597 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19598
19599 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19600 load programs into flash memory.
19601
19602 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19603 @end table
19604
19605 @node Byte Order
19606 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19607
19608 @cindex choosing target byte order
19609 @cindex target byte order
19610
19611 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19612 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19613 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19614 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19615 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19616 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19617
19618 @table @code
19619 @kindex set endian
19620 @item set endian big
19621 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19622
19623 @item set endian little
19624 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19625
19626 @item set endian auto
19627 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19628 executable.
19629
19630 @item show endian
19631 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19632
19633 @end table
19634
19635 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19636 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19637 target system.
19638
19639
19640 @node Remote Debugging
19641 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19642 @cindex remote debugging
19643
19644 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19645 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19646 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19647 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19648 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19649
19650 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19651 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19652 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19653 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19654 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19655 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19656
19657 Other remote targets may be available in your
19658 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19659
19660 @menu
19661 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19662 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19663 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19664 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19665 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19666 @end menu
19667
19668 @node Connecting
19669 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19670 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19671 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19672 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19673 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19674 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19675 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19676
19677 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19678 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19679 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19680 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19681
19682 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19683
19684 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19685 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19686 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19687 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19688
19689 @table @asis
19690
19691 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19692 @item Result of detach or program exit
19693 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19694 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19695 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19696
19697 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19698 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19699 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19700 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19701
19702 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19703 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19704 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19705 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19706
19707 @item Specifying the program to debug
19708 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19709 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19710 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19711 target.
19712
19713 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19714 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19715 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19716
19717 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19718 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19719 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19720 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19721
19722 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19723 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19724 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19725 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19726 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19727 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19728 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19729 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19730 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19731
19732 @item The @code{run} command
19733 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19734 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19735 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19736 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19737 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19738
19739 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19740 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19741 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19742 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19743 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19744
19745 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19746 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19747 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19748 @code{target remote} mode.
19749
19750 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19751 @item Attaching
19752 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19753 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19754 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19755
19756 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19757 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19758 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19759 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19760 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19761
19762 @end table
19763
19764 @anchor{Host and target files}
19765 @subsection Host and Target Files
19766 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19767 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19768
19769 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19770 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19771 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19772 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19773 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19774
19775 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19776 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19777 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19778 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19779 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19780
19781 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19782 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19783 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19784 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19785 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19786 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19787 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19788 target libraries.
19789
19790 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19791 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19792 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19793 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19794 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19795 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19796 programs.
19797
19798 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19799 @cindex remote connection commands
19800 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19801 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19802 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19803 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19804 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19805 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19806 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19807
19808 @table @code
19809
19810 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19811 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19812 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19813 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19814 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19815
19816 @smallexample
19817 target remote /dev/ttyb
19818 @end smallexample
19819
19820 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19821 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19822 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19823 @code{target} command.
19824
19825 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19826 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19827 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19828 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19829 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19830 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19831 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19832 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19833 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19834 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19835 target.
19836
19837 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19838 @code{manyfarms}:
19839
19840 @smallexample
19841 target remote manyfarms:2828
19842 @end smallexample
19843
19844 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19845 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19846 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19847 port 1234 on your local machine:
19848
19849 @smallexample
19850 target remote :1234
19851 @end smallexample
19852 @noindent
19853
19854 Note that the colon is still required here.
19855
19856 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19857 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19858 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19859 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19860 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19861
19862 @smallexample
19863 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19864 @end smallexample
19865
19866 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19867 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19868 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19869 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19870
19871 @item target remote | @var{command}
19872 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19873 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19874 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19875 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19876 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19877 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19878 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19879 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19880 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19881
19882 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19883 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19884 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19885
19886 @end table
19887
19888 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19889 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19890 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19891 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19892 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19893 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19894 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19895
19896 @smallexample
19897 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19898 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19899 @end smallexample
19900
19901 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19902 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19903 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19904 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19905
19906 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19907 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19908
19909 @table @code
19910 @kindex detach (remote)
19911 @item detach
19912 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19913 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19914 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19915 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19916 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19917 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19918 still connected to the target.
19919
19920 @kindex disconnect
19921 @item disconnect
19922 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19923 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19924 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19925 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19926 another target.
19927
19928 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19929 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19930 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19931 @kindex monitor
19932 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19933 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19934 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19935 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19936 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19937 and implement.
19938 @end table
19939
19940 @node File Transfer
19941 @section Sending files to a remote system
19942 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19943 @cindex file transfer
19944 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19945
19946 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19947 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19948 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19949 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19950 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19951 the only way to upload or download files.
19952
19953 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19954
19955 @table @code
19956 @kindex remote put
19957 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19958 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19959 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19960
19961 @kindex remote get
19962 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19963 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19964 on the host system.
19965
19966 @kindex remote delete
19967 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19968 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19969
19970 @end table
19971
19972 @node Server
19973 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19974
19975 @kindex gdbserver
19976 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19977 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19978 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19979 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19980 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19981
19982 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19983 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19984 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19985 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19986 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19987 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19988 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19989 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19990 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19991 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19992 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19993 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19994 choice for debugging.
19995
19996 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19997 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19998 protocol.
19999
20000 @quotation
20001 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20002 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20003 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20004 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20005 @code{gdbserver}.
20006 @end quotation
20007
20008 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20009 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20010 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20011 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20012
20013 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20014 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20015 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20016 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20017 system does all the symbol handling.
20018
20019 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20020 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20021 syntax is:
20022
20023 @smallexample
20024 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20025 @end smallexample
20026
20027 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20028 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20029 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20030 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20031 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20032 @file{/dev/com1}:
20033
20034 @smallexample
20035 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20036 @end smallexample
20037
20038 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20039 with it.
20040
20041 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20042
20043 @smallexample
20044 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20045 @end smallexample
20046
20047 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20048 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20049 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20050 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20051 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20052 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20053 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20054 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20055 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20056 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20057 @code{target remote} command.
20058
20059 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20060 with ssh:
20061
20062 @smallexample
20063 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20064 @end smallexample
20065
20066 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20067 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20068 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20069 You could elide it if you want to.
20070
20071 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20072 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20073 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20074 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20075
20076 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20077 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20078 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20079 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20080
20081 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20082 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20083
20084 @smallexample
20085 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20086 @end smallexample
20087
20088 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20089 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20090
20091 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20092 @value{GDBN} attach command
20093 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20094
20095 @pindex pidof
20096 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20097 @code{pidof} utility:
20098
20099 @smallexample
20100 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20101 @end smallexample
20102
20103 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20104 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20105 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20106
20107 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20108
20109 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20110 port.
20111
20112 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20113 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20114 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20115 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20116 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20117 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20118 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20119 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20120
20121 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20122 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20123 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20124
20125 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20126 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20127 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20128 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20129 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20130 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20131 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20132 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20133 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20134 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20135 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20136 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20137
20138 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20139 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20140
20141 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20142 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20143 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20144 program. For more information,
20145 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20146
20147 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20148 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20149 status information about the debugging process.
20150 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20151 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20152 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20153 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20154
20155 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20156 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20157 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20158 Possible options are:
20159
20160 @table @code
20161 @item none
20162 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20163 @item all
20164 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20165 @item timestamps
20166 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20167 @end table
20168
20169 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20170 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20171
20172 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20173 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20174 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20175 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20176 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20177
20178 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20179 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20180 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20181 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20182
20183 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20184 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20185 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20186 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20187
20188 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20189 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20190 environment:
20191
20192 @smallexample
20193 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20194 @end smallexample
20195
20196 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20197
20198 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20199 @itemize
20200
20201 @item
20202 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20203
20204 @item
20205 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20206 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20207 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20208 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20209 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20210 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20211
20212 @item
20213 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20214 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20215 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20216 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20217 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20218 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20219 program is already on the target.
20220
20221 @end itemize
20222
20223 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20224 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20225 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20226
20227 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20228 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20229 Here are the available commands.
20230
20231 @table @code
20232 @item monitor help
20233 List the available monitor commands.
20234
20235 @item monitor set debug 0
20236 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20237 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20238
20239 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20240 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20241 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20242 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20243
20244 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20245 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20246 Possible options are:
20247
20248 @table @code
20249 @item none
20250 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20251 @item all
20252 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20253 @item timestamps
20254 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20255 @end table
20256
20257 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20258 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20259
20260 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20261 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20262 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20263 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20264 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20265 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20266
20267 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20268 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20269
20270 @item monitor exit
20271 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20272 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20273 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20274 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20275 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20276
20277 @end table
20278
20279 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20280 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20281
20282 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20283 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20284
20285 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20286 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20287 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20288 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20289 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20290 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20291 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20292 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20293 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20294 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20295 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20296 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20297
20298 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20299
20300 @table @code
20301 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20302
20303 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20304 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20305 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20306
20307 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20308
20309 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20310 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20311 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20312 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20313 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20314 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20315
20316 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20317
20318 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20319 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20320 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20321 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20322 command for that. For example:
20323
20324 @smallexample
20325 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20326 @end smallexample
20327
20328 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20329 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20330 @end table
20331
20332 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20333 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20334 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20335 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20336 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20337 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20338 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20339 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20340 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20341 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20342
20343 @smallexample
20344 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20345 @end smallexample
20346
20347 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20348
20349 @smallexample
20350 $ gdb myprogram
20351 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20352 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20353 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20354 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20355 @end smallexample
20356
20357 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20358 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20359 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20360 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20361 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20362 tracing.
20363
20364 @node Remote Configuration
20365 @section Remote Configuration
20366
20367 @kindex set remote
20368 @kindex show remote
20369 This section documents the configuration options available when
20370 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20371 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20372 system-call-allowed}.
20373
20374 @table @code
20375 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20376 @cindex address size for remote targets
20377 @cindex bits in remote address
20378 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20379 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20380 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20381 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20382
20383 @item show remoteaddresssize
20384 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20385
20386 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20387 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20388 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20389 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20390 remote targets.
20391
20392 @item show serial baud
20393 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20394
20395 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20396 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20397 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20398
20399 @item show serial parity
20400 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20401
20402 @item set remotebreak
20403 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20404 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20405 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20406 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20407 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20408 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20409 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20410 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20411
20412 @item show remotebreak
20413 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20414 interrupt the remote program.
20415
20416 @item set remoteflow on
20417 @itemx set remoteflow off
20418 @kindex set remoteflow
20419 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20420 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20421
20422 @item show remoteflow
20423 @kindex show remoteflow
20424 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20425
20426 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20427 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20428 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20429 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20430 @code{ascii}.
20431
20432 @item show remotelogbase
20433 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20434 protocol.
20435
20436 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20437 @cindex record serial communications on file
20438 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20439 default is not to record at all.
20440
20441 @item show remotelogfile.
20442 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20443 serial communications.
20444
20445 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20446 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20447 @cindex remote timeout
20448 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20449 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20450
20451 @item show remotetimeout
20452 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20453 responses.
20454
20455 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20456 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20457 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20458 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20459 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20460 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20461 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20462 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20463
20464 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20465 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20466 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20467 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20468 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20469 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20470 as unlimited.
20471
20472 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20473 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20474 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20475
20476 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20477 @itemx show remote exec-file
20478 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20479 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20480 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20481 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20482 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20483 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20484
20485 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20486 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20487 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20488 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20489 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20490 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20491 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20492 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20493 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20494 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20495
20496 @item show interrupt-sequence
20497 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20498 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20499 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20500 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20501
20502 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20503 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20504 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20505 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20506 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20507 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20508
20509 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20510 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20511 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20512
20513 @kindex set tcp
20514 @kindex show tcp
20515 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20516 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20517 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20518 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20519 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20520 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20521 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20522 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20523 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20524
20525 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20526 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20527
20528 @item show tcp auto-retry
20529 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20530
20531 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20532 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20533 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20534 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20535 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20536 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20537 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20538 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20539 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20540 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20541 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20542
20543 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20544 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20545 @end table
20546
20547 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20548 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20549 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20550 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20551 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20552 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20553 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20554 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20555 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20556
20557 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20558 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20559 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20560 @value{GDBN} developers.
20561
20562 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20563 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20564 are:
20565
20566 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20567 @item Command Name
20568 @tab Remote Packet
20569 @tab Related Features
20570
20571 @item @code{fetch-register}
20572 @tab @code{p}
20573 @tab @code{info registers}
20574
20575 @item @code{set-register}
20576 @tab @code{P}
20577 @tab @code{set}
20578
20579 @item @code{binary-download}
20580 @tab @code{X}
20581 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20582
20583 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20584 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20585 @tab @code{info auxv}
20586
20587 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20588 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20589 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20590
20591 @item @code{attach}
20592 @tab @code{vAttach}
20593 @tab @code{attach}
20594
20595 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20596 @tab @code{vCont}
20597 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20598
20599 @item @code{run}
20600 @tab @code{vRun}
20601 @tab @code{run}
20602
20603 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20604 @tab @code{Z0}
20605 @tab @code{break}
20606
20607 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20608 @tab @code{Z1}
20609 @tab @code{hbreak}
20610
20611 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20612 @tab @code{Z2}
20613 @tab @code{watch}
20614
20615 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20616 @tab @code{Z3}
20617 @tab @code{rwatch}
20618
20619 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20620 @tab @code{Z4}
20621 @tab @code{awatch}
20622
20623 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20624 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20625 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20626
20627 @item @code{target-features}
20628 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20629 @tab @code{set architecture}
20630
20631 @item @code{library-info}
20632 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20633 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20634
20635 @item @code{memory-map}
20636 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20637 @tab @code{info mem}
20638
20639 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20640 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20641 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20642
20643 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20644 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20645 @tab @code{info spu}
20646
20647 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20648 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20649 @tab @code{info spu}
20650
20651 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20652 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20653 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20654
20655 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20656 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20657 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20658
20659 @item @code{threads}
20660 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20661 @tab @code{info threads}
20662
20663 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20664 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20665 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20666
20667 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20668 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20669 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20670
20671 @item @code{search-memory}
20672 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20673 @tab @code{find}
20674
20675 @item @code{supported-packets}
20676 @tab @code{qSupported}
20677 @tab Remote communications parameters
20678
20679 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20680 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20681 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20682
20683 @item @code{pass-signals}
20684 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20685 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20686
20687 @item @code{program-signals}
20688 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20689 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20690
20691 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20692 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20693 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20694
20695 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20696 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20697 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20698
20699 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20700 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20701 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20702
20703 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20704 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20705 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20706
20707 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20708 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20709 @tab @code{remote delete}
20710
20711 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20712 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20713 @tab Host I/O
20714
20715 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20716 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20717 @tab Host I/O
20718
20719 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20720 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20721 @tab Host I/O
20722
20723 @item @code{noack-packet}
20724 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20725 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20726
20727 @item @code{osdata}
20728 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20729 @tab @code{info os}
20730
20731 @item @code{query-attached}
20732 @tab @code{qAttached}
20733 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20734
20735 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20736 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20737 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20738
20739 @item @code{trace-status}
20740 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20741 @tab @code{tstatus}
20742
20743 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20744 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20745 @tab Traceframe info
20746
20747 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20748 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20749 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20750
20751 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20752 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20753 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20754
20755 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20756 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20757 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20758
20759 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20760 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20761 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20762
20763 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20764 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20765 @tab @code{break}
20766
20767 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20768 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20769 @tab @code{hbreak}
20770
20771 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20772 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20773 @tab @code{fork}
20774
20775 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20776 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20777 @tab @code{vfork}
20778
20779 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20780 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20781 @tab @code{exec}
20782
20783 @item @code{thread-events}
20784 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20785 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20786
20787 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20788 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20789 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20790
20791 @end multitable
20792
20793 @node Remote Stub
20794 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20795
20796 @cindex debugging stub, example
20797 @cindex remote stub, example
20798 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20799 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20800 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20801 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20802 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20803 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20804 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20805 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20806
20807 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20808 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20809 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20810 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20811 program, you need:
20812
20813 @enumerate
20814 @item
20815 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20816 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20817 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20818
20819 @item
20820 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20821 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20822
20823 @item
20824 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20825 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20826 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20827 documentation.
20828 @end enumerate
20829
20830 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20831 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20832 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20833
20834 @table @emph
20835 @item On the host,
20836 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20837 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20838 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20839
20840 @item On the target,
20841 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20842 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20843 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20844
20845 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20846 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20847 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20848 @end table
20849
20850 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20851 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20852 @sc{sparc} boards.
20853
20854 @cindex remote serial stub list
20855 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20856
20857 @table @code
20858
20859 @item i386-stub.c
20860 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20861 @cindex Intel
20862 @cindex i386
20863 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20864
20865 @item m68k-stub.c
20866 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20867 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20868 @cindex m680x0
20869 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20870
20871 @item sh-stub.c
20872 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20873 @cindex Renesas
20874 @cindex SH
20875 For Renesas SH architectures.
20876
20877 @item sparc-stub.c
20878 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20879 @cindex Sparc
20880 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20881
20882 @item sparcl-stub.c
20883 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20884 @cindex Fujitsu
20885 @cindex SparcLite
20886 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20887
20888 @end table
20889
20890 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20891 recently added stubs.
20892
20893 @menu
20894 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20895 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20896 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20897 @end menu
20898
20899 @node Stub Contents
20900 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20901
20902 @cindex remote serial stub
20903 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20904 subroutines:
20905
20906 @table @code
20907 @item set_debug_traps
20908 @findex set_debug_traps
20909 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20910 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20911 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20912 program's startup code.
20913
20914 @item handle_exception
20915 @findex handle_exception
20916 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20917 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20918 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20919 run when a trap is triggered.
20920
20921 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20922 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20923 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20924 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20925 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20926 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20927 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20928 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20929 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20930 machine.
20931
20932 @item breakpoint
20933 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20934 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20935 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20936 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20937 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20938 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20939 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20940 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20941 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20942 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20943 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20944
20945 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20946 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20947 start of your debugging session.
20948 @end table
20949
20950 @node Bootstrapping
20951 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20952
20953 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20954 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20955 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20956 debugging target machine.
20957
20958 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20959 serial port.
20960
20961 @table @code
20962 @item int getDebugChar()
20963 @findex getDebugChar
20964 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20965 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20966 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20967
20968 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20969 @findex putDebugChar
20970 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20971 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20972 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20973 @end table
20974
20975 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20976 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20977 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20978 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20979 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20980 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20981 remote system to stop.
20982
20983 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20984 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20985 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20986 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20987
20988 Other routines you need to supply are:
20989
20990 @table @code
20991 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20992 @findex exceptionHandler
20993 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20994 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20995 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20996 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20997 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20998 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20999 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21000 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21001 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21002 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21003 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21004 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21005 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21006
21007 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21008 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21009 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21010 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21011 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21012
21013 @item void flush_i_cache()
21014 @findex flush_i_cache
21015 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21016 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21017 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21018
21019 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21020 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21021 @end table
21022
21023 @noindent
21024 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21025
21026 @table @code
21027 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21028 @findex memset
21029 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21030 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21031 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21032 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21033 @end table
21034
21035 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21036 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21037 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21038 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21039
21040
21041 @node Debug Session
21042 @subsection Putting it All Together
21043
21044 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21045 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21046 steps.
21047
21048 @enumerate
21049 @item
21050 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21051 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21052 @display
21053 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21054 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21055 @end display
21056
21057 @item
21058 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21059 procedure is called:
21060
21061 @smallexample
21062 set_debug_traps();
21063 breakpoint();
21064 @end smallexample
21065
21066 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21067 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21068 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21069 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21070 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21071 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21072 progress.
21073
21074 @item
21075 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21076 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21077
21078 @smallexample
21079 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21080 @end smallexample
21081
21082 @noindent
21083 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21084 function in your program, that function is called when
21085 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21086 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21087 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21088
21089 @item
21090 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21091 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21092
21093 @item
21094 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21095 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21096
21097 @item
21098 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21099 @c document that. FIXME.
21100 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21101 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21102
21103 @item
21104 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21105 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21106
21107 @end enumerate
21108
21109 @node Configurations
21110 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21111
21112 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21113 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21114 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21115
21116 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21117 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21118 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21119 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21120 are quite different from each other.
21121
21122 @menu
21123 * Native::
21124 * Embedded OS::
21125 * Embedded Processors::
21126 * Architectures::
21127 @end menu
21128
21129 @node Native
21130 @section Native
21131
21132 This section describes details specific to particular native
21133 configurations.
21134
21135 @menu
21136 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21137 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21138 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21139 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21140 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21141 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21142 @end menu
21143
21144 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21145 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21146
21147 @cindex libkvm
21148 @cindex kernel memory image
21149 @cindex kernel crash dump
21150
21151 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21152 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21153 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21154 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21155 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21156 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21157 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21158 @code{kvm} target:
21159
21160 @smallexample
21161 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21162 @end smallexample
21163
21164 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21165 argument:
21166
21167 @smallexample
21168 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21169 @end smallexample
21170
21171 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21172 available:
21173
21174 @table @code
21175 @kindex kvm
21176 @item kvm pcb
21177 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21178
21179 @item kvm proc
21180 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21181 modern FreeBSD systems.
21182 @end table
21183
21184 @node SVR4 Process Information
21185 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21186 @cindex /proc
21187 @cindex examine process image
21188 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21189
21190 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21191 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21192 process using file-system subroutines.
21193
21194 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21195 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21196 information about the process running your program, or about any
21197 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21198 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21199
21200 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21201 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21202
21203 @table @code
21204 @kindex info proc
21205 @cindex process ID
21206 @item info proc
21207 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21208 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21209 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21210 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21211 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21212 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21213 executable file's absolute file name.
21214
21215 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21216 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21217 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21218 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21219 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21220 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21221
21222 @item info proc cmdline
21223 @cindex info proc cmdline
21224 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21225 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21226
21227 @item info proc cwd
21228 @cindex info proc cwd
21229 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21230 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21231
21232 @item info proc exe
21233 @cindex info proc exe
21234 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21235 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21236
21237 @item info proc mappings
21238 @cindex memory address space mappings
21239 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21240 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21241 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21242 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21243 memory access rights to that range.
21244
21245 @item info proc stat
21246 @itemx info proc status
21247 @cindex process detailed status information
21248 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21249 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21250 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21251 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21252 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21253 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21254 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21255
21256 @item info proc all
21257 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21258 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21259
21260 @ignore
21261 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21262 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21263 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21264 @kindex info proc times
21265 @item info proc times
21266 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21267 its children.
21268
21269 @kindex info proc id
21270 @item info proc id
21271 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21272 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21273 @end ignore
21274
21275 @item set procfs-trace
21276 @kindex set procfs-trace
21277 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21278 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21279
21280 @item show procfs-trace
21281 @kindex show procfs-trace
21282 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21283
21284 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21285 @kindex set procfs-file
21286 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21287 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21288 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21289 standard output.
21290
21291 @item show procfs-file
21292 @kindex show procfs-file
21293 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21294
21295 @item proc-trace-entry
21296 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21297 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21298 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21299 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21300 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21301 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21302 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21303 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21304 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21305
21306 @item info pidlist
21307 @kindex info pidlist
21308 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21309 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21310 processes and all the threads within each process.
21311
21312 @item info meminfo
21313 @kindex info meminfo
21314 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21315 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21316 @end table
21317
21318 @node DJGPP Native
21319 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21320 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21321 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21322 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21323
21324 @cindex DPMI
21325 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21326 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21327 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21328 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21329
21330 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21331 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21332 subsection describes those commands.
21333
21334 @table @code
21335 @kindex info dos
21336 @item info dos
21337 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21338 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21339
21340 @kindex sysinfo
21341 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21342 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21343 @item info dos sysinfo
21344 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21345 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21346 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21347
21348 @cindex GDT
21349 @cindex LDT
21350 @cindex IDT
21351 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21352 @cindex descriptor tables display
21353 @item info dos gdt
21354 @itemx info dos ldt
21355 @itemx info dos idt
21356 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21357 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21358 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21359 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21360 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21361 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21362 rights.
21363
21364 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21365 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21366 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21367 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21368 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21369
21370 @cindex garbled pointers
21371 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21372 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21373 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21374 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21375 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21376 debugged program's data segment:
21377
21378 @smallexample
21379 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21380 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21381 @end smallexample
21382
21383 @noindent
21384 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21385 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21386
21387 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21388 @item info dos pde
21389 @itemx info dos pte
21390 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21391 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21392 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21393 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21394 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21395 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21396 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21397 that is currently in use.
21398
21399 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21400 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21401 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21402 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21403 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21404 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21405 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21406
21407 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21408 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21409 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21410 controller.
21411
21412 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21413
21414 @cindex physical address from linear address
21415 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21416 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21417 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21418 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21419 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21420 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21421 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21422
21423 @smallexample
21424 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21425 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21426 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21427 @end smallexample
21428
21429 @noindent
21430 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21431 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21432 attributes of that page.
21433
21434 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21435 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21436 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21437 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21438 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21439 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21440
21441 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21442 transfer buffer:
21443
21444 @smallexample
21445 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21446 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21447 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21448 @end smallexample
21449
21450 @noindent
21451 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21452 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21453 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21454 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21455 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21456
21457 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21458 @end table
21459
21460 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21461 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21462 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21463 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21464
21465 @table @code
21466 @kindex set com1base
21467 @kindex set com1irq
21468 @kindex set com2base
21469 @kindex set com2irq
21470 @kindex set com3base
21471 @kindex set com3irq
21472 @kindex set com4base
21473 @kindex set com4irq
21474 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21475 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21476 port.
21477
21478 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21479 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21480 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21481
21482 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21483 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21484 other 3 COM ports.
21485
21486 @kindex show com1base
21487 @kindex show com1irq
21488 @kindex show com2base
21489 @kindex show com2irq
21490 @kindex show com3base
21491 @kindex show com3irq
21492 @kindex show com4base
21493 @kindex show com4irq
21494 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21495 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21496 lines used by the COM ports.
21497
21498 @item info serial
21499 @kindex info serial
21500 @cindex DOS serial port status
21501 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21502 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21503 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21504 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21505 @end table
21506
21507
21508 @node Cygwin Native
21509 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21510 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21511 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21512 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21513
21514 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21515 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21516
21517 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21518 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21519 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21520 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21521 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21522 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21523 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21524 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21525
21526 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21527 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21528 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21529
21530 @table @code
21531 @kindex info w32
21532 @item info w32
21533 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21534 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21535
21536 @item info w32 selector
21537 This command displays information returned by
21538 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21539 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21540 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21541 Without argument, this command displays information
21542 about the six segment registers.
21543
21544 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21545 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21546 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21547 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21548
21549 @kindex signal-event
21550 @item signal-event @var{id}
21551 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21552 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21553
21554 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21555 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21556 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21557 (for x86_64 versions):
21558
21559 @itemize @minus
21560 @item
21561 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21562 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21563 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21564
21565 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21566 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21567 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21568 to attach.
21569
21570 @item
21571 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21572 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21573 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21574 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21575 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21576 @end itemize
21577
21578 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21579 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21580 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21581 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21582 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21583 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21584 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21585 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21586 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21587 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21588 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21589
21590 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21591 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21592 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21593 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21594
21595 @kindex set new-console
21596 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21597 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21598 be started in a new console on next start.
21599 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21600 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21601
21602 @kindex show new-console
21603 @item show new-console
21604 Displays whether a new console is used
21605 when the debuggee is started.
21606
21607 @kindex set new-group
21608 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21609 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21610 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21611 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21612 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21613
21614 @kindex show new-group
21615 @item show new-group
21616 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21617
21618 @kindex set debugevents
21619 @item set debugevents
21620 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21621 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21622 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21623 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21624 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21625
21626 @kindex set debugexec
21627 @item set debugexec
21628 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21629 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21630
21631 @kindex set debugexceptions
21632 @item set debugexceptions
21633 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21634 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21635
21636 @kindex set debugmemory
21637 @item set debugmemory
21638 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21639 and writes by the debugger.
21640
21641 @kindex set shell
21642 @item set shell
21643 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21644 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21645
21646 @kindex show shell
21647 @item show shell
21648 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21649
21650 @end table
21651
21652 @menu
21653 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21654 @end menu
21655
21656 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21657 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21658 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21659 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21660
21661 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21662 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21663 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21664 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21665 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21666 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21667 ``minimal symbols''.
21668
21669 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21670 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21671 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21672 program run once to completion.
21673
21674 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21675
21676 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21677 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21678 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21679 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21680 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21681 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21682 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21683 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21684 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21685
21686 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21687 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21688 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21689 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21690 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21691 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21692
21693 @smallexample
21694 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21695 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21696
21697 Non-debugging symbols:
21698 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21699 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21700 @end smallexample
21701
21702 @smallexample
21703 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21704 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21705
21706 Non-debugging symbols:
21707 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21708 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21709 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21710 [etc...]
21711 @end smallexample
21712
21713 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21714
21715 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21716 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21717 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21718 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21719 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21720 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21721 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21722
21723 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21724 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21725 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21726 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21727 problem:
21728
21729 @smallexample
21730 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21731 $1 = 268572168
21732 @end smallexample
21733
21734 @smallexample
21735 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21736 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21737 @end smallexample
21738
21739 And two possible solutions:
21740
21741 @smallexample
21742 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21743 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21744 @end smallexample
21745
21746 @smallexample
21747 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21748 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21749 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21750 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21751 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21752 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21753 @end smallexample
21754
21755 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21756 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21757 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21758 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21759 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21760
21761 @smallexample
21762 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21763 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21764 @end smallexample
21765
21766 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21767 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21768 safe.
21769
21770 @node Hurd Native
21771 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21772 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21773
21774 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21775 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21776
21777 @table @code
21778 @item set signals
21779 @itemx set sigs
21780 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21781 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21782 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21783 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21784 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21785 @code{signals}.
21786
21787 @item show signals
21788 @itemx show sigs
21789 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21790 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21791 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21792
21793 @item set signal-thread
21794 @itemx set sigthread
21795 @kindex set signal-thread
21796 @kindex set sigthread
21797 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21798 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21799 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21800 signal-thread}.
21801
21802 @item show signal-thread
21803 @itemx show sigthread
21804 @kindex show signal-thread
21805 @kindex show sigthread
21806 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21807 delivered a signal.
21808
21809 @item set stopped
21810 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21811 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21812 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21813 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21814
21815 @item show stopped
21816 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21817 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21818 stopped.
21819
21820 @item set exceptions
21821 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21822 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21823 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21824 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21825 trapping on.
21826
21827 @item show exceptions
21828 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21829 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21830
21831 @item set task pause
21832 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21833 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21834 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21835 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21836 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21837 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21838 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21839 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21840 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21841
21842 @item show task pause
21843 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21844 Show the current state of task suspension.
21845
21846 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21847 @cindex task suspend count
21848 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21849 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21850 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21851
21852 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21853 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21854
21855 @item set task exception-port
21856 @itemx set task excp
21857 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21858 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21859 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21860 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21861
21862 @item set noninvasive
21863 @cindex noninvasive task options
21864 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21865 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21866 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21867 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21868
21869 @item info send-rights
21870 @itemx info receive-rights
21871 @itemx info port-rights
21872 @itemx info port-sets
21873 @itemx info dead-names
21874 @itemx info ports
21875 @itemx info psets
21876 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21877 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21878 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21879 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21880 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21881 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21882 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21883 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21884 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21885
21886 @item set thread pause
21887 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21888 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21889 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21890 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21891 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21892 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21893 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21894 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21895 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21896 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21897 only the current thread.
21898
21899 @item show thread pause
21900 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21901 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21902
21903 @item set thread run
21904 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21905
21906 @item show thread run
21907 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21908
21909 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21910 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21911 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21912 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21913 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21914 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21915 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21916
21917 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21918 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21919 detaching.
21920
21921 @item set thread exception-port
21922 @itemx set thread excp
21923 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21924 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21925 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21926
21927 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21928 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21929 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21930 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21931
21932 @item set thread default
21933 @itemx show thread default
21934 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21935 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21936 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21937 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21938 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21939 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21940 the non-default commands.
21941 @end table
21942
21943 @node Darwin
21944 @subsection Darwin
21945 @cindex Darwin
21946
21947 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21948
21949 @table @code
21950 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21951 @kindex set debug darwin
21952 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21953 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21954
21955 @item show debug darwin
21956 @kindex show debug darwin
21957 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21958
21959 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21960 @kindex set debug mach-o
21961 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21962 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21963 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21964 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21965 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21966 usage.
21967
21968 @item show debug mach-o
21969 @kindex show debug mach-o
21970 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21971
21972 @item set mach-exceptions on
21973 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21974 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21975 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21976 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21977 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21978 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21979
21980 @item show mach-exceptions
21981 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21982 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21983 @end table
21984
21985
21986 @node Embedded OS
21987 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21988
21989 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21990 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21991 architectures.
21992
21993 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21994 various real-time operating systems.
21995
21996 @node Embedded Processors
21997 @section Embedded Processors
21998
21999 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22000 configurations.
22001
22002 @cindex send command to simulator
22003 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22004 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22005
22006 @table @code
22007 @item sim @var{command}
22008 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22009 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22010 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22011 acceptable commands.
22012 @end table
22013
22014
22015 @menu
22016 * ARM:: ARM
22017 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22018 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22019 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22020 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22021 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22022 * CRIS:: CRIS
22023 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22024 @end menu
22025
22026 @node ARM
22027 @subsection ARM
22028
22029 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22030
22031 @table @code
22032 @item set arm disassembler
22033 @kindex set arm
22034 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22035 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22036
22037 @item show arm disassembler
22038 @kindex show arm
22039 Show the current disassembly style.
22040
22041 @item set arm apcs32
22042 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22043 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22044
22045 @item show arm apcs32
22046 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22047
22048 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22049 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22050 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22051
22052 @table @code
22053 @item auto
22054 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22055 @item softfpa
22056 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22057 processors.
22058 @item fpa
22059 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22060 @item softvfp
22061 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22062 @item vfp
22063 VFP co-processor.
22064 @end table
22065
22066 @item show arm fpu
22067 Show the current type of the FPU.
22068
22069 @item set arm abi
22070 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22071
22072 @item show arm abi
22073 Show the currently used ABI.
22074
22075 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22076 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22077 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22078 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22079 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22080 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22081 register).
22082
22083 @item show arm fallback-mode
22084 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22085
22086 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22087 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22088 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22089 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22090 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22091
22092 @item show arm force-mode
22093 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22094
22095 @item set debug arm
22096 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22097 target support subsystem.
22098
22099 @item show debug arm
22100 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22101 @end table
22102
22103 @table @code
22104 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22105 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22106
22107 @table @code
22108 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22109 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22110 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22111 The default value is @code{all}.
22112
22113 @table @code
22114 @item none
22115 @item demon
22116 @item angel
22117 @item redboot
22118 @item all
22119 @end table
22120 @end table
22121 @end table
22122
22123 @node M68K
22124 @subsection M68k
22125
22126 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22127
22128 @node MicroBlaze
22129 @subsection MicroBlaze
22130 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22131 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22132
22133 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22134 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22135 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22136 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22137 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22138 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22139 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22140 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22141 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22142 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22143 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22144
22145 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22146
22147 @table @code
22148 @item target remote :1234
22149 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22150 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22151
22152 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22153 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22154 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22155
22156 @item load
22157 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22158
22159 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22160 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22161
22162 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22163 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22164 @end table
22165
22166 @node MIPS Embedded
22167 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22168
22169 @noindent
22170 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22171
22172 @table @code
22173 @item set mipsfpu double
22174 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22175 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22176 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22177 @itemx show mipsfpu
22178 @kindex set mipsfpu
22179 @kindex show mipsfpu
22180 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22181 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22182 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22183 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22184 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22185 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22186 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22187 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22188 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22189 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22190 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22191 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22192 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22193
22194 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22195 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22196 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22197
22198 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22199 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22200 @end table
22201
22202 @node PowerPC Embedded
22203 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22204
22205 @cindex DVC register
22206 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22207 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22208
22209 @smallexample
22210 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22211 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22212 @end smallexample
22213
22214 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22215 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22216 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22217 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22218 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22219 or newer.
22220
22221 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22222 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22223 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22224 watching variables of scalar types.
22225
22226 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22227 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22228
22229 @smallexample
22230 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22231 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22232 @end smallexample
22233
22234 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22235 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22236
22237 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22238 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22239 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22240 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22241 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22242 use the @code{break-range} command.
22243
22244 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22245
22246 @table @code
22247 @kindex break-range
22248 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22249 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22250 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22251 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22252 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22253 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22254 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22255 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22256 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22257
22258 @kindex set powerpc
22259 @item set powerpc soft-float
22260 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22261 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22262 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22263 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22264
22265 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22266 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22267 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22268 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22269 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22270 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22271 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22272 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22273
22274 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22275 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22276 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22277 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22278 address of its first byte.
22279
22280 @end table
22281
22282 @node AVR
22283 @subsection Atmel AVR
22284 @cindex AVR
22285
22286 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22287 following AVR-specific commands:
22288
22289 @table @code
22290 @item info io_registers
22291 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22292 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22293 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22294 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22295 @end table
22296
22297 @node CRIS
22298 @subsection CRIS
22299 @cindex CRIS
22300
22301 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22302 following CRIS-specific commands:
22303
22304 @table @code
22305 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22306 @cindex CRIS version
22307 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22308 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22309 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22310
22311 @item show cris-version
22312 Show the current CRIS version.
22313
22314 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22315 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22316 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22317 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22318 @code{R59}.
22319
22320 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22321 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22322
22323 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22324 @cindex CRIS mode
22325 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22326 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22327 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22328
22329 @item show cris-mode
22330 Show the current CRIS mode.
22331 @end table
22332
22333 @node Super-H
22334 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22335 @cindex Super-H
22336
22337 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22338 commands:
22339
22340 @table @code
22341 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22342 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22343 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22344 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22345 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22346 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22347 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22348 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22349 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22350 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22351 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22352 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22353
22354 @item show sh calling-convention
22355 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22356 Show the current calling convention setting.
22357
22358 @end table
22359
22360
22361 @node Architectures
22362 @section Architectures
22363
22364 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22365 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22366
22367 @menu
22368 * AArch64::
22369 * i386::
22370 * Alpha::
22371 * MIPS::
22372 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22373 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22374 * PowerPC::
22375 * Nios II::
22376 @end menu
22377
22378 @node AArch64
22379 @subsection AArch64
22380 @cindex AArch64 support
22381
22382 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22383 following special commands:
22384
22385 @table @code
22386 @item set debug aarch64
22387 @kindex set debug aarch64
22388 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22389 messages are to be displayed.
22390
22391 @item show debug aarch64
22392 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22393
22394 @end table
22395
22396 @node i386
22397 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22398
22399 @table @code
22400 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22401 @kindex set struct-convention
22402 @cindex struct return convention
22403 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22404 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22405 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22406 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22407 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22408 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22409 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22410 be returned in a register.
22411
22412 @item show struct-convention
22413 @kindex show struct-convention
22414 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22415 from functions.
22416 @end table
22417
22418
22419 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22420 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22421
22422 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22423 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22424 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22425 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22426 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22427 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22428 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22429
22430 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22431 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22432 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22433 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22434 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22435 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22436
22437 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22438 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22439 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22440
22441 @smallexample
22442 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22443 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22444 @end smallexample
22445
22446 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22447 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22448 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22449 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22450 the pointer.
22451
22452 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22453 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22454 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22455 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22456 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22457
22458 @table @code
22459 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22460 @kindex show mpx bound
22461 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22462
22463 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22464 @kindex set mpx bound
22465 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22466 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22467 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22468 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22469 @end table
22470
22471 @node Alpha
22472 @subsection Alpha
22473
22474 See the following section.
22475
22476 @node MIPS
22477 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22478
22479 @cindex stack on Alpha
22480 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22481 @cindex Alpha stack
22482 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22483 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22484 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22485 find the beginning of a function.
22486
22487 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22488 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22489 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22490 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22491 commands:
22492
22493 @table @code
22494 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22495 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22496 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22497 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22498 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22499 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22500 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22501 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22502
22503 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22504 Display the current limit.
22505 @end table
22506
22507 @noindent
22508 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22509 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22510
22511 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22512 programs:
22513
22514 @table @code
22515 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22516 @kindex set mips abi
22517 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22518 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22519 values of @var{arg} are:
22520
22521 @table @samp
22522 @item auto
22523 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22524 default).
22525 @item o32
22526 @item o64
22527 @item n32
22528 @item n64
22529 @item eabi32
22530 @item eabi64
22531 @end table
22532
22533 @item show mips abi
22534 @kindex show mips abi
22535 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22536
22537 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22538 @kindex set mips compression
22539 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22540 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22541 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22542 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22543 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22544 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22545 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22546 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22547 provided by the executable.
22548
22549 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22550 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22551 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22552 identified as such.
22553
22554 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22555 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22556 implicitly from an executable.
22557
22558 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22559 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22560 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22561 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22562 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22563
22564 @item show mips compression
22565 @kindex show mips compression
22566 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22567 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22568
22569 @item set mipsfpu
22570 @itemx show mipsfpu
22571 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22572
22573 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22574 @kindex set mips mask-address
22575 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22576 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22577 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22578 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22579 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22580
22581 @item show mips mask-address
22582 @kindex show mips mask-address
22583 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22584 not.
22585
22586 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22587 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22588 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22589 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22590 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22591 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22592
22593 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22594 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22595 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22596
22597 @item set debug mips
22598 @kindex set debug mips
22599 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22600 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22601
22602 @item show debug mips
22603 @kindex show debug mips
22604 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22605 @end table
22606
22607
22608 @node HPPA
22609 @subsection HPPA
22610 @cindex HPPA support
22611
22612 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22613 following special commands:
22614
22615 @table @code
22616 @item set debug hppa
22617 @kindex set debug hppa
22618 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22619 messages are to be displayed.
22620
22621 @item show debug hppa
22622 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22623
22624 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22625 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22626 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22627 given @var{address}.
22628
22629 @end table
22630
22631
22632 @node SPU
22633 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22634 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22635 @cindex SPU
22636
22637 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22638 it provides the following special commands:
22639
22640 @table @code
22641 @item info spu event
22642 @kindex info spu
22643 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22644 and pending event status.
22645
22646 @item info spu signal
22647 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22648 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22649 notification channels.
22650
22651 @item info spu mailbox
22652 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22653 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22654 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22655
22656 @item info spu dma
22657 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22658 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22659 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22660
22661 @item info spu proxydma
22662 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22663 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22664 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22665
22666 @end table
22667
22668 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22669 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22670 special commands:
22671
22672 @table @code
22673 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22674 @kindex set spu
22675 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22676 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22677 function. The default is @code{off}.
22678
22679 @item show spu stop-on-load
22680 @kindex show spu
22681 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22682
22683 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22684 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22685 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22686 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22687 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22688 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22689
22690 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22691 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22692
22693 @end table
22694
22695 @node PowerPC
22696 @subsection PowerPC
22697 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22698
22699 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22700 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22701 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22702 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22703 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22704
22705 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22706 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22707 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22708
22709 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22710 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22711
22712 @node Nios II
22713 @subsection Nios II
22714 @cindex Nios II architecture
22715
22716 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22717 it provides the following special commands:
22718
22719 @table @code
22720
22721 @item set debug nios2
22722 @kindex set debug nios2
22723 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22724 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22725
22726 @item show debug nios2
22727 @kindex show debug nios2
22728 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22729 @end table
22730
22731 @node Controlling GDB
22732 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22733
22734 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22735 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22736 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22737 described here.
22738
22739 @menu
22740 * Prompt:: Prompt
22741 * Editing:: Command editing
22742 * Command History:: Command history
22743 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22744 * Numbers:: Numbers
22745 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22746 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22747 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22748 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22749 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22750 @end menu
22751
22752 @node Prompt
22753 @section Prompt
22754
22755 @cindex prompt
22756
22757 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22758 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22759 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22760 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22761 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22762 which one you are talking to.
22763
22764 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22765 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22766 or a prompt that does not.
22767
22768 @table @code
22769 @kindex set prompt
22770 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22771 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22772
22773 @kindex show prompt
22774 @item show prompt
22775 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22776 @end table
22777
22778 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22779 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22780 are:
22781
22782 @table @code
22783 @kindex set extended-prompt
22784 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22785 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22786 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22787 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22788 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22789 is displayed.
22790
22791 For example:
22792
22793 @smallexample
22794 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22795 @end smallexample
22796
22797 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22798 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22799
22800 @kindex show extended-prompt
22801 @item show extended-prompt
22802 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22803 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22804 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22805 @end table
22806
22807 @node Editing
22808 @section Command Editing
22809 @cindex readline
22810 @cindex command line editing
22811
22812 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22813 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22814 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22815 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22816 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22817 debugging sessions.
22818
22819 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22820 command @code{set}.
22821
22822 @table @code
22823 @kindex set editing
22824 @cindex editing
22825 @item set editing
22826 @itemx set editing on
22827 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22828
22829 @item set editing off
22830 Disable command line editing.
22831
22832 @kindex show editing
22833 @item show editing
22834 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22835 @end table
22836
22837 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22838 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22839 @end ifset
22840 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22841 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22842 @end ifclear
22843 for more details about the Readline
22844 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22845 encouraged to read that chapter.
22846
22847 @node Command History
22848 @section Command History
22849 @cindex command history
22850
22851 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22852 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22853 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22854 history facility.
22855
22856 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22857 package, to provide the history facility.
22858 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22859 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22860 @end ifset
22861 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22862 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22863 @end ifclear
22864 for the detailed description of the History library.
22865
22866 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22867 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22868 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22869 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22870 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22871 pressed on a line by itself.
22872
22873 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22874 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22875 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22876 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22877
22878 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22879 history.
22880
22881 @table @code
22882 @cindex history substitution
22883 @cindex history file
22884 @kindex set history filename
22885 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22886 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22887 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22888 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22889 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22890 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22891 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22892 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22893 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22894 is not set.
22895
22896 @cindex save command history
22897 @kindex set history save
22898 @item set history save
22899 @itemx set history save on
22900 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22901 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22902
22903 @item set history save off
22904 Stop recording command history in a file.
22905
22906 @cindex history size
22907 @kindex set history size
22908 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22909 @item set history size @var{size}
22910 @itemx set history size unlimited
22911 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22912 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22913 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22914 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22915 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22916 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22917
22918 @cindex remove duplicate history
22919 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22920 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22921 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22922 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22923 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22924 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22925 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22926 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22927 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22928
22929 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22930 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22931
22932 @end table
22933
22934 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22935 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22936 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22937 @end ifset
22938 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22939 @xref{Event Designators},
22940 @end ifclear
22941 for more details.
22942
22943 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22944 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22945 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22946 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22947 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22948 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22949 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22950 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22951
22952 The commands to control history expansion are:
22953
22954 @table @code
22955 @item set history expansion on
22956 @itemx set history expansion
22957 @kindex set history expansion
22958 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22959
22960 @item set history expansion off
22961 Disable history expansion.
22962
22963 @c @group
22964 @kindex show history
22965 @item show history
22966 @itemx show history filename
22967 @itemx show history save
22968 @itemx show history size
22969 @itemx show history expansion
22970 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22971 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22972 @c @end group
22973 @end table
22974
22975 @table @code
22976 @kindex show commands
22977 @cindex show last commands
22978 @cindex display command history
22979 @item show commands
22980 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22981
22982 @item show commands @var{n}
22983 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22984
22985 @item show commands +
22986 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22987 @end table
22988
22989 @node Screen Size
22990 @section Screen Size
22991 @cindex size of screen
22992 @cindex screen size
22993 @cindex pagination
22994 @cindex page size
22995 @cindex pauses in output
22996
22997 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22998 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22999 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23000 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23001 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23002 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23003 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23004 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23005
23006 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23007 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23008 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23009 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23010 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23011 width} commands:
23012
23013 @table @code
23014 @kindex set height
23015 @kindex set width
23016 @kindex show width
23017 @kindex show height
23018 @item set height @var{lpp}
23019 @itemx set height unlimited
23020 @itemx show height
23021 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23022 @itemx set width unlimited
23023 @itemx show width
23024 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23025 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23026 commands display the current settings.
23027
23028 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23029 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23030 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23031 buffer.
23032
23033 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23034 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23035
23036 @item set pagination on
23037 @itemx set pagination off
23038 @kindex set pagination
23039 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23040 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23041 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23042 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23043
23044 @item show pagination
23045 @kindex show pagination
23046 Show the current pagination mode.
23047 @end table
23048
23049 @node Numbers
23050 @section Numbers
23051 @cindex number representation
23052 @cindex entering numbers
23053
23054 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23055 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23056 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23057 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23058 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23059 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23060 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23061 both input and output with the commands described below.
23062
23063 @table @code
23064 @kindex set input-radix
23065 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23066 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23067 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23068 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23069 example, any of
23070
23071 @smallexample
23072 set input-radix 012
23073 set input-radix 10.
23074 set input-radix 0xa
23075 @end smallexample
23076
23077 @noindent
23078 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23079 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23080 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23081 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23082 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23083 change the radix.
23084
23085 @kindex set output-radix
23086 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23087 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23088 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23089 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23090
23091 @kindex show input-radix
23092 @item show input-radix
23093 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23094
23095 @kindex show output-radix
23096 @item show output-radix
23097 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23098
23099 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23100 @itemx show radix
23101 @kindex set radix
23102 @kindex show radix
23103 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23104 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23105 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23106 default value of 10.
23107
23108 @end table
23109
23110 @node ABI
23111 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23112
23113 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23114 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23115 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23116 current ABI.
23117
23118 @cindex OS ABI
23119 @kindex set osabi
23120 @kindex show osabi
23121 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23122
23123 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23124 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23125 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23126 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23127 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23128 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23129 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23130 platform provides.
23131
23132 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23133 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23134 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23135 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23136
23137 @table @code
23138 @item show osabi
23139 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23140
23141 @item set osabi
23142 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23143
23144 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23145 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23146 @end table
23147
23148 @cindex float promotion
23149
23150 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23151 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23152 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23153 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23154 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23155 @code{double} and then passed.
23156
23157 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23158 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23159 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23160
23161 @table @code
23162 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23163 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23164 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23165 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23166 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23167
23168 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23169 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23170 functions.
23171
23172 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23173 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23174 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23175 @end table
23176
23177 @kindex set cp-abi
23178 @kindex show cp-abi
23179 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23180 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23181 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23182 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23183 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23184 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23185 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23186 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23187 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23188 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23189 ``auto''.
23190
23191 @table @code
23192 @item show cp-abi
23193 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23194
23195 @item set cp-abi
23196 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23197
23198 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23199 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23200 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23201 @end table
23202
23203 @node Auto-loading
23204 @section Automatically loading associated files
23205 @cindex auto-loading
23206
23207 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23208 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23209 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23210 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23211 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23212 sources).
23213
23214 @menu
23215 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23216 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23217
23218 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23219 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23220 @end menu
23221
23222 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23223 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23224 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23225
23226 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23227 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23228 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23229
23230 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23231 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23232
23233 @table @code
23234 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23235 @kindex set auto-load off
23236 @item set auto-load off
23237 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23238 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23239 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23240 @smallexample
23241 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23242 @end smallexample
23243
23244 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23245 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23246 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23247 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23248 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23249 @code{set auto-load no}.
23250
23251 @anchor{show auto-load}
23252 @kindex show auto-load
23253 @item show auto-load
23254 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23255 or disabled.
23256
23257 @smallexample
23258 (gdb) show auto-load
23259 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23260 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23261 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23262 is on.
23263 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23264 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23265 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23266 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23267 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23268 @end smallexample
23269
23270 @anchor{info auto-load}
23271 @kindex info auto-load
23272 @item info auto-load
23273 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23274 not.
23275
23276 @smallexample
23277 (gdb) info auto-load
23278 gdb-scripts:
23279 Loaded Script
23280 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23281 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23282 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23283 loaded.
23284 python-scripts:
23285 Loaded Script
23286 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23287 @end smallexample
23288 @end table
23289
23290 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23291
23292 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23293 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23294 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23295 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23296 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23297 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23298 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23299 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23300 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23301 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23302 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23303 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23304 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23305 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23306 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23307 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23308 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23309 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23310 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23311 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23312 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23313 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23314 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23315 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23316 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23317 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23318 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23319 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23320 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23321 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23322 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23323 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23324 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23325 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23326 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23327 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23328 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23329 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23330 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23331 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23332 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23333 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23334 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23335 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23336 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23337 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23338 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23339 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23340 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23341 @end multitable
23342
23343 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23344 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23345 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23346
23347 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23348 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23349 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23350
23351 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23352 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23353
23354 @table @code
23355 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23356 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23357 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23358 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23359 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23360
23361 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23362 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23363 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23364 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23365 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23366
23367 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23368 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23369 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23370 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23371 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23372 @end table
23373
23374 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23375 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23376 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23377
23378 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23379
23380 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23381 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23382
23383 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23384 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23385 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23386 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23387 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23388 library.
23389
23390 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23391 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23392
23393 @table @code
23394 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23395 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23396 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23397 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23398
23399 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23400 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23401 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23402 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23403 enabled or disabled.
23404
23405 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23406 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23407 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23408 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23409 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23410 @end table
23411
23412 @node Auto-loading safe path
23413 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23414 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23415
23416 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23417 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23418 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23419 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23420 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23421
23422 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23423 get loaded:
23424
23425 @smallexample
23426 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23427 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23428 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23429 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23430 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23431 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23432 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23433 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23434 @end smallexample
23435
23436 @noindent
23437 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23438 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23439
23440 @smallexample
23441 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23442 @end smallexample
23443
23444 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23445
23446 @table @code
23447 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23448 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23449 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23450 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23451 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23452 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23453 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23454 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23455 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23456 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23457
23458 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23459 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23460 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23461
23462 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23463 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23464 @item show auto-load safe-path
23465 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23466 scripts.
23467
23468 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23469 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23470 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23471 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23472 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23473 by the host platform path separator in use.
23474 @end table
23475
23476 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23477 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23478 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23479 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23480 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23481
23482 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23483 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23484 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23485 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23486 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23487 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23488 init file in the current directory
23489 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23490
23491 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23492 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23493
23494 @table @asis
23495 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23496 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23497 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23498 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23499
23500 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23501 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23502 @value{GDBN} session.
23503
23504 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23505 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23506 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23507 from trusted sources.
23508
23509 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23510 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23511 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23512 trusted sources.
23513 @end table
23514
23515 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23516 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23517
23518 @table @asis
23519 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23520 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23521
23522 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23523 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23524 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23525 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23526 @end table
23527
23528 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23529 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23530 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23531 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23532 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23533 recommended to be entered.
23534
23535 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23536 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23537 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23538
23539 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23540 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23541 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23542 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23543 be printed.
23544
23545 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23546 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23547 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23548
23549 @smallexample
23550 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23551 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23552 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23553 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23554 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23555 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23556 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23557 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23558 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23559 @end smallexample
23560
23561 @table @code
23562 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23563 @kindex set debug auto-load
23564 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23565 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23566
23567 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23568 @kindex show debug auto-load
23569 @item show debug auto-load
23570 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23571 on or off.
23572 @end table
23573
23574 @node Messages/Warnings
23575 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23576
23577 @cindex verbose operation
23578 @cindex optional warnings
23579 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23580 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23581 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23582 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23583
23584 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23585 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23586 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23587
23588 @table @code
23589 @kindex set verbose
23590 @item set verbose on
23591 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23592
23593 @item set verbose off
23594 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23595
23596 @kindex show verbose
23597 @item show verbose
23598 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23599 @end table
23600
23601 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23602 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23603 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23604 Symbol Files}).
23605
23606 @table @code
23607
23608 @kindex set complaints
23609 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23610 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23611 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23612 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23613 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23614
23615 @kindex show complaints
23616 @item show complaints
23617 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23618
23619 @end table
23620
23621 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23622 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23623 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23624 you try to run a program which is already running:
23625
23626 @smallexample
23627 (@value{GDBP}) run
23628 The program being debugged has been started already.
23629 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23630 @end smallexample
23631
23632 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23633 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23634
23635 @table @code
23636
23637 @kindex set confirm
23638 @cindex flinching
23639 @cindex confirmation
23640 @cindex stupid questions
23641 @item set confirm off
23642 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23643 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23644 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23645
23646 @item set confirm on
23647 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23648
23649 @kindex show confirm
23650 @item show confirm
23651 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23652
23653 @end table
23654
23655 @cindex command tracing
23656 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23657 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23658 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23659 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23660
23661 @table @code
23662 @kindex set trace-commands
23663 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23664 @item set trace-commands on
23665 Enable command tracing.
23666 @item set trace-commands off
23667 Disable command tracing.
23668 @item show trace-commands
23669 Display the current state of command tracing.
23670 @end table
23671
23672 @node Debugging Output
23673 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23674 @cindex optional debugging messages
23675
23676 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23677 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23678 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23679 section documents those commands.
23680
23681 @table @code
23682 @kindex set exec-done-display
23683 @item set exec-done-display
23684 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23685 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23686 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23687 @kindex show exec-done-display
23688 @item show exec-done-display
23689 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23690 notification.
23691 @kindex set debug
23692 @cindex ARM AArch64
23693 @item set debug aarch64
23694 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23695 The default is off.
23696 @kindex show debug
23697 @item show debug aarch64
23698 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23699 ARM AArch64.
23700 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23701 @cindex architecture debugging info
23702 @item set debug arch
23703 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23704 @item show debug arch
23705 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23706 @item set debug aix-solib
23707 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23708 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23709 support module. The default is off.
23710 @item show debug aix-thread
23711 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23712 @item set debug aix-thread
23713 @cindex AIX threads
23714 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23715 module.
23716 @item show debug aix-thread
23717 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23718 @item set debug check-physname
23719 @cindex physname
23720 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23721 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23722 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23723 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23724 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23725 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23726 @item show debug check-physname
23727 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23728 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23729 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23730 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23731 exported symbols. The default is off.
23732 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23733 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23734 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23735 @item set debug dwarf-die
23736 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23737 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23738 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23739 A value of zero turns off the display.
23740 @item show debug dwarf-die
23741 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23742 @item set debug dwarf-line
23743 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23744 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23745 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23746 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23747 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23748 @item show debug dwarf-line
23749 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23750 @item set debug dwarf-read
23751 @cindex DWARF Reading
23752 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23753 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23754 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23755 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23756 @item show debug dwarf-read
23757 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23758 @item set debug displaced
23759 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23760 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23761 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23762 @item show debug displaced
23763 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23764 related to displaced stepping.
23765 @item set debug event
23766 @cindex event debugging info
23767 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23768 default is off.
23769 @item show debug event
23770 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23771 info.
23772 @item set debug expression
23773 @cindex expression debugging info
23774 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23775 expression parsing. The default is off.
23776 @item show debug expression
23777 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23778 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23779 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23780 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23781 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23782 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23783 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23784 @item set debug frame
23785 @cindex frame debugging info
23786 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23787 default is off.
23788 @item show debug frame
23789 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23790 info.
23791 @item set debug gnu-nat
23792 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23793 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23794 @item show debug gnu-nat
23795 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23796 @item set debug infrun
23797 @cindex inferior debugging info
23798 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23799 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23800 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23801 @item show debug infrun
23802 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23803 @item set debug jit
23804 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23805 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23806 @item show debug jit
23807 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23808 @item set debug lin-lwp
23809 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23810 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23811 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23812 @item show debug lin-lwp
23813 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23814 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23815 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23816 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23817 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23818 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23819 @item set debug mach-o
23820 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23821 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23822 processing. The default is off.
23823 @item show debug mach-o
23824 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23825 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23826 @item set debug notification
23827 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23828 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23829 The default is off.
23830 @item show debug notification
23831 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23832 @item set debug observer
23833 @cindex observer debugging info
23834 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23835 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23836 @item show debug observer
23837 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23838 @item set debug overload
23839 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23840 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23841 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23842 is off.
23843 @item show debug overload
23844 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23845 debugging info.
23846 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23847 @cindex debug expression parser
23848 @item set debug parser
23849 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23850 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23851 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23852 details. The default is off.
23853 @item show debug parser
23854 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23855 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23856 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23857 @cindex debug remote protocol
23858 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23859 @cindex display remote packets
23860 @item set debug remote
23861 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23862 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23863 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23864 @item show debug remote
23865 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23866 @item set debug serial
23867 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23868 default is off.
23869 @item show debug serial
23870 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23871 info.
23872 @item set debug solib-frv
23873 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23874 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23875 @item show debug solib-frv
23876 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23877 messages.
23878 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23879 @cindex symbol lookup
23880 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23881 The default is 0 (off).
23882 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23883 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23884 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23885 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23886 @item set debug symfile
23887 @cindex symbol file functions
23888 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23889 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23890 @item show debug symfile
23891 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23892 @item set debug symtab-create
23893 @cindex symbol table creation
23894 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23895 The default is 0 (off).
23896 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23897 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23898 @item show debug symtab-create
23899 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23900 @item set debug target
23901 @cindex target debugging info
23902 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23903 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23904 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23905 value of large memory transfers.
23906 @item show debug target
23907 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23908 info.
23909 @item set debug timestamp
23910 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23911 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23912 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23913 message.
23914 @item show debug timestamp
23915 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23916 debugging info.
23917 @item set debug varobj
23918 @cindex variable object debugging info
23919 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23920 info. The default is off.
23921 @item show debug varobj
23922 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23923 debugging info.
23924 @item set debug xml
23925 @cindex XML parser debugging
23926 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23927 @item show debug xml
23928 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23929 @end table
23930
23931 @node Other Misc Settings
23932 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23933 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23934
23935 @table @code
23936 @kindex set interactive-mode
23937 @item set interactive-mode
23938 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23939 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23940 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23941 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23942 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23943 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23944 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23945 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23946
23947 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23948 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23949 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23950 inside a cygwin window.
23951
23952 @kindex show interactive-mode
23953 @item show interactive-mode
23954 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23955 @end table
23956
23957 @node Extending GDB
23958 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23959 @cindex extending GDB
23960
23961 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23962 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23963 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23964 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23965 being debugged.
23966
23967 @menu
23968 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23969 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23970 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23971 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23972 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23973 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23974 @end menu
23975
23976 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23977 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23978 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23979 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23980 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23981 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23982
23983 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23984 setting:
23985
23986 @table @code
23987 @kindex set script-extension
23988 @kindex show script-extension
23989 @item set script-extension off
23990 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23991
23992 @item set script-extension soft
23993 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23994 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23995 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23996 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23997
23998 @item set script-extension strict
23999 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24000 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24001 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24002
24003 @item show script-extension
24004 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24005
24006 @end table
24007
24008 @node Sequences
24009 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24010
24011 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24012 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24013 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24014 files.
24015
24016 @menu
24017 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24018 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24019 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24020 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24021 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24022 @end menu
24023
24024 @node Define
24025 @subsection User-defined Commands
24026
24027 @cindex user-defined command
24028 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24029 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24030 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24031 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
24032 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24033 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
24034
24035 @smallexample
24036 define adder
24037 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24038 end
24039 @end smallexample
24040
24041 @noindent
24042 To execute the command use:
24043
24044 @smallexample
24045 adder 1 2 3
24046 @end smallexample
24047
24048 @noindent
24049 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24050 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24051 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24052 functions calls.
24053
24054 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24055 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24056 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24057 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
24058
24059 @smallexample
24060 define adder
24061 if $argc == 2
24062 print $arg0 + $arg1
24063 end
24064 if $argc == 3
24065 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24066 end
24067 end
24068 @end smallexample
24069
24070 @table @code
24071
24072 @kindex define
24073 @item define @var{commandname}
24074 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24075 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24076 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24077 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24078 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24079 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24080
24081 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24082 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24083 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24084
24085 @kindex document
24086 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24087 @item document @var{commandname}
24088 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24089 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24090 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24091 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24092 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24093 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24094
24095 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24096 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24097 does not change the documentation.
24098
24099 @kindex dont-repeat
24100 @cindex don't repeat command
24101 @item dont-repeat
24102 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24103 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24104 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24105
24106 @kindex help user-defined
24107 @item help user-defined
24108 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24109 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24110 included (if any).
24111
24112 @kindex show user
24113 @item show user
24114 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24115 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24116 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24117 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24118 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24119
24120 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24121 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24122 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24123 @item show max-user-call-depth
24124 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24125 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24126 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24127 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24128 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24129 @end table
24130
24131 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24132 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24133
24134 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24135 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24136 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24137
24138 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24139 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24140 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24141 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24142
24143 @node Hooks
24144 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24145 @cindex command hooks
24146 @cindex hooks, for commands
24147 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24148
24149 @kindex hook
24150 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24151 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24152 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24153 before that command.
24154
24155 @cindex hooks, post-command
24156 @kindex hookpost
24157 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24158 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24159 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24160 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24161 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24162
24163 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24164 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24165
24166 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24167 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24168
24169 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24170 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24171 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24172 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24173 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24174
24175 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24176 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24177 you could define:
24178
24179 @smallexample
24180 define hook-stop
24181 handle SIGALRM nopass
24182 end
24183
24184 define hook-run
24185 handle SIGALRM pass
24186 end
24187
24188 define hook-continue
24189 handle SIGALRM pass
24190 end
24191 @end smallexample
24192
24193 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24194 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24195 you could define:
24196
24197 @smallexample
24198 define hook-echo
24199 echo <<<---
24200 end
24201
24202 define hookpost-echo
24203 echo --->>>\n
24204 end
24205
24206 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24207 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24208 (@value{GDBP})
24209
24210 @end smallexample
24211
24212 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24213 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24214 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24215 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24216 @c or not?
24217 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24218 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24219 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24220
24221 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24222 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24223 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24224
24225 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24226 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24227
24228 @node Command Files
24229 @subsection Command Files
24230
24231 @cindex command files
24232 @cindex scripting commands
24233 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24234 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24235 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24236 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24237 terminal.
24238
24239 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24240 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24241 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24242 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24243 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24244
24245 @table @code
24246 @kindex source
24247 @cindex execute commands from a file
24248 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24249 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24250 @end table
24251
24252 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24253 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24254 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24255 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24256 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24257
24258 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24259 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24260 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24261 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24262 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24263 is not relevant to scripts.
24264
24265 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24266 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24267 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24268 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24269 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24270 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24271 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24272 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24273 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24274 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24275 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24276 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24277 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24278 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24279
24280 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24281 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24282 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24283
24284 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24285 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24286 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24287 when called from command files.
24288
24289 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24290 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24291 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24292 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24293 the next command.
24294
24295 @smallexample
24296 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24297 @end smallexample
24298
24299 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24300 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24301 would be directed to @file{log}.
24302
24303 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24304 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24305 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24306 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24307 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24308 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24309 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24310 conditionally, etc.
24311
24312 @table @code
24313 @kindex if
24314 @kindex else
24315 @item if
24316 @itemx else
24317 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24318 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24319 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24320 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24321 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24322 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24323 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24324
24325 @kindex while
24326 @item while
24327 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24328 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24329 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24330 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24331 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24332 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24333
24334 @kindex loop_break
24335 @item loop_break
24336 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24337 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24338 line.
24339
24340 @kindex loop_continue
24341 @item loop_continue
24342 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24343 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24344 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24345 the controlling expression.
24346
24347 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24348 @item end
24349 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24350 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24351 @end table
24352
24353
24354 @node Output
24355 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24356
24357 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24358 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24359 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24360 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24361 want.
24362
24363 @table @code
24364 @kindex echo
24365 @item echo @var{text}
24366 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24367 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24368 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24369 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24370 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24371 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24372 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24373 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24374 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24375 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24376 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24377
24378 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24379 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24380
24381 @smallexample
24382 echo This is some text\n\
24383 which is continued\n\
24384 onto several lines.\n
24385 @end smallexample
24386
24387 produces the same output as
24388
24389 @smallexample
24390 echo This is some text\n
24391 echo which is continued\n
24392 echo onto several lines.\n
24393 @end smallexample
24394
24395 @kindex output
24396 @item output @var{expression}
24397 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24398 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24399 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24400 on expressions.
24401
24402 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24403 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24404 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24405 Formats}, for more information.
24406
24407 @kindex printf
24408 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24409 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24410 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24411 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24412 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24413 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24414 executing the code below:
24415
24416 @smallexample
24417 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24418 @end smallexample
24419
24420 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24421 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24422 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24423 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24424 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24425 printed.
24426
24427 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24428
24429 @smallexample
24430 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24431 @end smallexample
24432
24433 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24434 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24435 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24436
24437 @itemize @bullet
24438 @item
24439 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24440
24441 @item
24442 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24443 width.
24444
24445 @item
24446 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24447 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24448
24449 @item
24450 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24451 supported.
24452
24453 @item
24454 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24455
24456 @item
24457 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24458 @end itemize
24459
24460 @noindent
24461 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24462 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24463 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24464 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24465
24466 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24467 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24468 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24469 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24470 supported.
24471
24472 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24473 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24474 together with a floating point specifier.
24475 letters:
24476
24477 @itemize @bullet
24478 @item
24479 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24480
24481 @item
24482 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24483
24484 @item
24485 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24486 @end itemize
24487
24488 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24489 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24490 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24491
24492 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24493 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24494
24495 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24496 @smallexample
24497 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24498 @end smallexample
24499
24500 @kindex eval
24501 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24502 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24503 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24504
24505 @end table
24506
24507 @node Auto-loading sequences
24508 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24509 @cindex native script auto-loading
24510
24511 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24512 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24513 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24514 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24515
24516 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24517 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24518
24519 @table @code
24520 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24521 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24522 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24523 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24524
24525 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24526 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24527 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24528 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24529 disabled.
24530
24531 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24532 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24533 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24534 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24535 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24536 auto-loaded.
24537 @end table
24538
24539 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24540 matching names are printed.
24541
24542 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24543 @include python.texi
24544
24545 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24546 @include guile.texi
24547
24548 @node Auto-loading extensions
24549 @section Auto-loading extensions
24550 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24551
24552 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24553 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24554 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24555 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24556 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24557
24558 @menu
24559 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24560 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24561 * Which flavor to choose?::
24562 @end menu
24563
24564 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24565 debugging commands and features.
24566
24567 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24568 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24569 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24570 for more information.
24571 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24572 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24573
24574 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24575 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24576
24577 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24578 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24579 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24580 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24581 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24582
24583 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24584 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24585 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24586 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24587
24588 @table @code
24589 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24590 GDB's own command language
24591 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24592 Python
24593 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24594 Guile
24595 @end table
24596
24597 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24598 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24599 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24600 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24601 script in the specified extension language.
24602
24603 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24604 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24605
24606 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24607 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24608
24609 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24610 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24611 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24612 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24613 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24614 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24615
24616 @table @code
24617 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24618 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24619 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24620 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24621 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24622 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24623
24624 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24625 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24626
24627 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24628 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24629 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24630 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24631
24632 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24633 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24634 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24635 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24636 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24637 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24638 platform.
24639
24640 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24641 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24642 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24643
24644 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24645 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24646 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24647 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24648
24649 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24650 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24651 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24652 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24653 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24654 @end table
24655
24656 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24657 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24658 @var{objfile} is opened.
24659 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24660 is evaluated more than once.
24661
24662 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24663 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24664 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24665
24666 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24667 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24668 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24669 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24670 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24671 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24672 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24673
24674 The following entries are supported:
24675
24676 @table @code
24677 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24678 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24679 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24680 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24681 @end table
24682
24683 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24684
24685 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24686 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24687 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24688 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24689 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24690
24691 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24692 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24693
24694 @example
24695 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24696 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24697 asm("\
24698 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24699 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24700 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24701 .popsection \n\
24702 ");
24703 @end example
24704
24705 @noindent
24706 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24707 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24708
24709 @example
24710 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24711 @end example
24712
24713 The script name may include directories if desired.
24714
24715 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24716 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24717
24718 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24719 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24720 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24721 will remove duplicates.
24722
24723 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24724
24725 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24726 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24727 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24728 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24729 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24730 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24731 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24732 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24733 on its name.
24734
24735 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24736 testsuite.
24737
24738 @example
24739 #include "symcat.h"
24740 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24741 asm(
24742 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24743 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24744 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24745 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24746 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24747 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24748 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24749 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24750 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24751 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24752 ".byte 0\n"
24753 ".popsection\n"
24754 );
24755 @end example
24756
24757 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24758 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24759 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24760 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24761
24762 @node Which flavor to choose?
24763 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24764
24765 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24766 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24767
24768 @noindent
24769 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24770
24771 @itemize @bullet
24772 @item
24773 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24774
24775 @item
24776 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24777
24778 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24779 in the source search path.
24780 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24781 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24782
24783 @item
24784 Doesn't require source code additions.
24785 @end itemize
24786
24787 @noindent
24788 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24789
24790 @itemize @bullet
24791 @item
24792 Works with static linking.
24793
24794 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24795 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24796 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24797 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24798 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24799
24800 @item
24801 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24802
24803 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24804 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24805
24806 @item
24807 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24808
24809 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24810 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24811 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24812 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24813 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24814 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24815 @end itemize
24816
24817 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24818 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24819
24820 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24821 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24822 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24823
24824 @subsection Python comes first
24825
24826 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24827 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24828 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24829 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24830 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24831 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24832 pretty-printed form of a value).
24833 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24834 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24835 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24836
24837 @node Aliases
24838 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24839 @cindex aliases for commands
24840
24841 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24842 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24843 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24844 that involves less typing.
24845
24846 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24847 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24848 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24849
24850 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24851 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24852 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24853
24854 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24855
24856 @table @code
24857
24858 @kindex alias
24859 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24860
24861 @end table
24862
24863 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24864 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24865 underscores.
24866
24867 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24868 that is being aliased.
24869
24870 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24871 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24872 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24873
24874 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24875 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24876
24877 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24878 of a command so that there is less to type.
24879 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24880 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24881 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24882 The following will accomplish this.
24883
24884 @smallexample
24885 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24886 @end smallexample
24887
24888 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24889 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24890 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24891 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24892
24893 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24894 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24895 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24896 of a command.
24897
24898 @smallexample
24899 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24900 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24901 (gdb) set p elms 20
24902 (gdb) show p elms
24903 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24904 @end smallexample
24905
24906 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24907 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24908 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24909
24910 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24911 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24912
24913 @smallexample
24914 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24915 @end smallexample
24916
24917 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24918 alias for a more complex command.
24919 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24920
24921 @smallexample
24922 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24923 (gdb) spe 20
24924 @end smallexample
24925
24926 @node Interpreters
24927 @chapter Command Interpreters
24928 @cindex command interpreters
24929
24930 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24931 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24932 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24933
24934 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24935 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24936 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24937 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24938
24939 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24940 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24941 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24942 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24943
24944 @table @code
24945 @item console
24946 @cindex console interpreter
24947 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24948 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24949 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24950
24951 @item mi
24952 @cindex mi interpreter
24953 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24954 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24955 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24956 Interface}.
24957
24958 @item mi2
24959 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24960 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24961
24962 @item mi1
24963 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24964 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24965
24966 @end table
24967
24968 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24969
24970 @kindex interpreter-exec
24971 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
24972 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
24973 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24974
24975 @smallexample
24976 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24977 @end smallexample
24978
24979 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24980 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24981
24982 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
24983 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
24984 permanently.
24985
24986 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
24987
24988 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
24989 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
24990 device (usually a tty).
24991
24992 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
24993 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
24994 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
24995 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
24996 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
24997 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
24998 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
24999 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25000 the separate MI interpreter.
25001
25002 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25003 @code{new-ui} command:
25004
25005 @kindex new-ui
25006 @cindex new user interface
25007 @smallexample
25008 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25009 @end smallexample
25010
25011 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25012 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25013 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25014 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25015 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25016 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25017
25018 @smallexample
25019 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25020 @end smallexample
25021
25022 @noindent
25023 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25024
25025 @node TUI
25026 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25027 @cindex TUI
25028 @cindex Text User Interface
25029
25030 @menu
25031 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25032 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25033 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25034 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25035 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25036 @end menu
25037
25038 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25039 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25040 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25041 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25042 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25043 is available.
25044
25045 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25046 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25047 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25048 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25049 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25050 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25051
25052 @node TUI Overview
25053 @section TUI Overview
25054
25055 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25056
25057 @table @emph
25058 @item command
25059 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25060 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25061 managed using readline.
25062
25063 @item source
25064 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25065 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25066
25067 @item assembly
25068 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25069
25070 @item register
25071 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25072 when their values change.
25073 @end table
25074
25075 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25076 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25077 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25078 indicates the breakpoint type:
25079
25080 @table @code
25081 @item B
25082 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25083
25084 @item b
25085 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25086
25087 @item H
25088 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25089
25090 @item h
25091 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25092 @end table
25093
25094 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25095
25096 @table @code
25097 @item +
25098 Breakpoint is enabled.
25099
25100 @item -
25101 Breakpoint is disabled.
25102 @end table
25103
25104 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25105 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25106 changes.
25107
25108 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25109 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25110 layouts:
25111
25112 @itemize @bullet
25113 @item
25114 source only,
25115
25116 @item
25117 assembly only,
25118
25119 @item
25120 source and assembly,
25121
25122 @item
25123 source and registers, or
25124
25125 @item
25126 assembly and registers.
25127 @end itemize
25128
25129 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25130
25131 @table @emph
25132 @item target
25133 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25134 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25135
25136 @item process
25137 Gives the current process or thread number.
25138 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25139
25140 @item function
25141 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25142 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25143 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25144 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25145
25146 @item line
25147 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25148 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25149
25150 @item pc
25151 Indicates the current program counter address.
25152 @end table
25153
25154 @node TUI Keys
25155 @section TUI Key Bindings
25156 @cindex TUI key bindings
25157
25158 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25159 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25160 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25161 @end ifset
25162 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25163 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25164 @end ifclear
25165 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25166 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25167
25168 @table @kbd
25169 @kindex C-x C-a
25170 @item C-x C-a
25171 @kindex C-x a
25172 @itemx C-x a
25173 @kindex C-x A
25174 @itemx C-x A
25175 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25176 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25177 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25178 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25179 The screen is then refreshed.
25180
25181 @kindex C-x 1
25182 @item C-x 1
25183 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25184 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25185 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25186
25187 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25188
25189 @kindex C-x 2
25190 @item C-x 2
25191 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25192 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25193 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25194 previous layout and the new one.
25195
25196 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25197
25198 @kindex C-x o
25199 @item C-x o
25200 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25201 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25202 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25203
25204 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25205
25206 @kindex C-x s
25207 @item C-x s
25208 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25209 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25210 @end table
25211
25212 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25213
25214 @table @asis
25215 @kindex PgUp
25216 @item @key{PgUp}
25217 Scroll the active window one page up.
25218
25219 @kindex PgDn
25220 @item @key{PgDn}
25221 Scroll the active window one page down.
25222
25223 @kindex Up
25224 @item @key{Up}
25225 Scroll the active window one line up.
25226
25227 @kindex Down
25228 @item @key{Down}
25229 Scroll the active window one line down.
25230
25231 @kindex Left
25232 @item @key{Left}
25233 Scroll the active window one column left.
25234
25235 @kindex Right
25236 @item @key{Right}
25237 Scroll the active window one column right.
25238
25239 @kindex C-L
25240 @item @kbd{C-L}
25241 Refresh the screen.
25242 @end table
25243
25244 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25245 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25246 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25247 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25248 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25249
25250 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25251 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25252 @cindex TUI single key mode
25253
25254 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25255 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25256 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25257
25258 @table @kbd
25259 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25260 @item c
25261 continue
25262
25263 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25264 @item d
25265 down
25266
25267 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25268 @item f
25269 finish
25270
25271 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25272 @item n
25273 next
25274
25275 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25276 @item q
25277 exit the SingleKey mode.
25278
25279 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25280 @item r
25281 run
25282
25283 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25284 @item s
25285 step
25286
25287 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25288 @item u
25289 up
25290
25291 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25292 @item v
25293 info locals
25294
25295 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25296 @item w
25297 where
25298 @end table
25299
25300 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25301 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25302 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25303 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25304 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25305 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25306
25307
25308 @node TUI Commands
25309 @section TUI-specific Commands
25310 @cindex TUI commands
25311
25312 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25313 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25314 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25315 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25316
25317 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25318 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25319 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25320 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25321 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25322
25323 @table @code
25324 @item tui enable
25325 @kindex tui enable
25326 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25327 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25328 otherwise a default layout is used.
25329
25330 @item tui disable
25331 @kindex tui disable
25332 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25333
25334 @item info win
25335 @kindex info win
25336 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25337
25338 @item layout @var{name}
25339 @kindex layout
25340 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25341 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25342 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25343
25344 @table @code
25345 @item next
25346 Display the next layout.
25347
25348 @item prev
25349 Display the previous layout.
25350
25351 @item src
25352 Display the source and command windows.
25353
25354 @item asm
25355 Display the assembly and command windows.
25356
25357 @item split
25358 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25359
25360 @item regs
25361 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25362 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25363 register, assembler, and command windows.
25364 @end table
25365
25366 @item focus @var{name}
25367 @kindex focus
25368 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25369 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25370
25371 @table @code
25372 @item next
25373 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25374
25375 @item prev
25376 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25377
25378 @item src
25379 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25380
25381 @item asm
25382 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25383
25384 @item regs
25385 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25386
25387 @item cmd
25388 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25389 @end table
25390
25391 @item refresh
25392 @kindex refresh
25393 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25394
25395 @item tui reg @var{group}
25396 @kindex tui reg
25397 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25398 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25399 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25400 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25401 following groups are available on most targets:
25402 @table @code
25403 @item next
25404 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25405 through all of the available register groups.
25406
25407 @item prev
25408 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25409 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25410 @var{next}.
25411
25412 @item general
25413 Display the general registers.
25414 @item float
25415 Display the floating point registers.
25416 @item system
25417 Display the system registers.
25418 @item vector
25419 Display the vector registers.
25420 @item all
25421 Display all registers.
25422 @end table
25423
25424 @item update
25425 @kindex update
25426 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25427
25428 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25429 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25430 @kindex winheight
25431 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25432 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25433 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25434 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25435 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25436
25437 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25438 @kindex tabset
25439 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25440 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25441 assembly windows.
25442 @end table
25443
25444 @node TUI Configuration
25445 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25446 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25447
25448 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25449
25450 @table @code
25451 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25452 @kindex set tui border-kind
25453 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25454 The possible values are the following:
25455 @table @code
25456 @item space
25457 Use a space character to draw the border.
25458
25459 @item ascii
25460 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25461
25462 @item acs
25463 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25464 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25465 @end table
25466
25467 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25468 @kindex set tui border-mode
25469 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25470 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25471 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25472 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25473 @table @code
25474 @item normal
25475 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25476
25477 @item standout
25478 Use standout mode.
25479
25480 @item reverse
25481 Use reverse video mode.
25482
25483 @item half
25484 Use half bright mode.
25485
25486 @item half-standout
25487 Use half bright and standout mode.
25488
25489 @item bold
25490 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25491
25492 @item bold-standout
25493 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25494 @end table
25495 @end table
25496
25497 @node Emacs
25498 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25499
25500 @cindex Emacs
25501 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25502 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25503 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25504 @value{GDBN}.
25505
25506 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25507 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25508 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25509 created Emacs buffer.
25510 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25511
25512 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25513 things:
25514
25515 @itemize @bullet
25516 @item
25517 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25518 the GUD buffer.
25519
25520 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25521 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25522
25523 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25524 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25525 in this way.
25526
25527 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25528 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25529 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25530 stop.
25531
25532 @item
25533 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25534
25535 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25536 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25537 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25538 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25539 and the source.
25540
25541 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25542 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25543 @end itemize
25544
25545 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25546 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25547 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25548 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25549
25550 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25551 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25552 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25553 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25554 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25555 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25556 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25557 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25558 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25559
25560 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25561 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25562 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25563 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25564
25565 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25566 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25567 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25568 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25569 one you want.
25570
25571 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25572 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25573
25574 @table @kbd
25575 @item C-h m
25576 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25577
25578 @item C-c C-s
25579 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25580 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25581
25582 @item C-c C-n
25583 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25584 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25585 to show the current file and location.
25586
25587 @item C-c C-i
25588 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25589 display window accordingly.
25590
25591 @item C-c C-f
25592 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25593 @code{finish} command.
25594
25595 @item C-c C-r
25596 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25597 command.
25598
25599 @item C-c <
25600 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25601 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25602 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25603
25604 @item C-c >
25605 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25606 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25607 @end table
25608
25609 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25610 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25611
25612 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25613 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25614 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25615 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25616 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25617 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25618 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25619
25620 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25621 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25622 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25623 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25624 frame.
25625
25626 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25627 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25628 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25629 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25630 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25631 to correspond properly with the code.
25632
25633 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25634 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25635 Emacs Manual}).
25636
25637 @node GDB/MI
25638 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25639
25640 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25641
25642 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25643 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25644 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25645 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25646 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25647 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25648
25649 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25650 in the form of a reference manual.
25651
25652 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25653 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25654 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25655
25656 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25657
25658 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25659 This chapter uses the following notation:
25660
25661 @itemize @bullet
25662 @item
25663 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25664
25665 @item
25666 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25667 it may or may not be given.
25668
25669 @item
25670 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25671 may repeat zero or more times.
25672
25673 @item
25674 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25675 may repeat one or more times.
25676
25677 @item
25678 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25679 @end itemize
25680
25681 @ignore
25682 @heading Dependencies
25683 @end ignore
25684
25685 @menu
25686 * GDB/MI General Design::
25687 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25688 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25689 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25690 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25691 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25692 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25693 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25694 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25695 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25696 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25697 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25698 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25699 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25700 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25701 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25702 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25703 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25704 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25705 @ignore
25706 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25707 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25708 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25709 @end ignore
25710 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25711 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25712 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25713 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25714 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25715 @end menu
25716
25717 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25718 @node GDB/MI General Design
25719 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25720 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25721
25722 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25723 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25724 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25725 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25726 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25727 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25728 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25729 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25730 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25731 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25732
25733 The important examples of notifications are:
25734 @itemize @bullet
25735
25736 @item
25737 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25738 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25739 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25740 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25741 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25742 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25743 command itself was successfully executed.
25744
25745 @item
25746 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25747 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25748 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25749 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25750 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25751 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25752
25753 @item
25754 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25755 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25756 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25757 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25758 orthogonal frontend design.
25759
25760 @end itemize
25761
25762 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25763 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25764 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25765 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25766 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25767 the user interface.
25768
25769
25770 @menu
25771 * Context management::
25772 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25773 * Thread groups::
25774 @end menu
25775
25776 @node Context management
25777 @subsection Context management
25778
25779 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25780
25781 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25782 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25783 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25784 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25785 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25786 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25787 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25788 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25789 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25790
25791 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25792 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25793 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25794 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25795 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25796 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25797 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25798 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25799 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25800 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25801 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25802
25803 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25804 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25805 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25806 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25807 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25808 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25809 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25810 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25811 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25812 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25813
25814 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25815 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25816 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25817 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25818 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25819 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25820 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25821 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25822 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25823 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25824 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25825 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25826 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25827 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25828 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25829 @samp{--frame} options.
25830
25831 @subsubsection Language
25832
25833 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25834 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25835 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25836 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25837 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25838 For instance:
25839
25840 @smallexample
25841 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25842 ^done,value="4"
25843 (gdb)
25844 @end smallexample
25845
25846 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25847 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25848 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25849
25850 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25851 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25852
25853 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25854 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25855 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25856 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25857 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25858 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25859 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25860 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25861 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25862
25863 @table @code
25864 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25865 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25866 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25867
25868 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25869 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25870 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25871
25872 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25873 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25874 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25875 MI commands even while the target is running.
25876
25877 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25878 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25879 @end table
25880
25881 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25882 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25883 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25884 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25885 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25886 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25887
25888 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25889 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25890 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25891 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25892 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25893 are running.
25894
25895 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25896 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25897 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25898 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25899 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25900 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25901 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25902 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25903 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25904 @samp{--thread} option).
25905
25906 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25907 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25908 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25909 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25910
25911 @node Thread groups
25912 @subsection Thread groups
25913 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25914 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25915 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25916 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25917 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25918
25919 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25920 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25921 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25922 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25923 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25924 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25925 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25926 into processes.
25927
25928 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25929 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25930 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25931 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25932 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25933 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25934 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25935 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25936 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25937 the members of specific thread group.
25938
25939 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25940 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25941 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25942 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25943 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25944 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25945 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25946 after attaching to that thread group.
25947
25948 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25949 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25950 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25951 such thread groups.
25952
25953 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25954 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25955 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25956
25957 @menu
25958 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25959 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25960 @end menu
25961
25962 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25963 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25964
25965 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25966 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25967 @table @code
25968 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25969 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25970
25971 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25972 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25973 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25974
25975 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25976 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25977 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25978
25979 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25980 "any sequence of digits"
25981
25982 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25983 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25984
25985 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25986 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25987
25988 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25989 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25990
25991 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25992 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25993 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25994
25995 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25996 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25997
25998 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25999 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26000 @end table
26001
26002 @noindent
26003 Notes:
26004
26005 @itemize @bullet
26006 @item
26007 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26008 output is described below.
26009
26010 @item
26011 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26012 finishes.
26013
26014 @item
26015 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26016 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26017 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26018 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26019 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26020 @end itemize
26021
26022 Pragmatics:
26023
26024 @itemize @bullet
26025 @item
26026 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26027
26028 @item
26029 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26030 @end itemize
26031
26032 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26033 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26034
26035 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26036 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26037 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26038 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26039 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26040 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26041
26042 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26043 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26044 @var{token}.
26045
26046 @table @code
26047 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26048 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26049
26050 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26051 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26052
26053 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26054 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26055
26056 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26057 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26058
26059 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26060 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26061
26062 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26063 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26064
26065 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26066 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26067
26068 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26069 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26070
26071 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26072 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26073
26074 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26075 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26076 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26077
26078 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26079 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26080
26081 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26082 @code{ @var{string} }
26083
26084 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26085 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26086
26087 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26088 @code{@var{c-string}}
26089
26090 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26091 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26092
26093 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26094 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26095 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26096
26097 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26098 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26099
26100 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26101 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26102
26103 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26104 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26105
26106 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26107 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26108
26109 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26110 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26111
26112 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26113 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26114 @end table
26115
26116 @noindent
26117 Notes:
26118
26119 @itemize @bullet
26120 @item
26121 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26122
26123 @item
26124 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26125 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26126 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26127 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26128 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26129 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26130 prior command.
26131
26132 @item
26133 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26134 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26135 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26136 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26137
26138 @item
26139 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26140 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26141 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26142 @samp{*}.
26143
26144 @item
26145 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26146 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26147 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26148 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26149
26150 @item
26151 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26152 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26153 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26154 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26155
26156 @item
26157 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26158 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26159 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26160
26161 @item
26162 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26163 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26164 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26165 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26166
26167 @item
26168 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26169 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26170 @var{values}.
26171
26172
26173 @end itemize
26174
26175 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26176 details about the various output records.
26177
26178 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26179 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26180 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26181
26182 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26183 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26184
26185 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26186 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26187 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26188 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26189 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26190 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26191
26192 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26193 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26194 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26195
26196 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26197 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26198 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26199 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26200
26201 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26202 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26203
26204 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26205 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26206 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26207 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26208 might change.
26209
26210 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26211 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26212 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26213 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26214
26215 @itemize @bullet
26216 @item
26217 New MI commands may be added.
26218
26219 @item
26220 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26221
26222 @item
26223 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26224 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26225
26226 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26227 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26228
26229 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26230 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26231 @end itemize
26232
26233 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26234 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26235 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26236 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26237 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26238
26239 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26240 @c version?
26241
26242 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26243 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26244 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26245 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26246 @cindex mailing lists
26247
26248 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26249 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26250 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26251
26252 @menu
26253 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26254 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26255 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26256 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26257 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26258 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26259 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26260 @end menu
26261
26262 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26263 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26264
26265 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26266 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26267 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26268 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26269
26270 @table @code
26271 @findex ^done
26272 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26273 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26274 values.
26275
26276 @item "^running"
26277 @findex ^running
26278 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26279 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26280 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26281 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26282 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26283 which threads are resumed.
26284
26285 @item "^connected"
26286 @findex ^connected
26287 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26288
26289 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26290 @findex ^error
26291 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26292 the corresponding error message.
26293
26294 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26295 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26296 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26297
26298 @table @samp
26299 @item "undefined-command"
26300 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26301 @end table
26302
26303 @item "^exit"
26304 @findex ^exit
26305 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26306
26307 @end table
26308
26309 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26310 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26311
26312 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26313 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26314 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26315 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26316 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26317
26318 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26319 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26320 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26321 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26322 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26323
26324 @table @code
26325 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26326 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26327 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26328
26329 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26330 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26331 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26332 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26333
26334 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26335 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26336 internals.
26337 @end table
26338
26339 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26340 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26341
26342 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26343 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26344 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26345 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26346 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26347 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26348
26349 The following is the list of possible async records:
26350
26351 @table @code
26352
26353 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26354 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26355 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26356 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26357 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26358 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26359 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26360 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26361 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26362 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26363 it run freely.
26364
26365 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26366 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26367 following values:
26368
26369 @table @code
26370 @item breakpoint-hit
26371 A breakpoint was reached.
26372 @item watchpoint-trigger
26373 A watchpoint was triggered.
26374 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26375 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26376 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26377 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26378 @item function-finished
26379 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26380 @item location-reached
26381 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26382 @item watchpoint-scope
26383 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26384 @item end-stepping-range
26385 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26386 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26387 @item exited-signalled
26388 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26389 @item exited
26390 The inferior exited.
26391 @item exited-normally
26392 The inferior exited normally.
26393 @item signal-received
26394 A signal was received by the inferior.
26395 @item solib-event
26396 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26397 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26398 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26399 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26400 @item fork
26401 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26402 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26403 @item vfork
26404 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26405 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26406 @item syscall-entry
26407 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26408 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26409 @item syscall-return
26410 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26411 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26412 @item exec
26413 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26414 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26415 @end table
26416
26417 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26418 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26419 Depending on whether all-stop
26420 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26421 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26422 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26423 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26424 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26425 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26426 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26427 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26428 if such information is not available.
26429
26430 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26431 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26432 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26433 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26434 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26435 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26436 cannot be used in any way.
26437
26438 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26439 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26440 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26441 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26442 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26443 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26444
26445 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26446 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26447 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26448 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26449 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26450 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26451
26452 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26453 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26454 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26455 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26456 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26457
26458 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26459 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26460 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26461 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26462 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26463 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26464 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26465
26466 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26467 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26468 that thread.
26469
26470 @item =library-loaded,...
26471 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26472 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26473 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26474 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26475 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26476 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26477 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26478 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26479 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26480 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26481 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26482 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26483 thread groups.
26484
26485 @item =library-unloaded,...
26486 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26487 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26488 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26489 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26490 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26491 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26492 thread groups.
26493
26494 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26495 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26496 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26497 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26498 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26499
26500 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26501 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26502 initial value @var{initial}.
26503
26504 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26505 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26506 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26507 trace state variables are deleted.
26508
26509 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26510 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26511 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26512 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26513 value of trace state variable is known.
26514
26515 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26516 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26517 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26518 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26519 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26520 user.
26521
26522 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26523 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26524 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26525
26526 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26527 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26528
26529 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26530 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26531 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26532 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26533 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26534
26535 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26536 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26537 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay}
26538 for existing method and format values.
26539
26540 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26541 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26542 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26543 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26544 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26545 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26546
26547 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26548 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26549 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26550 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26551 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26552 executable code.
26553 @end table
26554
26555 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26556 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26557
26558 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26559 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26560 following fields:
26561
26562 @table @code
26563 @item number
26564 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26565 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26566 @samp{1.2}.
26567
26568 @item type
26569 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26570 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26571
26572 @item catch-type
26573 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26574 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26575
26576 @item disp
26577 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26578 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26579 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26580
26581 @item enabled
26582 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26583 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26584 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26585
26586 @item addr
26587 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26588 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26589 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26590 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26591 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26592
26593 @item func
26594 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26595 If not known, this field is not present.
26596
26597 @item filename
26598 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26599 If not known, this field is not present.
26600
26601 @item fullname
26602 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26603 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26604
26605 @item line
26606 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26607 If not known, this field is not present.
26608
26609 @item at
26610 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26611 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26612 by a symbol name.
26613
26614 @item pending
26615 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26616 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26617
26618 @item evaluated-by
26619 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26620 @samp{target}.
26621
26622 @item thread
26623 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26624 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26625
26626 @item task
26627 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26628 field will hold the task identifier.
26629
26630 @item cond
26631 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26632
26633 @item ignore
26634 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26635
26636 @item enable
26637 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26638
26639 @item traceframe-usage
26640 FIXME.
26641
26642 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26643 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26644
26645 @item mask
26646 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26647
26648 @item pass
26649 A tracepoint's pass count.
26650
26651 @item original-location
26652 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26653 This field is optional.
26654
26655 @item times
26656 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26657
26658 @item installed
26659 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26660 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26661 is not.
26662
26663 @item what
26664 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26665
26666 @end table
26667
26668 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26669 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26670
26671 @smallexample
26672 -> -break-insert main
26673 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26674 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26675 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26676 times="0"@}
26677 <- (gdb)
26678 @end smallexample
26679
26680 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26681 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26682
26683 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26684 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26685 fields:
26686
26687 @table @code
26688 @item level
26689 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26690 zero. This field is always present.
26691
26692 @item func
26693 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26694 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26695
26696 @item addr
26697 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26698
26699 @item file
26700 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26701 address. This field may be absent.
26702
26703 @item line
26704 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26705 may be absent.
26706
26707 @item from
26708 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26709 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26710
26711 @end table
26712
26713 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26714 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26715
26716 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26717 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26718
26719 @table @code
26720 @item id
26721 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26722 always present.
26723
26724 @item target-id
26725 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26726
26727 @item details
26728 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26729 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26730 frontend. This field is optional.
26731
26732 @item state
26733 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26734 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26735
26736 @item core
26737 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26738 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26739 @end table
26740
26741 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26742 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26743
26744 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26745 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26746 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26747 the @code{exception-name} field.
26748
26749 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26750 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26751 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26752 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26753
26754 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26755 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26756 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26757 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26758
26759 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26760 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26761
26762 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26763
26764 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26765 information of the breakpoint.
26766
26767 @smallexample
26768 -> -break-insert main
26769 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26770 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26771 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26772 times="0"@}
26773 <- (gdb)
26774 @end smallexample
26775
26776 @subheading Program Execution
26777
26778 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26779 reason that execution stopped.
26780
26781 @smallexample
26782 -> -exec-run
26783 <- ^running
26784 <- (gdb)
26785 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26786 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26787 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26788 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26789 <- (gdb)
26790 -> -exec-continue
26791 <- ^running
26792 <- (gdb)
26793 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26794 <- (gdb)
26795 @end smallexample
26796
26797 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26798
26799 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26800
26801 @smallexample
26802 -> (gdb)
26803 <- -gdb-exit
26804 <- ^exit
26805 @end smallexample
26806
26807 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26808 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26809 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26810 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26811 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26812 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26813
26814 @subheading A Bad Command
26815
26816 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26817
26818 @smallexample
26819 -> -rubbish
26820 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26821 <- (gdb)
26822 @end smallexample
26823
26824
26825 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26826 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26827 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26828
26829 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26830 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26831
26832 @subheading Motivation
26833
26834 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26835
26836 @subheading Introduction
26837
26838 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26839
26840 @subheading Commands
26841
26842 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26843
26844 @subsubheading Synopsis
26845
26846 @smallexample
26847 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26848 @end smallexample
26849
26850 @subsubheading Result
26851
26852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26853
26854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26855
26856 @subsubheading Example
26857
26858 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26859 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26860
26861
26862 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26863 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26864 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26865
26866 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26867 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26868 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26869 breakpoints.
26870
26871 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26872 @findex -break-after
26873
26874 @subsubheading Synopsis
26875
26876 @smallexample
26877 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26878 @end smallexample
26879
26880 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26881 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26882 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26883 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26884
26885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26886
26887 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26888
26889 @subsubheading Example
26890
26891 @smallexample
26892 (gdb)
26893 -break-insert main
26894 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26895 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26896 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26897 times="0"@}
26898 (gdb)
26899 -break-after 1 3
26900 ~
26901 ^done
26902 (gdb)
26903 -break-list
26904 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26905 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26906 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26907 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26908 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26909 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26910 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26911 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26912 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26913 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26914 (gdb)
26915 @end smallexample
26916
26917 @ignore
26918 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26919 @findex -break-catch
26920 @end ignore
26921
26922 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26923 @findex -break-commands
26924
26925 @subsubheading Synopsis
26926
26927 @smallexample
26928 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26929 @end smallexample
26930
26931 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26932 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26933 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26934 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26935 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26936 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26937
26938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26939
26940 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26941
26942 @subsubheading Example
26943
26944 @smallexample
26945 (gdb)
26946 -break-insert main
26947 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26948 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26949 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26950 times="0"@}
26951 (gdb)
26952 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26953 ^done
26954 (gdb)
26955 @end smallexample
26956
26957 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26958 @findex -break-condition
26959
26960 @subsubheading Synopsis
26961
26962 @smallexample
26963 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26964 @end smallexample
26965
26966 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26967 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26968 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26969 command below).
26970
26971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26972
26973 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26974
26975 @subsubheading Example
26976
26977 @smallexample
26978 (gdb)
26979 -break-condition 1 1
26980 ^done
26981 (gdb)
26982 -break-list
26983 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26984 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26985 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26986 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26987 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26988 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26989 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26990 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26991 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26992 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26993 (gdb)
26994 @end smallexample
26995
26996 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26997 @findex -break-delete
26998
26999 @subsubheading Synopsis
27000
27001 @smallexample
27002 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27003 @end smallexample
27004
27005 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27006 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27007
27008 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27009
27010 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27011
27012 @subsubheading Example
27013
27014 @smallexample
27015 (gdb)
27016 -break-delete 1
27017 ^done
27018 (gdb)
27019 -break-list
27020 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27021 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27022 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27023 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27024 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27025 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27026 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27027 body=[]@}
27028 (gdb)
27029 @end smallexample
27030
27031 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27032 @findex -break-disable
27033
27034 @subsubheading Synopsis
27035
27036 @smallexample
27037 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27038 @end smallexample
27039
27040 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27041 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27042
27043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27044
27045 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27046
27047 @subsubheading Example
27048
27049 @smallexample
27050 (gdb)
27051 -break-disable 2
27052 ^done
27053 (gdb)
27054 -break-list
27055 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27056 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27057 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27058 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27059 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27060 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27061 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27062 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27063 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27064 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27065 (gdb)
27066 @end smallexample
27067
27068 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27069 @findex -break-enable
27070
27071 @subsubheading Synopsis
27072
27073 @smallexample
27074 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27075 @end smallexample
27076
27077 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27078
27079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27080
27081 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27082
27083 @subsubheading Example
27084
27085 @smallexample
27086 (gdb)
27087 -break-enable 2
27088 ^done
27089 (gdb)
27090 -break-list
27091 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27092 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27093 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27094 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27095 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27096 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27097 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27098 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27099 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27100 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27101 (gdb)
27102 @end smallexample
27103
27104 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27105 @findex -break-info
27106
27107 @subsubheading Synopsis
27108
27109 @smallexample
27110 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27111 @end smallexample
27112
27113 @c REDUNDANT???
27114 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27115
27116 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27117 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27118 table.
27119
27120 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27121
27122 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27123
27124 @subsubheading Example
27125 N.A.
27126
27127 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27128 @findex -break-insert
27129 @anchor{-break-insert}
27130
27131 @subsubheading Synopsis
27132
27133 @smallexample
27134 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27135 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27136 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27137 @end smallexample
27138
27139 @noindent
27140 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27141
27142 @table @var
27143 @item linespec location
27144 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27145
27146 @item explicit location
27147 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27148 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27149 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27150
27151 @table @samp
27152 @item --source @var{filename}
27153 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27154 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27155
27156 @item --function @var{function}
27157 The name of a function or method.
27158
27159 @item --label @var{label}
27160 The name of a label.
27161
27162 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27163 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27164 @end table
27165
27166 @item address location
27167 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27168 @end table
27169
27170 @noindent
27171 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27172
27173 @table @samp
27174 @item -t
27175 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27176 @item -h
27177 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27178 @item -f
27179 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27180 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27181 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27182 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27183 cannot be parsed.
27184 @item -d
27185 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27186 @item -a
27187 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27188 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27189 @item -c @var{condition}
27190 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27191 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27192 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27193 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27194 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27195 @var{thread-id}.
27196 @end table
27197
27198 @subsubheading Result
27199
27200 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27201 resulting breakpoint.
27202
27203 Note: this format is open to change.
27204 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27205
27206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27207
27208 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27209 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27210
27211 @subsubheading Example
27212
27213 @smallexample
27214 (gdb)
27215 -break-insert main
27216 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27217 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27218 times="0"@}
27219 (gdb)
27220 -break-insert -t foo
27221 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27222 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27223 times="0"@}
27224 (gdb)
27225 -break-list
27226 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27227 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27228 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27229 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27230 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27231 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27232 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27233 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27234 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27235 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27236 times="0"@},
27237 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27238 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27239 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27240 times="0"@}]@}
27241 (gdb)
27242 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27243 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27244 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27245 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27246 @c times="0"@}
27247 @c (gdb)
27248 @end smallexample
27249
27250 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27251 @findex -dprintf-insert
27252
27253 @subsubheading Synopsis
27254
27255 @smallexample
27256 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27257 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27258 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27259 [ @var{argument} ]
27260 @end smallexample
27261
27262 @noindent
27263 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27264 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27265
27266 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27267
27268 @table @samp
27269 @item -t
27270 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27271 @item -f
27272 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27273 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27274 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27275 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27276 cannot be parsed.
27277 @item -d
27278 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27279 @item -c @var{condition}
27280 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27281 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27282 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27283 to @var{ignore-count}.
27284 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27285 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27286 @var{thread-id}.
27287 @end table
27288
27289 @subsubheading Result
27290
27291 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27292 resulting breakpoint.
27293
27294 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27295
27296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27297
27298 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27299
27300 @subsubheading Example
27301
27302 @smallexample
27303 (gdb)
27304 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27305 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27306 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27307 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27308 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27309 original-location="foo"@}
27310 (gdb)
27311 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27312 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27313 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27314 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27315 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27316 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27317 (gdb)
27318 @end smallexample
27319
27320 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27321 @findex -break-list
27322
27323 @subsubheading Synopsis
27324
27325 @smallexample
27326 -break-list
27327 @end smallexample
27328
27329 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27330
27331 @table @samp
27332 @item Number
27333 number of the breakpoint
27334 @item Type
27335 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27336 @item Disposition
27337 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27338 or @samp{nokeep}
27339 @item Enabled
27340 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27341 @item Address
27342 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27343 @item What
27344 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27345 name, line number
27346 @item Thread-groups
27347 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27348 @item Times
27349 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27350 @end table
27351
27352 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27353 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27354
27355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27356
27357 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27358
27359 @subsubheading Example
27360
27361 @smallexample
27362 (gdb)
27363 -break-list
27364 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27365 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27366 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27367 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27368 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27369 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27370 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27371 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27372 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27373 times="0"@},
27374 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27375 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27376 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27377 (gdb)
27378 @end smallexample
27379
27380 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27381
27382 @smallexample
27383 (gdb)
27384 -break-list
27385 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27386 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27387 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27388 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27389 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27390 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27391 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27392 body=[]@}
27393 (gdb)
27394 @end smallexample
27395
27396 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27397 @findex -break-passcount
27398
27399 @subsubheading Synopsis
27400
27401 @smallexample
27402 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27403 @end smallexample
27404
27405 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27406 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27407 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27408 command @samp{passcount}.
27409
27410 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27411 @findex -break-watch
27412
27413 @subsubheading Synopsis
27414
27415 @smallexample
27416 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27417 @end smallexample
27418
27419 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27420 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27421 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27422 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27423 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27424 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27425 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27426 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27427
27428 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27429 breakpoints inserted.
27430
27431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27432
27433 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27434 @samp{rwatch}.
27435
27436 @subsubheading Example
27437
27438 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27439
27440 @smallexample
27441 (gdb)
27442 -break-watch x
27443 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27444 (gdb)
27445 -exec-continue
27446 ^running
27447 (gdb)
27448 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27449 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27450 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27451 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27452 (gdb)
27453 @end smallexample
27454
27455 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27456 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27457 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27458
27459 @smallexample
27460 (gdb)
27461 -break-watch C
27462 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27463 (gdb)
27464 -exec-continue
27465 ^running
27466 (gdb)
27467 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27468 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27469 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27470 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27471 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27472 (gdb)
27473 -exec-continue
27474 ^running
27475 (gdb)
27476 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27477 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27478 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27479 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27480 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27481 (gdb)
27482 @end smallexample
27483
27484 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27485 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27486 deleted.
27487
27488 @smallexample
27489 (gdb)
27490 -break-watch C
27491 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27492 (gdb)
27493 -break-list
27494 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27495 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27496 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27497 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27498 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27499 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27500 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27501 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27502 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27503 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27504 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27505 times="1"@},
27506 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27507 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27508 (gdb)
27509 -exec-continue
27510 ^running
27511 (gdb)
27512 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27513 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27514 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27515 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27516 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27517 (gdb)
27518 -break-list
27519 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27520 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27521 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27522 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27523 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27524 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27525 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27526 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27527 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27528 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27529 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27530 times="1"@},
27531 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27532 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27533 (gdb)
27534 -exec-continue
27535 ^running
27536 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27537 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27538 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27539 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27540 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27541 (gdb)
27542 -break-list
27543 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27544 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27545 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27546 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27547 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27548 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27549 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27550 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27551 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27552 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27553 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27554 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27555 (gdb)
27556 @end smallexample
27557
27558
27559 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27560 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27561 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27562
27563 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27564 catchpoints.
27565
27566 @menu
27567 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27568 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27569 @end menu
27570
27571 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27572 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27573
27574 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27575 @findex -catch-load
27576
27577 @subsubheading Synopsis
27578
27579 @smallexample
27580 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27581 @end smallexample
27582
27583 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27584 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27585 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27586 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27587 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27588
27589
27590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27591
27592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27593
27594 @subsubheading Example
27595
27596 @smallexample
27597 -catch-load -t foo.so
27598 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27599 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27600 (gdb)
27601 @end smallexample
27602
27603
27604 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27605 @findex -catch-unload
27606
27607 @subsubheading Synopsis
27608
27609 @smallexample
27610 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27611 @end smallexample
27612
27613 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27614 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27615 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27616 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27617 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27618
27619 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27620
27621 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27622
27623 @subsubheading Example
27624
27625 @smallexample
27626 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27627 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27628 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27629 (gdb)
27630 @end smallexample
27631
27632 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27633 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27634
27635 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27636 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27637
27638 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27639 @findex -catch-assert
27640
27641 @subsubheading Synopsis
27642
27643 @smallexample
27644 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27645 @end smallexample
27646
27647 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27648
27649 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27650
27651 @table @samp
27652 @item -c @var{condition}
27653 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27654 @item -d
27655 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27656 @item -t
27657 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27658 @end table
27659
27660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27661
27662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27663
27664 @subsubheading Example
27665
27666 @smallexample
27667 -catch-assert
27668 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27669 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27670 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27671 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27672 (gdb)
27673 @end smallexample
27674
27675 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27676 @findex -catch-exception
27677
27678 @subsubheading Synopsis
27679
27680 @smallexample
27681 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27682 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27683 @end smallexample
27684
27685 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27686 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27687 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27688 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27689 catchpoints.
27690
27691 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27692
27693 @table @samp
27694 @item -c @var{condition}
27695 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27696 @item -d
27697 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27698 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27699 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27700 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27701 @item -t
27702 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27703 @item -u
27704 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27705 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27706 @end table
27707
27708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27709
27710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27711 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27712
27713 @subsubheading Example
27714
27715 @smallexample
27716 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27717 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27718 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27719 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27720 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27721 (gdb)
27722 @end smallexample
27723
27724 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27725 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27726 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27727
27728 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27729 @findex -exec-arguments
27730
27731
27732 @subsubheading Synopsis
27733
27734 @smallexample
27735 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27736 @end smallexample
27737
27738 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27739 @samp{-exec-run}.
27740
27741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27742
27743 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27744
27745 @subsubheading Example
27746
27747 @smallexample
27748 (gdb)
27749 -exec-arguments -v word
27750 ^done
27751 (gdb)
27752 @end smallexample
27753
27754
27755 @ignore
27756 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27757 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27758
27759 @subsubheading Synopsis
27760
27761 @smallexample
27762 -exec-show-arguments
27763 @end smallexample
27764
27765 Print the arguments of the program.
27766
27767 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27768
27769 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27770
27771 @subsubheading Example
27772 N.A.
27773 @end ignore
27774
27775
27776 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27777 @findex -environment-cd
27778
27779 @subsubheading Synopsis
27780
27781 @smallexample
27782 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27783 @end smallexample
27784
27785 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27786
27787 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27788
27789 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27790
27791 @subsubheading Example
27792
27793 @smallexample
27794 (gdb)
27795 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27796 ^done
27797 (gdb)
27798 @end smallexample
27799
27800
27801 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27802 @findex -environment-directory
27803
27804 @subsubheading Synopsis
27805
27806 @smallexample
27807 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27808 @end smallexample
27809
27810 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27811 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27812 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27813 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27814 occurs as normal.
27815 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27816 multiple directories in a single command
27817 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27818 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27819 If blanks are needed as
27820 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27821 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27822 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27823 character must not be used
27824 in any directory name.
27825 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27826
27827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27828
27829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27830
27831 @subsubheading Example
27832
27833 @smallexample
27834 (gdb)
27835 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27836 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27837 (gdb)
27838 -environment-directory ""
27839 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27840 (gdb)
27841 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27842 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27843 (gdb)
27844 -environment-directory -r
27845 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27846 (gdb)
27847 @end smallexample
27848
27849
27850 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27851 @findex -environment-path
27852
27853 @subsubheading Synopsis
27854
27855 @smallexample
27856 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27857 @end smallexample
27858
27859 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27860 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27861 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27862 supplied in addition to the
27863 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27864 occurs as normal.
27865 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27866 multiple directories in a single command
27867 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27868 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27869 If blanks are needed as
27870 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27871 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27872 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27873 character must not be used
27874 in any directory name.
27875 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27876
27877
27878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27879
27880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27881
27882 @subsubheading Example
27883
27884 @smallexample
27885 (gdb)
27886 -environment-path
27887 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27888 (gdb)
27889 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27890 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27891 (gdb)
27892 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27893 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27894 (gdb)
27895 @end smallexample
27896
27897
27898 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27899 @findex -environment-pwd
27900
27901 @subsubheading Synopsis
27902
27903 @smallexample
27904 -environment-pwd
27905 @end smallexample
27906
27907 Show the current working directory.
27908
27909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27910
27911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27912
27913 @subsubheading Example
27914
27915 @smallexample
27916 (gdb)
27917 -environment-pwd
27918 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27919 (gdb)
27920 @end smallexample
27921
27922 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27923 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27924 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27925
27926
27927 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27928 @findex -thread-info
27929
27930 @subsubheading Synopsis
27931
27932 @smallexample
27933 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27934 @end smallexample
27935
27936 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27937 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27938 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
27939 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
27940 current thread.
27941
27942 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27943
27944 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27945 about all threads.
27946
27947 @subsubheading Result
27948
27949 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27950 defined for a given thread:
27951
27952 @table @samp
27953 @item current
27954 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27955
27956 @item id
27957 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27958
27959 @item target-id
27960 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27961
27962 @item details
27963 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27964 field is optional.
27965
27966 @item name
27967 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27968 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27969 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27970 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27971 field is omitted.
27972
27973 @item frame
27974 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27975
27976 @item state
27977 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27978 values:
27979
27980 @table @code
27981 @item stopped
27982 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27983 threads.
27984
27985 @item running
27986 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27987 threads.
27988
27989 @end table
27990
27991 @item core
27992 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27993 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27994
27995 @end table
27996
27997 @subsubheading Example
27998
27999 @smallexample
28000 -thread-info
28001 ^done,threads=[
28002 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28003 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28004 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28005 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28006 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28007 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28008 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28009 state="running"@}],
28010 current-thread-id="1"
28011 (gdb)
28012 @end smallexample
28013
28014 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28015 @findex -thread-list-ids
28016
28017 @subsubheading Synopsis
28018
28019 @smallexample
28020 -thread-list-ids
28021 @end smallexample
28022
28023 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28024 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28025 threads.
28026
28027 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28028 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28029
28030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28031
28032 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28033
28034 @subsubheading Example
28035
28036 @smallexample
28037 (gdb)
28038 -thread-list-ids
28039 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28040 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28041 (gdb)
28042 @end smallexample
28043
28044
28045 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28046 @findex -thread-select
28047
28048 @subsubheading Synopsis
28049
28050 @smallexample
28051 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28052 @end smallexample
28053
28054 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28055 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28056 topmost frame for that thread.
28057
28058 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28059 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28060
28061 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28062
28063 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28064
28065 @subsubheading Example
28066
28067 @smallexample
28068 (gdb)
28069 -exec-next
28070 ^running
28071 (gdb)
28072 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28073 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28074 (gdb)
28075 -thread-list-ids
28076 ^done,
28077 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28078 number-of-threads="3"
28079 (gdb)
28080 -thread-select 3
28081 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28082 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28083 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28084 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28085 (gdb)
28086 @end smallexample
28087
28088 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28089 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28090 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28091
28092 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28093 @findex -ada-task-info
28094
28095 @subsubheading Synopsis
28096
28097 @smallexample
28098 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28099 @end smallexample
28100
28101 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28102 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28103
28104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28105
28106 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28107 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28108
28109 @subsubheading Result
28110
28111 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28112 defined for each Ada task:
28113
28114 @table @samp
28115 @item current
28116 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28117
28118 @item id
28119 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28120
28121 @item task-id
28122 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28123
28124 @item thread-id
28125 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28126 task.
28127
28128 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28129 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28130 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28131
28132 @item parent-id
28133 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28134 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28135
28136 @item priority
28137 The base priority of the task.
28138
28139 @item state
28140 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28141 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28142
28143 @item name
28144 The name of the task.
28145
28146 @end table
28147
28148 @subsubheading Example
28149
28150 @smallexample
28151 -ada-task-info
28152 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28153 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28154 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28155 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28156 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28157 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28158 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28159 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28160 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28161 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28162 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28163 (gdb)
28164 @end smallexample
28165
28166 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28167 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28168 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28169
28170 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28171 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28172 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28173 other cases.
28174
28175 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28176 @findex -exec-continue
28177
28178 @subsubheading Synopsis
28179
28180 @smallexample
28181 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28182 @end smallexample
28183
28184 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28185 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28186 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28187 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28188 @itemize @bullet
28189 @item
28190 breakpoints or watchpoints
28191 @item
28192 signals or exceptions
28193 @item
28194 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28195 @item
28196 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28197 @end itemize
28198 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28199 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28200 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28201 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28202 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28203 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28204
28205 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28206
28207 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28208
28209 @subsubheading Example
28210
28211 @smallexample
28212 -exec-continue
28213 ^running
28214 (gdb)
28215 @@Hello world
28216 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28217 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28218 line="13"@}
28219 (gdb)
28220 @end smallexample
28221
28222
28223 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28224 @findex -exec-finish
28225
28226 @subsubheading Synopsis
28227
28228 @smallexample
28229 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28230 @end smallexample
28231
28232 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28233 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28234 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28235 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28236 function was called.
28237
28238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28239
28240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28241
28242 @subsubheading Example
28243
28244 Function returning @code{void}.
28245
28246 @smallexample
28247 -exec-finish
28248 ^running
28249 (gdb)
28250 @@hello from foo
28251 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28252 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28253 (gdb)
28254 @end smallexample
28255
28256 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28257 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28258 value itself.
28259
28260 @smallexample
28261 -exec-finish
28262 ^running
28263 (gdb)
28264 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28265 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28266 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28267 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28268 (gdb)
28269 @end smallexample
28270
28271
28272 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28273 @findex -exec-interrupt
28274
28275 @subsubheading Synopsis
28276
28277 @smallexample
28278 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28279 @end smallexample
28280
28281 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28282 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28283 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28284 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28285 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28286
28287 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28288 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28289 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28290 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28291
28292 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28293 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28294 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28295 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28296
28297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28298
28299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28300
28301 @subsubheading Example
28302
28303 @smallexample
28304 (gdb)
28305 111-exec-continue
28306 111^running
28307
28308 (gdb)
28309 222-exec-interrupt
28310 222^done
28311 (gdb)
28312 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28313 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28314 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28315 (gdb)
28316
28317 (gdb)
28318 -exec-interrupt
28319 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28320 (gdb)
28321 @end smallexample
28322
28323 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28324 @findex -exec-jump
28325
28326 @subsubheading Synopsis
28327
28328 @smallexample
28329 -exec-jump @var{location}
28330 @end smallexample
28331
28332 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28333 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28334 different forms of @var{location}.
28335
28336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28337
28338 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28339
28340 @subsubheading Example
28341
28342 @smallexample
28343 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28344 *running,thread-id="all"
28345 ^running
28346 @end smallexample
28347
28348
28349 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28350 @findex -exec-next
28351
28352 @subsubheading Synopsis
28353
28354 @smallexample
28355 -exec-next [--reverse]
28356 @end smallexample
28357
28358 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28359 of the next source line is reached.
28360
28361 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28362 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28363 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28364 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28365 source line where the function was called.
28366
28367
28368 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28369
28370 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28371
28372 @subsubheading Example
28373
28374 @smallexample
28375 -exec-next
28376 ^running
28377 (gdb)
28378 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28379 (gdb)
28380 @end smallexample
28381
28382
28383 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28384 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28385
28386 @subsubheading Synopsis
28387
28388 @smallexample
28389 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28390 @end smallexample
28391
28392 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28393 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28394 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28395 printed as well.
28396
28397 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28398 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28399 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28400 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28401 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28402
28403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28404
28405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28406
28407 @subsubheading Example
28408
28409 @smallexample
28410 (gdb)
28411 -exec-next-instruction
28412 ^running
28413
28414 (gdb)
28415 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28416 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28417 (gdb)
28418 @end smallexample
28419
28420
28421 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28422 @findex -exec-return
28423
28424 @subsubheading Synopsis
28425
28426 @smallexample
28427 -exec-return
28428 @end smallexample
28429
28430 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28431 Displays the new current frame.
28432
28433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28434
28435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28436
28437 @subsubheading Example
28438
28439 @smallexample
28440 (gdb)
28441 200-break-insert callee4
28442 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28443 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28444 (gdb)
28445 000-exec-run
28446 000^running
28447 (gdb)
28448 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28449 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28450 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28451 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28452 (gdb)
28453 205-break-delete
28454 205^done
28455 (gdb)
28456 111-exec-return
28457 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28458 args=[@{name="strarg",
28459 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28460 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28461 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28462 (gdb)
28463 @end smallexample
28464
28465
28466 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28467 @findex -exec-run
28468
28469 @subsubheading Synopsis
28470
28471 @smallexample
28472 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28473 @end smallexample
28474
28475 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28476 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28477 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28478 the program has exited exceptionally.
28479
28480 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28481 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28482 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28483 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28484 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28485
28486 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28487 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28488 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28489 (@pxref{Starting}).
28490
28491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28492
28493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28494
28495 @subsubheading Examples
28496
28497 @smallexample
28498 (gdb)
28499 -break-insert main
28500 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28501 (gdb)
28502 -exec-run
28503 ^running
28504 (gdb)
28505 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28506 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28507 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28508 (gdb)
28509 @end smallexample
28510
28511 @noindent
28512 Program exited normally:
28513
28514 @smallexample
28515 (gdb)
28516 -exec-run
28517 ^running
28518 (gdb)
28519 x = 55
28520 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28521 (gdb)
28522 @end smallexample
28523
28524 @noindent
28525 Program exited exceptionally:
28526
28527 @smallexample
28528 (gdb)
28529 -exec-run
28530 ^running
28531 (gdb)
28532 x = 55
28533 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28534 (gdb)
28535 @end smallexample
28536
28537 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28538 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28539
28540 @smallexample
28541 (gdb)
28542 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28543 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28544 @end smallexample
28545
28546
28547 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28548
28549
28550 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28551 @findex -exec-step
28552
28553 @subsubheading Synopsis
28554
28555 @smallexample
28556 -exec-step [--reverse]
28557 @end smallexample
28558
28559 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28560 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28561 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28562 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28563 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28564 previously executed source line.
28565
28566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28567
28568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28569
28570 @subsubheading Example
28571
28572 Stepping into a function:
28573
28574 @smallexample
28575 -exec-step
28576 ^running
28577 (gdb)
28578 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28579 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28580 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28581 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28582 (gdb)
28583 @end smallexample
28584
28585 Regular stepping:
28586
28587 @smallexample
28588 -exec-step
28589 ^running
28590 (gdb)
28591 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28592 (gdb)
28593 @end smallexample
28594
28595
28596 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28597 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28598
28599 @subsubheading Synopsis
28600
28601 @smallexample
28602 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28603 @end smallexample
28604
28605 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28606 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28607 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28608 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28609 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28610 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28611 as well.
28612
28613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28614
28615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28616
28617 @subsubheading Example
28618
28619 @smallexample
28620 (gdb)
28621 -exec-step-instruction
28622 ^running
28623
28624 (gdb)
28625 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28626 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28627 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28628 (gdb)
28629 -exec-step-instruction
28630 ^running
28631
28632 (gdb)
28633 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28634 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28635 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28636 (gdb)
28637 @end smallexample
28638
28639
28640 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28641 @findex -exec-until
28642
28643 @subsubheading Synopsis
28644
28645 @smallexample
28646 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28647 @end smallexample
28648
28649 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28650 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28651 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28652 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28653
28654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28655
28656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28657
28658 @subsubheading Example
28659
28660 @smallexample
28661 (gdb)
28662 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28663 ^running
28664 (gdb)
28665 x = 55
28666 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28667 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28668 (gdb)
28669 @end smallexample
28670
28671 @ignore
28672 @subheading -file-clear
28673 Is this going away????
28674 @end ignore
28675
28676 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28677 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28678 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28679
28680 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28681 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28682
28683 @smallexample
28684 -enable-frame-filters
28685 @end smallexample
28686
28687 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28688 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28689 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28690 request that this functionality be enabled.
28691
28692 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28693
28694 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28695 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28696
28697 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28698 @findex -stack-info-frame
28699
28700 @subsubheading Synopsis
28701
28702 @smallexample
28703 -stack-info-frame
28704 @end smallexample
28705
28706 Get info on the selected frame.
28707
28708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28709
28710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28711 (without arguments).
28712
28713 @subsubheading Example
28714
28715 @smallexample
28716 (gdb)
28717 -stack-info-frame
28718 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28719 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28720 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28721 (gdb)
28722 @end smallexample
28723
28724 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28725 @findex -stack-info-depth
28726
28727 @subsubheading Synopsis
28728
28729 @smallexample
28730 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28731 @end smallexample
28732
28733 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28734 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28735
28736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28737
28738 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28739
28740 @subsubheading Example
28741
28742 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28743
28744 @smallexample
28745 (gdb)
28746 -stack-info-depth
28747 ^done,depth="12"
28748 (gdb)
28749 -stack-info-depth 4
28750 ^done,depth="4"
28751 (gdb)
28752 -stack-info-depth 12
28753 ^done,depth="12"
28754 (gdb)
28755 -stack-info-depth 11
28756 ^done,depth="11"
28757 (gdb)
28758 -stack-info-depth 13
28759 ^done,depth="12"
28760 (gdb)
28761 @end smallexample
28762
28763 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28764 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28765 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28766
28767 @subsubheading Synopsis
28768
28769 @smallexample
28770 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28771 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28772 @end smallexample
28773
28774 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28775 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28776 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28777 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28778 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28779 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28780 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28781 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28782
28783 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28784 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28785 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28786 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28787 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28788 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28789
28790 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28791 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28792 are still displayed, however.
28793
28794 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28795 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28796
28797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28798
28799 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28800 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28801 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28802
28803 @subsubheading Example
28804
28805 @smallexample
28806 (gdb)
28807 -stack-list-frames
28808 ^done,
28809 stack=[
28810 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28811 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28812 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28813 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28814 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28815 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28816 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28817 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28818 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28819 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28820 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28821 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28822 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28823 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28824 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28825 (gdb)
28826 -stack-list-arguments 0
28827 ^done,
28828 stack-args=[
28829 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28830 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28831 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28832 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28833 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28834 (gdb)
28835 -stack-list-arguments 1
28836 ^done,
28837 stack-args=[
28838 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28839 frame=@{level="1",
28840 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28841 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28842 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28843 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28844 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28845 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28846 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28847 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28848 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28849 (gdb)
28850 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28851 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28852 (gdb)
28853 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28854 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28855 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28856 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28857 (gdb)
28858 @end smallexample
28859
28860 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28861
28862
28863 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28864 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28865 @findex -stack-list-frames
28866
28867 @subsubheading Synopsis
28868
28869 @smallexample
28870 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28871 @end smallexample
28872
28873 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28874 following info:
28875
28876 @table @samp
28877 @item @var{level}
28878 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28879 @item @var{addr}
28880 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28881 @item @var{func}
28882 Function name.
28883 @item @var{file}
28884 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28885 @item @var{fullname}
28886 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28887 @item @var{line}
28888 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28889 @item @var{from}
28890 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28891 if the frame's function is not known.
28892 @end table
28893
28894 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28895 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28896 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28897 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28898 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28899 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28900 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28901 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28902 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28903
28904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28905
28906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28907
28908 @subsubheading Example
28909
28910 Full stack backtrace:
28911
28912 @smallexample
28913 (gdb)
28914 -stack-list-frames
28915 ^done,stack=
28916 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28917 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28918 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28919 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28920 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28921 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28922 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28923 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28924 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28925 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28926 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28927 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28928 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28929 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28930 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28931 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28932 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28933 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28934 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28935 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28936 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28937 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28938 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28939 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28940 (gdb)
28941 @end smallexample
28942
28943 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28944
28945 @smallexample
28946 (gdb)
28947 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28948 ^done,stack=
28949 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28950 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28951 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28952 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28953 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28954 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28955 (gdb)
28956 @end smallexample
28957
28958 Show a single frame:
28959
28960 @smallexample
28961 (gdb)
28962 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28963 ^done,stack=
28964 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28965 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28966 (gdb)
28967 @end smallexample
28968
28969
28970 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28971 @findex -stack-list-locals
28972 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28973
28974 @subsubheading Synopsis
28975
28976 @smallexample
28977 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28978 @end smallexample
28979
28980 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28981 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28982 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28983 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28984 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28985 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28986 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28987 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28988 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28989 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28990
28991 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28992 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28993 variables are still displayed, however.
28994
28995 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28996 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28997
28998 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28999
29000 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29001
29002 @subsubheading Example
29003
29004 @smallexample
29005 (gdb)
29006 -stack-list-locals 0
29007 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29008 (gdb)
29009 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29010 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29011 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29012 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29013 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29014 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29015 (gdb)
29016 @end smallexample
29017
29018 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29019 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29020 @findex -stack-list-variables
29021
29022 @subsubheading Synopsis
29023
29024 @smallexample
29025 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29026 @end smallexample
29027
29028 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29029 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29030 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29031 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29032 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29033 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29034 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29035
29036 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29037 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29038 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29039
29040 @subsubheading Example
29041
29042 @smallexample
29043 (gdb)
29044 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29045 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29046 (gdb)
29047 @end smallexample
29048
29049
29050 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29051 @findex -stack-select-frame
29052
29053 @subsubheading Synopsis
29054
29055 @smallexample
29056 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29057 @end smallexample
29058
29059 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29060 the stack.
29061
29062 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29063 option to every command.
29064
29065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29066
29067 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29068 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29069
29070 @subsubheading Example
29071
29072 @smallexample
29073 (gdb)
29074 -stack-select-frame 2
29075 ^done
29076 (gdb)
29077 @end smallexample
29078
29079 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29080 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29081 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29082
29083 @ignore
29084
29085 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29086
29087 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29088 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29089 used by @code{Insight}.
29090
29091 The two main reasons for that are:
29092
29093 @enumerate 1
29094 @item
29095 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29096
29097 @item
29098 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29099 now).
29100 @end enumerate
29101
29102 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29103 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29104 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29105 hints about their use.
29106
29107 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29108 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29109 least, the following operations:
29110
29111 @itemize @bullet
29112 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29113 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29114 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29115 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29116 @end itemize
29117
29118 @end ignore
29119
29120 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29121
29122 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29123
29124 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29125 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29126 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29127 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29128 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29129 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29130 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29131 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29132 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29133 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29134 object, or to change display format.
29135
29136 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29137 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29138 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29139 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29140 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29141 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29142 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29143 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29144 child will be created.
29145
29146 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29147 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29148 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29149 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29150 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29151
29152 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29153 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29154 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29155 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29156 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29157 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29158 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29159 variables that frontend has created.
29160
29161 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29162 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29163 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29164 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29165 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29166 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29167 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29168 implicitly updated.
29169
29170 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29171 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29172 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29173 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29174 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29175 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29176 frame. Consider this example:
29177
29178 @smallexample
29179 void do_work(...)
29180 @{
29181 struct work_state state;
29182
29183 if (...)
29184 do_work(...);
29185 @}
29186 @end smallexample
29187
29188 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29189 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29190 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29191 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29192 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29193
29194 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29195 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29196 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29197 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29198 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29199 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29200
29201 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29202 access this functionality:
29203
29204 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29205 @item @strong{Operation}
29206 @tab @strong{Description}
29207
29208 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29209 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29210 @item @code{-var-create}
29211 @tab create a variable object
29212 @item @code{-var-delete}
29213 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29214 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29215 @tab set the display format of this variable
29216 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29217 @tab show the display format of this variable
29218 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29219 @tab tells how many children this object has
29220 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29221 @tab return a list of the object's children
29222 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29223 @tab show the type of this variable object
29224 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29225 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29226 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29227 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29228 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29229 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29230 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29231 @tab get the value of this variable
29232 @item @code{-var-assign}
29233 @tab set the value of this variable
29234 @item @code{-var-update}
29235 @tab update the variable and its children
29236 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29237 @tab set frozeness attribute
29238 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29239 @tab set range of children to display on update
29240 @end multitable
29241
29242 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29243 how it can be used.
29244
29245 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29246
29247 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29248 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29249
29250 @smallexample
29251 -enable-pretty-printing
29252 @end smallexample
29253
29254 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29255 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29256 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29257 request that this functionality be enabled.
29258
29259 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29260
29261 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29262 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29263
29264 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29265 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29266
29267 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29268 @findex -var-create
29269
29270 @subsubheading Synopsis
29271
29272 @smallexample
29273 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29274 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29275 @end smallexample
29276
29277 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29278 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29279 register.
29280
29281 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29282 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29283 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29284 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29285 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29286
29287 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29288 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29289 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29290 object must be created.
29291
29292 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29293 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29294
29295 @itemize @bullet
29296 @item
29297 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29298
29299 @item
29300 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29301
29302 @item
29303 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29304 @end itemize
29305
29306 @cindex dynamic varobj
29307 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29308 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29309 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29310 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29311 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29312 compatibility for existing clients.
29313
29314 @subsubheading Result
29315
29316 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29317 are:
29318
29319 @table @samp
29320 @item name
29321 The name of the varobj.
29322
29323 @item numchild
29324 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29325 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29326 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29327
29328 @item value
29329 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29330 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29331 will not be interesting.
29332
29333 @item type
29334 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29335 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29336 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29337 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29338 @emph{declared} one.
29339
29340 @item thread-id
29341 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29342 thread's global identifier.
29343
29344 @item has_more
29345 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29346 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29347
29348 @item dynamic
29349 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29350 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29351 then this attribute will not be present.
29352
29353 @item displayhint
29354 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29355 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29356 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29357 @end table
29358
29359 Typical output will look like this:
29360
29361 @smallexample
29362 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29363 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29364 @end smallexample
29365
29366
29367 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29368 @findex -var-delete
29369
29370 @subsubheading Synopsis
29371
29372 @smallexample
29373 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29374 @end smallexample
29375
29376 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29377 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29378
29379 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29380
29381
29382 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29383 @findex -var-set-format
29384
29385 @subsubheading Synopsis
29386
29387 @smallexample
29388 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29389 @end smallexample
29390
29391 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29392 @var{format-spec}.
29393
29394 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29395 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29399 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29400 @end smallexample
29401
29402 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29403 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29404 for pointers, etc.).
29405
29406 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29407 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29408 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29409 zero-hexadecimal format.
29410
29411 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29412 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29413
29414 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29415 @findex -var-show-format
29416
29417 @subsubheading Synopsis
29418
29419 @smallexample
29420 -var-show-format @var{name}
29421 @end smallexample
29422
29423 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29424
29425 @smallexample
29426 @var{format} @expansion{}
29427 @var{format-spec}
29428 @end smallexample
29429
29430
29431 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29432 @findex -var-info-num-children
29433
29434 @subsubheading Synopsis
29435
29436 @smallexample
29437 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29438 @end smallexample
29439
29440 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29441
29442 @smallexample
29443 numchild=@var{n}
29444 @end smallexample
29445
29446 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29447 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29448 be available.
29449
29450
29451 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29452 @findex -var-list-children
29453
29454 @subsubheading Synopsis
29455
29456 @smallexample
29457 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29458 @end smallexample
29459 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29460
29461 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29462 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29463 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29464 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29465 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29466 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29467 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29468 and unions.
29469
29470 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29471 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29472 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29473 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29474 reported.
29475
29476 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29477 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29478 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29479 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29480 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29481 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29482 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29483 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29484 the visible items.
29485
29486 For each child the following results are returned:
29487
29488 @table @var
29489
29490 @item name
29491 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29492
29493 @item exp
29494 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29495 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29496
29497 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29498 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29499
29500 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29501 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29502 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29503 type and value are not present.
29504
29505 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29506 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29507 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29508
29509 @item numchild
29510 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29511 0.
29512
29513 @item type
29514 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29515 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29516 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29517 @emph{declared} one.
29518
29519 @item value
29520 If values were requested, this is the value.
29521
29522 @item thread-id
29523 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29524 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29525
29526 @item frozen
29527 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29528
29529 @item displayhint
29530 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29531 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29532 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29533
29534 @item dynamic
29535 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29536 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29537 then this attribute will not be present.
29538
29539 @end table
29540
29541 The result may have its own attributes:
29542
29543 @table @samp
29544 @item displayhint
29545 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29546 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29547 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29548
29549 @item has_more
29550 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29551 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29552 @end table
29553
29554 @subsubheading Example
29555
29556 @smallexample
29557 (gdb)
29558 -var-list-children n
29559 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29560 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29561 (gdb)
29562 -var-list-children --all-values n
29563 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29564 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29565 @end smallexample
29566
29567
29568 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29569 @findex -var-info-type
29570
29571 @subsubheading Synopsis
29572
29573 @smallexample
29574 -var-info-type @var{name}
29575 @end smallexample
29576
29577 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29578 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29579 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29580
29581 @smallexample
29582 type=@var{typename}
29583 @end smallexample
29584
29585
29586 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29587 @findex -var-info-expression
29588
29589 @subsubheading Synopsis
29590
29591 @smallexample
29592 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29593 @end smallexample
29594
29595 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29596 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29597 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29598
29599 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29600 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29601
29602 @smallexample
29603 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29604 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29605 @end smallexample
29606
29607 @noindent
29608 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29609 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29610
29611 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29612 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29613 is of limited use.
29614
29615 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29616 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29617
29618 @subsubheading Synopsis
29619
29620 @smallexample
29621 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29622 @end smallexample
29623
29624 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29625 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29626 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29627 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29628 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29629 watchpoint from a variable object.
29630
29631 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29632 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29633
29634 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29635 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29636 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29637 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29638 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29639 @smallexample
29640 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29641 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29642 @end smallexample
29643
29644 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29645 @findex -var-show-attributes
29646
29647 @subsubheading Synopsis
29648
29649 @smallexample
29650 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29651 @end smallexample
29652
29653 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29654
29655 @smallexample
29656 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29657 @end smallexample
29658
29659 @noindent
29660 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29661
29662 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29663 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29664
29665 @subsubheading Synopsis
29666
29667 @smallexample
29668 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29669 @end smallexample
29670
29671 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29672 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29673 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29674 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29675 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29676 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29677 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29678
29679 @smallexample
29680 value=@var{value}
29681 @end smallexample
29682
29683 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29684 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29685
29686 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29687 @findex -var-assign
29688
29689 @subsubheading Synopsis
29690
29691 @smallexample
29692 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29693 @end smallexample
29694
29695 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29696 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29697 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29698 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29699
29700 @subsubheading Example
29701
29702 @smallexample
29703 (gdb)
29704 -var-assign var1 3
29705 ^done,value="3"
29706 (gdb)
29707 -var-update *
29708 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29709 (gdb)
29710 @end smallexample
29711
29712 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29713 @findex -var-update
29714
29715 @subsubheading Synopsis
29716
29717 @smallexample
29718 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29719 @end smallexample
29720
29721 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29722 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29723 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29724 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29725 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29726 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29727 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29728 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29729 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29730 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29731 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29732 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29733 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29734
29735 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29736 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29737 diagnostic.
29738
29739 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29740 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29741
29742 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29743 @samp{changelist}.
29744
29745 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29746
29747 @table @samp
29748 @item name
29749 The name of the varobj.
29750
29751 @item value
29752 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29753 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29754
29755 @item in_scope
29756 @anchor{-var-update}
29757 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29758
29759 @table @code
29760 @item "true"
29761 The variable object's current value is valid.
29762
29763 @item "false"
29764 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29765 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29766 scope.
29767
29768 @item "invalid"
29769 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29770 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29771 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29772 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29773 objects.
29774 @end table
29775
29776 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29777 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29778
29779 @item type_changed
29780 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29781 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29782 be @samp{false}.
29783
29784 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29785 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29786 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29787 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29788 unset.
29789
29790 @item new_type
29791 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29792 hold the new type.
29793
29794 @item new_num_children
29795 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29796 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29797
29798 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29799 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29800 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29801 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29802 children which may be available.
29803
29804 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29805 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29806 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29807 only happen at the end of the update range).
29808
29809 @item displayhint
29810 The display hint, if any.
29811
29812 @item has_more
29813 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29814 available outside the varobj's update range.
29815
29816 @item dynamic
29817 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29818 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29819 then this attribute will not be present.
29820
29821 @item new_children
29822 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29823 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29824 be listed in this attribute.
29825 @end table
29826
29827 @subsubheading Example
29828
29829 @smallexample
29830 (gdb)
29831 -var-assign var1 3
29832 ^done,value="3"
29833 (gdb)
29834 -var-update --all-values var1
29835 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29836 type_changed="false"@}]
29837 (gdb)
29838 @end smallexample
29839
29840 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29841 @findex -var-set-frozen
29842 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29843
29844 @subsubheading Synopsis
29845
29846 @smallexample
29847 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29848 @end smallexample
29849
29850 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29851 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29852 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29853 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29854 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29855 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29856 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29857 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29858 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29859 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29860 @code{-var-update} does.
29861
29862 @subsubheading Example
29863
29864 @smallexample
29865 (gdb)
29866 -var-set-frozen V 1
29867 ^done
29868 (gdb)
29869 @end smallexample
29870
29871 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29872 @findex -var-set-update-range
29873 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29874
29875 @subsubheading Synopsis
29876
29877 @smallexample
29878 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29879 @end smallexample
29880
29881 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29882 @code{-var-update}.
29883
29884 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29885 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29886 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29887 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29888
29889 @subsubheading Example
29890
29891 @smallexample
29892 (gdb)
29893 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29894 ^done
29895 @end smallexample
29896
29897 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29898 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29899 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29900
29901 @subsubheading Synopsis
29902
29903 @smallexample
29904 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29905 @end smallexample
29906
29907 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29908
29909 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29910 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29911
29912 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29913 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29914 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29915 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29916 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29917 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29918 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29919
29920 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29921 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29922 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29923 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29924
29925 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29926 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29927 can be used to check this.
29928
29929 @subsubheading Example
29930
29931 Resetting the visualizer:
29932
29933 @smallexample
29934 (gdb)
29935 -var-set-visualizer V None
29936 ^done
29937 @end smallexample
29938
29939 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29940
29941 @smallexample
29942 (gdb)
29943 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29944 ^done
29945 @end smallexample
29946
29947 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29948 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29949
29950 @smallexample
29951 (gdb)
29952 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29953 ^done
29954 @end smallexample
29955
29956 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29957 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29958 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29959
29960 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29961 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29962 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29963 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29964
29965 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29966 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29967
29968 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29969 @c @subheading -data-assign
29970 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29971 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29972 @c set variable
29973 @c @subsubheading Example
29974 @c N.A.
29975
29976 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29977 @findex -data-disassemble
29978
29979 @subsubheading Synopsis
29980
29981 @smallexample
29982 -data-disassemble
29983 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29984 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29985 -- @var{mode}
29986 @end smallexample
29987
29988 @noindent
29989 Where:
29990
29991 @table @samp
29992 @item @var{start-addr}
29993 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29994 @item @var{end-addr}
29995 is the end address
29996 @item @var{filename}
29997 is the name of the file to disassemble
29998 @item @var{linenum}
29999 is the line number to disassemble around
30000 @item @var{lines}
30001 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30002 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30003 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30004 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30005 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30006 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30007 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30008 are displayed.
30009 @item @var{mode}
30010 is one of:
30011 @itemize @bullet
30012 @item 0 disassembly only
30013 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30014 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30015 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30016 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30017 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30018 @end itemize
30019
30020 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30021 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30022 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30023 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30024 @end table
30025
30026 @subsubheading Result
30027
30028 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30029 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30030 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30031
30032 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30033 following fields:
30034
30035 @table @code
30036 @item address
30037 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30038
30039 @item func-name
30040 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30041
30042 @item offset
30043 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30044
30045 @item inst
30046 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30047
30048 @item opcodes
30049 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30050 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30051
30052 @end table
30053
30054 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30055 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30056
30057 @table @code
30058 @item line
30059 The line number within @samp{file}.
30060
30061 @item file
30062 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30063 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30064 used.
30065
30066 @item fullname
30067 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30068 using the source file search path
30069 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30070 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30071
30072 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30073 present in the debug information.
30074
30075 @item line_asm_insn
30076 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30077 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30078 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30079 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30080 @samp{opcodes}.
30081
30082 @end table
30083
30084 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30085 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30086 adjust its format.
30087
30088 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30089
30090 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30091
30092 @subsubheading Example
30093
30094 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30095
30096 @smallexample
30097 (gdb)
30098 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30099 ^done,
30100 asm_insns=[
30101 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30102 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30103 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30104 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30105 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30106 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30107 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30108 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30109 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30110 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30111 (gdb)
30112 @end smallexample
30113
30114 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30115 @code{main}.
30116
30117 @smallexample
30118 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30119 ^done,asm_insns=[
30120 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30121 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30122 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30123 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30124 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30125 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30126 [@dots{}]
30127 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30128 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30129 (gdb)
30130 @end smallexample
30131
30132 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30133
30134 @smallexample
30135 (gdb)
30136 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30137 ^done,asm_insns=[
30138 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30139 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30140 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30141 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30142 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30143 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30144 (gdb)
30145 @end smallexample
30146
30147 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30148
30149 @smallexample
30150 (gdb)
30151 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30152 ^done,asm_insns=[
30153 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30154 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30155 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30156 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30157 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30158 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30159 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30160 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30161 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30162 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30163 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30164 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30165 (gdb)
30166 @end smallexample
30167
30168
30169 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30170 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30171
30172 @subsubheading Synopsis
30173
30174 @smallexample
30175 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30176 @end smallexample
30177
30178 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30179 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30180 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30181
30182 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30183
30184 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30185 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30186 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30187
30188 @subsubheading Example
30189
30190 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30191 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30192 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30193 output.
30194
30195 @smallexample
30196 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30197 211^done,value="1"
30198 (gdb)
30199 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30200 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30201 (gdb)
30202 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30203 411^done,value="4"
30204 (gdb)
30205 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30206 511^done,value="4"
30207 (gdb)
30208 @end smallexample
30209
30210
30211 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30212 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30213
30214 @subsubheading Synopsis
30215
30216 @smallexample
30217 -data-list-changed-registers
30218 @end smallexample
30219
30220 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30221
30222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30223
30224 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30225 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30226
30227 @subsubheading Example
30228
30229 On a PPC MBX board:
30230
30231 @smallexample
30232 (gdb)
30233 -exec-continue
30234 ^running
30235
30236 (gdb)
30237 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30238 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30239 line="5"@}
30240 (gdb)
30241 -data-list-changed-registers
30242 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30243 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30244 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30245 (gdb)
30246 @end smallexample
30247
30248
30249 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30250 @findex -data-list-register-names
30251
30252 @subsubheading Synopsis
30253
30254 @smallexample
30255 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30256 @end smallexample
30257
30258 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30259 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30260 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30261 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30262 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30263 include empty register names.
30264
30265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30266
30267 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30268 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30269 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30270
30271 @subsubheading Example
30272
30273 For the PPC MBX board:
30274 @smallexample
30275 (gdb)
30276 -data-list-register-names
30277 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30278 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30279 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30280 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30281 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30282 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30283 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30284 (gdb)
30285 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30286 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30287 (gdb)
30288 @end smallexample
30289
30290 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30291 @findex -data-list-register-values
30292
30293 @subsubheading Synopsis
30294
30295 @smallexample
30296 -data-list-register-values
30297 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30298 @end smallexample
30299
30300 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30301 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30302 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30303 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30304 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30305 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30306
30307 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30308
30309 @table @code
30310 @item x
30311 Hexadecimal
30312 @item o
30313 Octal
30314 @item t
30315 Binary
30316 @item d
30317 Decimal
30318 @item r
30319 Raw
30320 @item N
30321 Natural
30322 @end table
30323
30324 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30325
30326 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30327 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30328
30329 @subsubheading Example
30330
30331 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30332 don't appear in the actual output):
30333
30334 @smallexample
30335 (gdb)
30336 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30337 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30338 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30339 (gdb)
30340 -data-list-register-values x
30341 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30342 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30343 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30344 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30345 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30346 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30347 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30348 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30349 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30350 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30351 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30352 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30353 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30354 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30355 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30356 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30357 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30358 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30359 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30360 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30361 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30362 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30363 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30364 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30365 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30366 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30367 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30368 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30369 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30370 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30371 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30372 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30373 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30374 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30375 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30376 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30377 (gdb)
30378 @end smallexample
30379
30380
30381 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30382 @findex -data-read-memory
30383
30384 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30385
30386 @subsubheading Synopsis
30387
30388 @smallexample
30389 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30390 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30391 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30392 @end smallexample
30393
30394 @noindent
30395 where:
30396
30397 @table @samp
30398 @item @var{address}
30399 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30400 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30401 quoted using the C convention.
30402
30403 @item @var{word-format}
30404 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30405 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30406 ,Output Formats}).
30407
30408 @item @var{word-size}
30409 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30410
30411 @item @var{nr-rows}
30412 The number of rows in the output table.
30413
30414 @item @var{nr-cols}
30415 The number of columns in the output table.
30416
30417 @item @var{aschar}
30418 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30419 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30420 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30421 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30422
30423 @item @var{byte-offset}
30424 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30425 @end table
30426
30427 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30428 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30429 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30430 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30431 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30432 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30433 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30434 @samp{addr}.
30435
30436 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30437 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30438 @samp{prev-page}.
30439
30440 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30441
30442 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30443 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30444
30445 @subsubheading Example
30446
30447 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30448 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30449 word. Display each word in hex.
30450
30451 @smallexample
30452 (gdb)
30453 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30454 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30455 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30456 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30457 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30458 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30459 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30460 (gdb)
30461 @end smallexample
30462
30463 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30464 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30465
30466 @smallexample
30467 (gdb)
30468 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30469 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30470 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30471 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30472 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30473 (gdb)
30474 @end smallexample
30475
30476 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30477 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30478 used as the non-printable character.
30479
30480 @smallexample
30481 (gdb)
30482 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30483 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30484 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30485 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30486 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30487 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30488 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30489 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30490 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30491 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30492 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30493 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30494 (gdb)
30495 @end smallexample
30496
30497 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30498 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30499
30500 @subsubheading Synopsis
30501
30502 @smallexample
30503 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30504 @var{address} @var{count}
30505 @end smallexample
30506
30507 @noindent
30508 where:
30509
30510 @table @samp
30511 @item @var{address}
30512 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30513 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30514 quoted using the C convention.
30515
30516 @item @var{count}
30517 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30518 literal.
30519
30520 @item @var{offset}
30521 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30522 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30523 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30524 arithmetics itself.
30525
30526 @end table
30527
30528 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30529 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30530 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30531 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30532 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30533 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30534
30535 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30536 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30537 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30538 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30539 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30540 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30541 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30542 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30543
30544 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30545 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30546 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30547 and has the following fields:
30548
30549 @table @code
30550 @item begin
30551 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30552
30553 @item end
30554 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30555
30556 @item offset
30557 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30558 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30559
30560 @item contents
30561 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30562
30563 @end table
30564
30565
30566
30567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30568
30569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30570
30571 @subsubheading Example
30572
30573 @smallexample
30574 (gdb)
30575 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30576 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30577 end="0xbffff15e",
30578 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30579 (gdb)
30580 @end smallexample
30581
30582
30583 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30584 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30585
30586 @subsubheading Synopsis
30587
30588 @smallexample
30589 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30590 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30591 @end smallexample
30592
30593 @noindent
30594 where:
30595
30596 @table @samp
30597 @item @var{address}
30598 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30599 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30600 be quoted using the C convention.
30601
30602 @item @var{contents}
30603 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30604 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30605
30606 @item @var{count}
30607 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30608 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30609 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30610 @var{count} memory units.
30611
30612 @end table
30613
30614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30615
30616 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30617
30618 @subsubheading Example
30619
30620 @smallexample
30621 (gdb)
30622 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30623 ^done
30624 (gdb)
30625 @end smallexample
30626
30627 @smallexample
30628 (gdb)
30629 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30630 ^done
30631 (gdb)
30632 @end smallexample
30633
30634 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30635 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30636 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30637
30638 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30639 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30640
30641 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30642 @findex -trace-find
30643
30644 @subsubheading Synopsis
30645
30646 @smallexample
30647 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30648 @end smallexample
30649
30650 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30651 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30652 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30653
30654 @table @samp
30655
30656 @item none
30657 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30658
30659 @item frame-number
30660 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30661 that index.
30662
30663 @item tracepoint-number
30664 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30665 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30666
30667 @item pc
30668 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30669 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30670 address.
30671
30672 @item pc-inside-range
30673 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30674 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30675 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30676
30677 @item pc-outside-range
30678 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30679 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30680 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30681
30682 @item line
30683 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30684 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30685 the specified location.
30686
30687 @end table
30688
30689 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30690 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30691
30692 @table @samp
30693 @item found
30694 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30695 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30696
30697 @item traceframe
30698 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30699 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30700
30701 @item tracepoint
30702 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30703 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30704
30705 @item frame
30706 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30707 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30708 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30709
30710 @end table
30711
30712 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30713
30714 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30715
30716 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30717 @findex -trace-define-variable
30718
30719 @subsubheading Synopsis
30720
30721 @smallexample
30722 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30723 @end smallexample
30724
30725 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30726 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30727 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30728 with the @samp{$} character.
30729
30730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30731
30732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30733
30734 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30735 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30736
30737 @subsubheading Synopsis
30738
30739 @smallexample
30740 -trace-frame-collected
30741 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30742 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30743 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30744 [--memory-contents]
30745 @end smallexample
30746
30747 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30748 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30749 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30750 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30751 See the output description table below for more details.
30752
30753 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30754 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30755 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30756 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30757 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30758
30759 For instance, if the actions were
30760 @smallexample
30761 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30762 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30763 @end smallexample
30764
30765 @noindent
30766 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30767 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30768 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30769 objects would be computed expressions.
30770
30771 An example output would be:
30772
30773 @smallexample
30774 (gdb)
30775 -trace-frame-collected
30776 ^done,
30777 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30778 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30779 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30780 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30781 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30782 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30783 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30784 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30785 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30786 ...
30787 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30788 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30789 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30790 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30791 (gdb)
30792 @end smallexample
30793
30794 Where:
30795
30796 @table @code
30797 @item explicit-variables
30798 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30799 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30800 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30801 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30802 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30803 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30804 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30805 arrays, structures and unions.
30806
30807 @item computed-expressions
30808 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30809 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30810 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30811 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30812
30813 @item registers
30814 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30815 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30816 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30817 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30818 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30819
30820 @item tvars
30821 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30822 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30823 current value are returned.
30824
30825 @item memory
30826 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30827 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30828 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30829
30830 @table @code
30831 @item address
30832 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30833
30834 @item length
30835 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30836
30837 @item contents
30838 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30839 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30840
30841 @end table
30842
30843 @end table
30844
30845 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30846
30847 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30848
30849 @subsubheading Example
30850
30851 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30852 @findex -trace-list-variables
30853
30854 @subsubheading Synopsis
30855
30856 @smallexample
30857 -trace-list-variables
30858 @end smallexample
30859
30860 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30861 table has the following fields:
30862
30863 @table @samp
30864 @item name
30865 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30866
30867 @item initial
30868 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30869 field is always present.
30870
30871 @item current
30872 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30873 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30874 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30875 presently running.
30876
30877 @end table
30878
30879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30880
30881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30882
30883 @subsubheading Example
30884
30885 @smallexample
30886 (gdb)
30887 -trace-list-variables
30888 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30889 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30890 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30891 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30892 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30893 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30894 (gdb)
30895 @end smallexample
30896
30897 @subheading -trace-save
30898 @findex -trace-save
30899
30900 @subsubheading Synopsis
30901
30902 @smallexample
30903 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30904 @end smallexample
30905
30906 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30907 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30908 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30909 to perform the save.
30910
30911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30912
30913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30914
30915
30916 @subheading -trace-start
30917 @findex -trace-start
30918
30919 @subsubheading Synopsis
30920
30921 @smallexample
30922 -trace-start
30923 @end smallexample
30924
30925 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30926 have any fields.
30927
30928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30929
30930 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30931
30932 @subheading -trace-status
30933 @findex -trace-status
30934
30935 @subsubheading Synopsis
30936
30937 @smallexample
30938 -trace-status
30939 @end smallexample
30940
30941 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30942 the following fields:
30943
30944 @table @samp
30945
30946 @item supported
30947 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30948 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30949 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30950 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30951 started. This field is always present.
30952
30953 @item running
30954 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30955 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30956 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30957
30958 @item stop-reason
30959 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30960 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30961 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30962 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30963 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30964 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30965 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30966 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30967 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30968
30969 @item stopping-tracepoint
30970 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30971 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30972 @samp{passcount}.
30973
30974 @item frames
30975 @itemx frames-created
30976 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30977 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30978 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30979 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30980
30981 @item buffer-size
30982 @itemx buffer-free
30983 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30984 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30985
30986 @item circular
30987 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30988 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30989 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30990 and may fill up.
30991
30992 @item disconnected
30993 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30994 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30995 that the trace run will stop.
30996
30997 @item trace-file
30998 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30999 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31000
31001 @end table
31002
31003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31004
31005 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31006
31007 @subheading -trace-stop
31008 @findex -trace-stop
31009
31010 @subsubheading Synopsis
31011
31012 @smallexample
31013 -trace-stop
31014 @end smallexample
31015
31016 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31017 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31018 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31019
31020 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31021
31022 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31023
31024
31025 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31026 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31027 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31028
31029
31030 @ignore
31031 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31032 @findex -symbol-info-address
31033
31034 @subsubheading Synopsis
31035
31036 @smallexample
31037 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31038 @end smallexample
31039
31040 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31041
31042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31043
31044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31045
31046 @subsubheading Example
31047 N.A.
31048
31049
31050 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31051 @findex -symbol-info-file
31052
31053 @subsubheading Synopsis
31054
31055 @smallexample
31056 -symbol-info-file
31057 @end smallexample
31058
31059 Show the file for the symbol.
31060
31061 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31062
31063 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31064 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31065
31066 @subsubheading Example
31067 N.A.
31068
31069
31070 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31071 @findex -symbol-info-function
31072
31073 @subsubheading Synopsis
31074
31075 @smallexample
31076 -symbol-info-function
31077 @end smallexample
31078
31079 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31080
31081 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31082
31083 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31084
31085 @subsubheading Example
31086 N.A.
31087
31088
31089 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31090 @findex -symbol-info-line
31091
31092 @subsubheading Synopsis
31093
31094 @smallexample
31095 -symbol-info-line
31096 @end smallexample
31097
31098 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31099
31100 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31101
31102 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31103 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31104
31105 @subsubheading Example
31106 N.A.
31107
31108
31109 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31110 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31111
31112 @subsubheading Synopsis
31113
31114 @smallexample
31115 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31116 @end smallexample
31117
31118 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31119
31120 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31121
31122 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31123
31124 @subsubheading Example
31125 N.A.
31126
31127
31128 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31129 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31130
31131 @subsubheading Synopsis
31132
31133 @smallexample
31134 -symbol-list-functions
31135 @end smallexample
31136
31137 List the functions in the executable.
31138
31139 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31140
31141 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31142 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31143
31144 @subsubheading Example
31145 N.A.
31146 @end ignore
31147
31148
31149 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31150 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31151
31152 @subsubheading Synopsis
31153
31154 @smallexample
31155 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31156 @end smallexample
31157
31158 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31159 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31160 ascending PC order.
31161
31162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31163
31164 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31165
31166 @subsubheading Example
31167 @smallexample
31168 (gdb)
31169 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31170 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31171 (gdb)
31172 @end smallexample
31173
31174
31175 @ignore
31176 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31177 @findex -symbol-list-types
31178
31179 @subsubheading Synopsis
31180
31181 @smallexample
31182 -symbol-list-types
31183 @end smallexample
31184
31185 List all the type names.
31186
31187 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31188
31189 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31190 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31191
31192 @subsubheading Example
31193 N.A.
31194
31195
31196 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31197 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31198
31199 @subsubheading Synopsis
31200
31201 @smallexample
31202 -symbol-list-variables
31203 @end smallexample
31204
31205 List all the global and static variable names.
31206
31207 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31208
31209 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31210
31211 @subsubheading Example
31212 N.A.
31213
31214
31215 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31216 @findex -symbol-locate
31217
31218 @subsubheading Synopsis
31219
31220 @smallexample
31221 -symbol-locate
31222 @end smallexample
31223
31224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31225
31226 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31227
31228 @subsubheading Example
31229 N.A.
31230
31231
31232 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31233 @findex -symbol-type
31234
31235 @subsubheading Synopsis
31236
31237 @smallexample
31238 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31239 @end smallexample
31240
31241 Show type of @var{variable}.
31242
31243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31244
31245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31246 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31247
31248 @subsubheading Example
31249 N.A.
31250 @end ignore
31251
31252
31253 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31254 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31255 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31256
31257 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31258 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31259
31260 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31261 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31262
31263 @subsubheading Synopsis
31264
31265 @smallexample
31266 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31267 @end smallexample
31268
31269 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31270 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31271 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31272 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31273 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31274 notification.
31275
31276 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31277
31278 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31279
31280 @subsubheading Example
31281
31282 @smallexample
31283 (gdb)
31284 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31285 ^done
31286 (gdb)
31287 @end smallexample
31288
31289
31290 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31291 @findex -file-exec-file
31292
31293 @subsubheading Synopsis
31294
31295 @smallexample
31296 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31297 @end smallexample
31298
31299 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31300 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31301 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31302 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31303 notification.
31304
31305 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31306
31307 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31308
31309 @subsubheading Example
31310
31311 @smallexample
31312 (gdb)
31313 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31314 ^done
31315 (gdb)
31316 @end smallexample
31317
31318
31319 @ignore
31320 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31321 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31322
31323 @subsubheading Synopsis
31324
31325 @smallexample
31326 -file-list-exec-sections
31327 @end smallexample
31328
31329 List the sections of the current executable file.
31330
31331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31332
31333 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31334 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31335 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31336
31337 @subsubheading Example
31338 N.A.
31339 @end ignore
31340
31341
31342 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31343 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31344
31345 @subsubheading Synopsis
31346
31347 @smallexample
31348 -file-list-exec-source-file
31349 @end smallexample
31350
31351 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31352 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31353 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31354 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31355
31356 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31357
31358 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31359
31360 @subsubheading Example
31361
31362 @smallexample
31363 (gdb)
31364 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31365 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31366 (gdb)
31367 @end smallexample
31368
31369
31370 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31371 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31372
31373 @subsubheading Synopsis
31374
31375 @smallexample
31376 -file-list-exec-source-files
31377 @end smallexample
31378
31379 List the source files for the current executable.
31380
31381 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31382 name) of a source file.
31383
31384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31385
31386 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31387 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31388
31389 @subsubheading Example
31390 @smallexample
31391 (gdb)
31392 -file-list-exec-source-files
31393 ^done,files=[
31394 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31395 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31396 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31397 (gdb)
31398 @end smallexample
31399
31400 @ignore
31401 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31402 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31403
31404 @subsubheading Synopsis
31405
31406 @smallexample
31407 -file-list-shared-libraries
31408 @end smallexample
31409
31410 List the shared libraries in the program.
31411
31412 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31413
31414 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31415
31416 @subsubheading Example
31417 N.A.
31418
31419
31420 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31421 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31422
31423 @subsubheading Synopsis
31424
31425 @smallexample
31426 -file-list-symbol-files
31427 @end smallexample
31428
31429 List symbol files.
31430
31431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31432
31433 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31434
31435 @subsubheading Example
31436 N.A.
31437 @end ignore
31438
31439
31440 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31441 @findex -file-symbol-file
31442
31443 @subsubheading Synopsis
31444
31445 @smallexample
31446 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31447 @end smallexample
31448
31449 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31450 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31451 produced, except for a completion notification.
31452
31453 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31454
31455 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31456
31457 @subsubheading Example
31458
31459 @smallexample
31460 (gdb)
31461 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31462 ^done
31463 (gdb)
31464 @end smallexample
31465
31466 @ignore
31467 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31468 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31469 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31470
31471 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31472
31473 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31474
31475 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31476
31477 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31478
31479 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31480
31481 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31482
31483 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31484
31485 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31486
31487 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31488 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31489 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31490
31491 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31492
31493 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31494
31495 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31496
31497 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31498 @end ignore
31499
31500
31501 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31502 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31503 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31504
31505
31506 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31507 @findex -target-attach
31508
31509 @subsubheading Synopsis
31510
31511 @smallexample
31512 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31513 @end smallexample
31514
31515 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31516 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31517 group, the id previously returned by
31518 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31519
31520 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31521
31522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31523
31524 @subsubheading Example
31525 @smallexample
31526 (gdb)
31527 -target-attach 34
31528 =thread-created,id="1"
31529 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31530 ^done
31531 (gdb)
31532 @end smallexample
31533
31534 @ignore
31535 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31536 @findex -target-compare-sections
31537
31538 @subsubheading Synopsis
31539
31540 @smallexample
31541 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31542 @end smallexample
31543
31544 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31545 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31546
31547 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31548
31549 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31550
31551 @subsubheading Example
31552 N.A.
31553 @end ignore
31554
31555
31556 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31557 @findex -target-detach
31558
31559 @subsubheading Synopsis
31560
31561 @smallexample
31562 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31563 @end smallexample
31564
31565 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31566 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31567 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31568
31569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31570
31571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31572
31573 @subsubheading Example
31574
31575 @smallexample
31576 (gdb)
31577 -target-detach
31578 ^done
31579 (gdb)
31580 @end smallexample
31581
31582
31583 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31584 @findex -target-disconnect
31585
31586 @subsubheading Synopsis
31587
31588 @smallexample
31589 -target-disconnect
31590 @end smallexample
31591
31592 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31593 generally not resumed.
31594
31595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31596
31597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31598
31599 @subsubheading Example
31600
31601 @smallexample
31602 (gdb)
31603 -target-disconnect
31604 ^done
31605 (gdb)
31606 @end smallexample
31607
31608
31609 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31610 @findex -target-download
31611
31612 @subsubheading Synopsis
31613
31614 @smallexample
31615 -target-download
31616 @end smallexample
31617
31618 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31619 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31620
31621 @table @samp
31622 @item section
31623 The name of the section.
31624 @item section-sent
31625 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31626 @item section-size
31627 The size of the section.
31628 @item total-sent
31629 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31630 @item total-size
31631 The size of the overall executable to download.
31632 @end table
31633
31634 @noindent
31635 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31636 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31637
31638 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31639 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31640
31641 @table @samp
31642 @item section
31643 The name of the section.
31644 @item section-size
31645 The size of the section.
31646 @item total-size
31647 The size of the overall executable to download.
31648 @end table
31649
31650 @noindent
31651 At the end, a summary is printed.
31652
31653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31654
31655 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31656
31657 @subsubheading Example
31658
31659 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31660 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31661
31662 @smallexample
31663 (gdb)
31664 -target-download
31665 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31666 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31667 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31668 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31669 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31670 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31671 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31672 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31673 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31674 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31675 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31676 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31677 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31678 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31679 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31680 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31681 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31682 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31683 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31684 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31685 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31686 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31687 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31688 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31689 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31690 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31691 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31692 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31693 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31694 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31695 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31696 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31697 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31698 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31699 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31700 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31701 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31702 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31703 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31704 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31705 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31706 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31707 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31708 write-rate="429"
31709 (gdb)
31710 @end smallexample
31711
31712
31713 @ignore
31714 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31715 @findex -target-exec-status
31716
31717 @subsubheading Synopsis
31718
31719 @smallexample
31720 -target-exec-status
31721 @end smallexample
31722
31723 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31724 not, for instance).
31725
31726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31727
31728 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31729
31730 @subsubheading Example
31731 N.A.
31732
31733
31734 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31735 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31736
31737 @subsubheading Synopsis
31738
31739 @smallexample
31740 -target-list-available-targets
31741 @end smallexample
31742
31743 List the possible targets to connect to.
31744
31745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31746
31747 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31748
31749 @subsubheading Example
31750 N.A.
31751
31752
31753 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31754 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31755
31756 @subsubheading Synopsis
31757
31758 @smallexample
31759 -target-list-current-targets
31760 @end smallexample
31761
31762 Describe the current target.
31763
31764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31765
31766 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31767 other things).
31768
31769 @subsubheading Example
31770 N.A.
31771
31772
31773 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31774 @findex -target-list-parameters
31775
31776 @subsubheading Synopsis
31777
31778 @smallexample
31779 -target-list-parameters
31780 @end smallexample
31781
31782 @c ????
31783 @end ignore
31784
31785 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31786
31787 No equivalent.
31788
31789 @subsubheading Example
31790 N.A.
31791
31792
31793 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31794 @findex -target-select
31795
31796 @subsubheading Synopsis
31797
31798 @smallexample
31799 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31800 @end smallexample
31801
31802 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31803
31804 @table @samp
31805 @item @var{type}
31806 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31807 @item @var{parameters}
31808 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31809 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31810 @end table
31811
31812 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31813 which the target program is, in the following form:
31814
31815 @smallexample
31816 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31817 args=[@var{arg list}]
31818 @end smallexample
31819
31820 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31821
31822 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31823
31824 @subsubheading Example
31825
31826 @smallexample
31827 (gdb)
31828 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31829 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31830 (gdb)
31831 @end smallexample
31832
31833 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31834 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31835 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31836
31837
31838 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31839 @findex -target-file-put
31840
31841 @subsubheading Synopsis
31842
31843 @smallexample
31844 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31845 @end smallexample
31846
31847 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31848 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31849
31850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31851
31852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31853
31854 @subsubheading Example
31855
31856 @smallexample
31857 (gdb)
31858 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31859 ^done
31860 (gdb)
31861 @end smallexample
31862
31863
31864 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31865 @findex -target-file-get
31866
31867 @subsubheading Synopsis
31868
31869 @smallexample
31870 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31871 @end smallexample
31872
31873 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31874 on the host system.
31875
31876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31877
31878 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31879
31880 @subsubheading Example
31881
31882 @smallexample
31883 (gdb)
31884 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31885 ^done
31886 (gdb)
31887 @end smallexample
31888
31889
31890 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31891 @findex -target-file-delete
31892
31893 @subsubheading Synopsis
31894
31895 @smallexample
31896 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31897 @end smallexample
31898
31899 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31900
31901 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31902
31903 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31904
31905 @subsubheading Example
31906
31907 @smallexample
31908 (gdb)
31909 -target-file-delete remotefile
31910 ^done
31911 (gdb)
31912 @end smallexample
31913
31914
31915 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31916 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31917 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31918
31919 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31920 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31921
31922 @subsubheading Synopsis
31923
31924 @smallexample
31925 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31926 @end smallexample
31927
31928 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31929 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31930 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31931
31932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31933
31934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31935
31936 @subsubheading Result
31937
31938 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31939 defined for each exception:
31940
31941 @table @samp
31942 @item name
31943 The name of the exception.
31944
31945 @item address
31946 The address of the exception.
31947
31948 @end table
31949
31950 @subsubheading Example
31951
31952 @smallexample
31953 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31954 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31955 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31956 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31957 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31958 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31959 @end smallexample
31960
31961 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31962
31963 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31964 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31965 Catchpoint Commands}.
31966
31967
31968 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31969 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31970 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31971
31972 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31973 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31974 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31975 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31976
31977 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31978 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31979 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31980
31981 @subsubheading Synopsis
31982
31983 @smallexample
31984 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31985 @end smallexample
31986
31987 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31988
31989 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31990 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31991 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31992 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31993 dash.
31994
31995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31996
31997 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31998
31999 @subsubheading Result
32000
32001 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32002
32003 @table @samp
32004 @item exists
32005 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32006 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32007
32008 @end table
32009
32010 @subsubheading Example
32011
32012 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32013
32014 @smallexample
32015 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32016 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32017 @end smallexample
32018
32019 @noindent
32020 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32021 to the debugger:
32022
32023 @smallexample
32024 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32025 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32026 @end smallexample
32027
32028 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32029 @findex -list-features
32030 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32031
32032 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32033 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32034 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32035 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32036 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32037 startup.
32038
32039 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32040 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32041 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32042 is given below.
32043
32044 Example output:
32045
32046 @smallexample
32047 (gdb) -list-features
32048 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32049 @end smallexample
32050
32051 The current list of features is:
32052
32053 @ftable @samp
32054 @item frozen-varobjs
32055 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32056 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32057 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32058 @item pending-breakpoints
32059 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32060 command.
32061 @item python
32062 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32063 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32064 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32065 @item thread-info
32066 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32067 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32068 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32069 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32070 @item breakpoint-notifications
32071 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32072 CLI will be announced via async records.
32073 @item ada-task-info
32074 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32075 @item language-option
32076 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32077 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32078 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32079 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32080 @item undefined-command-error-code
32081 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32082 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32083 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32084 @item exec-run-start-option
32085 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32086 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32087 @end ftable
32088
32089 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32090 @findex -list-target-features
32091
32092 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32093 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32094 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32095 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32096 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32097 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32098 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32099 Example output:
32100
32101 @smallexample
32102 (gdb) -list-target-features
32103 ^done,result=["async"]
32104 @end smallexample
32105
32106 The current list of features is:
32107
32108 @table @samp
32109 @item async
32110 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32111 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32112 while the target is running.
32113
32114 @item reverse
32115 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32116 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32117
32118 @end table
32119
32120 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32121 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32122 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32123
32124 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32125
32126 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32127 @findex -gdb-exit
32128
32129 @subsubheading Synopsis
32130
32131 @smallexample
32132 -gdb-exit
32133 @end smallexample
32134
32135 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32136
32137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32138
32139 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32140
32141 @subsubheading Example
32142
32143 @smallexample
32144 (gdb)
32145 -gdb-exit
32146 ^exit
32147 @end smallexample
32148
32149
32150 @ignore
32151 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32152 @findex -exec-abort
32153
32154 @subsubheading Synopsis
32155
32156 @smallexample
32157 -exec-abort
32158 @end smallexample
32159
32160 Kill the inferior running program.
32161
32162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32163
32164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32165
32166 @subsubheading Example
32167 N.A.
32168 @end ignore
32169
32170
32171 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32172 @findex -gdb-set
32173
32174 @subsubheading Synopsis
32175
32176 @smallexample
32177 -gdb-set
32178 @end smallexample
32179
32180 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32181 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32182
32183 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32184
32185 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32186
32187 @subsubheading Example
32188
32189 @smallexample
32190 (gdb)
32191 -gdb-set $foo=3
32192 ^done
32193 (gdb)
32194 @end smallexample
32195
32196
32197 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32198 @findex -gdb-show
32199
32200 @subsubheading Synopsis
32201
32202 @smallexample
32203 -gdb-show
32204 @end smallexample
32205
32206 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32207
32208 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32209
32210 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32211
32212 @subsubheading Example
32213
32214 @smallexample
32215 (gdb)
32216 -gdb-show annotate
32217 ^done,value="0"
32218 (gdb)
32219 @end smallexample
32220
32221 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32222
32223
32224 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32225 @findex -gdb-version
32226
32227 @subsubheading Synopsis
32228
32229 @smallexample
32230 -gdb-version
32231 @end smallexample
32232
32233 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32234
32235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32236
32237 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32238 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32239
32240 @subsubheading Example
32241
32242 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32243 @c box in TeX.
32244 @smallexample
32245 (gdb)
32246 -gdb-version
32247 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32248 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32249 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32250 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32251 ~ certain conditions.
32252 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32253 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32254 ~ details.
32255 ~This GDB was configured as
32256 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32257 ^done
32258 (gdb)
32259 @end smallexample
32260
32261 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32262 @findex -list-thread-groups
32263
32264 @subheading Synopsis
32265
32266 @smallexample
32267 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32268 @end smallexample
32269
32270 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32271 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32272 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32273 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32274 top-level thread groups.
32275
32276 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32277 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32278 available on the target.
32279
32280 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32281 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32282 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32283 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32284 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32285 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32286 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32287 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32288
32289 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32290 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32291 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32292 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32293 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32294 @samp{threads} field.
32295
32296 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32297 the following caveats:
32298
32299 @itemize @bullet
32300 @item
32301 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32302 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32303 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32304
32305 @item
32306 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32307 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32308 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32309 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32310 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32311 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32312
32313 @end itemize
32314
32315 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32316 have the following fields:
32317
32318 @table @code
32319 @item id
32320 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32321 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32322 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32323
32324 @item type
32325 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32326 valid type.
32327
32328 @item pid
32329 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32330 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32331
32332 @item exit-code
32333 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32334 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32335 only if the process is not running.
32336
32337 @item num_children
32338 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32339 absent for an available thread group.
32340
32341 @item threads
32342 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32343 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32344 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32345
32346 @item cores
32347 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32348 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32349 such information is not available.
32350
32351 @item executable
32352 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32353 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32354 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32355
32356 @end table
32357
32358 @subheading Example
32359
32360 @smallexample
32361 @value{GDBP}
32362 -list-thread-groups
32363 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32364 -list-thread-groups 17
32365 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32366 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32367 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32368 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32369 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32370 -list-thread-groups --available
32371 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32372 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32373 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32374 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32375 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32376 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32377 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32378 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32379 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32380 @end smallexample
32381
32382 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32383 @findex -info-os
32384
32385 @subsubheading Synopsis
32386
32387 @smallexample
32388 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32389 @end smallexample
32390
32391 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32392 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32393 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32394 of data of that type.
32395
32396 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32397 system.
32398
32399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32400
32401 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32402
32403 @subsubheading Example
32404
32405 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32406 like this:
32407
32408 @smallexample
32409 @value{GDBP}
32410 -info-os
32411 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32412 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32413 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32414 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32415 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32416 col2="CPUs"@},
32417 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32418 col2="File descriptors"@},
32419 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32420 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32421 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32422 col2="Message queues"@},
32423 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32424 col2="Processes"@},
32425 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32426 col2="Process groups"@},
32427 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32428 col2="Semaphores"@},
32429 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32430 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32431 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32432 col2="Sockets"@},
32433 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32434 col2="Threads"@}]
32435 @value{GDBP}
32436 -info-os processes
32437 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32438 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32439 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32440 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32441 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32442 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32443 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32444 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32445 ...
32446 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32447 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32448 (gdb)
32449 @end smallexample
32450
32451 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32452 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32453 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32454 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32455 @code{info os} omits it.)
32456
32457 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32458 @findex -add-inferior
32459
32460 @subheading Synopsis
32461
32462 @smallexample
32463 -add-inferior
32464 @end smallexample
32465
32466 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32467 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32468 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32469 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32470 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32471 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32472
32473 @subheading Example
32474
32475 @smallexample
32476 @value{GDBP}
32477 -add-inferior
32478 ^done,inferior="i3"
32479 @end smallexample
32480
32481 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32482 @findex -interpreter-exec
32483
32484 @subheading Synopsis
32485
32486 @smallexample
32487 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32488 @end smallexample
32489 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32490
32491 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32492
32493 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32494
32495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32496
32497 @subheading Example
32498
32499 @smallexample
32500 (gdb)
32501 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32502 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32503 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32504 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32505 ^done
32506 (gdb)
32507 @end smallexample
32508
32509 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32510 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32511
32512 @subheading Synopsis
32513
32514 @smallexample
32515 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32516 @end smallexample
32517
32518 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32519
32520 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32521
32522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32523
32524 @subheading Example
32525
32526 @smallexample
32527 (gdb)
32528 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32529 ^done
32530 (gdb)
32531 @end smallexample
32532
32533 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32534 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32535
32536 @subheading Synopsis
32537
32538 @smallexample
32539 -inferior-tty-show
32540 @end smallexample
32541
32542 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32543
32544 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32545
32546 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32547
32548 @subheading Example
32549
32550 @smallexample
32551 (gdb)
32552 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32553 ^done
32554 (gdb)
32555 -inferior-tty-show
32556 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32557 (gdb)
32558 @end smallexample
32559
32560 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32561 @findex -enable-timings
32562
32563 @subheading Synopsis
32564
32565 @smallexample
32566 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32567 @end smallexample
32568
32569 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32570 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32571 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32572 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32573
32574 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32575
32576 No equivalent.
32577
32578 @subheading Example
32579
32580 @smallexample
32581 (gdb)
32582 -enable-timings
32583 ^done
32584 (gdb)
32585 -break-insert main
32586 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32587 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32588 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32589 times="0"@},
32590 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32591 (gdb)
32592 -enable-timings no
32593 ^done
32594 (gdb)
32595 -exec-run
32596 ^running
32597 (gdb)
32598 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32599 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32600 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32601 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32602 (gdb)
32603 @end smallexample
32604
32605 @node Annotations
32606 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32607
32608 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32609 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32610 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32611 relatively high level.
32612
32613 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32614 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32615
32616 @ignore
32617 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32618 @end ignore
32619
32620 @menu
32621 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32622 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32623 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32624 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32625 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32626 * Annotations for Running::
32627 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32628 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32629 @end menu
32630
32631 @node Annotations Overview
32632 @section What is an Annotation?
32633 @cindex annotations
32634
32635 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32636 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32637 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32638 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32639 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32640 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32641 cannot contain newline characters.
32642
32643 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32644 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32645 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32646 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32647 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32648 means those three characters as output.
32649
32650 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32651 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32652 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32653 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32654 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32655 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32656 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32657 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32658 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32659
32660 @table @code
32661 @kindex set annotate
32662 @item set annotate @var{level}
32663 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32664 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32665
32666 @item show annotate
32667 @kindex show annotate
32668 Show the current annotation level.
32669 @end table
32670
32671 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32672
32673 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32674
32675 @smallexample
32676 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32677 GNU gdb 6.0
32678 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32679 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32680 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32681 under certain conditions.
32682 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32683 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32684 for details.
32685 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32686
32687 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32688 (@value{GDBP})
32689 ^Z^Zprompt
32690 @kbd{quit}
32691
32692 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32693 $
32694 @end smallexample
32695
32696 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32697 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32698 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32699 output from @value{GDBN}.
32700
32701 @node Server Prefix
32702 @section The Server Prefix
32703 @cindex server prefix
32704
32705 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32706 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32707 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32708 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32709 a transparent manner.
32710
32711 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32712 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32713 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32714 @code{print} command.
32715
32716 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32717 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32718
32719 @node Prompting
32720 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32721
32722 @cindex annotations for prompts
32723 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32724 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32725 over, etc.
32726
32727 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32728 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32729 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32730 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32731 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32732 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32733 features the following annotations:
32734
32735 @smallexample
32736 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32737 ^Z^Zprompt
32738 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32739 @end smallexample
32740
32741 The input types are
32742
32743 @table @code
32744 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32745 @findex prompt annotation
32746 @findex post-prompt annotation
32747 @item prompt
32748 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32749
32750 @findex pre-commands annotation
32751 @findex commands annotation
32752 @findex post-commands annotation
32753 @item commands
32754 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32755 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32756
32757 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32758 @findex overload-choice annotation
32759 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32760 @item overload-choice
32761 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32762
32763 @findex pre-query annotation
32764 @findex query annotation
32765 @findex post-query annotation
32766 @item query
32767 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32768
32769 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32770 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32771 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32772 @item prompt-for-continue
32773 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32774 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32775 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32776 presence of annotations.
32777 @end table
32778
32779 @node Errors
32780 @section Errors
32781 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32782
32783 @findex quit annotation
32784 @smallexample
32785 ^Z^Zquit
32786 @end smallexample
32787
32788 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32789
32790 @findex error annotation
32791 @smallexample
32792 ^Z^Zerror
32793 @end smallexample
32794
32795 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32796
32797 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32798 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32799 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32800 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32801 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32802 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32803 to the top level.
32804
32805 @findex error-begin annotation
32806 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32807
32808 @smallexample
32809 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32810 @end smallexample
32811
32812 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32813 message.
32814
32815 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32816 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32817 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32818
32819 @node Invalidation
32820 @section Invalidation Notices
32821
32822 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32823 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32824 changed.
32825
32826 @table @code
32827 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32828 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32829
32830 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32831 have changed.
32832
32833 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32834 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32835
32836 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32837 deleted a breakpoint.
32838 @end table
32839
32840 @node Annotations for Running
32841 @section Running the Program
32842 @cindex annotations for running programs
32843
32844 @findex starting annotation
32845 @findex stopping annotation
32846 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32847 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32848
32849 @smallexample
32850 ^Z^Zstarting
32851 @end smallexample
32852
32853 is output. When the program stops,
32854
32855 @smallexample
32856 ^Z^Zstopped
32857 @end smallexample
32858
32859 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32860 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32861
32862 @table @code
32863 @findex exited annotation
32864 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32865 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32866 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32867
32868 @findex signalled annotation
32869 @findex signal-name annotation
32870 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32871 @findex signal-string annotation
32872 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32873 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32874 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32875 annotation continues:
32876
32877 @smallexample
32878 @var{intro-text}
32879 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32880 @var{name}
32881 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32882 @var{middle-text}
32883 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32884 @var{string}
32885 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32886 @var{end-text}
32887 @end smallexample
32888
32889 @noindent
32890 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32891 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32892 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32893 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32894 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32895
32896 @findex signal annotation
32897 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32898 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32899 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32900 terminated with it.
32901
32902 @findex breakpoint annotation
32903 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32904 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32905
32906 @findex watchpoint annotation
32907 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32908 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32909 @end table
32910
32911 @node Source Annotations
32912 @section Displaying Source
32913 @cindex annotations for source display
32914
32915 @findex source annotation
32916 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32917
32918 @smallexample
32919 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32920 @end smallexample
32921
32922 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32923 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32924 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32925 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32926 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32927 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32928 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32929 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32930 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32931 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32932 depend on the language).
32933
32934 @node JIT Interface
32935 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32936 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32937 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32938
32939 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32940 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32941 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32942 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32943
32944 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32945 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32946 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32947 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32948 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32949 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32950
32951 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32952 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32953 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32954 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32955 LLVM JIT.
32956
32957 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32958 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32959 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32960 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32961 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32962 out about additional code.
32963
32964 @menu
32965 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32966 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32967 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32968 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32969 @end menu
32970
32971 @node Declarations
32972 @section JIT Declarations
32973
32974 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32975 implement the interface:
32976
32977 @smallexample
32978 typedef enum
32979 @{
32980 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32981 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32982 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32983 @} jit_actions_t;
32984
32985 struct jit_code_entry
32986 @{
32987 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32988 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32989 const char *symfile_addr;
32990 uint64_t symfile_size;
32991 @};
32992
32993 struct jit_descriptor
32994 @{
32995 uint32_t version;
32996 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32997 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32998 uint32_t action_flag;
32999 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33000 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33001 @};
33002
33003 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33004 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33005
33006 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33007 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33008 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33009 @end smallexample
33010
33011 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33012 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33013 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33014
33015 @node Registering Code
33016 @section Registering Code
33017
33018 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33019
33020 @itemize @bullet
33021 @item
33022 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33023 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33024
33025 @item
33026 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33027 file.
33028
33029 @item
33030 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33031
33032 @item
33033 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33034
33035 @item
33036 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33037 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33038 @end itemize
33039
33040 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33041 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33042 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33043 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33044
33045 @node Unregistering Code
33046 @section Unregistering Code
33047
33048 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33049
33050 @itemize @bullet
33051 @item
33052 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33053
33054 @item
33055 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33056
33057 @item
33058 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33059 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33060 @end itemize
33061
33062 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33063 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33064
33065 @node Custom Debug Info
33066 @section Custom Debug Info
33067 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33068 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33069
33070 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33071 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33072 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33073 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33074 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33075 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33076 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33077 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33078 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33079
33080 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33081 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33082 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33083 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33084 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33085 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33086 compiler.
33087
33088 @menu
33089 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33090 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33091 @end menu
33092
33093 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33094 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33095 @kindex jit-reader-load
33096 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33097
33098 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33099 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33100
33101 @table @code
33102 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33103 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33104 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33105 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33106 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33107 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33108 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33109
33110 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33111 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33112 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33113 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33114 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33115
33116 @item jit-reader-unload
33117 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33118
33119 @end table
33120
33121 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33122 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33123 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33124
33125 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33126 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33127
33128 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33129 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33130 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33131 the system include directory.
33132
33133 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33134 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33135 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33136
33137 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33138 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33139
33140 @findex gdb_init_reader
33141 @smallexample
33142 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33143 @end smallexample
33144
33145 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33146
33147 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33148 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33149 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33150 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33151 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33152 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33153
33154 @smallexample
33155 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33156 @{
33157 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33158 int reader_version;
33159
33160 /* For use by the reader. */
33161 void *priv_data;
33162
33163 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33164 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33165 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33166 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33167 @};
33168 @end smallexample
33169
33170 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33171 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33172
33173 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33174 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33175 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33176 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33177 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33178 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33179 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33180 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33181 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33182 target's address space.
33183
33184 @node In-Process Agent
33185 @chapter In-Process Agent
33186 @cindex debugging agent
33187 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33188 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33189 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33190 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33191 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33192 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33193 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33194 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33195 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33196 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33197 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33198 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33199 behavior without interrupting it.
33200
33201 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33202 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33203 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33204 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33205 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33206 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33207 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33208 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33209 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33210
33211 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33212 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33213 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33214 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33215
33216 @anchor{Control Agent}
33217 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33218 debugging with the following commands:
33219
33220 @table @code
33221 @kindex set agent on
33222 @item set agent on
33223 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33224 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33225 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33226 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33227 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33228 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33229
33230 @kindex set agent off
33231 @item set agent off
33232 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33233 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33234
33235 @kindex show agent
33236 @item show agent
33237 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33238 the in-process agent.
33239 @end table
33240
33241 @menu
33242 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33243 @end menu
33244
33245 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33246 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33247 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33248
33249 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33250 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33251 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33252 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33253 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33254 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33255 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33256 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33257 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33258
33259 @menu
33260 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33261 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33262 @end menu
33263
33264 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33265 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33266 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33267
33268 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33269 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33270
33271 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33272 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33273 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33274 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33275
33276 @enumerate
33277 @item
33278 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33279 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33280 @item
33281 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33282 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33283 the other one.
33284 @end enumerate
33285
33286 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33287
33288 @enumerate
33289 @item
33290 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33291 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33292 @anchor{agent expression object}
33293 @item
33294 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33295 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33296 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33297 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33298 @item
33299 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33300 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33301
33302 @end enumerate
33303
33304 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33305 object:
33306
33307 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33308 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33309 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33310 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33311 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33312 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33313 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33314 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33315 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33316 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33317 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33318 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33319 memory address for collecting.
33320 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33321 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33322 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33323 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33324 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33325 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33326 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33327 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33328 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33329 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33330 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33331 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33332 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33333 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33334 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33335 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33336 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33337 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33338 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33339 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33340 @ref{agent expression object}
33341 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33342 @ref{agent expression object}
33343 @item actions @tab variable
33344 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33345 @end multitable
33346
33347 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33348 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33349 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33350
33351 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33352 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33353
33354 @table @samp
33355
33356 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33357 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33358 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33359 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33360 in IPA finally.
33361
33362 Replies:
33363 @table @samp
33364 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33365 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33366 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33367 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33368 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33369 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33370 @item E @var{NN}
33371 for an error
33372
33373 @end table
33374
33375 @item close
33376 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33377 is about to kill inferiors.
33378
33379 @item qTfSTM
33380 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33381 @item qTsSTM
33382 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33383 @item qTSTMat
33384 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33385 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33386 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33387
33388 Replies:
33389 @table @samp
33390 @item E @var{NN}
33391 for an error
33392 @end table
33393 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33394 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33395 @end table
33396
33397 @node GDB Bugs
33398 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33399 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33400 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33401
33402 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33403
33404 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33405 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33406 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33407 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33408
33409 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33410 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33411
33412 @menu
33413 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33414 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33415 @end menu
33416
33417 @node Bug Criteria
33418 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33419 @cindex bug criteria
33420
33421 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33422
33423 @itemize @bullet
33424 @cindex fatal signal
33425 @cindex debugger crash
33426 @cindex crash of debugger
33427 @item
33428 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33429 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33430
33431 @cindex error on valid input
33432 @item
33433 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33434 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33435 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33436
33437 @cindex invalid input
33438 @item
33439 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33440 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33441 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33442 for traditional practice''.
33443
33444 @item
33445 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33446 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33447 @end itemize
33448
33449 @node Bug Reporting
33450 @section How to Report Bugs
33451 @cindex bug reports
33452 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33453
33454 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33455 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33456 contact that organization first.
33457
33458 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33459 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33460 distribution.
33461 @c should add a web page ref...
33462
33463 @ifset BUGURL
33464 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33465 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33466 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33467 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33468 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33469 be used.
33470
33471 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33472 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33473 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33474 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33475
33476 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33477 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33478 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33479 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33480 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33481 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33482 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33483 bug reports to the mailing list.
33484 @end ifset
33485 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33486 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33487 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33488 @end ifclear
33489 @end ifset
33490
33491 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33492 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33493 fact or leave it out, state it!
33494
33495 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33496 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33497 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33498 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33499 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33500 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33501 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33502 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33503 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33504
33505 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33506 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33507 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33508 self-contained.
33509
33510 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33511 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33512 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33513 bugs properly.
33514
33515 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33516
33517 @itemize @bullet
33518 @item
33519 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33520 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33521 version}.
33522
33523 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33524 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33525
33526 @item
33527 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33528 version number.
33529
33530 @item
33531 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33532 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33533 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33534 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33535
33536 @item
33537 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33538 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33539
33540 @item
33541 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33542 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33543 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33544 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33545 those compilers.
33546
33547 @item
33548 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33549 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33550 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33551 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33552
33553 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33554 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33555
33556 @item
33557 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33558 reproduce the bug.
33559
33560 @item
33561 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33562 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33563
33564 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33565 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33566 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33567 a chance to make a mistake.
33568
33569 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33570 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33571 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33572 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33573 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33574 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33575 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33576 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33577
33578 @pindex script
33579 @cindex recording a session script
33580 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33581 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33582 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33583 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33584
33585 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33586 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33587
33588 @item
33589 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33590 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33591 it by context, not by line number.
33592
33593 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33594 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33595
33596 @end itemize
33597
33598 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33599
33600 @itemize @bullet
33601 @item
33602 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33603
33604 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33605 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33606 changes will not affect it.
33607
33608 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33609 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33610 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33611 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33612
33613 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33614 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33615 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33616 less time, and so on.
33617
33618 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33619 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33620
33621 @item
33622 A patch for the bug.
33623
33624 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33625 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33626 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33627 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33628
33629 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33630 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33631 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33632 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33633
33634 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33635 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33636 help us to understand.
33637
33638 @item
33639 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33640
33641 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33642 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33643 @end itemize
33644
33645 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33646 @c and consists of the two following files:
33647 @c rluser.texi
33648 @c hsuser.texi
33649 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33650 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33651 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33652 @include rluser.texi
33653 @include hsuser.texi
33654 @end ifclear
33655
33656 @node In Memoriam
33657 @appendix In Memoriam
33658
33659 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33660 contributors:
33661
33662 @table @code
33663 @item Fred Fish
33664 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33665 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33666 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33667
33668 @item Michael Snyder
33669 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33670 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33671 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33672 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33673 @end table
33674
33675 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33676 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33677
33678 @node Formatting Documentation
33679 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33680
33681 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33682 @cindex reference card
33683 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33684 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33685 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33686 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33687 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33688 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33689
33690 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33691 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33692
33693 @smallexample
33694 make refcard.dvi
33695 @end smallexample
33696
33697 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33698 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33699 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33700 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33701 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33702
33703 @cindex documentation
33704
33705 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33706 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33707 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33708 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33709 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33710 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33711
33712 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33713 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33714 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33715 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33716 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33717 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33718 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33719 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33720
33721 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33722 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33723 @code{makeinfo}.
33724
33725 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33726 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33727 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33728
33729 @smallexample
33730 cd gdb
33731 make gdb.info
33732 @end smallexample
33733
33734 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33735 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33736 Texinfo definitions file.
33737
33738 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33739 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33740 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33741 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33742 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33743 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33744 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33745
33746 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33747 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33748 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33749 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33750 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33751 directory.
33752
33753 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33754 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33755 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33756 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33757
33758 @smallexample
33759 make gdb.dvi
33760 @end smallexample
33761
33762 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33763
33764 @node Installing GDB
33765 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33766 @cindex installation
33767
33768 @menu
33769 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33770 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33771 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33772 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33773 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33774 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33775 @end menu
33776
33777 @node Requirements
33778 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33779 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33780
33781 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33782 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33783
33784 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33785 @table @asis
33786 @item ISO C90 compiler
33787 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33788 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33789
33790 @end table
33791
33792 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33793 @table @asis
33794 @item Expat
33795 @anchor{Expat}
33796 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33797 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33798 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33799 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33800 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33801 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33802
33803 Expat is used for:
33804
33805 @itemize @bullet
33806 @item
33807 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33808 @item
33809 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33810 @item
33811 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33812 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33813 @item
33814 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33815 @item
33816 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33817 @item
33818 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33819 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33820 @end itemize
33821
33822 @item zlib
33823 @cindex compressed debug sections
33824 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33825 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33826 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33827 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33828 information in such binaries.
33829
33830 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33831 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33832 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33833
33834 @item iconv
33835 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33836 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33837 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33838 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33839
33840 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33841 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33842 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33843 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33844
33845 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33846 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33847 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33848
33849 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33850 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33851 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33852 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33853 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33854 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33855 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33856 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33857 @end table
33858
33859 @node Running Configure
33860 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33861 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33862 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33863 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33864 build the @code{gdb} program.
33865 @iftex
33866 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33867 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33868 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33869 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33870 @end iftex
33871
33872 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33873 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33874 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33875
33876 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33877 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33878
33879 @table @code
33880 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33881 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33882
33883 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33884 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33885
33886 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33887 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33888
33889 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33890 @sc{gnu} include files
33891
33892 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33893 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33894
33895 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33896 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33897
33898 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33899 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33900
33901 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33902 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33903
33904 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33905 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33906 @end table
33907
33908 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33909 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33910 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33911
33912 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33913 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33914 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33915 argument.
33916
33917 For example:
33918
33919 @smallexample
33920 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33921 ./configure @var{host}
33922 make
33923 @end smallexample
33924
33925 @noindent
33926 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33927 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33928 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33929 correct value by examining your system.)
33930
33931 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33932 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33933 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33934 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33935
33936 @need 750
33937 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33938 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33939 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33940
33941 @smallexample
33942 sh configure @var{host}
33943 @end smallexample
33944
33945 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33946 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33947 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33948 @file{configure}
33949 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33950 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33951
33952 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33953 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33954 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33955 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33956 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33957 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33958 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33959 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33960 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33961
33962 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33963 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33964 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33965 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33966 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33967
33968 @node Separate Objdir
33969 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33970
33971 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33972 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33973 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33974 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33975 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33976 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33977 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33978 program specified there.
33979
33980 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33981 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33982 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33983 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33984 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33985 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33986
33987 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33988 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33989
33990 @smallexample
33991 @group
33992 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33993 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33994 cd ../gdb-sun4
33995 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33996 make
33997 @end group
33998 @end smallexample
33999
34000 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34001 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34002 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34003 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34004 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34005 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34006
34007 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34008 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34009 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34010 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34011 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34012
34013 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34014 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34015 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34016 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34017 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34018 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34019
34020 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34021 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34022 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34023
34024 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34025 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34026 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34027 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34028 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34029
34030 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34031 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34032 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34033 with each other.
34034
34035 @node Config Names
34036 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34037
34038 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34039 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34040 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34041 of information in the following pattern:
34042
34043 @smallexample
34044 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34045 @end smallexample
34046
34047 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34048 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34049 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34050
34051 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34052 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34053 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34054 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34055 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34056 abbreviations---for example:
34057
34058 @smallexample
34059 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34060 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34061 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34062 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34063 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34064 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34065 % sh config.sub sun4
34066 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34067 % sh config.sub sun3
34068 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34069 % sh config.sub i986v
34070 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34071 @end smallexample
34072
34073 @noindent
34074 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34075 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34076
34077 @node Configure Options
34078 @section @file{configure} Options
34079
34080 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34081 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34082 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34083 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34084
34085 @smallexample
34086 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34087 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34088 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34089 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34090 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34091 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34092 @var{host}
34093 @end smallexample
34094
34095 @noindent
34096 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34097 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34098 @samp{--}.
34099
34100 @table @code
34101 @item --help
34102 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34103
34104 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34105 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34106 @file{@var{dir}}.
34107
34108 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34109 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34110 @file{@var{dir}}.
34111
34112 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34113 @need 2000
34114 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34115 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34116 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34117 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34118 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34119 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34120 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34121 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34122 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34123 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34124 @var{dirname}.
34125
34126 @item --norecursion
34127 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34128 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34129
34130 @item --target=@var{target}
34131 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34132 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34133 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34134
34135 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34136
34137 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34138 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34139
34140 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34141 @end table
34142
34143 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34144 needed for special purposes only.
34145
34146 @node System-wide configuration
34147 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34148 @cindex system-wide init file
34149
34150 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34151 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34152 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34153
34154 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34155
34156 @table @code
34157 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34158 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34159 @var{file}.
34160 @end table
34161
34162 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34163 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34164
34165 @itemize @bullet
34166 @item
34167 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34168 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34169 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34170 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34171 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34172 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34173
34174 @item
34175 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34176 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34177 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34178 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34179 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34180 @end itemize
34181
34182 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34183 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34184 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34185 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34186 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34187 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34188 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34189 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34190 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34191 reread.
34192
34193 @menu
34194 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34195 @end menu
34196
34197 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34198 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34199 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34200
34201 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34202 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34203 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34204 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34205 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34206 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34207
34208 The following scripts are currently available:
34209 @itemize @bullet
34210
34211 @item @file{elinos.py}
34212 @pindex elinos.py
34213 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34214 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34215 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34216 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34217 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34218 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34219
34220 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34221 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34222 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34223 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34224 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34225 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34226
34227 @end itemize
34228
34229 @node Maintenance Commands
34230 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34231 @cindex maintenance commands
34232 @cindex internal commands
34233
34234 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34235 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34236 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34237 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34238 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34239
34240 @table @code
34241 @kindex maint agent
34242 @kindex maint agent-eval
34243 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34244 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34245 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34246 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34247 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34248 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34249 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34250 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34251 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34252 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34253 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34254 addition and return the sum.
34255 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34256 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34257
34258 @kindex maint agent-printf
34259 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34260 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34261 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34262 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34263 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34264
34265 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34266 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34267 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34268 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34269 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34270 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34271 is shown:
34272
34273 @table @code
34274 @item breakpoint
34275 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34276
34277 @item watchpoint
34278 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34279
34280 @item longjmp
34281 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34282 @code{longjmp} calls.
34283
34284 @item longjmp resume
34285 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34286
34287 @item until
34288 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34289
34290 @item finish
34291 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34292
34293 @item shlib events
34294 Shared library events.
34295
34296 @end table
34297
34298 @kindex maint info btrace
34299 @item maint info btrace
34300 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34301
34302 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34303 @item maint btrace packet-history
34304 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34305 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34306 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34307 recording format.
34308
34309 @table @code
34310 @item bts
34311 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34312 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34313
34314 @table @asis
34315 @item Block number
34316 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34317 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34318 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34319 @end table
34320
34321 @item pt
34322 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34323 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34324 information is printed:
34325
34326 @table @asis
34327 @item Packet number
34328 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34329 @item Trace offset
34330 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34331 @item Packet opcode and payload
34332 @end table
34333 @end table
34334
34335 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34336 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34337 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34338 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34339 needed.
34340
34341 @kindex maint btrace clear
34342 @item maint btrace clear
34343 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34344 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34345
34346 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34347 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34348 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34349 buffer.
34350
34351 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34352 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34353 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34354 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34355 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34356 packet history.
34357
34358 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34359 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34360 @cindex displaced stepping support
34361 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34362 @item set displaced-stepping
34363 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34364 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34365 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34366 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34367 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34368 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34369
34370 @table @code
34371 @item set displaced-stepping on
34372 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34373 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34374
34375 @item set displaced-stepping off
34376 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34377 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34378
34379 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34380 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34381 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34382 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34383 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34384 @end table
34385
34386 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34387 @item maint check-psymtabs
34388 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34389 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34390
34391 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34392 @item maint check-symtabs
34393 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34394
34395 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34396 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34397 Expand symbol tables.
34398 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34399 names matching @var{regexp}.
34400
34401 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34402 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34403 @cindex demangler crashes
34404 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34405 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34406 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34407 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34408 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34409 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34410 option to terminate the current session.
34411
34412 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34413 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34414 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34415
34416 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34417 @item maint cplus namespace
34418 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34419
34420 @kindex maint deprecate
34421 @kindex maint undeprecate
34422 @cindex deprecated commands
34423 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34424 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34425 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34426 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34427 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34428 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34429 the replacement as part of the warning.
34430
34431 @kindex maint dump-me
34432 @item maint dump-me
34433 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34434 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34435 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34436 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34437
34438 @kindex maint internal-error
34439 @kindex maint internal-warning
34440 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34441 @cindex demangler crashes
34442 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34443 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34444 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34445
34446 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34447 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34448 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34449 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34450 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34451 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34452 @value{GDBN} session.
34453
34454 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34455 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34456
34457 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34458
34459 @smallexample
34460 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34461 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34462 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34463 debugging may prove unreliable.
34464 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34465 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34466 (@value{GDBP})
34467 @end smallexample
34468
34469 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34470 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34471 @cindex demangler crashes
34472
34473 @kindex maint set internal-error
34474 @kindex maint show internal-error
34475 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34476 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34477 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34478 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34479 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34480 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34481 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34482 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34483 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34484 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34485 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34486 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34487 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34488 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34489 described in the table below.
34490
34491 @table @samp
34492 @item quit
34493 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34494 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34495
34496 @item corefile
34497 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34498 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34499 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34500 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34501 disabled.
34502 @end table
34503
34504 @kindex maint packet
34505 @item maint packet @var{text}
34506 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34507 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34508 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34509 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34510 checksum.
34511
34512 @kindex maint print architecture
34513 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34514 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34515 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34516
34517 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34518 @item maint print c-tdesc
34519 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34520 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34521 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34522
34523 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34524 @item maint print dummy-frames
34525 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34526
34527 @smallexample
34528 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34529 @dots{}
34530 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34531 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34532 58 return (a + b);
34533 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34534 @dots{}
34535 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34536 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34537 (@value{GDBP})
34538 @end smallexample
34539
34540 Takes an optional file parameter.
34541
34542 @kindex maint print registers
34543 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34544 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34545 @kindex maint print register-groups
34546 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34547 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34548 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34549 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34550 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34551 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34552 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34553
34554 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34555 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34556 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34557 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34558 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34559 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34560 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34561 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34562
34563 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34564 write the information.
34565
34566 @kindex maint print reggroups
34567 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34568 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34569 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34570 information.
34571
34572 The register groups info looks like this:
34573
34574 @smallexample
34575 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34576 Group Type
34577 general user
34578 float user
34579 all user
34580 vector user
34581 system user
34582 save internal
34583 restore internal
34584 @end smallexample
34585
34586 @kindex flushregs
34587 @item flushregs
34588 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34589
34590 @kindex maint print objfiles
34591 @cindex info for known object files
34592 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34593 Print a dump of all known object files.
34594 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34595 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34596 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34597
34598 @kindex maint print user-registers
34599 @cindex user registers
34600 @item maint print user-registers
34601 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34602 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34603 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34604 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34605 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34606 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34607 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34608
34609 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34610 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34611 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34612 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34613 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34614 matching @var{regexp}.
34615 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34616 and the full path if known.
34617 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34618
34619 @kindex maint print statistics
34620 @cindex bcache statistics
34621 @item maint print statistics
34622 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34623 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34624 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34625 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34626 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34627 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34628 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34629 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34630 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34631 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34632 lengths.
34633
34634 @kindex maint print target-stack
34635 @cindex target stack description
34636 @item maint print target-stack
34637 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34638 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34639 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34640 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34641 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34642 address.
34643
34644 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34645 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34646
34647 @kindex maint print type
34648 @cindex type chain of a data type
34649 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34650 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34651 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34652 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34653 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34654 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34655
34656 @kindex maint selftest
34657 @cindex self tests
34658 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
34659 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34660
34661 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34662 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34663 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34664 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34665 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34666 information.
34667
34668 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34669 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34670 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34671 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34672 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34673 always see the disassembly form.
34674
34675 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34676
34677 @smallexample
34678 (gdb) info addr argc
34679 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34680 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34681 @end smallexample
34682
34683 For more information on these expressions, see
34684 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34685
34686 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34687 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34688 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34689 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34690 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34691
34692 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34693 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34694 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34695 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34696 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34697 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34698 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34699 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34700 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34701
34702 @kindex maint set profile
34703 @kindex maint show profile
34704 @cindex profiling GDB
34705 @item maint set profile
34706 @itemx maint show profile
34707 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34708
34709 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34710 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34711 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34712 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34713 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34714 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34715 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34716
34717 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34718 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34719
34720 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34721 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34722 @cindex hardware debug registers
34723 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34724 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34725 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34726 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34727 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34728 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34729 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34730
34731 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34732 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34733 @item maint set show-all-tib
34734 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34735 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34736 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34737 command.
34738
34739 @kindex maint set target-async
34740 @kindex maint show target-async
34741 @item maint set target-async
34742 @itemx maint show target-async
34743 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34744 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34745 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34746 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34747
34748 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34749 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34750 @item maint set target-non-stop
34751 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34752
34753 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34754 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34755 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34756 if supported by the target.
34757
34758 @table @code
34759 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34760 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34761 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34762
34763 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34764 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34765 does not indicate support.
34766
34767 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34768 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34769 target supports it.
34770 @end table
34771
34772 @kindex maint set per-command
34773 @kindex maint show per-command
34774 @item maint set per-command
34775 @itemx maint show per-command
34776 @cindex resources used by commands
34777
34778 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34779 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34780
34781 @table @code
34782 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34783 @itemx maint show per-command space
34784 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34785 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34786 took, following the command's own output.
34787 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34788 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34789
34790 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34791 @itemx maint show per-command time
34792 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34793 for each command.
34794 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34795 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34796 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34797 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34798 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34799 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34800 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34801 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34802 spent by the program been debugged.
34803 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34804 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34805
34806 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34807 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34808 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34809 for each command.
34810 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34811
34812 @enumerate a
34813 @item
34814 number of symbol tables
34815 @item
34816 number of primary symbol tables
34817 @item
34818 number of blocks in the blockvector
34819 @end enumerate
34820 @end table
34821
34822 @kindex maint space
34823 @cindex memory used by commands
34824 @item maint space @var{value}
34825 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34826 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34827
34828 @kindex maint time
34829 @cindex time of command execution
34830 @item maint time @var{value}
34831 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34832 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34833
34834 @kindex maint translate-address
34835 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34836 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34837 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34838 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34839 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34840 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34841 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34842
34843 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34844 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34845 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34846
34847 @end table
34848
34849 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34850 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34851
34852 @table @code
34853 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34854 @kindex set watchdog
34855 @cindex watchdog timer
34856 @cindex timeout for commands
34857 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34858 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34859 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34860
34861 @item show watchdog
34862 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34863 @end table
34864
34865 @node Remote Protocol
34866 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34867
34868 @menu
34869 * Overview::
34870 * Packets::
34871 * Stop Reply Packets::
34872 * General Query Packets::
34873 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34874 * Tracepoint Packets::
34875 * Host I/O Packets::
34876 * Interrupts::
34877 * Notification Packets::
34878 * Remote Non-Stop::
34879 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34880 * Examples::
34881 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34882 * Library List Format::
34883 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34884 * Memory Map Format::
34885 * Thread List Format::
34886 * Traceframe Info Format::
34887 * Branch Trace Format::
34888 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34889 @end menu
34890
34891 @node Overview
34892 @section Overview
34893
34894 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34895 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34896 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34897 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34898
34899 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34900 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34901
34902 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34903 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34904 @cindex remote serial protocol
34905 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34906 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34907 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34908 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34909 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34910
34911 @smallexample
34912 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34913 @end smallexample
34914 @noindent
34915
34916 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34917 @noindent
34918 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34919 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34920 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34921
34922 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34923 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34924
34925 @smallexample
34926 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34927 @end smallexample
34928
34929 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34930 @noindent
34931 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34932 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34933 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34934
34935 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34936 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34937 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34938 retransmission):
34939
34940 @smallexample
34941 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34942 <- @code{+}
34943 @end smallexample
34944 @noindent
34945
34946 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34947 once a connection is established.
34948 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34949
34950 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34951 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34952 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34953 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34954 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34955 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34956 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34957
34958 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34959 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34960 exceptions).
34961
34962 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34963 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34964 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34965 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34966
34967 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34968 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34969 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34970
34971 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34972 @anchor{Binary Data}
34973 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34974 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34975 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34976 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34977 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34978 binary data.
34979
34980 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34981 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34982 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34983 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34984 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34985 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34986 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34987 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34988 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34989 (described next).
34990
34991 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34992 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34993 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34994 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34995 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34996 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34997 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34998 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34999 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35000 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35001 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35002 3}} more times.
35003
35004 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35005 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35006 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35007 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35008 @samp{0*"00}.
35009
35010 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35011 error number. That number is not well defined.
35012
35013 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35014 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35015 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35016 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35017 on that response.
35018
35019 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35020 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35021 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35022 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35023 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35024 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35025
35026 @node Packets
35027 @section Packets
35028
35029 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35030 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35031 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35032 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35033
35034 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35035 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35036 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35037 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35038 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35039 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35040 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35041 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35042 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35043 @var{baz}.
35044
35045 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35046 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35047 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35048 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35049 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35050 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35051 pick any thread.
35052
35053 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35054 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35055 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35056 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35057 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35058 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35059 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35060 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35061 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35062 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35063 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35064 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35065 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35066
35067 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35068 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35069 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35070 more information.
35071
35072 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35073 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35074
35075 Here are the packet descriptions.
35076
35077 @table @samp
35078
35079 @item !
35080 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35081 @anchor{extended mode}
35082 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35083 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35084 debugged.
35085
35086 Reply:
35087 @table @samp
35088 @item OK
35089 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35090 @end table
35091
35092 @item ?
35093 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35094 @anchor{? packet}
35095 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35096 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35097 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35098
35099 Reply:
35100 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35101
35102 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35103 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35104 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35105 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35106 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35107
35108 Reply:
35109 @table @samp
35110 @item OK
35111 The arguments were set.
35112 @item E @var{NN}
35113 An error occurred.
35114 @end table
35115
35116 @item b @var{baud}
35117 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35118 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35119 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35120
35121 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35122 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35123 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35124
35125 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35126 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35127 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35128 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35129 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35130
35131 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35132 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35133 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35134 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35135
35136 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35137 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35138
35139 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35140 @anchor{bc}
35141 @item bc
35142 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35143 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35144
35145 Reply:
35146 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35147
35148 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35149 @anchor{bs}
35150 @item bs
35151 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35152 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35153
35154 Reply:
35155 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35156
35157 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35158 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35159 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35160 is omitted, resume at current address.
35161
35162 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35163 packet}.
35164
35165 Reply:
35166 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35167
35168 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35169 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35170 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35171 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35172
35173 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35174 packet}.
35175
35176 Reply:
35177 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35178
35179 @item d
35180 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35181 Toggle debug flag.
35182
35183 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35184 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35185
35186 @item D
35187 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35188 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35189 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35190 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35191 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35192
35193 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35194 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35195 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35196 big-endian hex string.
35197
35198 Reply:
35199 @table @samp
35200 @item OK
35201 for success
35202 @item E @var{NN}
35203 for an error
35204 @end table
35205
35206 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35207 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35208 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35209 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35210 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35211
35212 @item g
35213 @anchor{read registers packet}
35214 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35215 Read general registers.
35216
35217 Reply:
35218 @table @samp
35219 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35220 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35221 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35222 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35223 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35224 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
35225 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
35226
35227 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35228 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35229 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35230 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35231 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35232 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35233 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35234 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35235
35236 @smallexample
35237 -> @code{g}
35238 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35239 @end smallexample
35240
35241 @item E @var{NN}
35242 for an error.
35243 @end table
35244
35245 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35246 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35247 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35248 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35249
35250 Reply:
35251 @table @samp
35252 @item OK
35253 for success
35254 @item E @var{NN}
35255 for an error
35256 @end table
35257
35258 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35259 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35260 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35261 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35262 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35263 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35264 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35265 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35266 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35267
35268 Reply:
35269 @table @samp
35270 @item OK
35271 for success
35272 @item E @var{NN}
35273 for an error
35274 @end table
35275
35276 @c FIXME: JTC:
35277 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35278 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35279 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35280 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35281 @c described. For example:
35282 @c
35283 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35284 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35285 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35286 @c
35287 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35288 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35289 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35290
35291 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35292 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35293 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35294 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35295 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35296 step starting at that address.
35297
35298 @item I
35299 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35300 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35301 step packet}.
35302
35303 @item k
35304 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35305 Kill request.
35306
35307 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35308
35309 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35310 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35311
35312 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35313
35314 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35315 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35316 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35317
35318 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35319 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35320 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35321
35322 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35323 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35324 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35325 (@pxref{? packet}).
35326
35327 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35328 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35329 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35330 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35331 any particular boundary.
35332
35333 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35334 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35335 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35336 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35337 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35338 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35339 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35340 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35341
35342 Reply:
35343 @table @samp
35344 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35345 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35346 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35347 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35348 @item E @var{NN}
35349 @var{NN} is errno
35350 @end table
35351
35352 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35353 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35354 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35355 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35356 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35357
35358 Reply:
35359 @table @samp
35360 @item OK
35361 for success
35362 @item E @var{NN}
35363 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35364 written).
35365 @end table
35366
35367 @item p @var{n}
35368 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35369 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35370 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35371 register value is encoded.
35372
35373 Reply:
35374 @table @samp
35375 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35376 the register's value
35377 @item E @var{NN}
35378 for an error
35379 @item @w{}
35380 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35381 @end table
35382
35383 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35384 @anchor{write register packet}
35385 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35386 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35387 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35388 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35389
35390 Reply:
35391 @table @samp
35392 @item OK
35393 for success
35394 @item E @var{NN}
35395 for an error
35396 @end table
35397
35398 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35399 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35400 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35401 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35402 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35403 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35404
35405 @item r
35406 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35407 Reset the entire system.
35408
35409 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35410
35411 @item R @var{XX}
35412 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35413 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35414 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35415
35416 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35417
35418 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35419 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35420 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35421 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35422
35423 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35424 packet}.
35425
35426 Reply:
35427 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35428
35429 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35430 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35431 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35432 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35433 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35434
35435 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35436 packet}.
35437
35438 Reply:
35439 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35440
35441 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35442 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35443 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35444 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35445 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35446
35447 @item T @var{thread-id}
35448 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35449 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35450
35451 Reply:
35452 @table @samp
35453 @item OK
35454 thread is still alive
35455 @item E @var{NN}
35456 thread is dead
35457 @end table
35458
35459 @item v
35460 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35461 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35462
35463 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35464 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35465 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35466 The process ID is a
35467 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35468 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35469 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35470
35471 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35472 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35473 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35474 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35475 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35476 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35477 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35478 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35479
35480 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35481
35482 Reply:
35483 @table @samp
35484 @item E @var{nn}
35485 for an error
35486 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35487 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35488 @item OK
35489 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35490 @end table
35491
35492 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35493 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35494 @anchor{vCont packet}
35495 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35496 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35497 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35498 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35499 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35500 Specifying multiple
35501 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35502 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35503
35504 Currently supported actions are:
35505
35506 @table @samp
35507 @item c
35508 Continue.
35509 @item C @var{sig}
35510 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35511 @item s
35512 Step.
35513 @item S @var{sig}
35514 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35515 @item t
35516 Stop.
35517 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35518 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35519 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35520 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35521 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35522 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35523
35524 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35525 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35526 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35527 jumps to @var{start}).
35528
35529 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35530 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35531 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35532
35533 @end table
35534
35535 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35536 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35537 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35538
35539 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35540 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35541 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35542 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35543 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35544 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35545 as an implementation detail.
35546
35547 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35548 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35549 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35550 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35551 @var{thread-id}.
35552
35553 Reply:
35554 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35555
35556 @item vCont?
35557 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35558 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35559
35560 Reply:
35561 @table @samp
35562 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35563 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35564 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35565 @item @w{}
35566 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35567 @end table
35568
35569 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35570 @item vCtrlC
35571 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35572 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35573 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35574 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35575 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35576 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35577 variant.
35578
35579 Reply:
35580 @table @samp
35581 @item E @var{nn}
35582 for an error
35583 @item OK
35584 for success
35585 @end table
35586
35587 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35588 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35589 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35590 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35591
35592 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35593 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35594 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35595 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35596 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35597 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35598 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35599 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35600 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35601 packet is received.
35602
35603 Reply:
35604 @table @samp
35605 @item OK
35606 for success
35607 @item E @var{NN}
35608 for an error
35609 @end table
35610
35611 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35612 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35613 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35614 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35615 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35616 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35617 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35618 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35619 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35620 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35621 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35622 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35623
35624
35625 Reply:
35626 @table @samp
35627 @item OK
35628 for success
35629 @item E.memtype
35630 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35631 @item E @var{NN}
35632 for an error
35633 @end table
35634
35635 @item vFlashDone
35636 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35637 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35638 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35639 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35640 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35641 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35642 request is completed.
35643
35644 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35645 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35646 @anchor{vKill packet}
35647 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35648 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35649 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35650 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35651
35652 Reply:
35653 @table @samp
35654 @item E @var{nn}
35655 for an error
35656 @item OK
35657 for success
35658 @end table
35659
35660 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35661 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35662 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35663 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35664 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35665 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35666 state.
35667
35668 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35669
35670 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35671
35672 Reply:
35673 @table @samp
35674 @item E @var{nn}
35675 for an error
35676 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35677 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35678 @end table
35679
35680 @item vStopped
35681 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35682 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35683
35684 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35685 @anchor{X packet}
35686 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35687 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35688 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35689 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35690 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35691
35692 Reply:
35693 @table @samp
35694 @item OK
35695 for success
35696 @item E @var{NN}
35697 for an error
35698 @end table
35699
35700 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35701 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35702 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35703 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35704 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35705 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35706 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35707
35708 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35709 separately.
35710
35711 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35712 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35713 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35714 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35715 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35716 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35717
35718 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35719 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35720 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35721 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35722 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35723 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35724
35725 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35726 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35727 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35728 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35729 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35730 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35731 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35732 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35733 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35734 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35735
35736 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35737 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35738
35739 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35740 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35741
35742 @table @samp
35743
35744 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35745 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35746 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35747
35748 @end table
35749
35750 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35751 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35752 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35753 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35754 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35755 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35756 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35757
35758 @table @samp
35759
35760 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35761 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35762 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35763
35764 @end table
35765
35766 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35767
35768 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35769 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35770 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35771 target, is not defined.}
35772
35773 Reply:
35774 @table @samp
35775 @item OK
35776 success
35777 @item @w{}
35778 not supported
35779 @item E @var{NN}
35780 for an error
35781 @end table
35782
35783 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35784 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35785 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35786 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35787 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35788 address @var{addr}.
35789
35790 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35791 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35792 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35793
35794 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35795 movement.}
35796
35797 Reply:
35798 @table @samp
35799 @item OK
35800 success
35801 @item @w{}
35802 not supported
35803 @item E @var{NN}
35804 for an error
35805 @end table
35806
35807 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35808 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35809 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35810 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35811 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35812 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35813
35814 Reply:
35815 @table @samp
35816 @item OK
35817 success
35818 @item @w{}
35819 not supported
35820 @item E @var{NN}
35821 for an error
35822 @end table
35823
35824 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35825 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35826 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35827 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35828 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35829 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35830
35831 Reply:
35832 @table @samp
35833 @item OK
35834 success
35835 @item @w{}
35836 not supported
35837 @item E @var{NN}
35838 for an error
35839 @end table
35840
35841 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35842 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35843 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35844 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35845 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35846 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35847
35848 Reply:
35849 @table @samp
35850 @item OK
35851 success
35852 @item @w{}
35853 not supported
35854 @item E @var{NN}
35855 for an error
35856 @end table
35857
35858 @end table
35859
35860 @node Stop Reply Packets
35861 @section Stop Reply Packets
35862 @cindex stop reply packets
35863
35864 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35865 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35866 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35867 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35868 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35869 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35870 @value{GDBN} source code.
35871
35872 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35873 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35874 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35875 components.
35876
35877 @table @samp
35878
35879 @item S @var{AA}
35880 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35881 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35882 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35883
35884 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35885 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35886 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35887 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35888 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35889 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35890 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35891 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35892
35893 @itemize @bullet
35894 @item
35895 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35896 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35897 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35898 two-digit hex number.
35899
35900 @item
35901 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35902 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35903
35904 @item
35905 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35906 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35907
35908 @item
35909 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35910 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35911 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35912 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35913
35914 @item
35915 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35916 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35917 future.
35918 @end itemize
35919
35920 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35921
35922 @table @samp
35923 @item watch
35924 @itemx rwatch
35925 @itemx awatch
35926 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35927 hex.
35928
35929 @item syscall_entry
35930 @itemx syscall_return
35931 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35932 syscall number, in hex.
35933
35934 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35935 @item library
35936 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35937 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35938 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35939
35940 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35941 @item replaylog
35942 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35943 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35944 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35945 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35946 for more information.
35947
35948 @item swbreak
35949 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35950 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35951 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35952 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35953 part must be left empty.
35954
35955 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35956 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35957 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35958 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35959 address.
35960
35961 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35962 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35963 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35964 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35965 indicating support.
35966
35967 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35968
35969 @item hwbreak
35970 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35971 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35972
35973 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35974 apply.
35975
35976 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35977 @item fork
35978 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35979 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35980 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35981 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35982 fork events.
35983
35984 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35985 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35986 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35987 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35988 indicating support.
35989
35990 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35991 @item vfork
35992 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35993 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35994 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35995 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35996 vfork events.
35997
35998 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35999 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36000 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36001 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36002 indicating support.
36003
36004 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36005 @item vforkdone
36006 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36007 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36008 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36009 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36010 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36011
36012 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36013 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36014 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36015 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36016 indicating support.
36017
36018 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36019 @item exec
36020 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36021 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36022 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36023
36024 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36025 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36026 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36027 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36028 indicating support.
36029
36030 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36031 @anchor{thread create event}
36032 @item create
36033 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36034 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36035 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36036 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36037 also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
36038
36039 @end table
36040
36041 @item W @var{AA}
36042 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36043 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36044 applicable to certain targets.
36045
36046 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
36047 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
36048 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36049 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36050
36051 @item X @var{AA}
36052 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36053 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36054
36055 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36056 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36057 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36058 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36059
36060 @anchor{thread exit event}
36061 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36062 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36063
36064 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36065 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36066 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36067
36068 @item N
36069 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36070 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36071 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36072 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36073 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36074 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36075 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36076 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36077 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36078 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36079 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36080 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36081 support.
36082
36083 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36084 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36085 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36086 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36087 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36088
36089 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36090 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36091 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36092 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36093 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36094 system calls.
36095
36096 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36097 this very system call.
36098
36099 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36100 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36101 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36102 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36103 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36104 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36105
36106 @end table
36107
36108 @node General Query Packets
36109 @section General Query Packets
36110 @cindex remote query requests
36111
36112 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36113 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36114 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36115 sending information to and from the stub.
36116
36117 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36118 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36119 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36120 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36121 conventions:
36122
36123 @itemize @bullet
36124 @item
36125 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36126 @item
36127 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36128 letter.
36129 @item
36130 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36131 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36132 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36133 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36134 @end itemize
36135
36136 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36137 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36138 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36139 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36140 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36141 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36142 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36143 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36144 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36145 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36146 packet.}.
36147
36148 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36149 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36150 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36151 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36152 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36153
36154 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36155
36156 @table @samp
36157
36158 @item QAgent:1
36159 @itemx QAgent:0
36160 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36161 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36162
36163 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36164 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36165 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36166 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36167 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36168 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36169 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36170 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36171 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36172 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36173 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36174
36175 @item qC
36176 @cindex current thread, remote request
36177 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36178 Return the current thread ID.
36179
36180 Reply:
36181 @table @samp
36182 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36183 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36184 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36185 @item @r{(anything else)}
36186 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36187 @end table
36188
36189 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36190 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36191 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36192 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36193 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36194 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36195 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36196 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36197
36198 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36199 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36200 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36201 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36202 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36203 detect trailing zeros.
36204
36205 Reply:
36206 @table @samp
36207 @item E @var{NN}
36208 An error (such as memory fault)
36209 @item C @var{crc32}
36210 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36211 @end table
36212
36213 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36214 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36215 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36216 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36217 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36218 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36219 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36220 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36221 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36222 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36223 randomization.
36224
36225 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36226
36227 Reply:
36228 @table @samp
36229 @item OK
36230 The request succeeded.
36231
36232 @item E @var{nn}
36233 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36234
36235 @item @w{}
36236 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36237 by the stub.
36238 @end table
36239
36240 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36241 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36242 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36243 address space randomization.
36244
36245 @item qfThreadInfo
36246 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36247 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36248 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36249 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36250 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36251 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36252 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36253 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36254 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36255 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36256
36257 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36258
36259 Reply:
36260 @table @samp
36261 @item m @var{thread-id}
36262 A single thread ID
36263 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36264 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36265 @item l
36266 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36267 @end table
36268
36269 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36270 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36271 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36272 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36273 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36274 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36275 fields.
36276
36277 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36278 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36279 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36280 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36281 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36282
36283 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36284 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36285 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36286 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36287 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36288
36289 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36290 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36291
36292 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36293 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36294 information associated with the variable.)
36295
36296 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36297 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36298 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36299 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36300 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36301 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36302
36303 Reply:
36304 @table @samp
36305 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36306 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36307 local storage requested.
36308
36309 @item E @var{nn}
36310 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36311
36312 @item @w{}
36313 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36314 @end table
36315
36316 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36317 @cindex get thread information block address
36318 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36319 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36320
36321 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36322
36323 Reply:
36324 @table @samp
36325 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36326 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36327 thread information block.
36328
36329 @item E @var{nn}
36330 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36331 address could not be retrieved.
36332
36333 @item @w{}
36334 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36335 @end table
36336
36337 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36338 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36339 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36340 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36341 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36342 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36343 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36344
36345 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36346
36347 Reply:
36348 @table @samp
36349 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36350 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36351 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36352 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36353 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36354 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36355 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36356 @end table
36357
36358 @item qOffsets
36359 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36360 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36361 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36362 image.
36363
36364 Reply:
36365 @table @samp
36366 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36367 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36368 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36369 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36370 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36371 segments by the supplied offsets.
36372
36373 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36374 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36375 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36376
36377 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36378 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36379 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36380 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36381 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36382 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36383 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36384 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36385 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36386 @end table
36387
36388 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36389 @cindex thread information, remote request
36390 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36391 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36392 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36393 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36394
36395 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36396 (see below).
36397
36398 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36399
36400 @item QNonStop:1
36401 @itemx QNonStop:0
36402 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36403 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36404 @anchor{QNonStop}
36405 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36406 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36407
36408 Reply:
36409 @table @samp
36410 @item OK
36411 The request succeeded.
36412
36413 @item E @var{nn}
36414 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36415
36416 @item @w{}
36417 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36418 the stub.
36419 @end table
36420
36421 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36422 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36423 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36424 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36425
36426 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36427 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36428 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36429 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36430 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36431 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36432 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36433
36434 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36435 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36436 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36437
36438 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36439 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36440 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36441 report the requested syscalls.
36442
36443 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36444 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36445
36446 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36447 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36448 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36449 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36450
36451 Reply:
36452 @table @samp
36453 @item OK
36454 The request succeeded.
36455
36456 @item E @var{nn}
36457 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36458
36459 @item @w{}
36460 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36461 the stub.
36462 @end table
36463
36464 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36465 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36466 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36467 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36468
36469 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36470 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36471 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36472 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36473 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36474 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36475 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36476 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36477 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36478 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36479 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36480 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36481 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36482
36483 Reply:
36484 @table @samp
36485 @item OK
36486 The request succeeded.
36487
36488 @item E @var{nn}
36489 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36490
36491 @item @w{}
36492 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36493 the stub.
36494 @end table
36495
36496 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36497 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36498 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36499 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36500
36501 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36502 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36503 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36504 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36505 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36506 Others should be silently discarded.
36507
36508 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36509 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36510 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36511 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36512 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36513 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36514 signals.
36515
36516 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36517 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36518
36519 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36520 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36521 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36522 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36523 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36524
36525 Reply:
36526 @table @samp
36527 @item OK
36528 The request succeeded.
36529
36530 @item E @var{nn}
36531 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36532
36533 @item @w{}
36534 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36535 by the stub.
36536 @end table
36537
36538 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36539 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36540 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36541 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36542
36543 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36544 @item QThreadEvents:1
36545 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36546 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36547 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36548
36549 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36550 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36551 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36552 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36553 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36554 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36555 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36556 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36557 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36558 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36559
36560 Reply:
36561 @table @samp
36562 @item OK
36563 The request succeeded.
36564
36565 @item E @var{nn}
36566 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36567
36568 @item @w{}
36569 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36570 the stub.
36571 @end table
36572
36573 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36574 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36575
36576 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36577 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36578 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36579 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36580 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36581 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36582 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36583 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36584 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36585
36586 Reply:
36587 @table @samp
36588 @item OK
36589 A command response with no output.
36590 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36591 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36592 @item E @var{NN}
36593 Indicate a badly formed request.
36594 @item @w{}
36595 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36596 @end table
36597
36598 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36599 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36600 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36601 packets.)
36602
36603 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36604 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36605 @ifnotinfo
36606 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36607 @end ifnotinfo
36608 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36609 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36610 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36611 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36612 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36613
36614 Reply:
36615 @table @samp
36616 @item 0
36617 The pattern was not found.
36618 @item 1,address
36619 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36620 @item E @var{NN}
36621 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36622 @item @w{}
36623 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36624 @end table
36625
36626 @item QStartNoAckMode
36627 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36628 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36629 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36630 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36631
36632 Reply:
36633 @table @samp
36634 @item OK
36635 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36636 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36637 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36638 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36639 @item @w{}
36640 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36641 @end table
36642
36643 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36644 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36645 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36646 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36647 @anchor{qSupported}
36648 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36649 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36650 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36651 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36652 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36653 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36654 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36655 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36656 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36657 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36658 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36659 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36660 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36661 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36662
36663 Reply:
36664 @table @samp
36665 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36666 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36667 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36668 possible forms).
36669 @item @w{}
36670 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36671 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36672 @end table
36673
36674 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36675 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36676 are:
36677
36678 @table @samp
36679 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36680 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36681 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36682 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36683 @item @var{name}+
36684 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36685 need an associated value.
36686 @item @var{name}-
36687 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36688 @item @var{name}?
36689 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36690 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36691 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36692 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36693 @end table
36694
36695 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36696 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36697 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36698 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36699 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36700
36701 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36702 are defined:
36703
36704 @table @samp
36705 @item multiprocess
36706 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36707 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36708 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36709 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36710 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36711
36712 @item xmlRegisters
36713 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36714 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36715 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36716 description.
36717
36718 @item qRelocInsn
36719 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36720 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36721 instruction reply packet}).
36722
36723 @item swbreak
36724 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36725 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36726
36727 @item hwbreak
36728 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36729 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36730
36731 @item fork-events
36732 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36733 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36734 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36735 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36736
36737 @item vfork-events
36738 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36739 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36740 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36741 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36742
36743 @item exec-events
36744 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36745 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36746 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36747 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36748
36749 @item vContSupported
36750 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36751 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36752 @end table
36753
36754 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36755 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36756 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36757 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36758 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36759 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36760 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36761 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36762 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36763 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36764 all the features it supports.
36765
36766 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36767 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36768
36769 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36770 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36771 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36772 form response.
36773
36774 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36775 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36776 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36777 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36778
36779 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36780 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36781 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36782 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36783 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36784
36785 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36786
36787 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36788 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36789 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36790 @item Feature Name
36791 @tab Value Required
36792 @tab Default
36793 @tab Probe Allowed
36794
36795 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36796 @tab Yes
36797 @tab @samp{-}
36798 @tab No
36799
36800 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36801 @tab No
36802 @tab @samp{-}
36803 @tab Yes
36804
36805 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36806 @tab No
36807 @tab @samp{-}
36808 @tab Yes
36809
36810 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36811 @tab No
36812 @tab @samp{-}
36813 @tab Yes
36814
36815 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36816 @tab No
36817 @tab @samp{-}
36818 @tab Yes
36819
36820 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36821 @tab No
36822 @tab @samp{-}
36823 @tab Yes
36824
36825 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36826 @tab No
36827 @tab @samp{-}
36828 @tab Yes
36829
36830 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36831 @tab No
36832 @tab @samp{-}
36833 @tab Yes
36834
36835 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36836 @tab No
36837 @tab @samp{-}
36838 @tab No
36839
36840 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36841 @tab No
36842 @tab @samp{-}
36843 @tab Yes
36844
36845 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36846 @tab No
36847 @tab @samp{-}
36848 @tab Yes
36849
36850 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36851 @tab No
36852 @tab @samp{-}
36853 @tab Yes
36854
36855 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36856 @tab No
36857 @tab @samp{-}
36858 @tab Yes
36859
36860 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36861 @tab No
36862 @tab @samp{-}
36863 @tab Yes
36864
36865 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36866 @tab No
36867 @tab @samp{-}
36868 @tab Yes
36869
36870 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36871 @tab No
36872 @tab @samp{-}
36873 @tab Yes
36874
36875 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36876 @tab No
36877 @tab @samp{-}
36878 @tab Yes
36879
36880 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36881 @tab No
36882 @tab @samp{-}
36883 @tab Yes
36884
36885 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36886 @tab No
36887 @tab @samp{-}
36888 @tab Yes
36889
36890 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36891 @tab Yes
36892 @tab @samp{-}
36893 @tab Yes
36894
36895 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36896 @tab Yes
36897 @tab @samp{-}
36898 @tab Yes
36899
36900 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36901 @tab Yes
36902 @tab @samp{-}
36903 @tab Yes
36904
36905 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36906 @tab Yes
36907 @tab @samp{-}
36908 @tab Yes
36909
36910 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36911 @tab Yes
36912 @tab @samp{-}
36913 @tab Yes
36914
36915 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36916 @tab No
36917 @tab @samp{-}
36918 @tab Yes
36919
36920 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36921 @tab No
36922 @tab @samp{-}
36923 @tab Yes
36924
36925 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36926 @tab No
36927 @tab @samp{-}
36928 @tab Yes
36929
36930 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36931 @tab No
36932 @tab @samp{-}
36933 @tab Yes
36934
36935 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36936 @tab No
36937 @tab @samp{-}
36938 @tab No
36939
36940 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36941 @tab No
36942 @tab @samp{-}
36943 @tab No
36944
36945 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36946 @tab No
36947 @tab @samp{-}
36948 @tab No
36949
36950 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36951 @tab No
36952 @tab @samp{-}
36953 @tab No
36954
36955 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36956 @tab No
36957 @tab @samp{-}
36958 @tab No
36959
36960 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36961 @tab No
36962 @tab @samp{-}
36963 @tab No
36964
36965 @item @samp{QAgent}
36966 @tab No
36967 @tab @samp{-}
36968 @tab No
36969
36970 @item @samp{QAllow}
36971 @tab No
36972 @tab @samp{-}
36973 @tab No
36974
36975 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36976 @tab No
36977 @tab @samp{-}
36978 @tab No
36979
36980 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36981 @tab No
36982 @tab @samp{-}
36983 @tab No
36984
36985 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36986 @tab No
36987 @tab @samp{-}
36988 @tab No
36989
36990 @item @samp{tracenz}
36991 @tab No
36992 @tab @samp{-}
36993 @tab No
36994
36995 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36996 @tab No
36997 @tab @samp{-}
36998 @tab No
36999
37000 @item @samp{swbreak}
37001 @tab No
37002 @tab @samp{-}
37003 @tab No
37004
37005 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37006 @tab No
37007 @tab @samp{-}
37008 @tab No
37009
37010 @item @samp{fork-events}
37011 @tab No
37012 @tab @samp{-}
37013 @tab No
37014
37015 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37016 @tab No
37017 @tab @samp{-}
37018 @tab No
37019
37020 @item @samp{exec-events}
37021 @tab No
37022 @tab @samp{-}
37023 @tab No
37024
37025 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37026 @tab No
37027 @tab @samp{-}
37028 @tab No
37029
37030 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37031 @tab No
37032 @tab @samp{-}
37033 @tab No
37034
37035 @end multitable
37036
37037 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37038
37039 @table @samp
37040 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37041 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37042 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37043 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37044 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37045 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37046 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37047 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37048 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37049 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37050
37051 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37052 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37053 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37054
37055 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37056 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37057 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37058
37059 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37060 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37061 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37062
37063 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37064 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37065 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37066
37067 @item qXfer:features:read
37068 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37069 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37070
37071 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37072 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37073 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37074
37075 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37076 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37077 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37078
37079 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37080 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37081 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37082 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37083
37084 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37085 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37086 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37087
37088 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37089 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37090 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37091
37092 @item qXfer:spu:read
37093 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37094 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37095
37096 @item qXfer:spu:write
37097 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37098 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37099
37100 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37101 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37102 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37103
37104 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37105 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37106 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37107
37108 @item qXfer:threads:read
37109 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37110 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37111
37112 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37113 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37114 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37115
37116 @item qXfer:uib:read
37117 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37118 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37119
37120 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37121 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37122 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37123
37124 @item QNonStop
37125 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37126 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37127
37128 @item QCatchSyscalls
37129 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37130 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37131
37132 @item QPassSignals
37133 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37134 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37135
37136 @item QStartNoAckMode
37137 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37138 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37139
37140 @item multiprocess
37141 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37142 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37143 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37144 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37145 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37146 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37147 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37148 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37149 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37150 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37151 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37152
37153 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37154 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37155 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37156
37157 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37158 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37159 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37160 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37161
37162 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37163 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37164 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37165
37166 @item ReverseContinue
37167 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37168 (@pxref{bc}).
37169
37170 @item ReverseStep
37171 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37172 (@pxref{bs}).
37173
37174 @item TracepointSource
37175 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37176 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37177
37178 @item QAgent
37179 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37180
37181 @item QAllow
37182 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37183
37184 @item QDisableRandomization
37185 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37186
37187 @item StaticTracepoint
37188 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37189 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37190
37191 @item InstallInTrace
37192 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37193 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37194
37195 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37196 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37197 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37198 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37199
37200 @item QTBuffer:size
37201 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37202 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37203
37204 @item tracenz
37205 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37206 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37207 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37208
37209 @item BreakpointCommands
37210 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37211 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37212 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37213
37214 @item Qbtrace:off
37215 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37216
37217 @item Qbtrace:bts
37218 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37219
37220 @item Qbtrace:pt
37221 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37222
37223 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37224 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37225
37226 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37227 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37228
37229 @item swbreak
37230 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37231 breakpoints.
37232
37233 @item hwbreak
37234 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37235 breakpoints.
37236
37237 @item fork-events
37238 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37239
37240 @item vfork-events
37241 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37242 and vforkdone events.
37243
37244 @item exec-events
37245 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37246
37247 @item vContSupported
37248 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37249 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37250
37251 @item QThreadEvents
37252 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37253
37254 @item no-resumed
37255 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37256
37257 @end table
37258
37259 @item qSymbol::
37260 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37261 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37262 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37263 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37264
37265 Reply:
37266 @table @samp
37267 @item OK
37268 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37269 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37270 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37271 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37272 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37273 below.
37274 @end table
37275
37276 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37277 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37278
37279 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37280 target has previously requested.
37281
37282 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37283 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37284 will be empty.
37285
37286 Reply:
37287 @table @samp
37288 @item OK
37289 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37290 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37291 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37292 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37293 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37294 @end table
37295
37296 @item qTBuffer
37297 @itemx QTBuffer
37298 @itemx QTDisconnected
37299 @itemx QTDP
37300 @itemx QTDPsrc
37301 @itemx QTDV
37302 @itemx qTfP
37303 @itemx qTfV
37304 @itemx QTFrame
37305 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37306
37307 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37308
37309 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37310 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37311 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37312 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37313 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37314 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37315 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37316 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37317 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37318 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37319 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37320
37321 Reply:
37322 @table @samp
37323 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37324 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37325 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37326 the thread's attributes.
37327 @end table
37328
37329 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37330 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37331 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37332 packets.)
37333
37334 @item QTNotes
37335 @itemx qTP
37336 @itemx QTSave
37337 @itemx qTsP
37338 @itemx qTsV
37339 @itemx QTStart
37340 @itemx QTStop
37341 @itemx QTEnable
37342 @itemx QTDisable
37343 @itemx QTinit
37344 @itemx QTro
37345 @itemx qTStatus
37346 @itemx qTV
37347 @itemx qTfSTM
37348 @itemx qTsSTM
37349 @itemx qTSTMat
37350 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37351
37352 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37353 @cindex read special object, remote request
37354 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37355 @anchor{qXfer read}
37356 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37357 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37358 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37359 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37360 additional details about what data to access.
37361
37362 Reply:
37363 @table @samp
37364 @item m @var{data}
37365 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37366 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37367 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37368 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37369 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37370 request.
37371
37372 @item l @var{data}
37373 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37374 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37375 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37376
37377 @item l
37378 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37379 There is no more data to be read.
37380
37381 @item E00
37382 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37383
37384 @item E @var{nn}
37385 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37386 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37387
37388 @item @w{}
37389 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37390 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37391 @end table
37392
37393 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37394 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37395 formats, listed above.
37396
37397 @table @samp
37398 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37399 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37400 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37401 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37402
37403 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37404 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37405
37406 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37407 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37408
37409 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37410 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37411 packet may have one of the following values:
37412
37413 @table @code
37414 @item all
37415 Returns all available branch trace.
37416
37417 @item new
37418 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37419 the last read request.
37420
37421 @item delta
37422 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37423 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37424 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37425 used to stitch traces together.
37426
37427 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37428 @end table
37429
37430 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37431 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37432
37433 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37434 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37435
37436 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37437 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37438
37439 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37440 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37441
37442 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37443 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37444 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37445 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37446 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37447 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37448 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37449
37450 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37451 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37452
37453 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37454 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37455 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37456 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37457 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37458
37459 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37460 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37461
37462 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37463 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37464 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37465 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37466 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37467
37468 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37469 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37470 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37471
37472 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37473 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37474
37475 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37476 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37477 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37478 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37479 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37480 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37481 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37482 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37483
37484 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37485 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37486
37487 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37488 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37489
37490 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37491 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37492 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37493 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37494
37495 @table @code
37496 @item start=@var{address}
37497 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37498 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37499 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37500 chosen as the starting point.
37501
37502 @item prev=@var{address}
37503 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37504 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37505 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37506 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37507 exists prior to the starting point.
37508
37509 @end table
37510
37511 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37512 ignored.
37513
37514 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37515 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37516 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37517 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37518 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37519
37520 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37521 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37522
37523 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37524 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37525
37526 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37527 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37528 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37529 Action Lists}.
37530
37531 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37532 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37533 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37534
37535 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37536 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37537 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37538 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37539 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37540
37541 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37542 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37543 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37544
37545 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37546 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37547 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37548 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37549 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37550 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37551 in that context to be accessed.
37552
37553 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37554 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37555 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37556
37557 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37558 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37559 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37560 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37561 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37562
37563 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37564 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37565
37566 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37567 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37568
37569 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37570 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37571 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37572
37573 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37574 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37575
37576 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37577 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37578
37579 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37580 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37581
37582 This packet is not probed by default.
37583
37584 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37585 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37586 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37587 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37588 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37589
37590 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37591 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37592
37593 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37594 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37595 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37596 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37597
37598 @end table
37599
37600 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37601 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37602 @anchor{qXfer write}
37603 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37604 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37605 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37606 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37607 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37608 to access.
37609
37610 Reply:
37611 @table @samp
37612 @item @var{nn}
37613 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37614 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37615
37616 @item E00
37617 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37618
37619 @item E @var{nn}
37620 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37621 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37622
37623 @item @w{}
37624 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37625 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37626 @end table
37627
37628 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37629 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37630 formats, listed above.
37631
37632 @table @samp
37633 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37634 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37635 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37636 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37637 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37638
37639 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37640 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37641 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37642
37643 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37644 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37645 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37646 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37647 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37648 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37649 in that context to be accessed.
37650
37651 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37652 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37653 @end table
37654
37655 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37656 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37657 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37658 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37659 must respond with an empty packet.
37660
37661 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37662 @cindex query attached, remote request
37663 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37664 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37665 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37666 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37667 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37668 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37669 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37670
37671 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37672 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37673 the @code{quit} command.
37674
37675 Reply:
37676 @table @samp
37677 @item 1
37678 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37679 @item 0
37680 The remote server created a new process.
37681 @item E @var{NN}
37682 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37683 @end table
37684
37685 @item Qbtrace:bts
37686 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37687
37688 Reply:
37689 @table @samp
37690 @item OK
37691 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37692 @item E.errtext
37693 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37694 @end table
37695
37696 @item Qbtrace:pt
37697 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37698
37699 Reply:
37700 @table @samp
37701 @item OK
37702 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37703 @item E.errtext
37704 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37705 @end table
37706
37707 @item Qbtrace:off
37708 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37709
37710 Reply:
37711 @table @samp
37712 @item OK
37713 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37714 @item E.errtext
37715 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37716 @end table
37717
37718 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37719 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37720 btrace recording method in bts format.
37721
37722 Reply:
37723 @table @samp
37724 @item OK
37725 The ring buffer size has been set.
37726 @item E.errtext
37727 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37728 @end table
37729
37730 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37731 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37732 btrace recording method in pt format.
37733
37734 Reply:
37735 @table @samp
37736 @item OK
37737 The ring buffer size has been set.
37738 @item E.errtext
37739 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37740 @end table
37741
37742 @end table
37743
37744 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37745 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37746
37747 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37748 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37749 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37750
37751 @menu
37752 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37753 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37754 @end menu
37755
37756 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37757 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37758
37759 @menu
37760 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37761 @end menu
37762
37763 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37764 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37765 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37766
37767 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37768
37769 @table @r
37770
37771 @item 2
37772 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37773
37774 @item 3
37775 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37776
37777 @item 4
37778 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37779
37780 @end table
37781
37782 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37783 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37784
37785 @menu
37786 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37787 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37788 @end menu
37789
37790 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37791 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37792 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37793
37794 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37795 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37796 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37797 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37798 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37799 most-significant -- least-significant.
37800
37801 @table @r
37802
37803 @item MIPS32
37804 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37805 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37806 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37807
37808 @item MIPS64
37809 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37810 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37811 as @code{MIPS32}.
37812
37813 @end table
37814
37815 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37816 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37817 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37818
37819 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37820
37821 @table @r
37822
37823 @item 2
37824 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37825
37826 @item 3
37827 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37828
37829 @item 4
37830 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37831
37832 @item 5
37833 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37834
37835 @end table
37836
37837 @node Tracepoint Packets
37838 @section Tracepoint Packets
37839 @cindex tracepoint packets
37840 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37841
37842 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37843 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37844
37845 @table @samp
37846
37847 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37848 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37849 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37850 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37851 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37852 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37853 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37854 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37855 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37856 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37857 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37858 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37859 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37860 actions.
37861
37862 Replies:
37863 @table @samp
37864 @item OK
37865 The packet was understood and carried out.
37866 @item qRelocInsn
37867 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37868 @item @w{}
37869 The packet was not recognized.
37870 @end table
37871
37872 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37873 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37874 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37875 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37876 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37877 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37878 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37879
37880 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37881 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37882 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37883 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37884 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37885 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37886 tracepoint actions.
37887
37888 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37889 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37890 following forms:
37891
37892 @table @samp
37893
37894 @item R @var{mask}
37895 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37896 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37897 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37898 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37899 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37900
37901 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37902 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37903 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37904 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37905 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37906 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37907 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37908
37909 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37910 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37911 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37912 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37913 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37914 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37915 packet).
37916
37917 @end table
37918
37919 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37920 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37921 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37922 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37923 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37924 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37925 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37926 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37927
37928 Replies:
37929 @table @samp
37930 @item OK
37931 The packet was understood and carried out.
37932 @item qRelocInsn
37933 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37934 @item @w{}
37935 The packet was not recognized.
37936 @end table
37937
37938 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37939 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37940 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37941 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37942 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37943 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37944 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37945 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37946
37947 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37948 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37949 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37950 fit in a single packet.
37951 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37952 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37953
37954 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37955 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37956 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37957 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37958
37959 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37960 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37961 query packets.
37962
37963 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37964 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37965 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37966 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37967 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37968 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37969 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37970 be found.
37971
37972 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37973 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37974 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37975 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37976 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37977 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37978 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37979 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37980 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37981 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37982 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37983 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37984 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37985 variable.
37986
37987 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37988 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37989 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37990 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37991 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37992
37993 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37994 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37995 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37996 one of the following forms:
37997
37998 @table @samp
37999 @item F @var{f}
38000 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38001 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38002 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38003
38004 @item T @var{t}
38005 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38006 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38007
38008 @end table
38009
38010 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38011 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38012 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38013 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38014
38015 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38016 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38017 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38018 is a hexadecimal number.
38019
38020 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38021 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38022 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38023 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38024 numbers.
38025
38026 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38027 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38028 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38029
38030 @item qTMinFTPILen
38031 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38032 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38033 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38034 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38035 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38036 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38037 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38038 arrange for that.
38039
38040 Replies:
38041
38042 @table @samp
38043 @item 0
38044 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38045 @item @var{length}
38046 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38047 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38048 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38049 regardless of size.
38050 @item E
38051 An error has occurred.
38052 @item @w{}
38053 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38054 @end table
38055
38056 @item QTStart
38057 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38058 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38059 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38060 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38061 instruction reply packet}).
38062
38063 @item QTStop
38064 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38065 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38066
38067 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38068 @anchor{QTEnable}
38069 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38070 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38071 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38072 of data from it will resume.
38073
38074 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38075 @anchor{QTDisable}
38076 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38077 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38078 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38079 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38080
38081 @item QTinit
38082 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38083 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38084
38085 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38086 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38087 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38088 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38089 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38090
38091 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38092 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38093 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38094 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38095
38096 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38097 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38098 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38099 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38100 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38101 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38102
38103 @item qTStatus
38104 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38105 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38106
38107 The reply has the form:
38108
38109 @table @samp
38110
38111 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38112 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38113 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38114 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38115
38116 @end table
38117
38118 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38119 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38120
38121 @table @samp
38122
38123 @item tnotrun:0
38124 No trace has been run yet.
38125
38126 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38127 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38128 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38129 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38130 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38131
38132 @item tfull:0
38133 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38134
38135 @item tdisconnected:0
38136 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38137
38138 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38139 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38140
38141 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38142 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38143 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38144 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38145 is hex encoded.
38146
38147 @item tunknown:0
38148 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38149
38150 @end table
38151
38152 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38153 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38154 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38155 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38156 trace.
38157
38158 @table @samp
38159
38160 @item tframes:@var{n}
38161 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38162
38163 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38164 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38165 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38166
38167 @item tsize:@var{n}
38168 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38169
38170 @item tfree:@var{n}
38171 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38172
38173 @item circular:@var{n}
38174 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38175 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38176 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38177 and may fill up.
38178
38179 @item disconn:@var{n}
38180 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38181 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38182 that the trace run will stop.
38183
38184 @end table
38185
38186 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38187 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38188 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38189 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38190 address @var{addr}.
38191
38192 Replies:
38193 @table @samp
38194 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38195 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38196 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38197 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38198 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38199
38200 @end table
38201
38202 @item qTV:@var{var}
38203 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38204 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38205 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38206
38207 Replies:
38208 @table @samp
38209 @item V@var{value}
38210 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38211 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38212 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38213 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38214 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38215 program is running.
38216
38217 @item U
38218 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38219 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38220 was not collected.
38221 @end table
38222
38223 @item qTfP
38224 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38225 @itemx qTsP
38226 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38227 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38228 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38229 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38230 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38231 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38232
38233 @item qTfV
38234 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38235 @itemx qTsV
38236 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38237 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38238 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38239 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38240 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38241 trace state variables.
38242
38243 @item qTfSTM
38244 @itemx qTsSTM
38245 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38246 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38247 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38248 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38249 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38250 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38251 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38252 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38253
38254 Reply:
38255 @table @samp
38256 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38257 A single marker
38258 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38259 a comma-separated list of markers
38260 @item l
38261 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38262 @item E @var{nn}
38263 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38264 @item @w{}
38265 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38266 stub.
38267 @end table
38268
38269 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38270 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38271
38272 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38273 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38274 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38275 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38276 @dfn{last}).
38277
38278 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38279 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38280 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38281 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38282 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38283 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38284 tracepoint markers.
38285
38286 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38287 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38288 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38289 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38290 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38291 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38292
38293 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38294 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38295 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38296 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38297 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38298 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38299 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38300 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38301 available.
38302
38303 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38304 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38305 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38306
38307 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38308 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38309 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38310 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38311 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38312 use whatever size it prefers.
38313
38314 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38315 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38316 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38317 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38318 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38319
38320 @end table
38321
38322 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38323 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38324 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38325 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38326 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38327 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38328 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38329 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38330 it had executed in the original location.
38331
38332 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38333 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38334 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38335 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38336 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38337 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38338 format of the request is:
38339
38340 @table @samp
38341 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38342
38343 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38344 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38345 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38346 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38347 memory starting at @var{to}.
38348 @end table
38349
38350 Replies:
38351 @table @samp
38352 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38353 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38354 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38355 @item E @var{NN}
38356 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38357 relocating the instruction.
38358 @end table
38359
38360 @node Host I/O Packets
38361 @section Host I/O Packets
38362 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38363 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38364
38365 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38366 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38367 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38368 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38369 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38370 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38371 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38372 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38373 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38374 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38375
38376 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38377 its arguments. They have this format:
38378
38379 @table @samp
38380
38381 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38382 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38383 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38384 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38385 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38386 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38387 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38388 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38389 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38390
38391 @end table
38392
38393 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38394
38395 @table @samp
38396
38397 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38398 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38399 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38400 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38401 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38402 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38403 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38404 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38405 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38406 @var{attachment}.
38407
38408 @item @w{}
38409 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38410
38411 @end table
38412
38413 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38414
38415 @table @samp
38416 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38417 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38418 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38419 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38420 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38421 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38422 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38423
38424 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38425 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38426 -1 if an error occurs.
38427
38428 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38429 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38430 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38431 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38432 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38433 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38434 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38435 @var{count} was zero.
38436
38437 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38438 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38439 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38440 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38441 some characters were escaped.
38442
38443 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38444 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38445 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38446 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38447 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38448 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38449 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38450 error occurred.
38451
38452 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38453 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38454 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38455 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38456 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38457 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38458
38459 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38460 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38461 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38462
38463 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38464 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38465 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38466
38467 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38468 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38469 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38470 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38471 some characters were escaped.
38472
38473 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38474 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38475 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38476 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38477 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38478 inferior(s).
38479
38480 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38481 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38482 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38483 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38484 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38485 operation.
38486
38487 @end table
38488
38489 @node Interrupts
38490 @section Interrupts
38491 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38492 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38493
38494 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38495 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38496 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38497 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38498
38499 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38500 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38501 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38502 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38503 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38504
38505 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38506 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38507 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38508 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38509 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38510 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38511 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38512 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38513
38514 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38515 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38516 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38517
38518 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38519 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38520 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38521 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38522 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38523 @code{0x03}.
38524
38525 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38526 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38527 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38528 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38529 currently-executing threads and processes.
38530 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38531 running program, it should send one of the stop
38532 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38533 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38534 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38535 Interrupts received while the
38536 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38537 it is resumed next time.
38538
38539 @node Notification Packets
38540 @section Notification Packets
38541 @cindex notification packets
38542 @cindex packets, notification
38543
38544 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38545 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38546 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38547 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38548 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38549 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38550 is not a problem.
38551
38552 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38553 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38554 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38555 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38556 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38557 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38558 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38559
38560 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38561 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38562
38563 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38564 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38565 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38566 not they understand it.
38567
38568 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38569 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38570 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38571 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38572 recipients.
38573
38574 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38575 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38576 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38577 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38578 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38579
38580 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38581 @table @samp
38582 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38583 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38584 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38585 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38586 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38587 @item @var{ack}
38588 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38589 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38590 @end table
38591
38592 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38593 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38594
38595 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38596 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38597 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38598 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38599 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38600 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38601 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38602 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38603 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38604 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38605
38606 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38607 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38608 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38609 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38610 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38611 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38612
38613 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38614 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38615 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38616 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38617 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38618
38619 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38620 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38621 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38622 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38623 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38624 normally.
38625
38626 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38627 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38628 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38629 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38630 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38631 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38632 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38633 the process shall be repeated.
38634
38635 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38636 following example:
38637 @smallexample
38638 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38639 @code{...}
38640 -> @code{vStopped}
38641 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38642 -> @code{vStopped}
38643 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38644 -> @code{vStopped}
38645 <- @code{OK}
38646 @end smallexample
38647
38648 The following notifications are defined:
38649 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38650
38651 @item Notification
38652 @tab Ack
38653 @tab Event
38654 @tab Description
38655
38656 @item Stop
38657 @tab vStopped
38658 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38659 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38660 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38661 @value{GDBN}.
38662 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38663
38664 @end multitable
38665
38666 @node Remote Non-Stop
38667 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38668
38669 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38670 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38671 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38672 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38673
38674 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38675 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38676 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38677 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38678 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38679 probe the target state after a mode change.
38680
38681 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38682 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38683 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38684 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38685 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38686 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38687 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38688 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38689 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38690 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38691 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38692
38693 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38694 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38695 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38696 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38697 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38698 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38699 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38700 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38701 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38702 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38703 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38704 @samp{OK}.
38705
38706 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38707 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38708 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38709 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38710 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38711 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38712 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38713 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38714 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38715 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38716 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38717 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38718 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38719
38720 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38721 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38722
38723 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38724 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38725 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38726 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38727 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38728 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38729 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38730
38731 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38732 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38733 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38734 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38735 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38736
38737 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38738 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38739 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38740 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38741
38742 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38743 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38744 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38745 @pxref{qSupported}.
38746 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38747 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38748 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38749 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38750 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38751 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38752 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38753
38754 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38755 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38756 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38757 connection.
38758 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38759 new connection is established,
38760 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38761 for the current connection, once disabled.
38762
38763 @node Examples
38764 @section Examples
38765
38766 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38767 does not get any direct output:
38768
38769 @smallexample
38770 -> @code{R00}
38771 <- @code{+}
38772 @emph{target restarts}
38773 -> @code{?}
38774 <- @code{+}
38775 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38776 -> @code{+}
38777 @end smallexample
38778
38779 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38780
38781 @smallexample
38782 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38783 <- @code{+}
38784 -> @code{s}
38785 <- @code{+}
38786 @emph{time passes}
38787 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38788 -> @code{+}
38789 -> @code{g}
38790 <- @code{+}
38791 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38792 -> @code{+}
38793 @end smallexample
38794
38795 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38796 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38797 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38798
38799 @menu
38800 * File-I/O Overview::
38801 * Protocol Basics::
38802 * The F Request Packet::
38803 * The F Reply Packet::
38804 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38805 * Console I/O::
38806 * List of Supported Calls::
38807 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38808 * Constants::
38809 * File-I/O Examples::
38810 @end menu
38811
38812 @node File-I/O Overview
38813 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38814 @cindex file-i/o overview
38815
38816 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38817 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38818 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38819 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38820 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38821 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38822
38823 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38824 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38825 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38826 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38827 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38828
38829 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38830 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38831 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38832 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38833 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38834 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38835 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38836
38837 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38838 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38839 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38840 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38841 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38842
38843 @smallexample
38844 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38845 <- target requests 'system call X'
38846 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38847 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38848 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38849 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38850 @end smallexample
38851
38852 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38853 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38854 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38855 system are not supported by this protocol.
38856
38857 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38858
38859 @node Protocol Basics
38860 @subsection Protocol Basics
38861 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38862
38863 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38864 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38865 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38866 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38867 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38868 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38869 to call the appropriate host system call:
38870
38871 @itemize @bullet
38872 @item
38873 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38874
38875 @item
38876 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38877 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38878 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38879 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38880
38881 @end itemize
38882
38883 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38884
38885 @itemize @bullet
38886 @item
38887 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38888 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38889 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38890 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38891 packet.
38892
38893 @item
38894 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38895 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38896
38897 @item
38898 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38899
38900 @item
38901 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38902
38903 @item
38904 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38905 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38906 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38907 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38908 packet.
38909
38910 @end itemize
38911
38912 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38913 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38914
38915 @itemize @bullet
38916 @item
38917 Return value.
38918
38919 @item
38920 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38921
38922 @item
38923 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38924
38925 @end itemize
38926
38927 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38928 the latest continue or step action.
38929
38930 @node The F Request Packet
38931 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38932 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38933 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38934
38935 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38936
38937 @table @samp
38938 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38939
38940 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38941 This is just the name of the function.
38942
38943 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38944 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38945 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38946 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38947 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38948 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38949 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38950
38951 @end table
38952
38953
38954
38955 @node The F Reply Packet
38956 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38957 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38958 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38959
38960 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38961
38962 @table @samp
38963
38964 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38965
38966 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38967
38968 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38969 representation.
38970 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38971
38972 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38973 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38974 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38975
38976 @smallexample
38977 F0,0,C
38978 @end smallexample
38979
38980 @noindent
38981 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38982
38983 @smallexample
38984 F-1,4,C
38985 @end smallexample
38986
38987 @noindent
38988 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38989
38990 @end table
38991
38992
38993 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38994 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38995 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38996
38997 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38998 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38999 the target should behave as if it had
39000 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39001 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39002 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39003 packet.
39004
39005 It's important for the target to know in which
39006 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39007
39008 @itemize @bullet
39009 @item
39010 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39011
39012 @item
39013 The system call on the host has been finished.
39014
39015 @end itemize
39016
39017 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39018 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39019 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39020 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39021 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39022 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39023
39024 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39025 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39026 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39027 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39028 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39029 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39030 or the full action has been completed.
39031
39032 @node Console I/O
39033 @subsection Console I/O
39034 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39035
39036 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39037 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39038 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39039 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39040 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39041 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39042 conditions is met:
39043
39044 @itemize @bullet
39045 @item
39046 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39047 @code{read}
39048 system call is treated as finished.
39049
39050 @item
39051 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39052 newline.
39053
39054 @item
39055 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39056 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39057
39058 @end itemize
39059
39060 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39061 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39062 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39063 is stopped at the user's request.
39064
39065
39066 @node List of Supported Calls
39067 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39068 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39069
39070 @menu
39071 * open::
39072 * close::
39073 * read::
39074 * write::
39075 * lseek::
39076 * rename::
39077 * unlink::
39078 * stat/fstat::
39079 * gettimeofday::
39080 * isatty::
39081 * system::
39082 @end menu
39083
39084 @node open
39085 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39086 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39087
39088 @table @asis
39089 @item Synopsis:
39090 @smallexample
39091 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39092 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39093 @end smallexample
39094
39095 @item Request:
39096 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39097
39098 @noindent
39099 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39100
39101 @table @code
39102 @item O_CREAT
39103 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39104 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39105 are concerned.
39106
39107 @item O_EXCL
39108 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39109 an error and open() fails.
39110
39111 @item O_TRUNC
39112 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39113 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39114 truncated to zero length.
39115
39116 @item O_APPEND
39117 The file is opened in append mode.
39118
39119 @item O_RDONLY
39120 The file is opened for reading only.
39121
39122 @item O_WRONLY
39123 The file is opened for writing only.
39124
39125 @item O_RDWR
39126 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39127 @end table
39128
39129 @noindent
39130 Other bits are silently ignored.
39131
39132
39133 @noindent
39134 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39135
39136 @table @code
39137 @item S_IRUSR
39138 User has read permission.
39139
39140 @item S_IWUSR
39141 User has write permission.
39142
39143 @item S_IRGRP
39144 Group has read permission.
39145
39146 @item S_IWGRP
39147 Group has write permission.
39148
39149 @item S_IROTH
39150 Others have read permission.
39151
39152 @item S_IWOTH
39153 Others have write permission.
39154 @end table
39155
39156 @noindent
39157 Other bits are silently ignored.
39158
39159
39160 @item Return value:
39161 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39162 occurred.
39163
39164 @item Errors:
39165
39166 @table @code
39167 @item EEXIST
39168 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39169
39170 @item EISDIR
39171 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39172
39173 @item EACCES
39174 The requested access is not allowed.
39175
39176 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39177 @var{pathname} was too long.
39178
39179 @item ENOENT
39180 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39181
39182 @item ENODEV
39183 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39184
39185 @item EROFS
39186 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39187 write access was requested.
39188
39189 @item EFAULT
39190 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39191
39192 @item ENOSPC
39193 No space on device to create the file.
39194
39195 @item EMFILE
39196 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39197
39198 @item ENFILE
39199 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39200 has been reached.
39201
39202 @item EINTR
39203 The call was interrupted by the user.
39204 @end table
39205
39206 @end table
39207
39208 @node close
39209 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39210 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39211
39212 @table @asis
39213 @item Synopsis:
39214 @smallexample
39215 int close(int fd);
39216 @end smallexample
39217
39218 @item Request:
39219 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39220
39221 @item Return value:
39222 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39223
39224 @item Errors:
39225
39226 @table @code
39227 @item EBADF
39228 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39229
39230 @item EINTR
39231 The call was interrupted by the user.
39232 @end table
39233
39234 @end table
39235
39236 @node read
39237 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39238 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39239
39240 @table @asis
39241 @item Synopsis:
39242 @smallexample
39243 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39244 @end smallexample
39245
39246 @item Request:
39247 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39248
39249 @item Return value:
39250 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39251 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39252 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39253
39254 @item Errors:
39255
39256 @table @code
39257 @item EBADF
39258 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39259 reading.
39260
39261 @item EFAULT
39262 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39263
39264 @item EINTR
39265 The call was interrupted by the user.
39266 @end table
39267
39268 @end table
39269
39270 @node write
39271 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39272 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39273
39274 @table @asis
39275 @item Synopsis:
39276 @smallexample
39277 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39278 @end smallexample
39279
39280 @item Request:
39281 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39282
39283 @item Return value:
39284 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39285 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39286 is returned.
39287
39288 @item Errors:
39289
39290 @table @code
39291 @item EBADF
39292 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39293 writing.
39294
39295 @item EFAULT
39296 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39297
39298 @item EFBIG
39299 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39300 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39301
39302 @item ENOSPC
39303 No space on device to write the data.
39304
39305 @item EINTR
39306 The call was interrupted by the user.
39307 @end table
39308
39309 @end table
39310
39311 @node lseek
39312 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39313 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39314
39315 @table @asis
39316 @item Synopsis:
39317 @smallexample
39318 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39319 @end smallexample
39320
39321 @item Request:
39322 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39323
39324 @var{flag} is one of:
39325
39326 @table @code
39327 @item SEEK_SET
39328 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39329
39330 @item SEEK_CUR
39331 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39332 bytes.
39333
39334 @item SEEK_END
39335 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39336 bytes.
39337 @end table
39338
39339 @item Return value:
39340 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39341 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39342 value of -1 is returned.
39343
39344 @item Errors:
39345
39346 @table @code
39347 @item EBADF
39348 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39349
39350 @item ESPIPE
39351 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39352
39353 @item EINVAL
39354 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39355
39356 @item EINTR
39357 The call was interrupted by the user.
39358 @end table
39359
39360 @end table
39361
39362 @node rename
39363 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39364 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39365
39366 @table @asis
39367 @item Synopsis:
39368 @smallexample
39369 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39370 @end smallexample
39371
39372 @item Request:
39373 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39374
39375 @item Return value:
39376 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39377
39378 @item Errors:
39379
39380 @table @code
39381 @item EISDIR
39382 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39383 directory.
39384
39385 @item EEXIST
39386 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39387
39388 @item EBUSY
39389 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39390 process.
39391
39392 @item EINVAL
39393 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39394 of itself.
39395
39396 @item ENOTDIR
39397 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39398 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39399 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39400
39401 @item EFAULT
39402 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39403
39404 @item EACCES
39405 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39406
39407 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39408
39409 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39410
39411 @item ENOENT
39412 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39413
39414 @item EROFS
39415 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39416
39417 @item ENOSPC
39418 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39419 directory entry.
39420
39421 @item EINTR
39422 The call was interrupted by the user.
39423 @end table
39424
39425 @end table
39426
39427 @node unlink
39428 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39429 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39430
39431 @table @asis
39432 @item Synopsis:
39433 @smallexample
39434 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39435 @end smallexample
39436
39437 @item Request:
39438 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39439
39440 @item Return value:
39441 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39442
39443 @item Errors:
39444
39445 @table @code
39446 @item EACCES
39447 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39448
39449 @item EPERM
39450 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39451
39452 @item EBUSY
39453 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39454 being used by another process.
39455
39456 @item EFAULT
39457 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39458
39459 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39460 @var{pathname} was too long.
39461
39462 @item ENOENT
39463 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39464
39465 @item ENOTDIR
39466 A component of the path is not a directory.
39467
39468 @item EROFS
39469 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39470
39471 @item EINTR
39472 The call was interrupted by the user.
39473 @end table
39474
39475 @end table
39476
39477 @node stat/fstat
39478 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39479 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39480 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39481
39482 @table @asis
39483 @item Synopsis:
39484 @smallexample
39485 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39486 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39487 @end smallexample
39488
39489 @item Request:
39490 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39491 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39492
39493 @item Return value:
39494 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39495
39496 @item Errors:
39497
39498 @table @code
39499 @item EBADF
39500 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39501
39502 @item ENOENT
39503 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39504 path is an empty string.
39505
39506 @item ENOTDIR
39507 A component of the path is not a directory.
39508
39509 @item EFAULT
39510 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39511
39512 @item EACCES
39513 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39514
39515 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39516 @var{pathname} was too long.
39517
39518 @item EINTR
39519 The call was interrupted by the user.
39520 @end table
39521
39522 @end table
39523
39524 @node gettimeofday
39525 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39526 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39527
39528 @table @asis
39529 @item Synopsis:
39530 @smallexample
39531 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39532 @end smallexample
39533
39534 @item Request:
39535 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39536
39537 @item Return value:
39538 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39539
39540 @item Errors:
39541
39542 @table @code
39543 @item EINVAL
39544 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39545
39546 @item EFAULT
39547 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39548 @end table
39549
39550 @end table
39551
39552 @node isatty
39553 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39554 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39555
39556 @table @asis
39557 @item Synopsis:
39558 @smallexample
39559 int isatty(int fd);
39560 @end smallexample
39561
39562 @item Request:
39563 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39564
39565 @item Return value:
39566 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39567
39568 @item Errors:
39569
39570 @table @code
39571 @item EINTR
39572 The call was interrupted by the user.
39573 @end table
39574
39575 @end table
39576
39577 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39578 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39579 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39580 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39581 needed.
39582
39583
39584 @node system
39585 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39586 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39587
39588 @table @asis
39589 @item Synopsis:
39590 @smallexample
39591 int system(const char *command);
39592 @end smallexample
39593
39594 @item Request:
39595 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39596
39597 @item Return value:
39598 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39599 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39600 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39601 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39602 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39603 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39604 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39605
39606 @item Errors:
39607
39608 @table @code
39609 @item EINTR
39610 The call was interrupted by the user.
39611 @end table
39612
39613 @end table
39614
39615 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39616 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39617 the host is simplified before it's returned
39618 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39619 is discarded, and the return value consists
39620 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39621
39622 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39623 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39624 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39625
39626 @table @code
39627 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39628 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39629 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39630 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39631
39632 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39633 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39634 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39635 protocol.
39636 @end table
39637
39638 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39639 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39640 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39641
39642 @menu
39643 * Integral Datatypes::
39644 * Pointer Values::
39645 * Memory Transfer::
39646 * struct stat::
39647 * struct timeval::
39648 @end menu
39649
39650 @node Integral Datatypes
39651 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39652 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39653
39654 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39655 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39656 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39657
39658 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39659 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39660
39661 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39662
39663 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39664 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39665
39666 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39667
39668 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39669 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39670 byte order.
39671
39672 @node Pointer Values
39673 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39674 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39675
39676 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39677 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39678 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39679 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39680
39681 @smallexample
39682 @code{1aaf/12}
39683 @end smallexample
39684
39685 @noindent
39686 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39687 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39688 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39689 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39690
39691 @smallexample
39692 @code{123456/d}
39693 @end smallexample
39694
39695 @node Memory Transfer
39696 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39697 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39698
39699 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39700 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39701 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39702 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39703 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39704 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39705 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39706
39707
39708 @node struct stat
39709 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39710 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39711
39712 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39713 is defined as follows:
39714
39715 @smallexample
39716 struct stat @{
39717 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39718 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39719 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39720 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39721 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39722 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39723 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39724 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39725 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39726 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39727 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39728 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39729 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39730 @};
39731 @end smallexample
39732
39733 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39734 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39735 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39736
39737 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39738 range of values.
39739
39740 @table @code
39741
39742 @item st_dev
39743 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39744
39745 @item st_ino
39746 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39747
39748 @item st_mode
39749 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39750 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39751
39752 @item st_uid
39753 @itemx st_gid
39754 @itemx st_rdev
39755 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39756
39757 @item st_atime
39758 @itemx st_mtime
39759 @itemx st_ctime
39760 These values have a host and file system dependent
39761 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39762 support exact timing values.
39763 @end table
39764
39765 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39766 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39767 continuing.
39768
39769 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39770 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39771 get truncated on the target.
39772
39773 @node struct timeval
39774 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39775 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39776
39777 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39778 is defined as follows:
39779
39780 @smallexample
39781 struct timeval @{
39782 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39783 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39784 @};
39785 @end smallexample
39786
39787 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39788 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39789 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39790
39791 @node Constants
39792 @subsection Constants
39793 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39794
39795 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39796 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39797 values before and after the call as needed.
39798
39799 @menu
39800 * Open Flags::
39801 * mode_t Values::
39802 * Errno Values::
39803 * Lseek Flags::
39804 * Limits::
39805 @end menu
39806
39807 @node Open Flags
39808 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39809 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39810
39811 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39812
39813 @smallexample
39814 O_RDONLY 0x0
39815 O_WRONLY 0x1
39816 O_RDWR 0x2
39817 O_APPEND 0x8
39818 O_CREAT 0x200
39819 O_TRUNC 0x400
39820 O_EXCL 0x800
39821 @end smallexample
39822
39823 @node mode_t Values
39824 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39825 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39826
39827 All values are given in octal representation.
39828
39829 @smallexample
39830 S_IFREG 0100000
39831 S_IFDIR 040000
39832 S_IRUSR 0400
39833 S_IWUSR 0200
39834 S_IXUSR 0100
39835 S_IRGRP 040
39836 S_IWGRP 020
39837 S_IXGRP 010
39838 S_IROTH 04
39839 S_IWOTH 02
39840 S_IXOTH 01
39841 @end smallexample
39842
39843 @node Errno Values
39844 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39845 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39846
39847 All values are given in decimal representation.
39848
39849 @smallexample
39850 EPERM 1
39851 ENOENT 2
39852 EINTR 4
39853 EBADF 9
39854 EACCES 13
39855 EFAULT 14
39856 EBUSY 16
39857 EEXIST 17
39858 ENODEV 19
39859 ENOTDIR 20
39860 EISDIR 21
39861 EINVAL 22
39862 ENFILE 23
39863 EMFILE 24
39864 EFBIG 27
39865 ENOSPC 28
39866 ESPIPE 29
39867 EROFS 30
39868 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39869 EUNKNOWN 9999
39870 @end smallexample
39871
39872 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39873 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39874
39875 @node Lseek Flags
39876 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39877 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39878
39879 @smallexample
39880 SEEK_SET 0
39881 SEEK_CUR 1
39882 SEEK_END 2
39883 @end smallexample
39884
39885 @node Limits
39886 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39887 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39888
39889 All values are given in decimal representation.
39890
39891 @smallexample
39892 INT_MIN -2147483648
39893 INT_MAX 2147483647
39894 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39895 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39896 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39897 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39898 @end smallexample
39899
39900 @node File-I/O Examples
39901 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39902 @cindex file-i/o examples
39903
39904 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39905 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39906
39907 @smallexample
39908 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39909 @emph{request memory read from target}
39910 -> @code{m1234,6}
39911 <- XXXXXX
39912 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39913 -> @code{F6}
39914 @end smallexample
39915
39916 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39917 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39918
39919 @smallexample
39920 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39921 @emph{request memory write to target}
39922 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39923 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39924 -> @code{F6}
39925 @end smallexample
39926
39927 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39928 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39929
39930 @smallexample
39931 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39932 -> @code{F-1,9}
39933 @end smallexample
39934
39935 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39936 host is called:
39937
39938 @smallexample
39939 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39940 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39941 <- @code{T02}
39942 @end smallexample
39943
39944 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39945 host is called:
39946
39947 @smallexample
39948 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39949 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39950 <- @code{T02}
39951 @end smallexample
39952
39953 @node Library List Format
39954 @section Library List Format
39955 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39956
39957 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39958 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39959 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39960 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39961 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39962 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39963 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39964 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39965 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39966 are loaded.
39967
39968 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39969 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39970 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39971 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39972
39973 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39974 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39975 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39976 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39977 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39978 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39979
39980 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39981 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39982
39983 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39984 offset, looks like this:
39985
39986 @smallexample
39987 <library-list>
39988 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39989 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39990 </library>
39991 </library-list>
39992 @end smallexample
39993
39994 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39995 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39996
39997 @smallexample
39998 <library-list>
39999 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40000 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40001 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40002 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40003 </library>
40004 </library-list>
40005 @end smallexample
40006
40007 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40008
40009 @smallexample
40010 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40011 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40012 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40013 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40014 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40015 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40016 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40017 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40018 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40019 @end smallexample
40020
40021 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40022 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40023 section for each library.
40024
40025 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40026 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40027 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40028
40029 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40030 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40031 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40032 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40033
40034 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40035 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40036 target, the following parameters are reported:
40037
40038 @itemize @minus
40039 @item
40040 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40041 @code{struct link_map}.
40042 @item
40043 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40044 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40045 @item
40046 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40047 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40048 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40049 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40050 @item
40051 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40052 @end itemize
40053
40054 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40055 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40056 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40057
40058 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40059 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40060
40061 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40062 looks like this:
40063
40064 @smallexample
40065 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40066 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40067 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40068 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40069 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40070 </library-list-svr>
40071 @end smallexample
40072
40073 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40074
40075 @smallexample
40076 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40077 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40078 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40079 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40080 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40081 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40082 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40083 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40084 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40085 @end smallexample
40086
40087 @node Memory Map Format
40088 @section Memory Map Format
40089 @cindex memory map format
40090
40091 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40092 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40093 memory map.
40094
40095 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40096 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40097 lists memory regions.
40098
40099 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40100 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40101
40102 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40103
40104 @smallexample
40105 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40106 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40107 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40108 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40109 <memory-map>
40110 region...
40111 </memory-map>
40112 @end smallexample
40113
40114 Each region can be either:
40115
40116 @itemize
40117
40118 @item
40119 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40120 bytes from there:
40121
40122 @smallexample
40123 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40124 @end smallexample
40125
40126
40127 @item
40128 A region of read-only memory:
40129
40130 @smallexample
40131 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40132 @end smallexample
40133
40134
40135 @item
40136 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40137 bytes in length:
40138
40139 @smallexample
40140 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40141 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40142 </memory>
40143 @end smallexample
40144
40145 @end itemize
40146
40147 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40148 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40149 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40150
40151 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40152
40153 @smallexample
40154 <!-- ................................................... -->
40155 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40156 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40157 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40158 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40159 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40160 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40161 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40162 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40163 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40164 and its type, or device. -->
40165 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40166 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40167 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40168 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40169 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40170 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40171 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40172 @end smallexample
40173
40174 @node Thread List Format
40175 @section Thread List Format
40176 @cindex thread list format
40177
40178 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40179 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40180 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40181 the following structure:
40182
40183 @smallexample
40184 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40185 <threads>
40186 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40187 ... description ...
40188 </thread>
40189 </threads>
40190 @end smallexample
40191
40192 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40193 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40194 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40195 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40196 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40197 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40198 auxiliary information.
40199
40200 @node Traceframe Info Format
40201 @section Traceframe Info Format
40202 @cindex traceframe info format
40203
40204 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40205 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40206 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40207 collected in a traceframe.
40208
40209 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40210 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40211
40212 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40213 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40214
40215 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40216
40217 @smallexample
40218 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40219 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40220 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40221 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40222 <traceframe-info>
40223 block...
40224 </traceframe-info>
40225 @end smallexample
40226
40227 Each traceframe block can be either:
40228
40229 @itemize
40230
40231 @item
40232 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40233 @var{length} bytes from there:
40234
40235 @smallexample
40236 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40237 @end smallexample
40238
40239 @item
40240 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40241 collected:
40242
40243 @smallexample
40244 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40245 @end smallexample
40246
40247 @end itemize
40248
40249 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40250
40251 @smallexample
40252 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40253 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40254
40255 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40256 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40257 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40258 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40259 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40260 @end smallexample
40261
40262 @node Branch Trace Format
40263 @section Branch Trace Format
40264 @cindex branch trace format
40265
40266 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40267 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40268 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40269 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40270
40271 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40272 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40273
40274 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40275 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40276
40277 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40278
40279 @smallexample
40280 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40281 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40282 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40283 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40284 <btrace>
40285 block...
40286 </btrace>
40287 @end smallexample
40288
40289 @itemize
40290
40291 @item
40292 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40293 and ending at @var{end}:
40294
40295 @smallexample
40296 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40297 @end smallexample
40298
40299 @end itemize
40300
40301 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40302
40303 @smallexample
40304 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40305 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40306
40307 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40308 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40309 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40310
40311 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40312
40313 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40314
40315 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40316 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40317 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40318 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40319 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40320
40321 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40322 @end smallexample
40323
40324 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40325 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40326 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40327
40328 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40329 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40330 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40331
40332 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40333 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40334
40335 @table @code
40336 @item bts
40337 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40338 @table @code
40339 @item size
40340 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40341 @end table
40342 @item pt
40343 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40344 PT}) format.
40345 @table @code
40346 @item size
40347 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40348 @end table
40349 @end table
40350
40351 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40352 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40353
40354 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40355
40356 @smallexample
40357 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40358 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40359
40360 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40361 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40362
40363 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40364 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40365 @end smallexample
40366
40367 @include agentexpr.texi
40368
40369 @node Target Descriptions
40370 @appendix Target Descriptions
40371 @cindex target descriptions
40372
40373 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40374 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40375 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40376 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40377 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40378 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40379 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40380
40381 @itemize @bullet
40382 @item
40383 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40384 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40385 @item
40386 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40387 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40388 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40389 @item
40390 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40391 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40392 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40393 @end itemize
40394
40395 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40396 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40397 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40398 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40399 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40400
40401 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40402 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40403
40404 @menu
40405 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40406 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40407 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40408 descriptions.
40409 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40410 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40411 @end menu
40412
40413 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40414 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40415
40416 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40417 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40418 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40419 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40420 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40421 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40422 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40423 Format}.
40424
40425 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40426 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40427 specify a file are:
40428
40429 @table @code
40430 @cindex set tdesc filename
40431 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40432 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40433
40434 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40435 @item unset tdesc filename
40436 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40437 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40438
40439 @cindex show tdesc filename
40440 @item show tdesc filename
40441 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40442 @end table
40443
40444
40445 @node Target Description Format
40446 @section Target Description Format
40447 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40448
40449 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40450 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40451 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40452 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40453 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40454 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40455 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40456
40457 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40458 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40459 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40460 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40461 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40462
40463 Here is a simple target description:
40464
40465 @smallexample
40466 <target version="1.0">
40467 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40468 </target>
40469 @end smallexample
40470
40471 @noindent
40472 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40473 the x86-64 architecture.
40474
40475 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40476 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40477 are explained further below.
40478
40479 @smallexample
40480 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40481 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40482 <target version="1.0">
40483 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40484 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40485 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40486 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40487 </target>
40488 @end smallexample
40489
40490 @noindent
40491 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40492 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40493 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40494 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40495 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40496 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40497 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40498 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40499 the version mismatch.
40500
40501 @subsection Inclusion
40502 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40503 @cindex XInclude
40504 @ifnotinfo
40505 @cindex <xi:include>
40506 @end ifnotinfo
40507
40508 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40509 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40510 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40511 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40512 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40513
40514 @smallexample
40515 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40516 @end smallexample
40517
40518 @noindent
40519 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40520 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40521 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40522 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40523 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40524 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40525 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40526 original description.
40527
40528 @subsection Architecture
40529 @cindex <architecture>
40530
40531 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40532
40533 @smallexample
40534 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40535 @end smallexample
40536
40537 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40538 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40539
40540 @subsection OS ABI
40541 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40542
40543 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40544 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40545
40546 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40547
40548 @smallexample
40549 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40550 @end smallexample
40551
40552 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40553 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40554
40555 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40556 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40557
40558 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40559 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40560
40561 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40562
40563 @smallexample
40564 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40565 @end smallexample
40566
40567 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40568 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40569
40570 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40571 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40572 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40573 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40574 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40575 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40576 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40577
40578 @smallexample
40579 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40580 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40581 @end smallexample
40582
40583 @subsection Features
40584 @cindex <feature>
40585
40586 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40587 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40588 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40589 has this form:
40590
40591 @smallexample
40592 <feature name="@var{name}">
40593 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40594 @var{reg}@dots{}
40595 </feature>
40596 @end smallexample
40597
40598 @noindent
40599 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40600 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40601 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40602 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40603
40604 @subsection Types
40605
40606 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40607 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40608 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40609 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40610 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40611 and enum types.
40612
40613 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40614 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40615 Types must be defined before they are used.
40616
40617 @cindex <vector>
40618 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40619 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40620 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40621 @var{count}:
40622
40623 @smallexample
40624 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40625 @end smallexample
40626
40627 @cindex <union>
40628 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40629 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40630 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40631 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40632
40633 @smallexample
40634 <union id="@var{id}">
40635 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40636 @dots{}
40637 </union>
40638 @end smallexample
40639
40640 @cindex <struct>
40641 @cindex <flags>
40642 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40643 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40644 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40645 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40646 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40647 specified.
40648
40649 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40650
40651 @smallexample
40652 <struct id="@var{id}">
40653 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40654 @dots{}
40655 </struct>
40656 @end smallexample
40657
40658 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40659 No implicit padding is added.
40660
40661 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40662
40663 @smallexample
40664 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40665 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40666 @dots{}
40667 </struct>
40668 @end smallexample
40669
40670 @smallexample
40671 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40672 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40673 @dots{}
40674 </flags>
40675 @end smallexample
40676
40677 The @var{name} value is required.
40678 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40679 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40680 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40681
40682 The @var{start} value is required, and @var{end} and @var{type}
40683 are optional.
40684 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40685 and zero represents the least significant bit.
40686 The default value of @var{end} is @var{start}, a single bit field.
40687
40688 The default value of @var{type} depends on whether the
40689 @var{end} was specified. If @var{end} is specified then the default
40690 value of @var{type} is an unsigned integer. If @var{end} is unspecified
40691 then the default value of @var{type} is @code{bool}.
40692
40693 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
40694
40695 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40696 defining them with @samp{struct}:
40697
40698 @itemize @bullet
40699 @item
40700 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40701 @item
40702 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40703 @end itemize
40704
40705 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40706 defining them with @samp{flags}:
40707
40708 @itemize @bullet
40709 @item
40710 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40711
40712 @smallexample
40713 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40714 $1 = 42
40715 @end smallexample
40716
40717 @end itemize
40718
40719 @subsection Registers
40720 @cindex <reg>
40721
40722 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40723
40724 @smallexample
40725 <reg name="@var{name}"
40726 bitsize="@var{size}"
40727 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40728 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40729 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40730 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40731 @end smallexample
40732
40733 @noindent
40734 The components are as follows:
40735
40736 @table @var
40737
40738 @item name
40739 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40740
40741 @item bitsize
40742 The register's size, in bits.
40743
40744 @item regnum
40745 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40746 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40747 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40748 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40749 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40750 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40751 in order of increasing register number.
40752
40753 @item save-restore
40754 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40755 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40756 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40757 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40758 ABI.
40759
40760 @item type
40761 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40762 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40763 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40764 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40765 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40766 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40767
40768 @item group
40769 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40770 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40771 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40772 in @code{info registers}.
40773
40774 @end table
40775
40776 @node Predefined Target Types
40777 @section Predefined Target Types
40778 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40779
40780 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40781 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40782 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40783 types. The currently supported types are:
40784
40785 @table @code
40786
40787 @item bool
40788 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40789
40790 @item int8
40791 @itemx int16
40792 @itemx int32
40793 @itemx int64
40794 @itemx int128
40795 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40796
40797 @item uint8
40798 @itemx uint16
40799 @itemx uint32
40800 @itemx uint64
40801 @itemx uint128
40802 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40803
40804 @item code_ptr
40805 @itemx data_ptr
40806 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40807 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40808 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40809 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40810 may be marked as data pointers.
40811
40812 @item ieee_single
40813 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40814
40815 @item ieee_double
40816 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40817
40818 @item arm_fpa_ext
40819 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40820
40821 @item i387_ext
40822 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40823
40824 @item i386_eflags
40825 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40826
40827 @item i386_mxcsr
40828 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40829
40830 @end table
40831
40832 @node Enum Target Types
40833 @section Enum Target Types
40834 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
40835
40836 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
40837 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
40838
40839 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
40840
40841 @smallexample
40842 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40843 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
40844 @dots{}
40845 </enum>
40846 @end smallexample
40847
40848 Enums must be defined before they are used.
40849
40850 @smallexample
40851 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
40852 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
40853 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
40854 </enum>
40855 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
40856 <field name="X" start="0"/>
40857 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
40858 </flags>
40859 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
40860 @end smallexample
40861
40862 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
40863 would be printed as:
40864
40865 @smallexample
40866 (gdb) info register flags
40867 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
40868 @end smallexample
40869
40870 @node Standard Target Features
40871 @section Standard Target Features
40872 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40873
40874 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40875 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40876 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40877 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40878 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40879 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40880 can recognize them.
40881
40882 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40883 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40884 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40885 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40886 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40887 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40888 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40889 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40890
40891 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40892 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40893 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40894
40895 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40896 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40897 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40898 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40899
40900 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40901 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40902 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40903
40904 @menu
40905 * AArch64 Features::
40906 * ARM Features::
40907 * i386 Features::
40908 * MicroBlaze Features::
40909 * MIPS Features::
40910 * M68K Features::
40911 * NDS32 Features::
40912 * Nios II Features::
40913 * PowerPC Features::
40914 * S/390 and System z Features::
40915 * TIC6x Features::
40916 @end menu
40917
40918
40919 @node AArch64 Features
40920 @subsection AArch64 Features
40921 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40922
40923 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40924 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40925 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40926
40927 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40928 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40929 and @samp{fpcr}.
40930
40931 @node ARM Features
40932 @subsection ARM Features
40933 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40934
40935 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40936 ARM targets.
40937 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40938 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40939
40940 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40941 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40942 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40943 and @samp{xpsr}.
40944
40945 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40946 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40947
40948 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40949 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40950 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40951 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40952
40953 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40954 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40955 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40956 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40957 halves of the double-precision registers.
40958
40959 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40960 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40961 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40962 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40963 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40964 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40965
40966 @node i386 Features
40967 @subsection i386 Features
40968 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40969
40970 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40971 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40972
40973 @itemize @minus
40974 @item
40975 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40976 @item
40977 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40978 @item
40979 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40980 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40981 @item
40982 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40983 @item
40984 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40985 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40986 @end itemize
40987
40988 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40989
40990 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40991 describe registers:
40992
40993 @itemize @minus
40994 @item
40995 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40996 @item
40997 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40998 @item
40999 @samp{mxcsr}
41000 @end itemize
41001
41002 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41003 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41004 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41005
41006 @itemize @minus
41007 @item
41008 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41009 @item
41010 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41011 @end itemize
41012
41013 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41014 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41015
41016 @itemize @minus
41017 @item
41018 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41019 @item
41020 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41021 @end itemize
41022
41023 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41024 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41025
41026 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41027 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41028 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41029
41030 @itemize @minus
41031 @item
41032 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41033 @end itemize
41034
41035 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41036
41037 @itemize @minus
41038 @item
41039 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41040 @end itemize
41041
41042 It should
41043 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41044
41045 @itemize @minus
41046 @item
41047 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41048 @item
41049 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41050 @end itemize
41051
41052 It should
41053 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41054
41055 @itemize @minus
41056 @item
41057 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41058 @end itemize
41059
41060 @node MicroBlaze Features
41061 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41062 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41063
41064 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41065 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41066 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41067 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41068 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41069
41070 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41071 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41072
41073 @node MIPS Features
41074 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41075 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41076
41077 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41078 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41079 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41080 on the target.
41081
41082 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41083 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41084 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41085
41086 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41087 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41088 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41089 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41090
41091 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41092 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41093 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41094 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41095
41096 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41097 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41098 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41099
41100 @node M68K Features
41101 @subsection M68K Features
41102 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41103
41104 @table @code
41105 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41106 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41107 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41108 One of those features must be always present.
41109 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41110 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41111 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41112 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41113
41114 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41115 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41116 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41117 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41118 @end table
41119
41120 @node NDS32 Features
41121 @subsection NDS32 Features
41122 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41123
41124 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41125 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41126 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41127 and @samp{pc}.
41128
41129 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41130 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41131 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41132 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41133
41134 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41135 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41136 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41137 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41138 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41139 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41140 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41141
41142 @node Nios II Features
41143 @subsection Nios II Features
41144 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41145
41146 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41147 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41148 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41149 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41150 @samp{mpuacc}).
41151
41152 @node PowerPC Features
41153 @subsection PowerPC Features
41154 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41155
41156 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41157 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41158 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41159 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41160
41161 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41162 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41163
41164 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41165 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41166 and @samp{vrsave}.
41167
41168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41169 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41170 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41171 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41172 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41173 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41174
41175 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41176 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41177 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41178 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41179 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41180 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41181 user.
41182
41183 @node S/390 and System z Features
41184 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41185 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41186 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41187
41188 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41189 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41190 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41191 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41192 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41193 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41194 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41195 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41196 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41197
41198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41199 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41200 @samp{fpc}.
41201
41202 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41203 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41204
41205 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41206 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41207 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41208 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41209 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41210 32-bit wide.
41211
41212 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41213 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41214 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41215
41216 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41217 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41218 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41219 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41220 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41221 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41222 @samp{v31}.
41223
41224 @node TIC6x Features
41225 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41226 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41227 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41228 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41229 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41230 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41231
41232 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41233 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41234 through @samp{B31}.
41235
41236 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41237 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41238
41239 @node Operating System Information
41240 @appendix Operating System Information
41241 @cindex operating system information
41242
41243 @menu
41244 * Process list::
41245 @end menu
41246
41247 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41248 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41249 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41250 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41251 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41252 on a different aspect of target.
41253
41254 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41255 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41256 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41257 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41258
41259 @node Process list
41260 @appendixsection Process list
41261 @cindex operating system information, process list
41262
41263 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41264 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41265 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41266 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41267
41268 An example document is:
41269
41270 @smallexample
41271 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41272 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41273 <osdata type="processes">
41274 <item>
41275 <column name="pid">1</column>
41276 <column name="user">root</column>
41277 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41278 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41279 </item>
41280 </osdata>
41281 @end smallexample
41282
41283 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41284 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41285 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41286 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41287 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41288 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41289 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41290
41291 @node Trace File Format
41292 @appendix Trace File Format
41293 @cindex trace file format
41294
41295 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41296 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41297
41298 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41299 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41300 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41301 in the future.
41302
41303 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41304 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41305 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41306 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41307 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41308 of this section.
41309
41310 @table @code
41311 @item R @var{size}
41312 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41313 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41314 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41315 a single trace file.
41316
41317 @item status @var{status}
41318 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41319 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41320 file.
41321
41322 @item tp @var{payload}
41323 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41324 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41325 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41326 reply packets.
41327
41328 @item tsv @var{payload}
41329 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41330 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41331 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41332 reply packets.
41333
41334 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41335 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41336 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41337 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41338 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41339 file. Includes are not allowed.
41340
41341 @end table
41342
41343 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41344 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41345 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41346 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41347 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41348 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41349 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41350 endianness.
41351
41352 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41353
41354 @table @code
41355 @item R @var{bytes}
41356 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41357 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41358 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41359
41360 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41361 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41362 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41363 @var{length} bytes.
41364
41365 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41366 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41367 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41368
41369 @end table
41370
41371 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41372 of blocks.
41373
41374 @node Index Section Format
41375 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41376 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41377 @cindex index section format
41378
41379 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41380 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41381 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41382 description.
41383
41384 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41385 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41386 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41387 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41388 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41389 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41390
41391 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41392
41393 @enumerate
41394 @item
41395 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41396 unless otherwise noted:
41397
41398 @enumerate
41399 @item
41400 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41401 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41402 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41403 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41404 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41405 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41406 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41407
41408 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41409 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41410 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41411 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41412
41413 @item
41414 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41415
41416 @item
41417 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41418 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41419 to the next offset.
41420
41421 @item
41422 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41423
41424 @item
41425 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41426
41427 @item
41428 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41429 @end enumerate
41430
41431 @item
41432 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41433 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41434 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41435 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41436 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41437 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41438 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41439 CU indices.
41440
41441 @item
41442 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41443 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41444 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41445 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41446
41447 @item
41448 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41449 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41450
41451 @enumerate
41452 @item
41453 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41454
41455 @item
41456 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41457 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41458
41459 @item
41460 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41461 @end enumerate
41462
41463 @item
41464 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41465 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41466
41467 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41468 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41469 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41470 constant pool.
41471
41472 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41473 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41474 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41475
41476 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41477 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41478 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41479 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41480 index version:
41481
41482 @table @asis
41483 @item Version 4
41484 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41485
41486 @item Versions 5 to 7
41487 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41488 @end table
41489
41490 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41491
41492 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41493 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41494 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41495 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41496 collision.
41497
41498 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41499 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41500 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41501 the code.
41502
41503 @item
41504 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41505 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41506 strings.
41507
41508 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41509 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41510 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41511 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41512 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41513 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41514
41515 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41516 @end enumerate
41517
41518 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41519 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41520 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41521
41522 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41523 (bit 0 = LSB):
41524
41525 @table @asis
41526
41527 @item Bits 0-23
41528 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41529 @item Bits 24-27
41530 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41531 @item Bits 28-30
41532 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41533
41534 @table @asis
41535 @item 0
41536 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41537 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41538 with previous versions of the index.
41539 @item 1
41540 The symbol is a type.
41541 @item 2
41542 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41543 @item 3
41544 The symbol is a function.
41545 @item 4
41546 Any other kind of symbol.
41547 @item 5,6,7
41548 These values are reserved.
41549 @end table
41550
41551 @item Bit 31
41552 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41553
41554 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41555 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41556 @value{GDBN} sources.
41557
41558 @end table
41559
41560 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41561 global/static attributes in the index.
41562
41563 @smallexample
41564 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41565 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41566 switch (die->tag)
41567 @{
41568 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41569 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41570 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41571 kind = TYPE;
41572 is_static = 1;
41573 break;
41574 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41575 kind = VARIABLE;
41576 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41577 break;
41578 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41579 kind = FUNCTION;
41580 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41581 break;
41582 case DW_TAG_constant:
41583 kind = VARIABLE;
41584 is_static = ! is_external;
41585 break;
41586 case DW_TAG_variable:
41587 kind = VARIABLE;
41588 is_static = ! is_external;
41589 break;
41590 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41591 kind = TYPE;
41592 is_static = 0;
41593 break;
41594 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41595 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41596 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41597 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41598 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41599 kind = TYPE;
41600 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41601 break;
41602 default:
41603 assert (0);
41604 @}
41605 @end smallexample
41606
41607 @node Man Pages
41608 @appendix Manual pages
41609 @cindex Man pages
41610
41611 @menu
41612 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41613 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41614 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41615 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41616 @end menu
41617
41618 @node gdb man
41619 @heading gdb man
41620
41621 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41622
41623 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41624 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41625 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41626 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41627 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41628 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41629 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41630 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41631 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41632 @c man end
41633
41634 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41635 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41636 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41637 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41638
41639 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41640 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41641
41642 @itemize @bullet
41643 @item
41644 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41645
41646 @item
41647 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41648
41649 @item
41650 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41651
41652 @item
41653 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41654 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41655 @end itemize
41656
41657 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41658 Modula-2.
41659
41660 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41661 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41662 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41663 by using the command @code{help}.
41664
41665 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41666 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41667 executable program as the argument:
41668
41669 @smallexample
41670 gdb program
41671 @end smallexample
41672
41673 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41674
41675 @smallexample
41676 gdb program core
41677 @end smallexample
41678
41679 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41680 to debug a running process:
41681
41682 @smallexample
41683 gdb program 1234
41684 gdb -p 1234
41685 @end smallexample
41686
41687 @noindent
41688 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41689 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41690 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41691
41692 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41693
41694 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41695 @table @env
41696 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41697 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41698
41699 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41700 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41701
41702 @item bt
41703 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41704
41705 @item print @var{expr}
41706 Display the value of an expression.
41707
41708 @item c
41709 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41710
41711 @item next
41712 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41713 function calls in the line.
41714
41715 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41716 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41717
41718 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41719 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41720
41721 @item step
41722 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41723 function calls in the line.
41724
41725 @item help [@var{name}]
41726 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41727 about using @value{GDBN}.
41728
41729 @item quit
41730 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41731 @end table
41732
41733 @ifset man
41734 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41735 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41736 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41737 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41738 @end ifset
41739 @c man end
41740
41741 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41742 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41743 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41744 encountered with no
41745 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41746 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41747 Many options have
41748 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41749 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41750 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41751 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41752 more usual convention.)
41753
41754 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41755 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41756 option is used.
41757
41758 @table @env
41759 @item -help
41760 @itemx -h
41761 List all options, with brief explanations.
41762
41763 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41764 @itemx -s @var{file}
41765 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41766
41767 @item -write
41768 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41769
41770 @item -exec=@var{file}
41771 @itemx -e @var{file}
41772 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41773 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41774 dump.
41775
41776 @item -se=@var{file}
41777 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41778 file.
41779
41780 @item -core=@var{file}
41781 @itemx -c @var{file}
41782 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41783
41784 @item -command=@var{file}
41785 @itemx -x @var{file}
41786 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41787
41788 @item -ex @var{command}
41789 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41790
41791 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41792 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41793 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41794
41795 @item -nh
41796 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41797
41798 @item -nx
41799 @itemx -n
41800 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41801
41802 @item -quiet
41803 @itemx -q
41804 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41805 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41806
41807 @item -batch
41808 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41809 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41810 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41811 commands in the command files.
41812
41813 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41814 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41815 more useful, the message
41816
41817 @smallexample
41818 Program exited normally.
41819 @end smallexample
41820
41821 @noindent
41822 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41823 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41824
41825 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41826 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41827 instead of the current directory.
41828
41829 @item -fullname
41830 @itemx -f
41831 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41832 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41833 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41834 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41835 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41836 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41837 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41838 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41839
41840 @item -b @var{bps}
41841 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41842 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41843
41844 @item -tty=@var{device}
41845 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41846 @end table
41847 @c man end
41848
41849 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41850 @ifset man
41851 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41852 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41853 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41854
41855 @smallexample
41856 info gdb
41857 @end smallexample
41858
41859 @noindent
41860 should give you access to the complete manual.
41861
41862 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41863 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41864 @end ifset
41865 @c man end
41866
41867 @node gdbserver man
41868 @heading gdbserver man
41869
41870 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41871 @format
41872 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41873 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41874
41875 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41876
41877 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41878 @c man end
41879 @end format
41880
41881 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41882 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41883 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41884
41885 @ifclear man
41886 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41887 @end ifclear
41888 @ifset man
41889 Usage (server (target) side):
41890 @end ifset
41891
41892 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41893 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41894 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41895 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41896
41897 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41898 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41899 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41900
41901 @smallexample
41902 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41903 @end smallexample
41904
41905 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41906
41907 @smallexample
41908 @ifset man
41909 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41910 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41911 @end ifset
41912 @ifclear man
41913 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41914 @end ifclear
41915 @end smallexample
41916
41917 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41918 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41919 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41920
41921 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41922
41923 @smallexample
41924 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41925 @end smallexample
41926
41927 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41928 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41929 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41930 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41931 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41932 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41933 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41934 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41935 print an error message and exit.
41936
41937 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41938 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41939
41940 @smallexample
41941 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41942 @end smallexample
41943
41944 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41945 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41946
41947 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41948 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41949 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41950 the program you want to debug.
41951
41952 @smallexample
41953 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41954 @end smallexample
41955
41956 @ifclear man
41957 @subheading Usage (host side)
41958 @end ifclear
41959 @ifset man
41960 Usage (host side):
41961 @end ifset
41962
41963 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41964 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41965 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41966 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41967 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41968 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41969 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41970 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41971 descriptor. For example:
41972
41973 @smallexample
41974 @ifset man
41975 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41976 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41977 @end ifset
41978 @ifclear man
41979 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41980 @end ifclear
41981 @end smallexample
41982
41983 @noindent
41984 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41985
41986 @smallexample
41987 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41988 @end smallexample
41989
41990 @noindent
41991 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41992 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41993 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41994 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41995 `Connection refused'.
41996
41997 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41998 described in
41999 @ifset man
42000 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42001 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42002 @end ifset
42003 @ifclear man
42004 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42005 @end ifclear
42006 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42007
42008 @smallexample
42009 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42010 @end smallexample
42011
42012 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42013 case.
42014 @c man end
42015
42016 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42017 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42018
42019 @itemize @bullet
42020
42021 @item
42022 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42023
42024 @smallexample
42025 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42026 @end smallexample
42027
42028 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42029 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42030 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42031 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42032 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42033 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42034 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42035
42036 @item
42037 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42038 program:
42039
42040 @smallexample
42041 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42042 @end smallexample
42043
42044 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42045 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42046 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42047 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42048
42049 @item
42050 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42051
42052 @smallexample
42053 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42054 @end smallexample
42055
42056 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42057 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42058 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42059 debug several processes in the same session.
42060 @end itemize
42061
42062 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42063
42064 @table @env
42065
42066 @item --help
42067 List all options, with brief explanations.
42068
42069 @item --version
42070 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42071
42072 @item --attach
42073 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42074
42075 @smallexample
42076 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42077 @end smallexample
42078
42079 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42080 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42081
42082 @item --multi
42083 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42084 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42085 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42086 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42087
42088 @smallexample
42089 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42090 @end smallexample
42091
42092 @item --debug
42093 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42094 process.
42095 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42096 the developers.
42097
42098 @item --remote-debug
42099 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42100 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42101 the developers.
42102
42103 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42104 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42105 of debugging output.
42106 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42107
42108 @item --wrapper
42109 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42110 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42111 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42112 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42113
42114 @item --once
42115 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42116 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42117 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42118 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42119
42120 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42121
42122 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42123 @c QDisableRandomization.
42124
42125 @end table
42126 @c man end
42127
42128 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42129 @ifset man
42130 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42131 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42132 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42133
42134 @smallexample
42135 info gdb
42136 @end smallexample
42137
42138 should give you access to the complete manual.
42139
42140 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42141 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42142 @end ifset
42143 @c man end
42144
42145 @node gcore man
42146 @heading gcore
42147
42148 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42149
42150 @format
42151 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42152 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42153 @c man end
42154 @end format
42155
42156 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42157 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42158 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42159 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42160 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42161 running without any change.
42162 @c man end
42163
42164 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42165 @table @env
42166 @item -o @var{filename}
42167 The optional argument
42168 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42169 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42170 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42171 @end table
42172 @c man end
42173
42174 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42175 @ifset man
42176 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42177 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42178 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42179
42180 @smallexample
42181 info gdb
42182 @end smallexample
42183
42184 @noindent
42185 should give you access to the complete manual.
42186
42187 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42188 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42189 @end ifset
42190 @c man end
42191
42192 @node gdbinit man
42193 @heading gdbinit
42194
42195 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42196
42197 @format
42198 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42199 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42200 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42201 @end ifset
42202
42203 ~/.gdbinit
42204
42205 ./.gdbinit
42206 @c man end
42207 @end format
42208
42209 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42210 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42211 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42212 described in
42213 @ifset man
42214 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42215 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42216 @end ifset
42217 @ifclear man
42218 @ref{Sequences}.
42219 @end ifclear
42220
42221 Please read more in
42222 @ifset man
42223 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42224 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42225 @end ifset
42226 @ifclear man
42227 @ref{Startup}.
42228 @end ifclear
42229
42230 @table @env
42231 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42232 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42233 @end ifset
42234 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42235 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42236 @end ifclear
42237 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42238 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42239 See more in
42240 @ifset man
42241 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42242 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42243 @end ifset
42244 @ifclear man
42245 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42246 @end ifclear
42247
42248 @item ~/.gdbinit
42249 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42250 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42251
42252 @item ./.gdbinit
42253 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42254 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42255 See more in
42256 @ifset man
42257 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42258 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42259 @end ifset
42260 @ifclear man
42261 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42262 @end ifclear
42263 @end table
42264 @c man end
42265
42266 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42267 @ifset man
42268 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42269
42270 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42271 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42272 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42273
42274 @smallexample
42275 info gdb
42276 @end smallexample
42277
42278 should give you access to the complete manual.
42279
42280 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42281 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42282 @end ifset
42283 @c man end
42284
42285 @include gpl.texi
42286
42287 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42288 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42289 @include fdl.texi
42290
42291 @node Concept Index
42292 @unnumbered Concept Index
42293
42294 @printindex cp
42295
42296 @node Command and Variable Index
42297 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42298
42299 @printindex fn
42300
42301 @tex
42302 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42303 % meantime:
42304 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42305 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42306 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42307 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42308 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42309 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42310 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42311 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42312 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42313 \page\colophon
42314 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42315 @end tex
42316
42317 @bye